Manual ProConcrete
Manual ProConcrete
Professional
November 2008
Bentley Systems
Page I
No part of this manual may be reproduced or copied and distributed by any form of electronic means (copy, microfilm, etc.) without written permission of Bentley Systems. Bentley Systems does not guarantee, either explicitly or implicitly, the suitability for sale or the capability for particular applications of these materials which are supplied only in the existing form. Bentley Systems does not assume any liability for collateral, accidental or indirect damages arising from the purchase and the application of these materials. Where a liability is assumed by Bentley Systems, such liability is limited to the purchase price of the materials described herein. Bentley Systems reserves the right to revise or to modify this product at their own discretion. This users guide describes the product at the time of publication. This description may not be applicable to future versions of this product. Please note: all indicated trade names are registered trade marks of the companies concerned. Content (responsible persons) Illustrations and Layout J. Friedrich / C.Trinkner / G.Griesing C. Trinkner
Page II
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
A
A.1
INTRODUCTION
Introduction
General information System Requirements A.1.1 A.1.2
1
1
1 3
A.2 A.3
A.3.1 A.3.2 A.3.3 A.3.4 A.3.5
1 1
1 4 9 10 11
A.4
A.4.1 A.4.2 A.4.3
Input Options
Input Options in Input Fields Input Options at Object Selection Special Key-Commands
1
1 2 3
A.5
A.5.1
Project Manager
Working with Projects
1
2
A.1
Global Settings
B
B.1 B.2
1
1 1
1 6
B.2.1 B.2.2
B.3
B.3.1 B.3.2 B.3.3 B.3.4 B.3.5
3D Object Views
Object View / Object-UCS Surface View / Surface-UCS Global View Top View Free View
1
1 3 4 5 6
Page III
B.4
B.4.1 B.4.2 B.4.3 B.4.4 B.4.5 B.4.6 B.4.7
1
2 3 4 5 7 9 10
B.5
B.5.1 B.5.2 B.5.3 B.5.4 B.5.5 B.5.6 B.5.7
1
1 3 4 6 7 11 13
B.6
B.6.1 B.6.2 B.6.3 B.6.4 B.6.5 B.6.6 B.6.7 B.6.8 B.6.9
Work Frames
Rectangular Work Frame Cylindrical Work Frame Wedge-Shaped Work Frame Pyramidal Work Frame Create Views Axes Names Additional Axes (Border Lines) Options User-defined Blocks
1
2 6 7 8 9 11 14 15 17
B.7 B.8
B.8.1 B.8.2 B.8.3 B.8.4 B.8.5 B.8.6 B.8.7
1 1
2 8 9 11 13 15 17
B.9
B.9.1 B.9.2 Page IV
Insert Plates
Flat Straight Plates Flat Bent Plates
1
1 6
Table of Contents B.9.3 B.9.4 B.9.5 Gratings Bent Plates Additional Settings 7 8 13
B.10 B.11
1 1
2 12 15 17 19 21 29
B.12
Plate Editor
Boolean Operations Chamfer / Rounding Off Edge Processing
1
2 4 6
B.13
1
2 6 8 10
B.14
Bolts
Bolting parts Bolt Style Management Sort
1
2 4 13
B.15 B.16
1 1
2 15 18
1 1 1
Page V
Table of Contents
1 1 1 1
2 6 9 12
B.24
Static Bracing
Settings Creation of Bracing Parts
1
2 6
B.24.1 B.24.2
1 1 1
1 3 7 11
B.28
Positioning
Automatic Positioning Manual Insertion Automatic Insertion (Distribution) Other Auxiliary Commands Add Drawing Number Depiction of Position Flags Management of Styles
1
2 14 18 25 27 28 32
B.29 B.30
1 1
2 5
B.30.1 B.30.2
B.31
1
1 4
B.31.1 B.31.2
Page VI
Table of Contents B.31.3 B.31.4 Management of Parts List Styles Processing the Content of Parts List 10 11
B.32
Containment List
Creation of Containment List Processing of List Styles Processing the Content of Drawing Containment List
1
1 3 9
C
C.1
DETAILING
DetailCenter
The 2D-Detailing Detailing with the DetailCenter General Information Scale and Dimension Styles General Information - Detail Types General Information Group Structure Intelligent 2D-Details Display of Construction Component Lists Component Overview Views Overview Detail Block Overview (Insert) Global Settings Automatic Translation Transfer Drawing Paths Drawing Verification Direct Detailing Modification Management Replace Detail Blocks C.1.1 C.1.2 C.1.3 C.1.4 C.1.5 C.1.6 C.1.7 C.1.8 C.1.9 C.1.10 C.1.11 C.1.12 C.1.13 C.1.14 C.1.15 C.1.16 C.1.17
1
1
1 3 9 11 16 20 22 30 43 52 58 64 67 69 74 76 86
C.2
C.2.1 C.2.2 C.2.3 C.2.4 C.2.4 C.2.5 C.2.6 C.2.7
Detailing Style
Working with Detailing Styles General Info Global Settings 2D-Display 2D-Display Dimensioning Label Settings Settings for ProConcrete 3D Parts
1
1 2 4 12 12 33 129 137
C.3
C.3.1 C.3.2 C.3.3
DetailCenter Express
Running DetailCenter Express Selection Pages Single Sheet Output
1
2 3 23
C.4
InsertExpress
1
Page VII
Table of Contents C.4.1 C.4.2 C.4.3 C.4.4 Start InsertExpress Manual Insertion Mode Batch Insertion Mode Format File 2 4 16 18
C.5 C.6 C.7 C.8 C.9 C.10 C.11 C.12 C.13 C.14 C.15 C.16 C.17 C.18 C.19
Cranked 2D-View North Symbol Manual Dimensioning Points Manual Object Link Global Scale Drawing Border Manual 2D-Cut Manual Dimensioning Elevation Flags Weld Symbols Short 2D manually 2D-Cutout Hole Display Automatic 2D-Cut Flatten Viewport
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
D
D.1
MISCELLANOUS
User-Defined Component Parts
Special Parts Weld Shapes Parametric Shapes D.1.1 D.1.2 D.1.3
1
1
1 11 15
Page VIII
Table of Contents
D.2
D.2.1 D.2.2 D.2.3 D.2.4 D.2.5
BlockCenter
Structure of the BlockCenter Creation and Edition of Blocks Insert Blocks Display of Block Structure Database of Block Data
1
2 4 6 8 11
D.3 D.4
D.4.1 D.4.2
1 1
2 5
D.5
D.5.1 D.5.2 D.5.3 D.5.4 D.5.5 D.5.6 D.5.7
Auxiliary Tools
Collision Check Center of Gravity Tube Unfold Move Objects Create ACIS-DWG Create AutoCAD Drawing Convert ADT shapes
1
1 4 5 7 8 10 11
D.6 D.7
1 5
5 7 13 15 20 24 25 32 43
D.7.1 General Information about Data Exchange D.7.2 Exchange Lists D.7.3 Interface Format Selection D.7.4 Data Import Command D.7.5 Data Export Command D.7.6 Direct Data Exchange with RSTAB D.7.7 New Interfaces PSB-Interface (ProSteel Object-Exchange Data) D.7.8 Previous Interfaces
E
E.1 E.2 E.3
APPENDIX
Structural Element Staircase Structural Element Handrail Structural Element Hangar Frame
1
1 1 1
Page IX
Table of Contents
Structural Element Truss Girder Structural Element Purlin Course Structural Element Ladder Structural Element Joist ProSteel Properties Dialogs
Shapes Plates Bolts Volume Solids / Basic Primitives Special Parts Assemblies Work Frames / Views Structural Elements Roof/Wall-Objects Position Flags, Elevations, Weld Marks,.. Drawing Parts Lists 3D Modifications Flat Cuts Poly-Cuts Edge Processing Notches (Outlets) Common Properties
1 1 1 1 1
2 15 20 25 27 28 30 30 30 30 30 31 34 35 36 37 38
E.8.1 E.8.2 E.8.3 E.8.4 E.8.5 E.8.6 E.8.7 E.8.8 E.8.9 E.8.10 E.8.11 E.8.12 E.8.13 E.8.14 E.8.15 E.8.16 E.8.17
E.9 E.10
1 7
Page X
Introduction
A Introduction
Page A - 1
Introduction
Page A - 2
Introduction
A.1
Introduction
Welcome to ProSteel
You decided to buy our ProSteel program because you are convinced that you will cope with your daily tasks faster and in a more reliable way in the future by using a CAD software package which is successful, well tried and tested all over the world. We are pleased that you selected a product of our company and we hope that for a long time we will be your reliable partners.
Page A.1 - 1
Introduction
Page A.1 - 2
Introduction
Hardware-Performance (Recommended) Processor Working Memory Fixed Disk Storage Pentium Core 2 Duo with 2,4 GHz 2048 MB 2,0 GB
The requirements for the graphic card correspond to the recommendations of Messrs. AutoDesk for 3D-mode. In addition, a CD-ROM-drive for the installation is required and depending on the software protection a floppy disk drive, USB-port or parallel port. Operating System and Additionally Installed Software Microsoft Windows 2000/XP Professional AutoCAD 2004...2008 or the corresponding Mechanical- or ADT product Adobe Reader 6.0 or higher
Page A.1 - 3
Introduction
Page A.1 - 4
Language Selection
A.2
Language Selection
In ProSteel you can select the language of the menu prompt and thus of the configuration, too while the program is running.
The displayed dialog offers all languages which are installed at the very moment. To switch over to another language check the field beside the flag and confirm the modification with the OK-button. Apart from the language of the menu prompt, the modified settings for the configuration will be loaded as well when the program is started for the next time. If you switch over e. g. from German to English, nothing will happen first in the running mode except the language of the dialogs. However, if you start ProSteel anew together with the modified language setting, the configuration of the language setting will be loaded as well from the currently installed language set. This means that a plate will not be created with the name Blech but with the name Plate. The search paths of the program for blocks, temp- and varia-directories will change as well and another ProSteel configuration will be available. Please refer to the chapter Installation to see which installations depend on the language.
Page A.2 - 1
Language Selection
Page A.2 - 2
Dialog Framework
A.3
Dialog Framework
The standard elements (lower button bar) as well as the general behaviour of the dialogs are described below. When the different commands are described, these things wont be explained any more.
Page A.3 - 1
Dialog Framework
Dialog-Commands
OK By clicking on this button, you close the dialog and the last settings such as content of the dialog, position on the screen, selected dialog tab, etc. are stored. Depending on the command, you are prompted to continue with other things like e.g. selection of component parts, etc. CANCEL By clicking on this button, you close the dialog and the command is cancelled. If possible, the previous status is restored as it was before selection of the command
TEMPLATE By clicking on this button, you can save or load again the complete settings of the dialog for the selected command under any template name you like. Here, another dialog of ProSteel template management opens which is described separately in this subordinate chapter. CLONE By clicking on this button, you can read the settings of an existing connection and import it onto another one. This function is especially suitable for automatic connections. It helps you to obtain an identical connection to an existing one, the exact default settings of which, however, you dont know any more. For more detailed information, please refer to the descriptions of the individual functions.
Page A.3 - 2
Dialog Framework
UPDATE When you click on this button, the connection, structure or the component part are updated according to your default settings. Normally in ProSteel, you are working in a dynamic mode. Each modification of a parameter is directly translated into a modification of the corresponding object so that you can see the results immediately. In case of very complex structures or less powerful computers, it may be reasonable to deactivate this automatic update in the global settings of ProSteel and to activate it manually if need be.
ROLL-OVER By clicking on this button, you alternatively switch on or off the so-called Roll-Over-mechanism. When RollOver is switched on, the visible dialog area depends on the current mouse position. For more detailed information, please refer to the separate description in this chapter.
GRAPHIC When you click on this button, the auxiliary graphics of the corresponding dialogs are alternatively switched on or off. This influences the size of the dialog on the screen.
Page A.3 - 3
Dialog Framework
The methods of working within the template management are very similar to those of Windows Explorer. For example, you can organize the templates structure in different list branches and easily modify this structure at any time via Drag&Drop.
Page A.3 - 4
Dialog Framework
Dialog-Commands
LOAD When you click on this button, the template marked in the selection list is loaded and the input fields of the dialog box are filled in accordingly. Then, the dialog will be closed immediately. You can also double-click the list entry for this command. SAVE By clicking on this button, you can save the settings entered in the dialog frame using a name indicated by you. You first have to select the desired list branch where your template has to be saved and then click the SAVE button. Now an entry with a standard name will be created the name of which can be modified immediately or at a later moment. To overwrite an existing entry, select the corresponding entry instead of a list branch. NEW FOLDER By clicking on this button, you can create a new branch (folder) on the topmost level or even within a list branch to save your templates. You first have to select the desired list branch and then click the NEW FOLDER button. IMPORT Click on this button to add other templates of the same type to your current template file. This may be a single template, a list branch or the complete file. A file selection dialog opens where you can select the template file to be imported. It is checked whether you selected the same type. If the name of some list branches of the imported template file is identical with the entry in the existing file, you can decide for each branch individually whether the existing data have to be overwritten or not. The new branches or templates are only added; they may be re-organized later by using Drag&Drop.
Page A.3 - 5
Dialog Framework
Order
Click on this button, and the alphabetical order of the display list is turned upside down. You can reach entries which are placed further down without having to scroll up and down the list. First, you have to select a list branch the order of which has to be changed. Sorting can be defined for each branch individually.
Context Menu
Most of the dialog commands can be reached via the context menu of the right mouse key. Further commands are available here. REMOVE Select this command to delete the selected template or a complete branch including all subordinate branches. EXPORT Select this command to save the selected template or a complete branch including all subordinate branches under any file name you like. The data can be added again at any time using the IMPORT command or they can be made accessible to other users for import. After selection of the command, the file selection dialog opens where you can select a file name or a file path. FAVOURITES Select this command to add the selected template to the favourites list or to remove it from this list. BLOCK Select this command to block the selected template against overwriting. This function is only available in expert mode. UNBLOCK Select this command to unblock templates which were blocked against overwriting. This function is only available in expert mode.
Page A.3 - 6
Dialog Framework
Page A.3 - 7
Dialog Framework
Version Control
You are perhaps used to the fact that in other programs and in previous ProSteel versions already defined templates were often lost during an update. This is the reason why the data structure of template file was equipped with a version and type control. Your new defined templates remain compatible with the following versions and when former files are loaded, any new added values will have a standard value.
Favourites
You can collect selected templates individually in a favourites list. These lists are displayed in the dialogs of the functions to have a quick selection of templates available. First click on the corresponding entry to define a template as favourite. Then, select the option Add to favourites in the context menu. Now, the entry is displayed in bold type. To remove an entry, click on the entry again and select the entry Remove from Favourites in the context menu.
Page A.3 - 8
Dialog Framework
A.3.3 RollOver-Mechanism
The so-called RollOver-mechanism allows for a better use of your drawing surface in ProSteel because the dialogs are only displayed completely if you probably intend to enter something or to control the settings. Otherwise, the dialogs are reduced to the title bar allowing you at any time to recognize which dialogs are open at the moment. The change from complete to reduced status depends on the movements of your mouse. When you leave the input area of a dialog with the mouse, it will be folded up except for the title bar shortly afterwards and you can look at your construction. It is not until you move to the title bar again with the mouse, that the dialog is displayed completely because the program now assumes that you are going to modify something.
Individual Control
Due to the fact that perhaps you dont want to have a RollOver-mechanism activated for each dialog, it can be switched on or off for each dialog individually. You may even completely deactivate the RollOver-mechanism in the global settings if you dont like this way of working at a ll. However, your individual defaults are kept in each dialog frame and become valid again when the mechanism is activated.
Page A.3 - 9
Dialog Framework
Auxiliary Graphics
The auxiliary graphics show a depiction in the form of a diagram, e.g. a connection or a structural element with the most important dimensions, which can be modified in the dialog frame. Here, different numbers which you will find again in the labelling of input fields and which allow for a clear assignment marks the dimensions. In some dialog frames, the graphics change depending on the selection of an option or even of an input field. Thus they are sufficient in most cases as help for the parameters.
Monitor
The monitor frame helps you to define the reference points e.g. at the insertion of shapes. In this case, you usually find small circles serving as marks to be clicked. The activated reference point then is displayed in red. In addition, the monitor also shows a preview of your current default settings e.g. at the definition of position flags. In contrast to the auxiliary graphics, its proportions change.
Page A.3 - 10
Dialog Framework
Pick Lengths
Most input fields for entering distances allow picking the distance in your drawing. Then, the picked length is entered into the input field. This extension permits comfortable seizing of distances from your construction. To do so, select the entry Add Picked Length in the corresponding field via the context menu; the dialog frame is temporarily hidden, and you can pick the distance via two points. If you select the entry Add Picked Length (without Z) instead, the distance will be calculated without Z-coordinates.
Pocket Calculator
Most input fields for entering distances alternatively allow the use of an integrated pocket calculator to calculate the values. The new calculated value then is entered into the input field. To do so, select the entry Add Calculated Value via the context menu; the pocket calculator is displayed. If a value was entered into the input field before, it will be automatically displayed in the pocket calculator.
Page A.3 - 11
Dialog Framework
Page A.3 - 12
Input Options
A.4
Input Options
Additional Functions Pick Length If you select this function, the dialog is hidden and you can pick two points in the drawing. The distance from one point to the other is calculated and the result is entered into the corresponding dialog field. Then, the dialog is displayed again.
Pick Length without Z If you select this option, the z-coordinates are removed at distance calculation. Running is the same as described above. Pocket Calculator A small pocket calculator is displayed when you use this option. When selected, the calculator takes over the content of the current field and you can directly calculate with this value. When the calculation is finished and you want to copy the result into the current input field, just quit the calculator using the COPY button.
Page A.4 - 1
Input Options
Filter
In this case you would filter your input for all parts being longer than 2000 mm. If you press the OK-button, the parts are selected on which the filtering is based. Then, the original function is carried out together with the filter result. For a detailed description of the filter possibilities, please refer to the description of PS_SEARCH command.
Page A.4 - 2
Input Options
Select View
Display Class
NC-Data
Positioning
Work Frame
Positioning
Modify Properties Keep the STRG-key pressed to modify the properties of exactly one component part.
Page A.4 - 3
Input Options
Use of ALT-Key
General The pressed ALT-key avoids working off the link update. No updates due to modifications are carried out. You can e.g. use this function to move parts without causing a reaction of the connected parts. After the parts for Render-Export have been selected, a standard file name is used. The ALT-key permits file name selection. The object view first creates a non-aligned view on the part. Alignment is made via RETURN-button. If you press the ALTkey at selection of view direction, an aligned view will be directly created. This is not carried out using Clipping. If the ALT-key is pressed, the global clipping distances will be used. A pressed ALT-key during Object Snap selection inserts the reference points as well, if existing. At shape selection, the selection of the previous type can be taken over if you keep the ALT-key pressed while selecting the shape class (post, hand rail, knee-high guard rail, etc.). The same function is valid at modification of shape status, i.e. whether the corresponding shape is used or not. At modification of drill holes, you can cancel the blocking of bolt fields by means of the ALT-key. These then can be deleted as well. Use this option carefully! Same function as for the selection of handrail shapes. Same function as for the selection of handrail shapes. At insertion, the lattice girder is created with the entered width. The Alt-key creates a frame with the width of the entered points. Select View At Select View command, double-clicking on it activates the selected view. The ALT-key only moves to the corresponding UCS. At insertion, the frame is created with the entered width. The ALT-key creates a frame with the width of the entered points.
Render Export
Object View
Hangar Frame
Page A.4 - 4
Input Options
Haunch
If you press the ALT-key while seizing the connection shape, a ceiling joist is carried out. If you press the ALT-key while seizing the supporting shape, the plate thicknesses are adapted to the supporting shape.
The ALT-key causes that the ladder length is calculated from the third point. If you choose Select Position, a pick into the drawing causes a rotation by 90. The ALT-key causes a rotation by -90. If you keep the ALT-key pressed during selection, the program is forced to an input via angles. At selection via menu points instead of via dialog, the ALT-key causes a conversion of the setting, whether the operation is valid for group or not. Activating one of the three list fields for distances permits comfortable input of the distances. If the CTRL-key is pressed, the existing distances are deleted. Pressing the ALT-key at selection causes not only a cut but, if need be, an adaptation, too. Pressing the ALT-key at selection of the second shape avoids type check and everything is connected. Osnap and Center: The ALT-key causes that the endpoints can be seized as well. If a bolt is modified using its grips, the ALT-key causes that the endpoints can be moved freely in space, otherwise only in bolt direction. If the frame is modified, moving of the grips along a line causes the movement of the line without modifying the size. If the ALT-key is pressed, the line is moved and the size is modified depending on the neighbouring lines. Same effects as purlin connection object. Osnap and Center. The ALT-key causes that the endpoints can be seized as well. In groups, the movement of an accessory part doesnt cause new drawing of the main part. The modification will only be visible after regeneration. Pressing the ALT-key forces restructuring of the group even without regeneration.
Working Areas
Purlin Connect.
Page A.4 - 5
Input Options
Grips
For shapes, you can specify whether the length modification has only to be effected in shape direction or freely. Using the ALT-key turns this setting upside down.
Page A.4 - 6
Global Settings
A.5
Project Manager
In all ProSteel versions it is possible to store drawing files, parts list files or similar things on the folder you like. This feature is often very useful; on the other hand, however, the problem is to keep all files of a project together. Up to now, it was not possible to store the pre-settings, templates or even configurations related to the project. In the current version, a project manager has been implemented offering exactly these options.
Page A.1
Input Options
Use this button to load the currently highlighted project and to carry out all desired modifications of the configuration. The available possibilities are displayed under Create Project. Alternatively, you can activate a project by double-clicking on it. Load Project... If this option is activated, the current project is automatically activated when you start ProSteel. The prerequisite is, however, that ProSteel has been quit as usual. Click on this button to finish the current project and to return to the basic configuration. This option permits to create a new project. The available possibilities are displayed below.
Page A.4 - 2
Global Settings
Use this option to delete the currently highlighted project as well as all included files. Also, you have the possibility to close this function, and then the files will be deleted. The current project cannot be deleted. This option allows the modification of project data and settings. Please refer to Create New Project. This option permits the creation of a DwgInfo-table (drawing information) throughout the project. In each project drawing, these files can be taken over later into the corresponding DwgInfo-table. The change of the AutoCAD main dialog informs you whether a project has been loaded. Name and file path of the loaded project are displayed there, instead of the information that you are working with a certain AutoCAD version. Open this dialog to see the name of the current project displayed in the bottom line as well.
Page A.1
Input Options Create New Projects The following dialog appears when you want to create a new project. Use this dialog to enter the project data.
Project Name
Enter the desired name of your project. The remaining paths are modified as well according to your inputs. However, they can be overwritten individually. Enter the path to be used for storing your model files. In contrast to the other paths, it is not possible to force AutoCAD to use this path as previously set. Therefore at storing, you have to take care manually that this path will be used to store your model files there. This button allows interactive path selection if you dont want to use the proposed path. This button deletes your individual input and activates the previously set path again.
Model Files
Page A.4 - 4
Global Settings Detail Files This is the path for your detail drawings. The Detail Centre takes over the selection made here as pre-setting. Parts Lists.. This is the path for your parts list files. The file for the creation of parts lists takes over the selection made here as presetting. Of course, only the new selection is concerned. If another project was activated at the last selection of the parts list creation, the path still is the one set for this project. This is the path for your NC files. The NC-creation takes over the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only the new selection is concerned. If another project was activated at the last selection of the NC-creation, the path still is the one set for this project. This is the path for your PPS files. The PPS-function takes over the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only the new selection is concerned. If another project was activated at the last selection of the PPS-function, the path still is the one set for this project. This is the path for your export files. The export function takes over the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only the new selection is concerned. If another project was activated at the last selection of the NC-creation, the path still is the one set for this project. If this option is activated, you can store the temporary files separated from the standard storing place and organize your settings related to the project. In the temporary files e.g. the last active dialog content, the dialog position, etc. are stored. Enter the path for your temporary files. Enter the path from which all existing temporary files have to be copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with a bare installation, but you will find the usual environment, even if from now on it will only be valid for this project.
NC Files
PPS Files
Export Files
Temp Project
Templates Proj... If this option is activated, you can store the template files separated from the standard storing place and organize your settings related to the project. In the template files, all data are stored which have been created via the template management. Template Files Copy from Enter the path for your template files. Enter the path from which all existing template files have to be copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with a bare installation, but you will find the usual environment, even if from now on it will only be valid for this project.
Page A.1
Input Options
Styles Project
If this option is activated, you can store the style files separated from the standard storing place and organize your settings related to the project. This option is valid for all 5 types of style files (detailing style, position flags, weld marks, elevations, bolts). Enter the path for your style files. This path is used to file the corresponding subdirectories for the 5 types of style files. Enter the path from which all existing style files have to be copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with a bare installation, but you will find the usual environment, even if from now on it will only be valid for this project. If this option is activated, you can store the Dwg format templates separated from the standard storing place and organize your settings related to the project. Enter the path for your frame files. Enter the path from which all existing Dwg frames have to be copied into the new directory. Here you have the opportunity to describe your project in 10 lines. The data are displayed at project selection and have to facilitate selection.
DWG Project
Page A.4 - 6
Global Settings
A.1
Global Settings
This dialog box and its pages allow you to enter the standard settings for several functions. You access the dialog by selecting the ProSteel/Options item via the context menu of the right mouse button when no objects are selected. Identical values for the corresponding ProSteel-components resulting from these settings can be modified at any time for each part via the Change PS Properties command. Most entries are explained with the individual functions; therefore just some settings will be explained in the following. Options Grips Shapes Straight Plates Bolts Work Frame Assembly Values LogLinks Revision Display Colours Monitor Configuration Dialogs Files General settings Settings for grips and stretching; when no grip is entered for an object, the AutoCAD-command Stretch cannot be used. Settings for shapes Settings for any kind of plate (poly-plates) Settings for bolt display Settings for work frame Settings for assemblies Settings for resolution of circular volumes for volume patterns (Facet-Modeler) Settings for links between elements Settings for modification control Settings for display Settings for the element and other highlighting colours Settings for the display monitor in the dialogs Settings for iso-views, layers, flat steel tables Settings for all dialogs are specified. Access to the most important system files; this is only visible in expert mode (see Dialog settings).
Page A.1 - 1
Global Settings
Options
Analysis View
For shape properties, an additional tab for the static view is available. If this option is not required, you can deactivate it here generally. The part properties can be processed by double clicking the part. You are asked at the beginning of a new drawing in which unit system you want to work (metrical or British). Otherwise, the current AutoCAD-setting will be adopted. As the consequent use of the same unit system within a drawing is indispensable for the correct display of shapes, the modification of the system variable MEASUREMENT that is responsible for this can cause unwanted results. This option grants that the once selected unit system is kept and a corresponding hint will be displayed in case of (mostly unwanted) modifications.
Enable DSTV
The shape and bolt designations in a parts list are named according to the latest DSTV standard.
Page A.1 - 2
Global Settings
Remove Modifications Drill holes e.g. which lie outside of the shape after a length modification has been performed, are deleted automatically. Remove Links Logical links, which havent any meaning any more, are deleted when parts are deleted. During normal operation, this option should be turned on.
Remove References When the drawing is cleaned with the AutoCAD command Purge, in order to reduce the drawing size, unused shape references can be deleted after confirmation. Check DWG Each time the drawing is opened, it is verified with regard to invalid group entries. In some cases, unexpectedly big drawings could be created which is avoided using this option. Internal calculations are not carried out by ProSteel each time a part is touched, but only if it is really necessary. This shortens the processing time of some functions.
Recalculate Parts
Group as a Whole This option permits selection of groups as a whole if the AutoCAD system variable Pickstyle has been set accordingly. Convert Boolean In case of Boolean volume operations, the solid, which is responsible for the processing, will be parameterized. Thus it is possibly to modify the dimensions of the processing later, even if the solid responsible for the processing doesnt exist any more (in the case it was e.g. only an auxiliary object and has been deleted again).
Ignore Detailing In case of Boolean deduction of parts, the component parts are deducted without detailing. Thus it is easier to switch over from Acis to Facet model and vice versa. However, it may be that not any detailing is carried out correctly. Check Shape Lengths The shape lengths are automatically verified when a shape is inserted. Check Hole Edges The admissible edge distances are automatically verified if drill holes are inserted.
Description Layer
Component parts are placed on the corresponding layer indicated in the description file
Page A.1 - 3
Global Settings
Execute Boolean
When logical links are processed, the Boolean volume operations within the parts are carried out before a cut is made. The display of component parts can change by using this option.
Shapes as Acis New shapes are created by means of the Acis modeller. Plates as Acis Log Dwg Input New plates are created by means of the Acis modeller. A log file is created when a file is opened.
Grips
Shapes Modify Length Move Cuts A grip is created for length change (or for position change) and all measurements can be altered. A grip is created for the section. You might now have one grip for changing the length and one for changing the section.
Page A.1 - 4
Global Settings
Please note: When you move a section grip in a way to shorten the length of the shape, the length grip is moved simultaneously. When you move the length grip over the section grip, the shape will be cut off at the same spot, because you have not moved the sectional plane. When you move the section grip over the length grip, you eliminate the section from the shape (although the sectional plane remains at the section grip) the section grip seizes the sectional plane, while the length grip seizes the shape length. When you stretch a cut shape, the section angle within the shape remains the same, just like in reality. Move Holes Drill holes receive a grip and can be moved. Otherwise they remain where inserted when the shape is stretched.
Move Polycuts
Poly-sections receive a grip and can be moved (the original form of the poly-line is stored; therefore you only move the line). Otherwise, the section remains where inserted when the shape is stretched.
Only Along Center Line Shapes can only be stretched along their axis, i. e. a change of position is not possible. Layout When you have entered a value > 0 in this input field, the length of the shape can only be changed via grips in preset modular steps. When you have entered 0, any kind of change can be performed.
Plates Modify Plate Size Move Cuts A grip for changing thickness is displayed, in all other cases only form changes can be performed. All other plates fields have same definition as the shape fields. Please refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
Page A.1 - 5
Global Settings
Shapes
With the exception of the additional dialog tabs and some specifications, most of the settings can be found under the section describing the shape properties. Offset Centre Line You specify the length beyond which the centre line has to exceed the shape ends. Maximum Shape If you enter a value bigger than 0 and you have checked the entry Verify Shape Lengths under Options, and shapes are inserted, a message is displayed drawing your attention to the fact that the maximum delivery length is exceeded by some shapes. A hint dialog appears and the corresponding shapes are highlighted in colour.
Page A.1 - 6
configuration of which is set here. Text Size Enter the text size of the shape labelling.
Page A.1 - 7
Global Settings
Distance
Enter the distance between labelling and the upper side of the shape. However, dont forget that the actual size depends on the set global scale of the drawing.
Position No. Prefix This designation is put in front of the position number. Text Style Label The AutoCAD text style for the labelling text The name of the shape is additionally added to the labelling.
Position Number The position number is additionally added to the labelling. Length Note2 The length of the shape is additionally added to the labelling. The content of the note2 field is output as well. If the Below field is also checked, it will be displayed in a second line.
Page A.1 - 8
Global Settings
Dynamic
The text of shape labelling is dynamically adjusted to the view for depictions in paper area if the Viewport- support has been activated.
Page A.1 - 9
Global Settings The advantage is that the text has the same size independent of the scale in the view window. Select the AutoCAD text style to be used for the labelling in the selection list Text Style. Shape Type not to be labelled In this input field you enter the shape types, which have to be excluded from labelling. The advantage is that only shape sizes differing from a default value will be output individually.
Shapes...Sketch Display
Sketch Size Sketch Length You can enter the length of sketch display from the centre in the Value input field below to outline the shape as solid. If you enter the value 0, the result will only be a cross-section display at the centre.
Page A.1 - 10
Global Settings
Relative Length You can enter the relative size of sketch display related t o the overall length of the shape in the Value input field below. End Offset You can enter the distance of the end points of the displayed system line towards the actual insertion points in the Value input field below.
Layout Insertion Line Middle Line The insertion line of the shape is displayed as system line of the shape (which could for example be the upper edge). The middle line of the shape is displayed as system line.
Here, you can see an example for a sketch display as well as some corresponding dimensions:
Page A.1 - 11
Input Fields
Here, you can indicate a general default consisting of format variables and constant designations for the indicated shape type in question. All format variables are placed in round brackets and start with a $-symbol outside the brackets. Thus they can be identified as variables at once. This is followed by the format specification for the desired dimension. Format Specifications: $(W) shape width $(H) shape height $(T) shape thickness $(D) outside diameter in case of round shapes or edge length at square shapes
Page A.1 - 12
Select from List Dimensions of e.g. end plates which are preferably produced of flat steel can only be selected from flat steels existing in the database. When the option is not activated, you can indicate any lengths and widths.
Metrical/Imperial List Here, you select the kind of shape designation from the selection lists depending on the unit system of the model.
Places after Decimal Point Here, you specify the accuracy of the dimensions in the list display depending on the unit system of the model. E.g. it is possible to nevertheless use the American designations in models with metrical unit system and to have them displayed with a higher accuracy than metrical designations would normally permit.
Page A.1 - 13
Global Settings
Straight Plates
With the exception of the additional dialog tabs and some specifications, most of the settings can be found under the section describing the shape properties.
Grid lengthwise Here you enter the lengthwise grid distances if a grid is to be displayed. Grid cross-wise Here you enter the cross-wise grid distances if a grid is to be displayed. Grid Length This is where you specify the maximum grid length running from the outer edge of the plate or from existing inner contours. If you enter the value 0, the plate will be displayed with a complete grid. This option permits you to display the plate without complete grid. The display is limited to the contour edges. Shapes that are situated below remain visible by this way. Enter the grid height here.
Grid Height
Grid = Thickness The grid height always corresponds to the current plate thickness.
Page A.1 - 14
Global Settings
Offset Middle Line If you selected the display as middle line, this is where you enter a projection of the middle line over the two plate surfaces. In contrast to shapes, the centre line of plates is not running along the longitudinal direction but along the plate thickness. Input Thickness You can indicate the plate thickness in the insertion dialog, as you like. Otherwise, only the values of a selection list are available (preference values). Volume Weight Plates...Labels The weight of the plates is determined by the volume.
Since this dialog tab is identical with the shape labelling, please refer to this chapter for the meaning of the input fields.
Page A.1 - 15
Standard Plate Name Name of the plate when it has been created by means of ProSteel. Desired Plate Name Name of the plate which has to be used for PPS- / NC-output.; Keep this name later, otherwise there will be compatibility problems with output. Description of Name Here, you specify the format default of the plate name as it is used e.g. at labelling and in the property fields. Position Flags Export Here, you specify the format default of the plate name in position flags. Here, you specify the format default of the plate name at the export of parts list data. Format Default Structure: The names like e.g. $(N) serve as variable for the current value of the corresponding plate and are explained in the dialog itself. The Name of the plate is the constant part like plate, grating, etc.
Page A.1 - 16
Global Settings
In the input fields of the corresponding description, you can enter a text consisting of the variables and any other characters. When the program is running, the variables are replaced by the current values e.g. for the length and the other characters will be kept as in the original input. Round at... Here, you specify the accuracy to which the specifications concerning dimensions of the plate name have to be rounded. This doesnt have any influence on the actual dimensions of the plate model.
Length greatest... The greatest value of dimensions is always regarded as plate length. This doesnt depend on how you inserted the plate.
Plates...Calculation
Here, a dialog tab opens where you can determine the method for calculating the weight of the plate resp. the surface to be painted. These specifications influence the result in the parts list output.
Page A.1 - 17
Global Settings
The values can be defined according to the exact form, according to the rubber tape-method (as if a rubber tape was tightened around the plate) or according to the smallest surrounding rectangle. For plates having a grid (e.g. to display a gridiron) you can reduce the weight to the percentage value indicated in the input field Weight at Grid.
Bolts
Layout
Bolts can be inserted into the drawing with different display settings: as Middle Line, Line with Circle, Extruded Circles or in real Display. permits automatic bolted connections back-to-back; the bolts are guided through all parts (penetrating bolts).
Back to Back
Global Workloose It is not possible to set an individual clearance in the dialogs, but a uniform value is used instead. Round...to When the bolt is attached, the found clamping length is rounded to a clamping length which can be divided through the indicated value. The rounding is set to the next bigger value. The found clamping length is not decreased, but always increased.
Round bigger...
Search smaller... If a bolt cannot be created with the found size, the next smaller bolt will be searched and used.
Page A.1 - 18
Global Settings
Bolt Weight
The bolt weight is calculated approximately unless a weight has been indicated in the database.
Page A.1 - 19
Global Settings
Work Frame
The outer frame will be displayed. The diagonal will be drawn. The cutting planes are displayed. The coordinate system of the working area (ECS) will be displayed. The frame text will be displayed. The frame text will be displayed dynamically so that axis designations can be read well in 3D, too.
Size Adjustment The frame text will be adjusted to the particular size of the display. Update Shapes Shapes inserted on work frame axes are moved as well if the work area is modified. Left Designation The left axis designation will be displayed. Right Designation The right axis designation will be displayed.
Page A.1 - 20
Global Settings
Assembly
Depiction
Indicates how an assembly object has to be displayed in the drawing. It may be displayed as UCS-symbol, sphere, envelopping box or not at all. Sets the symbol size of an assembly object to be displayed in the drawing.
Character Size
Page A.1 - 21
Global Settings
Values
Resolution: The input fields are used to specify the resolution for creating circular volumes. The higher the resolution, the more detailed the display but the computer processing speed decreases. Use high-resolution settings only for large scales and important details. Due to some special features in the volume-modeller, you should only specify odd numbers here. However, this only influences the Facet Modeler. Specify the size of the pick helper symbol for detailed construction groups. You need the pick helpers to access the individual parts of construction groups in the workshop drawing after the detailing.
2D Subpart
Clip Plane Distance Specify the front and rear section plane distances of the object view.
Page A.1 - 22
Global Settings
Rounding Stiffener Thickness Here, you specify the accuracy the plate thickness of the calculated stiffener thickness has to be rounded at stiffeners in connections. An unnecessary accuracy can thus be avoided resp. only certain plate thicknesses, which are available in the workshop, will be used. Front/Rear Distance Here, you specify the front or rear distance of the sectional area which is used as standard value for a limited visual depth (sectional area). Specific Weight Steel Here you define the specific weight of steel to be used as basis for weight calculation.
Logical Links
The active or passive links referencing the corresponding components are created. Any changes made to a component are not passed on to its associated components using an update. You are prompted to indicate if any changes made to a component are to be passed on to its associated components using an update.
Page A.1 - 23
Global Settings
Automatic Update Any changes made to a component are immediately passed on to its associated components using an update. Lock Part Properties The part properties created under the control of a logical link can only be read but not edited. Structural Elements... The automatic update of all structural elements such as bracing, staircases, etc. is suppressed. Allow additional data You can enter additional data of logical links e.g. an identification code.
Page A.1 - 24
Global Settings
Revision Check
Length Tolerance Tolerances Here, you specify the tolerances to be used for comparing the component parts. You can specify the values for line length as well as the comparison of drill holes, lengths and weight. Modifications are determined by means of a type of comparison which is also used for positioning.
Single Parts At Changes Here, you specify the behaviour of the single part position number at a changed part. Keep The position number is not changed. Confirm The position number is only deleted if this is individually confirmed for each part. Delete The position number is always deleted.
Page A.1 - 25
Global Settings
Storing
Here, you specify what has to happen with the invalid (former) position number at a changed single part. No Storing The position number is ignored. Confirm The position number is only stored as original position if this is individually confirmed for each part. Save The position number is saved as original position.
Groups Here, you specify the behaviour of the group position number at a changed part. The possible specifications correspond to those for single parts and are described there.
Others Modify Flag The part is only checked as modified if it has already a position number.
Page A.1 - 26
Global Settings
Display
Viewport
Here you can set the support of optimum depiction when working with view windows in the paper area. Without Support No adaptations are made within the depiction. Only for normal output The depiction of the shape labelling is e.g. adapted to the depiction scale if dynamic adjustment option has been activated. Complete Support A complete support of the depiction takes place. The active UCS plane (top view) displays the cross-section of the object tapered to it theoretically. This option should be turned on. When this option is switched off, you do not get a correct cross-section top view of an object if it starts below and ends above sectional plane. This option is identical with ShapeClipping, but it is only valid for plates.
Shape Clipping
Plate Clipping
Page A.1 - 27
Global Settings
Suppress... Cache 2D
Any shape labelling inserted into the model is hidden if the function Hide / Shade is selected. The result of all line calculations effected by the volumemodeller (e.g. at a 2D-depiction, object snap, etc) is written into an intermediate storage. A new calculation is only made in case of modifications. Thus the processing speed for the determination of AutoCADobject snap-points especially in case of complex construction groups is considerably increased. Bolts are not displayed when the function Hide / Shade is selected. Bolts are displayed as real objects when the function Hide/Shade is selected. This option should be turned on during normal operation. Curved shapes (arcs) are displayed as real objects when the function Hide/Shade is selected. This option should be turned on during normal operation
Real Arc...
Position Flags at Shade All position flags placed in the model will not be hidden when the function Hide/Shade is selected. Additional Lines at Shade All lines in the model, like centre lines, gravity lines or other construction lines will not be hidden when the function Hide/Shade is selected. Workframe at Shade All work frames within the model will not be hidden when the function Hide/Shade is selected. Structural Objects at Shade Structural objects are displayed when the function Hide/Shade is selected. Display Hole Holes are always displayed as polygons consisting of lines, even if it is a matter of real holes in ACIS-objects.
No Subpart Grips There is no output of subpart grips at plotting. No System Lines There is no output of system lines of structural elements at plotting.
Page A.1 - 28
Global Settings
Colours
Input Fields
Here, you set the colours to be used for the different display markings and objects of the program by indicating the AutoCAD colour number. Please refer to the corresponding commands for the meaning of the different markings.
COLOUR SELECTION You can also select the colour in a comfortable way by clicking the corresponding input field and then loading the AutoCAD dialog for colour selection.
Page A.1 - 29
Global Settings
Monitor Colours
The background colour of the monitor. The colour which is normally used for displaying objects in the monitor. The colour which is normally used for displaying the pick points in the monitor. The colour which is used for displaying highlighted objects or pick points in the monitor
COLOUR SELECTION You can also select the colour in a comfortable way by clicking the corresponding input field and then loading the AutoCAD dialog for colour selection.
Page A.1 - 30
Global Settings
Configuration / Iso-Views
Here you specify how to set the global iso-views of the program. To define a view, zoom or turn the model into the view to be used as iso-view. Then, press the button and the pre-set values will be adopted as pre-set view iso1 up to Iso5. These views are also available in the DetailCenter.
Page A.1 - 31
Global Settings
Configuration...Layer
This dialog tab is used to realize the configuration of ProSteel. Here you set the layer names, colours and line types.
Page A.1 - 32
Global Settings
This dialog is used to set the preset files for flat and wide-flat steel from which the flat steels have to be taken in the further run of the program.
Page A.1 - 33
Global Settings
Dialog Settings
Expert Mode
Here, you can configure different display properties in the dialogs. The following options are available for selection: Beginner, Middle and Expert. This setting has an influence on the display of constructional graphics in the dialogs and more. Here you specify the value for the display accuracy of lengths, angles and other values. If you selected the option Use AutoCAD settings, the accuracy depends on the system settings (LUPREC). Otherwise, you specify the desired value here. Here, you switch on RollOver for the dialogs. You can specify any hole diameter. If this field is not checked, you can only specify hole diameters from a given list.
Accuracy
Dynamic Point Input This option permits dynamic zoom and pan during the picking of points or lines. Tabs one after the other If there isnt enough place, the selection tabs for the pages of a dialog are displayed one after the other instead of next to each other.
Page A.1 - 34
Global Settings
No Updates
Switches off the dynamic update in the dialogs. The advantage is during operation in the case of very complex calculating processes. To permit a manual release of update an additional button with an exclamation mark is displayed in the command line of some dialogs. For some symbols different colours are displayed instead of the symbols of one colour (blue).
Coloured Icons
RETURN to select all ALL parts in the model are selected at a query when you enter RETURN in the selection functions of ProSteel.
Dialog Settings...ToolTips
The ToolTips are not displayed in the dialogs. The period (in milliseconds) until a ToolTip of an input field is displayed at all. The period (in milliseconds) how long a visible ToolTip of an input field is displayed.
Page A.1 - 35
Global Settings
Dialog Settings...Classes/Families
Here you enter the standard values for the number of available selection, display, area classes and part families.
Page A.1 - 36
Global Settings
In this dialog, you can specify the default settings for the properties of individual object types in ProSteel. Select the object type in the Selection List. The depiction of the dialog tab will be adopted. Please refer to the descriptions of the different object types for the meaning of the entries. The default settings are used by MatchProp-command in AutoCAD.
Page A.1 - 37
Global Settings
Configuration Files
The basic configuration of ProSteel is effected via different files which you can see by corresponding selection and which you can edit using the integrated text editor. DELETE TEMPORARY FILES Click this button to delete any existing files in the temporary directory. By deleting the temporary files, you reset all command dialogs to the original state at delivery. DELETE TEMPLATES Click this button to delete all existing data in the template directory. However, please remember that in this case all dialog templates created by you will be irrevocably deleted. Important templates such as e.g. certain company standards should be saved elsewhere.
Please note that you have access to this page only via Expert Mode, because the modifications made here have a decisive influence on the operation of the program.
Page A.1 - 38
Page B - 1
Page B - 2
Layer Functions
B.1
Layer Functions
The program is equipped with an automatic layer control. Normally you dont have to take care of this. If you use the program commands to create different objects such as shapes, dimensions, welding symbols, etc., these are created on their own layer. The activation, deactivation, and switching of layers is one of the most frequently performed tasks when using AutoCAD. ProSteel supplies its own switching functions for this purpose. Switching to the most important layers can be done with just one click, and without long searches. Select the command by clicking its associated button or enter PS_LAYER from the keyboard with the indicated parameter. Work Frame On: LFRAMEON The layer with the frame for the work area is activated. Work Frame Off: LFRAMEOFF The layer with the frame for the work area is deactivated. Element Layer On: LELEMON The layers for the main elements are activated. These are the layers for shape, roof/wall shapes, plates, construction lines, and bolts. Element Layer Off: LELEMOFF The layers for the main elements are deactivated. These are the layers for shape, roof/wall shapes, plates, construction lines, and bolts.
Page B.1 - 1
Layer Functions Additional Layer On: LADDION The layers for the additional elements are activated. These are the layers for dimensioning, midlines, position flags, relative heights, welding symbols, etc. Additional Layer Off: LADDIOFF The layers for the additional elements are deactivated. These are the layers for dimensioning, midlines, position flags, relative heights, welding symbols, etc. Object Layer Current: LOBJECT The layer for a freely selectable element becomes the current layer. You can select the element by clicking it. Object Layer Off: LOBJECTOFF The layer for a freely selectable element is deactivated. You can select the element by clicking it. Construction Lines Current: LCONSTAKT (black lines)
The layer for the construction lines becomes the current layer.
LCONSTON
(brown lines)
Page B.1 - 2
Layer Functions Construction Lines Off: LCONSTOFF The layer for the construction lines is deactivated.
Layer 0 Current:
Page B.1 - 3
Layer Functions
Page B.1 - 4
Construction Utilities
B.2
Construction Utilities
Indicates how the direction of the construction line is defined. You have to pick 2 points. You pick a line. You pick a line for direction and a point for position. You can either use standard lines the length of which is determined by projection or X-lines which always run up to the edge of the screen. The distance of the construction line(s) from the displayed line in case of parallel or vertical construction lines; resp. the distance of one line to the other if several lines have been generated.
Distance
Page B.2 - 1
Construction Utilities
Scale
Distance / spacing information is converted to the scale of your drawing indicated here. This allows actual dimensions to be used. The construction lines are rotated by the angle indicated here. The number of construction lines or divisions created simultaneously when using the Divide function. The construction lines are extended at both ends by this value with respect to the displayed reference line. All construction lines are only created on the current UCS (user coordinate system)-plane. In addition, possible picked points are projected to the current UCS-plane as well.
Create Reference Line A construction line is drawn on the reference line as well (even for a non-existing line indicated with only 2 points). Loop The function is repeated until the procedure is interrupted. This creates a construction line parallel towards the current UCS-x-axis, either at the picked point or with the selected distance to the picked reference. This creates a construction line parallel towards the current UCS-y-axis, either at the picked point or with the selected distance to the picked reference. This creates parallel construction lines for a reference line selected or displayed via pick points. This creates vertical construction lines for a reference line selected or displayed via pick points. The reference line created by two pick points is divided into equal sections with the help of construction lines running perpendicular to this distance. A 3D distance is measured and displayed in different variations. Starting and end point have to be picked.
Page B.2 - 2
Construction Utilities
A 3D distance is measured and displayed in different variations. The end point of the previous measuring is used as starting point of the current measuring.
Page B.2 - 3
Construction Utilities
PS_CONST_HOR This command creates a horizontal construction line. Click a point the construction line is to intersect. PS_CONST_VER This command creates a vertical construction line. Click a point the construction line is to intersect. PS_CONST_PAP This command creates a construction line running parallel with a reference line. First click the reference line and then on a point the construction line is to intersect. PS_CONST_PAE This command creates a construction line running parallel with a reference line using a specified distance. First enter the desired distance and then click the reference line. Finally, click the side of the reference line along which the parallel line is to be created. PS_CONST_SAP This command creates a perpendicular construction line for a reference line. Click the reference line and then on a point the construction line is to intersect.
Page B.2 - 4
Construction Utilities
PS_CONST_SAE
With Distance: This command creates a perpendicular construction line for a reference line. With Distance from a Reference Point: First enter the desired distance and then click the reference line. Finally, click the reference point and then on the side of the reference point where the perpendicular line is to be created. PS_CONST_DVD This command divides a reference line into equal segments and creates corresponding perpendicular construction lines along this line (also utilizing the start and end point). First enter the number of sections and then click the reference line. PS_CONST_DEL This command deletes all construction lines drawn up to then on the layer created for the construction lines.
Page B.2 - 5
Construction Utilities
The area Coordinates in UCS shows the measuring results regarding the current user coordinate system! Start or End X, Y, Z are the coordinates of the two measuring points. Distance in X, Y, Z is the distance in the direction of the respective coordinate axis. Dist Direct is the direct distance of the points. Angle is the angle from the start to end point in reference to the user coordinate x-axis. The section Coordinates in WCS shows the measuring results regarding the current world coordinate system. Start or End X, Y, Z are the coordinates of the two measuring points in the WCS and Cos X, Y, Z is the so-called directional cosine of the vector from start to end point (a mathematical size which normally hasn't any further meaning for you).
Page B.2 - 6
3D Object Views
B.3
3D Object Views
Page B.3 - 1
3D Object Views The following message appears in the command line after the command Object View has been selected: Pick the steel component defining the view or hit RETURN to align the view. After part selection, coloured coordinate crosshairs are displayed on the selected component and the following message appears in the command line: Select the desired axis. Now use your mouse to click the corresponding coloured circle and the object view is displayed with the selected direction. You want an object view on front. Pick the shape while keeping the ALT-key pressed, clicking one of these lines on the front,...
..and coordinate crosshairs appear at the pick point. You can now select the matching colour by clicking it.
The view is displayed, the UCSs origin is aligned and parallel with the front.
Page B.3 - 2
3D Object Views
When you select the function, you first have to click the desired component part at a bordering edge between two surfaces. Then the coordinate crosshairs are displayed at this position and you can select the desired view by clicking an axis. If you have selected the command PS_FACE_VIEW_CEN, the origin of the view is situated in the middle of the clicked line.
Page B.3 - 3
3D Object Views
Page B.3 - 4
3D Object Views
Page B.3 - 5
3D Object Views
Page B.3 - 6
3D Object Views
Off
The cut plane command is deactivated. All component parts are shown. When switching to another view, the command is activated again, provided that it has not been turned off globally.
Page B.3 - 7
3D Object Views
On
The cut plane command is activated. Only those component parts that are located within the delimitation are shown. If the command has been turned off globally, it is turned on again when switching to another view. The cut plane command is alternately switched on or off globally. This command makes sense when you do not want to work with the cut plane command for a long time. Input of the cut plane distances First enter the rear distance and then the front distance. When you enter the distance 0, no cut planes are created. When switching to one of the standard views, these values are overwritten.
Flip
Distance
(Object-) view on the upper stage frame with switched on cut plane command (standard setting)
(Object-) view on the upper stage frame with switched off cut plane command
Page B.3 - 8
3D Object Views
Lines of vision changes are only possible using coordinates and the pick function is deactivated. Changing to the model global view does not yield the desired result until the perspective view is deactivated again.
Page B.3 - 9
3D Object Views Remember that the perspective view is only a display view and does not allow any changes. For that, switch back to the isometric display. In the following, you will see some examples of the difference between the perspective and the isometric display as well as the effect of the focal distance on the isometric display: Isometric Display
3D Global View Isometric Display The point down on the left (0,0,0) is also the point of origin of the world coordinate system.
Front View Isometric Display You see a view with the settings Target point = (5000,0,5000) Source point = (5000,-100,5000)
Page B.3 - 10
Front View Perspective View Focal distance = 50 The source and target points are first set identically to the points of the isometric view. However, since the picture is much too large, the distance from camera to target is increased to 30000. This corresponds with the source point (5000,-30000,5000).
Front View Perspective View Focal distance = 100 The focal distance of the camera is increased but the picture shows only a section of the result.
Page B.3 - 11
3D Object Views
Page B.3 - 12
B.4
The notes about the AutoCAD standard commands mention the fact that ProSteel objects are treated as AutoCAD elements, and can be copied or moved the same way. This is correct, but the ProSteel copy and move commands offer you additional help by offering the option of limiting the direction of the move. Apart from that, you can specifically take the group structure into consideration. Using AutoCAD object snaps in a view may result in points being selected that are not in the proper plane. The ProSteel copy and move commands prevent this by limiting the direction of the move to the current user coordinate system plane or even to one axis direction. If several individual components have been assembled into construction modules or groups, this command can be used to process the entire group by selecting just one part of the group. This will eliminate unnecessary searching and collecting of the parts within a selection set. After the command has been selected, a dialog box will become available featuring the following options, each single tab permitting a certain action.
This button carries out the selected action for single parts without taking into consideration a possible group.
This button carries out the action for complete groups. In the options, you can specify whether this selection has to be made only when the main part is picked or for each part of the group.
Page B.4 - 1
B.4.1 Move/Copy
Alignment Here, you select the move direction of the actions. A cone shows you the move direction. 3D The selected elements can be moved in all three dimensions. 2D The start and end points of the move are perpendicular to the current UCS-plane. This means that shapes are only moved within this UCS-plane. X-Axis - The start and end points of the move are perpendicular to the X-axis of the current UCS-plane. This means that shapes are only moved parallel to the X-axis within this UCS-plane. Y-Axis - The start and end points of the move are perpendicular to the Y-axis of the current UCS-plane. This means that shapes are only moved parallel to the Y-axis within this UCS-plane. Z-Axis - The start and end points of the move are perpendicular to the Z-axis of the current UCS-plane. This means that shapes are only moved in vertical direction to this UCS-plane. Free You can move the selected elements in any of the three dimensions. The elements drag with the crosshairs and thus can be visibly moved. The elements can be moved several times.
Multiple
Page B.4 - 2
B.4.2 Turn
Axis
Here, you select the desired rotation axis. Free Axis The rotation axis can be determined by clicking two points. Object Axis One of the (parallel) coordinate axes of the element UCS is specified as the rotation axis. By specifying a starting point after selection of the parts you can move it in parallel direction. Here, you select the desired part axis if the Object Axis option has been specified. The selected axis is displayed at the object selected first in colour for your orientation. Specify the rotation angle. Select either one of the defined angles or the Free field for indication of any rotation angle you like. A copy of the component parts is created first which then will be turned. Otherwise, the original parts are rotated to the new position.
Object Axis
Angle
Turn+Copy
Page B.4 - 3
B.4.3 Mirror
Method
Enter the desired mirror plane here. 2-Points You can determine the plane by clicking two points. The mirror plane is then perpendicular to the current view and aligned with this line (for this purpose, it is best to use a perpendicular view of the component). 3 Points The plane is indicated by clicking three points in space. A copy of the component parts are created first which then will be mirrored. Otherwise, the original parts will be mirrored.
Mirror+Copy
Page B.4 - 4
B.4.4 Align
Use this command to align a component or an entire construction group in respect to a certain plane or coordinate system. Specify two coordinate systems, which are then aligned congruently with one another. The calculated required movement and rotation are applied to the selected parts. You can determine the coordinate systems either by specifying three points for each one or via element surfaces. There, the point of origin is always regarded as the bottom point of the surface.
Method Align+Copy
Determine the two planes either by specifying three points or via part surfaces. A copy of the component parts is created first which will be aligned afterwards. Otherwise, the original parts will be aligned.
Surface Method When applying the surface method, you can only make use of one element. Select the element at an edge neighbouring the desired surface. Then, you obtain a coloured display of the surfaces available for selection. The target surface is selected analogously.
Page B.4 - 5
Move and Copy Parts 3-Point Method If 3-Point was selected, specify the original position after object selection by clicking the origin as well as a point on the X- and Y-axis as a reference position. Then indicate the desired new position by clicking the origin as well as a point on the X- and Y-axis. The parts are then aligned according to the specifications with the origin points being identical. The example below shows how the left shape was aligned on the right shape as a copy. It is moved and rotated at the same time.
Page B.4 - 6
B.4.5 Clone
Use this command to transfer the manipulations performed on a component or an entire construction group to other components. A prerequisite for cloning is that the parts have a position number and that these match. The manipulations are transferred in such a way that all components are identical again after the transfer has been concluded. However, there is the option to limit the manipulations to be transferred to certain types such as only drill holes, etc. For example, use this command to apply the same modifications within a model at a later time. For example, if a hangar has been constructed with many identical supports and holes have to be added later to each support, they may be added to just one support and then transferred to all of the others.
All normal cuts are transferred. This includes the mitred cuts as well. All drilled holes are transferred. All poly-cuts are transferred. All outlets are transferred. All Boolean operations are transferred.
Page B.4 - 7
Move and Copy Parts When you start this action, you first have to select the component with the manipulations to be transferred. Then select the components, which are to accept the manipulations. However, only parts with the same position number as the original part will be considered. Please remember that the transfer of the manipulations refers to the coordinate system of the parts. For example, if you look at a shape whose parts coordinate system has its origin on the right side and you would like to transfer a drill hole to a part 100 mm from the right but its parts coordinate system originates from the left, this component will receive the new boring 100 mm from the left as well.
Page B.4 - 8
B.4.6 Rotate
This command permits a rotated copy with vertical offset to distribute e.g. the steps of a spiral staircase. Two methods can be applied. The number of steps and the angle between the steps, or by an angle area and the steps to be distributed within this area either/or defines the rotation.
Defines the kind of distribution. Either the total amount or the number via the angle area. Either the angle between the steps or the complete angle. Vertical offset between the different elements.
The construction on the left has been created by rotating the flat steel around the central tube.
Page B.4 - 9
B.4.7 Settings
Swap Effect
The meaning of the ALT-key during selection of the parts is changed. If these functions are directly selected via the menu, normally the selection as single parts is activated. If you keep the ALTkey pressed during selection, this has the effect that as group is selected. The selection as complete group is only effected if the main part has been selected. Otherwise the selection is made at any part of a group.
Group only...
Page B.4 - 10
B.5
B.5.1 Hide
This command can be used to hide components or whole groups, which means that the parts are made invisible, and cannot be selected. This command permits you to hide only selected components or to show only selected components and to hide all others. This provides a clearer view of the model. HINT: This command is most practical if individual parts are to be hidden from view. To hide/show entire groups of parts it is better to use display classes feature. PS_Hide Select the parts to be hidden after selecting the command. The parts are no longer visible after pressing the ENTER key or using the right mouse button. The command Regenerate (not to be confused with the AutoCAD-command Regenerate) will switch all parts back to visible. PS_Hide_Exclude This function is working just the other way round than the previous one. After selecting the command, you can choose the parts which you dont want to hide. After pressing the ENTER key or using the right mouse button, all other parts are hidden. PS_Hide_Group This function is working like PS_HIDE. The only difference is that the whole group is hidden, if you only selected one part of the group. PS_Hide_Group_Exclude This function is working like PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE. The only difference is that the whole group remains visible, if you only selected one part of the group.
Page B.5 -1
PS_Hide_Plane This function is working like PS_HIDE. The only difference is that the whole component parts of a work plane are hidden, if you only selected one work plane. PS_Hide_Exclude_Plane This function is working like PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE. The only difference is that the whole component parts of a work plane remain visible, if you only selected one work plane.
Page B.5 - 2
B.5.2 Regenerate
This command shows all components hidden by the user or hidden automatically by the program. You have to use this command, for example, to generate a parts list since all processed parts are automatically hidden there for control purposes. This command is not identical with the AutoCAD-command Regenerate since the AutoCAD command does not reactivate the components again.
Page B.5 -3
Class Name
The available display classes are listed and the desired class may be selected. In the field Status you see if the elements are currently shown (On) or hidden (Off). You can edit the content of the field Class Name by double-clicking it. Here, you see the current status of a display class. You can modify the status by double-clicking on it. It is also possible to highlight several lines and to carry out the modification for all highlighted lines.
Status
Page B.5 - 4
This button permits to hide parts without creating an assignment to a display class. See PS_HIDE
Click this button to show all individually hidden parts again.See PS_REGEN.
This command hides the elements of all other display classes except for the selected ones.
This command shows the elements of all other display classes except for the selected ones.
Click on this button to assign elements to a display class. The desired class must be selected in the list first. After clicking the button, select the elements to be assigned to the display class in the model. Click on this button to remove elements from a display class. The desired class must be selected in the list first. After clicking the button, select the elements to be removed from the display class in the model. Count Indicates the number of available display classes. If you increase the value here, this increases the number of available classes in the drawing. If this field is checked, the complete group will be selected at selection of elements, even if you select only one part of this group.
Complete Groups
Page B.5 -5
Page B.5 - 6
The currently available family classes are listed as well as the linked defaults of colour, prefix etc. If you click on a button of this line, the parts are treated as single parts at selection. In this mode, all data of the family classes will be adopted into the components. If you click on a button of this line, only the component groups are treated at selection of the parts. In this mode, only the prefixes of the family classes will be adopted for the position number of the group. If you click on a button of this line, both the single parts and the groups are treated at selection of the parts.
Groups
Both
Page B.5 -7
Display / Assign parts Click on these buttons to assign elements to a part family. The desired class must be selected in the list first. After clicking the buttons, select the elements to be assigned to the family class in the model.
Click on these buttons to remove elements from a part family. The desired class must be selected in the list first. After clicking the buttons, select the elements to be removed from the family class in the model
Click on these buttons to transfer the modifications of the entries in the part family to the component parts. After clicking the buttons, select the elements to be updated in the model.
Count
Indicates the number of available part families. If you increase the value here, this increases the number of available part families in the drawing.
By double-clicking on a line, you can modify the definition of the part family.
Page B.5 - 8
Enter the name of your part family here. The entry appears in the selection list and the part properties. Here, you enter the pos. prefix, which appears in front of each position number itself if the part belongs to this family. Enter the colour of the part family here. Indicate the AutoCAD colour number or select it by clicking the SELECT button. Enter the detail style to be assigned to a component part belonging to this family. Enter the name of the detail style or select it by clicking the SELECT button. Note that assigning detail styles normally should be done inside the DetailCenter. If the DetailCenter is open, the component part list has to be updated after modification of shape properties.
Page B.5 -9
Select Line Type Here, you indicate the line type determined for the 2Ddepiction. The settings can be defined individually for visible, invisible and center lines. Detail Colour Line Type Here you specify the colour to be used for 2D-depiction of the selected line. Here, you specify the line type to be used for 2D-depiction of the selected line.
Please note that the 2D line settings are only activated if the component parts are displayed in 2D. These settings dont have any effects on the model display.
Page B.5 - 10
The process status of the part is another possibility to check or classify the component parts in the drawing. This function helps you to check the parts in colour according to certain criteria and thus to display the current process status in production resp. installation in the CAD model.
Permanent
If this button is switched on, the colour cannot be removed from the parts.
Preset File You can define the preset values of the process status function (the names as well as the corresponding colours) in a text file. This can be seen and modified here.
Page B.5 - 12
B.5.7
Search Parts
Use this command to search for parts and components within a model, which meet certain requirements. You can define several conditions, which have to be met at the same time. If these conditions are met, the part is either marked or all parts not meeting the requirements are hidden.
Fields Operator
This list displays the search terms available to you by clicking them. Select the respective condition operator between search term and comparison value.
Compare Value Here you indicate the value that has to be filled. Only values existing in the drawing are offered. In case of names, you can also indicate an asterisk (*) for any other characters such as e.g. HE* for HEA,HEB etc. Buttons Use the following buttons to combine the filter condition with different logical operators.
Complete Filter Condition Here, the complete filter expression is displayed after insertion of all filter conditions. You can reset or restore the last step using the buttons or you can delete the complete filter condition. Specifications Mark Select the action that has to be carried out with the parts found. If this field is checked, all parts satisfying the search condition are marked in colour. Use the command Global Settings / colours to specify what colours to apply. If this field is checked all parts not satisfying the search condition are hidden. The hidden parts become visible again using the command Regenerate. If this field is checked, all parts satisfying the search condition are automatically zoomed to. A dialog opens permitting you to indicate the display size (zoom factor) and to make an iteration of the different found parts using the keys << and >>.
Hide
Zoom
Condition List
This list displays the current search conditions linked with AND. Click this button to add a search condition formed from the selected search term, operator and comparison value to the condition list. Click this button to start the search. First, you have to select all objects to be included in the search, then the result will be highlighted or hidden, depending on your choice.
Page B.5 - 14
Placeholders when Searching for Descriptions * ? # @ , Any other characters (blank spaces as well) Exactly one character you like in this specific position Exactly one numerical character you like in this specific position (0-9) Exactly one alphabetical character you like in this specific position (aA-zZ) Separator to indicate two possibilities. Thus you can also, separated by the comma, reach an OR-connection such as e.g. (HEA*,HEB*)
Page B.5 - 16
Work Frames
B.6
Work Frames
of one or several display the basic aid objects, and views created by
Any ProSteel model generation is started with the creation work frames. These work frames aid 3D orientation because they can system dimensions (e. g. axes dimensions) as design automatically create the associated UCS systems of the defining the work frame. A simple click of the mouse will change the view.
Basic Types
Before defining a work frame, first decide basic shape desired. The following choices are possible: - Rectangular work frames - Cylindrical (also conical) work frames - Wedge-shaped work frames - Pyramidal work frames
Page B.6 - 1
Work Frames
Workframe-Layout Here you specify the design of the desired work frame. Length Specify the length of the work frame and its longitudinal division. If the Length input field is activated, you define the length by means of the overall length and the number of regular fields. If the field is not activated, the fields can be defined individually by specification of the width for each individual field. Please also refer to the hints at the end of this section. The work frame width is determined analogously to the length. The work frame height is determined analogously to the length. Normally, you enter the height of the different fields. If this field has been checked, the list data define absolute height values.
Axis Descriptions Axes labels are added according to the settings in the text pages. The axes labels can be moved to their destination by means of grips. Insert Position Defines the insertion position of the work frame related to the insertion point.
Page B.6 - 2
Work Frames
If you want to have the form of a gabled roof for your work frame, you can enter the roof slope in degrees. If you want to have the form of a gabled roof for your work frame, you can enter the ridge height. If you want to have the form of a gabled roof for your work frame, you can enter the ridge width. If it is 0 or equal to the width of the work frame, only a roof surface will be created.
Asymmetrical Divisions
To simplify the input of asymmetrical work frames, you can choose a special kind of input. The following dialog opens when you keep the ALT-key pressed while activating one of the three list values:
In the input field, you can either indicate the different fields separated by a comma or repeated sections by number*distance. This simplifies the input of complex divisions. Keeping CTRL-key pressed while activating one of the three list fields, you will delete the whole field definition in this dimension. Existing field definitions cannot be modified using this method. They will be completely overwritten.
Page B.6 - 3
Work Frames The entries of the dialogs above result in the following display of a ProSteel work frame in AutoCAD (no additional rotation):
With asymmetrical length division L=15000, B=8000,H=5000 X-axis: axis 1 Y-axis: axis A Z-axis: perpendicular to axis A/1 Origin: Axis A/1, Height H=0
A platform with the dimensions 3000 x 3000 and the height 1500 is to be inserted as displayed. The coordinates of the origin are set to y=0, x=5000, z=0 and the group name is platform the other settings match the size and sections. The axes are not displayed although this is possible.
Page B.6 - 4
Work Frames When selecting the views to be created, the overlapping views of the same work plane of other work frames may be omitted because normally they are of no further use for you (when selecting the corresponding plane, you will see the whole view). In connection with the object-oriented feature of ProSteel there are good reasons for creating these views. It is e.g. possible to move the complete work frame and this view is perhaps missing. However, if the above picture corresponds to the reality, you can omit the front and right side view of the platform because the hangar work frame already provides them.
The platform is moved and the entire work frame 'hangar' and 'platform' is rotated. Click on the 3D-grid via "Change Properties", and the divisions or even the basic shape of the frame can be modified.
Page B.6 - 5
Work Frames
Base cylinder radius Top cylinder radius You can specify the height of the work frame analogously to the height of the rectangular dimension. This input field indicates the number of circle segments into which the cylinder is divided.
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
Page B.6 - 6
Work Frames
At left
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
Page B.6 - 7
Work Frames
indicates the length of the roof. indicates the width of the ridge.
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
Page B.6 - 8
Work Frames
Front View Side View R Side View L Back View Top View
A view on the front view is created. A view on the right side view is created. A view on the left side view is created. A view on the back side is created. A view on the horizontal roof area is created.
Underside View An underside view is created. Roof View R Roof View L Length Axis Width Axis Height Axis A view upon the right roof area is created. A view on the left roof area is created. A view is created for each created axis into the depth. A view is created for each created axis into the width. A view is created for each created axis into the height.
Page B.6 - 9
Work Frames
Use Axis Descriptions You can either select standardized names such as X_1,X_2 for length and width axes or you can use the specified axes names. Height with Coordinates For the height axes, the heights are additionally added to the name. Group Name Since several work frames may be inserted into one drawing, these have to be equipped with their own code. The group name is placed in front of all views. In this case, it is R1_X2.
Distances Cut.Surfaces The views can automatically hide all elements situated outside a certain distance. Here, you specify these distances for all views of this work frame, separated in front and back.
Page B.6 - 10
Work Frames
Depiction
123/ABC - Choose the axis name type. The designations may either be numerical (123) or alphanumerical (ABC). Text, Circle... Here you specify the depiction of the text. The text can either be displayed just as it is or with the selected border. If you have selected Block depiction, you may use an own text design. Please refer to Blocks for more detailed information.
Connection Line A line is drawn from the corresponding edge of the work frame to the text. Start Value Size Scale Distance indicates the start of automatic axes names. The text size is specified. At blocks it is defined by the attribute size. You can enter a scale for the blocks. indicates the distance of the text to the edge of the work frame.
Page B.6 - 11
Work Frames
Main Axis
When several work frames are involved, you can here enter the name of the main work frame, if the current frame is rather considered to be a subordinate frame. It can also be used as prefix.
Suppress First Axis When frames are used, the axes names can overlap. This option suppresses the display of the first axis. Suppress Last Axis When frames are used, the axes names can overlap. This option suppresses the display of the last axis. Avoid I, O Decreasing Position 2 Lines Dynamic When alphanumerical axes names are used, you can refrain from using I and O to avoid any possibility of confusion. Normally, axis labelling is effected in increasing order, e. g. 1, 2, 3, etc. This option has the opposite effect. The axes can be attached either in front or at the rear, or on the left or on the right. Main and subordinate axes are displayed in 2 lines. The axes names are always adapted to the corresponding view direction. Thus, a good readability will be guaranteed at any time. Here, the distance of the actual grid to the connection line of axis name is indicated. This entry is only displayed if you edit the grid in a 2D-detail.
Axis Gap
Page B.6 - 12
Work Frames
Here, you can enter the name and the main axis for each single axis. In addition, you can specify whether the axis name has to be overwritten manually (manual) and whether this axis has to be displayed (invisible). Switch over by double-clicking the entries in the first two columns. The entries of the last two columns can be edited by double-clicking.
Page B.6 - 13
Work Frames
An axis is added to the grid. To do so, click on an existing line (position of the axis), and a new grid axis is built at this position. Numbering will be adapted correspondingly. Several axes are added to the grid. To do so, click on the existing lines, and new grid axes are built at this position. Numbering will be adapted correspondingly. A user-defined axis is removed from the grid. To do so, click on the desired grid line.
This function helps you to create an axis grid completely out of an existing 2Daxis plan. First, you insert a temporary grid into the plan and then you align it to a reference point as desired. Afterwards, you add the grid axes by clicking on the existing 2D-axes.
Page B.6 - 14
Work Frames
B.6.8 Options
The work frame doesnt create any inner lines. This option has the effect that the axes names are not displayed in a fixed distance to the work frame edges, but always at the outer edge of the displayed view. You are informed about the corresponding position, even if the work frame edges are invisible. This option reacts to each command except for the use of dynamic Pan/Zoom commands. To update the display you can release a normal zoom or Regenerate. It is helpful to switch on the 'Dynamic' option. The connection lines of the work frame edges are drawn up to the designations and even within.
Height Grid Lines In side or front views the height axes indicating the corresponding height are displayed as well. 3D Pattern Within Roof Lock Layer The work frame is displayed as 3D-object. The grid is displayed within the work frame, too. This enables snapping the endpoints of the grid on the planes. A grid is also displayed for the roof. The layer for the view elements is locked.
Page B.6 - 15
Work Frames
The circles of cylindrical work frames are displayed in segments. Select the text style for axis labelling. Select the line type for the connection lines of work frame edges and axes names. The axes names are scaled using this factor. The colours of the different work frame elements can be selected freely. Either enter the colour number directly or check the corresponding field and use the left button for dialog selection. All colours are reset to standard values with the right button.
With Lines
Without Lines
On Screen Edge
Page B.6 - 16
Work Frames
From File DWG Blocks Block Path Block Name X Block Name Y
Only blocks are used which have already been defined in this drawing. Blocks of external drawings are used. They are loaded unless existing. The path from which the blocks can be loaded. The selected block for the axes names in X-direction. The selected block for the axes names in Y-direction.
Page B.6 - 17
Work Frames
Page B.6 - 18
Choose View
B.7
Choose View
Use this command to select the views defined by the work frames command or by adding new views. Once you select a view, ProSteel places the UCS into the selected work plane and displays the 3D model looking at the plane vertically. The specified cut planes are activated at the same time so that only the objects within this area are visible. In addition, you have access to all other auxiliary functions for view control using this dialog.
This dialog shows you the views, which are the result of the settings for a work frame with the area name R1. The views available in the model are sorted and displayed in this list. Please note that you can modify the name of a view manually via Change Properties. Zoom Extents Clipping-Plane After a view has been activated a Zoom Extents is carried out at once to have a complete look on the model. If a view is activated, the clipping-planes are activated as well. This means: All elements in front of or behind the view reaching beyond the defined distances are not displayed.
Page B.7 - 1
Choose View
Double Click
If you double click an entry, the selected view is automatically activated and the dialog is closed. If this option is deactivated, only the view is displayed. If you keep the CTRL-key pressed during double clicking, you can inverse this setting. If this option is selected, the selected view is activated and the dialog is closed.
If this option is selected, the UCS of the selected view is activated and the dialog is closed. The view is not modified.
If this option is selected, the selected view is deleted from the model.
This option allows the creation of another view. You are asked for the name and then you have to indicate a rectangle. After that, this view will be created in the current UCS and entered into the list. This option allows the view via 2 points. The dialog is closed and you have to specify the target point of the view as well as the camera point of the view. This option permits a view on an object. The dialog is closed and you are prompted to select an object. Then, you can select the desired view via coloured arrows. This option permits an UCS on an object. The dialog is closed and you are prompted to select an object. Then, you can select the desired UCS-alignment via coloured arrows. See also PS_ObjectUCS.
Page B.7 - 2
Insert Shapes
B.8
Insert Shapes
The actual design work with ProSteel starts when shapes are inserted into the model. However, you need not deal with shape dimensions, representations, etc., but simply instruct the program which shape shall be inserted where and the program will carry out the operation. When inserting, you need not pay attention to overlapping shapes: there are many possibilities of correcting overlapping afterwards using a mouse click. First, make sure that the shapes are correctly positioned. Since the shop drawings are based on this position, proceed with care. From now on, you will work in work frames of the model that are smaller: Selection of an appropriate view and creation of further construction lines, if necessary. Insertion of some shapes and corrections, if necessary. Adaptation of the shapes (e.g. shortening) and creation of connections. Copying of identical parts, if any. After selection of the command, a dialog window appears where you can specify the basic behaviour of the command and further settings. You can create any kinds of straight, bent or cranked shapes.
Page B.8 - 1
Insert Shapes
Shape Selection Shape Type Select the general shape type here. The ProSteel shapes are divided into 5 different types: Standard Shapes These are shapes based on a data base included in the standard delivery range. Special Shapes These are shape definitions which you can create yourself by drawing the cross-section once and creating a shape out of this cross-section. Roof-Wall-Shapes These are special shapes created by you which have been optimized for roof-wall installation. Combination Shapes These are shapes which are combined out of several already defined types. Weld Shapes These are also user-defined and permit any shape which can be welded by means of plates. Here, you select the resolution of the depiction Low, Normal and High for special shapes to make the monitor display clearer in case of complex types. You can change the resolution at any time afterwards if e.g. a more detailed depiction is required.
Resolution
Page B.8 - 2
Insert Shapes
Shape Class
Depending on the selected shape type, the available shape catalogues are listed here. You can specify which catalogues for standard shapes are listed by means of the shape catalogue selection described in this chapter. For all other shape types, the created shape catalogues are listed from the corresponding directories on the hard drive. After a shape catalogue has been selected, all included shape sizes will be displayed in this list. Each shape has its own clear access key. This access key can be entered directly here to be able to create non-standardized shape sizes of tubes, flat steel, round iron, etc.
Further Defaults Material Layer Part Family Select the material of the shape here. Here, you can specify on which layer the shapes have to be filed. If family classes have been defined, you can set them here. The selection of the family class can influence the colour of the part. If detailing styles have been defined, you can set them here. If display classes have been defined, you can set them here. If area classes have been defined, you can set them here. If general parts descriptions have been defined, you can set them here. The selection of the description can influence the colour and the layer. The insertion offset in x-direction; this field can only be entered, if you have selected the position Free as insertion point (this is the biggest displayed insertion point). The insertion offset in y-direction; this field can only be entered, if you have selected the position Free as insertion point (this is the biggest displayed insertion point). An item number can be used directly here.
Delta X
Delta Y
Item
Page B.8 - 3
Insert Shapes
Length
Specify the length of the shape. This is important if you want to insert shapes in the cross-section. Inputs in this field overwrite the length specified by the insertion points. Here, you indicate the angle of rotation used to turn the shape around the insertion axis. This option creates a group out of the shape after insertion.
Insertion Points The standard insertion points of the shape are displayed on the monitor. User-defined Insertion Points The user-defined insertion points of the shape are displayed on the monitor. Monitor The selected shape is displayed as cross-section on the monitor. The possible insertion points are shown as well. Select one of these points to insert the shape at this insertion axis in longitudinal direction. Additionally to the corner and center points further points appear with a slightly smaller depiction (hole crack, center of gravity or manually created insertion points at special shapes) as well as a bigger point (free placing).
Insertion of Shapes
After having selected the shape type, resolution, shape class and size, the shape can be inserted. There are several options to insert shapes. In general, a shape is always inserted by means of two 3D-points. These points can either be seized by picking the points or by picking a line. For this purpose, the shape is positioned in a way that if you stood at the end point and looked into the direction of the starting point the view corresponds to the depiction on the monitor. However, since two points alone dont clearly define the shape position in the space, a third point is defined which determines the position (rotation) depending on the situation: You can indicate the third point. When the two points are perpendicular in the world coordinate system (WCS) the alignment is made according to the WCS x-axis. When the points have been freely selected in the space, the alignment is made in a way that the x-axis is aligned as parallel as possible towards the WCS xy-plane.
Page B.8 - 4
Insert Shapes
Insertion Commands
ALONG LINE First you are prompted to select a line. The end points of this line are used as insertion points of the shape. Since in most cases it is not clear which one of the line points is the starting and which the end point, the program displays a cone for asymmetrical shapes. This cone allows exchanging the insertion points and to obtain that the shape is mirrored at the y-axis. In the case of a dynamic dialog, this can alternatively be realized via the button. If the selected line is a poly-line, a cranked shape will be inserted along the polyline. The bend radius is either taken from the input value on the option tab or if this is 0, the minimum radius will be used.
ALONG 2 POINTS First you are prompted to pick any two points in the space, which then are used to insert the shape.
ALONG DIAGONAL This option is also available if another point than the middle axis has been selected as insertion point. First you are prompted to select a line or to select two points using the P option. Now the shape is inserted along these points as follows: The selected insertion position at the starting point is kept (e.g. center of the lower edge). At the end point, however, the opposite position is used (in this case center upper edge). If the Select Position after Insertion option is activated as well, the positions are exchanged with rotations via the left mouse button.
ALONG 3 POINTS You select the starting and end point where the shape has to be inserted. Dynamic mode (see options) will be activated automatically. In addition, you are prompted for the third point defining the alignment. The shape dynamically follows each move of the mouse pointer and the position can be determined very precisely.
Page B.8 - 5
Insert Shapes
MULTIPLE ALONG LINE This option permits the simultaneous insertion of several shapes. Several lines can be seized at the same time and the desired shapes are inserted along all line points. If these lines are positioned in a way that the end points are overlapping, the inserted shapes will either get a mitered cut there (if the radius value is equal 0) or additional arcs with the corresponding radius will be inserted. Please note that depending on the selected insertion point the results cannot be correct. This proceeding is only safe if you insert along the middle line.
ALONG VIEW DIRECTION You can use this option if you have indicated a fixed shape length. You are prompted for an insertion point and for an alignment. Depending on the selection of the insertion point, the shape will be inserted along the alignment.
ALONG CROSS-SECTION DIRECTION You can use this option if you have indicated a fixed shape length. You are prompted for an insertion point and for an alignment. Then the shape will be inserted on the current xy-plane of the UCS with the corresponding length to the back (into the depth).
Additional Functions
INTERRUPT DIALOG All inserted shapes are still connected with the dialog, so that subsequent modifications can also be transferred to already inserted shapes. If you dont want this option, you can interrupt the connection using this button. However, the shape is not deleted in this case.
Page B.8 - 6
Insert Shapes
SHAPE DATA Click this button to open the following dialog where all relevant shape data are displayed:
MIRROR All inserted shapes, which are still connected with the dialog, are mirrored along their y-axis. You will obtain this by exchanging the insertion points.
TURN POSITIVE The shapes are turned positive (turned left in shape direction) around their insertion point using the entered value.
TURN NEGATIVE The shapes are turned negative (turned right in shape direction) around their insertion point using the entered value.
FETCH INSERTION DATA This option permits to select an existing shape from the drawing and to set the insertion parameters accordingly.
Page B.8 - 7
Insert Shapes
Apart from normal straight shapes, you have also the possibility to insert a bent shape. The bent shapes have a constant bending radius. All settings for selection of the shape type, material, etc. are the same as in the case of inserting straight shapes. For information, refer to this chapter. All settings on this tab are stored separately from the straight shapes so that your defaults on this page dont disturb the settings for straight shapes.
Insertion Functions
ALONG ARC First you are prompted to pick an existing arc on the base of which the shape will be inserted. The position of the arc in the space is not important.
ALONG 3 POINTS First you are prompted to pick the center point of the arc, the starting point and the end point. The points are perpendicular to the current UCS plane and the shape then is inserted on the base of these points. It is not possible to insert a shape, which is positioned in the space using this method. Nor can this command create an arc of 180 degrees.
Page B.8 - 8
Insert Shapes
The height above the current UCS-plane where the shapes are inserted The offset at the starting point of straight shapes The offset at the end point of straight shapes The rounding radius at shapes which are inserted several times The insertion scale if the shapes have to be inserted as 2D depiction The distance of the shapes if a shape class has been selected permitting an offset of several shapes in horizontal direction.
(SHAPECLASSLAYOUT=HORDOUBLE, QUADRUPLE, DIAGONAL)
Vertical Dist.
The distance of the shapes if a shape class has been selected permitting an offset of several shapes in vertical direction.
(SHAPECLASSLAYOUT=VERDOUBLE, QUADRUPLE, DIAGONAL)
Angular Insertion If you select an insertion along a defined length and position, you can select here which point of the shape has to be used at the pick point InsertX,Y Plane All picked points are perpendicular to the current UCS -plane before being evaluated.
Page B.8 - 9
Insert Shapes
Orientate
This option permits to rotate the shape around its insertion axis immediately after insertion. For this purpose, click somewhere in the model with the left mouse key, and the shape will be rotated in increments of 90. The shape is hanging on the mouse pointer during insertion. Normally, the points are seized first and then the shape is inserted.
Dynamic
Reference Points The insertion points of the shape are entered as reference points into the shape. This permits later tracing back of the original insertion points and, if need be, their dimensioning. 3 Point Method As 2D-Shape This option permits the insertion by means of two planes. After insertion, the shape is projected as 2D-shape onto the current UCS-plane. You can scale the shape for a depiction related to scale. After the insertion is finished, the dialog is closed. If this option is not activated, the dialog returns and has to be closed explicitly. This behaviour of the dialog permits direct modification of already inserted shapes. The entry in the Length input field is restored at next opening of the dialog.
Close Dialog
Keep Length
Enable Chains at Points Input At points input, the last point each will be used as starting point for the next shape. Adjust to Work frame Supports are adjusted to the work frame into which they have been inserted. Group Girder Position These setting are only important if the command Girder Position is activated. Connect AEC-Lines The AEC-lines (static effect lines) of the inserted subordinate girders are automatically connected with the AEClines of the main girders. Notch The subordinate girders have a notch at the main girders.
Notch Template Select the desired notch template from the available templates. Click this button to jump directly into the dialog Notch where you can specify the settings for the notch and create new templates.
Page B.8 - 10
Insert Shapes
SHAPE CATALOGUES Click this button to limit the displayed catalogues at shape selection to the types important for you. In addition, you can freely determine the order of the entries to find frequently used types on top position in the selection list.
Available Shape Series In this list (on the left) all country specific shape series available in the program are listed sorted according to countries. You can completely activate or deactivate the shape series of a certain country. The registration of a country is effected via a *.cfg file in the shape data directory. Available Shape Classes In this list (in the middle) all shape classes registered by the activated country specific shape series are listed. The registration of possible shape classes of a country is effected via the entries in the corresponding *.cfg file in the shape data directory.
Page B.8 - 11
Insert Shapes
Current Shape
In this list (on the right) all shape classes are displayed which are available in the commands as entry. These are displayed there in exactly this order. The database entries of the corresponding shape file define which shape sizes are available for the shape class. The shape names are displayed in metric unit system. The shape names are displayed in imperial unit system. The shape names corresponding to the setting of the current drawing are displayed. This means that in a metric drawing only metric shape names will be displayed. In the different shape files it is provided that the data records can have a certain priority. If this field is checked, only the shapes are displayed the preference value of which is smaller or equal the value selected here. The shape class selected in the middle list will be added to the end of the selection list. The shape class selected in the middle list will be inserted at the currently marked position of the right list. The shape class marked in the right list will be removed from the selection list. All shape classes of the middle list will be taken over into the right list. All shape classes of the right list will be removed from there so that the list will be empty.
Preferred Level
Please note that in all ProSteel functions only the shape classes in the right selection list are offered for selection.
Page B.8 - 12
Insert Shapes
You are prompted to pick a straight or already cranked shape at the end to be extended. Then, the segment is added at this end. You are prompted to pick a cranked shape at the end to be deleted. The last segment at this end is then deleted. You are prompted to pick a cranked shape at the end to be processed. The data are read and can be modified within the dialog.
Page B.8 - 13
Insert Shapes
Bent Segment Radius Angle Rotation The radius of the bent segment The opening angle of the bent segment The current rotation angle of the segment with regard to the xaxis (longitudinal axis) of the shape The segment is additionally turned positive (to the left) using the neighbouring angle. The segment is additionally turned negative (to the right) using the neighbouring angle.
Turn Angle
Page B.8 - 14
Insert Shapes
Here you can continuously indicate individual distances or series of equal values. (number*distance). A comma separates the individual data. Now the subordinate girders are in any case inserted in a way that they are aligned to the upper edge of the main girders (the position setting in the dialog for shape insertion doesnt matter). Depending on the setting, they are immediately notched as well. If the option Connect AEC-lines has been activated, the static effect lines are automatically linked with those of the main girders. This saves you some work during transfer to a static program. Press the ALT-key while calling the function to insert a subordinate girder along a line. It will be appropriately inserted between the main girders.
Page B.8 - 15
Insert Shapes
Here, you define the desired distances to the corresponding shape ends; a line displays the position of the shape. Now the subordinate girder is in any case inserted in a way that it is aligned to the upper edge of the main girders (the position setting in the dialog for shape insertion doesnt matter). For the static effect lines and notches, the same is valid as already described above under Multiple.
Page B.8 - 16
Insert Shapes
Insert Columns
This function permits the insertion of columns with previously defined pitches (e.g. for joints). After having called the function, the following dialog opens, where you can define the pitches in the list. Each line corresponds to a shape segment of the column. Then, you have several insertion variants at disposal.
The starting height (Z-coordinate of the insertion point) of the selected segment The end height (Z-coordinate of the insertion point) of the selected segment Click on this button to insert a blank line in front of the selected entry. Then, you can indicate the starting and end height of this new segment. Click on this button to remove the selected entry again. Click on this button to remove all entries from the list.
Page B.8 - 17
Insert Shapes
Click on this button to insert the column at the position to be picked and to divide it into segments corresponding to the list. Click on this button to insert the column at the intersection point of any two lines and to divide it into segments corresponding to the list. To do so, you have to click on both lines. Click on this button to insert the column at the intersection point of the work frame axes (grid) which are situated within a rectangular area and then it is divided into segments corresponding to the list. To do so, you have to click on the lower left and the upper right point of the area. Click on this button to insert the column at the intersection point of the work frame axes (grid) which are situated within any area and then it is divided into segments corresponding to the list. To do so, you have to click on the corner points of the frequency polygon describing the desired area.
Insert Girder
This function permits to insert several girders at the work frame axes (grid). At the intersection points of the axes, they are automatically divided into segments. To do so, you should first be in a plan view on the desired area because the girders are always inserted in the current UCS. Then, you have to click on the lower left and the upper right point of the area. Now, all grid axes situated in this area are examined and the girders are inserted along the axes according to the specifications of the shape insertion dialog. Finally, these are divided at all intersection points of the grid axes. Press the ALT-key while calling the function to specify a polygon for the creation area. Press the STRG-key to specify a rectangular for the creation area.
Page B.8 - 18
Insert Shapes The following example shows the automatic insertion of girders in an isometric view: In the upper figure, a frame is stretched out over the upper grid lines of the work frame. The figure below shows the result of the automatic insertion.
Page B.8 - 19
Insert Shapes
Page B.8 - 20
Insert Plates
B.9
Insert Plates
Length Width
Page B.9 - 1
Insert Plates
Thickness
plate thickness; it is indicated in list form. The list can be edited to add certain thicknesses not included in the list. To do so, open the file ..\Prg\pro_st3d.ptt with an editor and complete it with the desired thicknesses. Alternatively, you can switch on overwriting with any values in the Global Settings/Plates. Otherwise, you can only take values from this list.
Insertion Height This is the height of the plate above the current UCS.
X-Offset
x-offset of the plate related to the selected insertion position. You can either enter this value or define the insertion point by means of the points on screen. y- offset of the plate related to the selected insertion position. You can either enter this value or define the insertion point by means of the points on screen. Here you can directly use an item number. If this value is activated, an additional grid is visible at the upper side that can be set. By this way you can show that it isnt a plate but a component part such as e.g. gridirons. In the settings/plate, you can enter a reduction of weight in percent for this case. Indicates the user coordinate system to be used. The option Object-ECS is only possible if you want to enter the plate by means of a selected contour. Then, the plate is situated in the plane of the poly-line. The option Selected Areas is only possible at insertion of Rectangular Plate and Insertion Point. Then, you can define a UCS to be used by indicating two lines. For all other insertion options the current UCS-system in question is decisive.
Y-Offset
Insertion Plane
Page B.9 - 2
Insert Plates
Indicates the vertical position of the plate related to the current UCS or ECS-system, depending on the selected input form. You can take the name of your plate from an editable file. The content of this file is displayed in this list. The file is ..\Prg\pro_st3d.pdc. In addition to the name, you can define a weight as well which has to be indicated in plain text. After selection of a name, the material is directly set as well. List of all available materials
Material
Part Family
If part families are defined, you can set them here. The selection of part family can influence the colour of the component part. If detailing styles are defined, you can determine them here. If display classes are defined, you can determine them here. If area classes are defined, you can determine them here. If general part descriptions are defined, you can determine them here. The selection of the description can influence the colour and the layer. Here, you can specify on which layer the plates have to be stored. This option permits free picking of a polygon. This polygon is used to form a poly-plate after the dialog was closed. No construction lines or similar things are necessary. Take care that no crossings are generated by your input. Then, plate creation will not be possible. This option permits to form a plate on the base of an existing contour. The contour can be a poly-plate, a circle or an arc which is not closed. The plates can alternatively be created on the current UCS or on the contour ECS. A rectangular plate with the desired dimensions is created at the selected insertion point using this option. The form of polygonal plates can be modified as you like whereas rectangular plates always remain rectangular unless you change this status using Change Properties.
Layer
Page B.9 - 3
Insert Plates
Insert a plate at any line using this option. The length of the line determines the plate length; the width and the thickness are defined by your input. After having realized this insertion, you can select the position, rotation and the insertion point via the dialog. The rotation can either be modified in 90 increments or in freely selectable increments. The plate then is rotated around the insertion line. +Phi - Phi +90 -90 Rotation The plate is rotated in positive direction using the entered angle. The plate is rotated in negative direction using the entered angle. The plate is rotated in positive direction by 90 degrees. The plate is rotated in negative direction by 90 degrees. The value used for rotation in the first two options. This option permits creation of a plate by means of four points. These points dont have to be situated in the current UCS. The first three selected points specify the plane. The order is: bottom left; bottom right, top left, top right. A flat is transformed into a poly-plate using this option. All processing actions will be adopted. A plate is inserted according to its diagonal. The alignment of x- and y-direction is specified by the current UCS.
CL
After insertion, the plates are still connected with the dialog. Further modifications are still possible. Use this button to interrupt this connection.
Dialog-Commands
SURFACE GRID Click on this button to define the alignment of the surface grid. Usually this grid is aligned to the plate-ECS, it can be modified using this button.
Page B.9 - 4
Insert Plates PLATE DIMENSIONS Click on this button to define the calculation direction. First select the plate and then the direction according to which calculation has to be made. You can cancel the manual specification of direction in the plate properties.
BEND Click on this button to add edged or bent segments to the plate. The result is a three-dimensionally bent plate which however is representing a single component part and which can be depicted as flat via unfolding. A dialog opens where you can select the reference edges and make further settings (see under Bent plates).
Analysis of Dimensions
The calculation of plate dimensions is either carried out according to an automatic pattern or it can be specified manually. At automatic calculation, the following order is respected: 1) Are there any parallel edges and is their distance sufficient? 2) Is there any rectangular corner? 3) Search for the longest side Depending on the geometry, the found direction is recognized as length direction and the plate dimensions are aligned to this direction.
Page B.9 - 5
Insert Plates
By using this option, you create a bent plate on the base of an arc.
By using this option, you create a bent plate on the base of three points. Keep the ALT-key pressed at input and you can enter an arc with > 180.
=0
Use this option if you want to return to the original position of your plate after rotation.
Page B.9 - 6
Insert Plates
B.9.3 Gratings
Gratings are a special case in plate production. In principle, you can call any plate a grating, but often customers ask to fall back on standard sizes depending on the manufacturer. Another problem is to determine the weight for the parts list which traditionally can only be calculated in an insufficient way. ProSteel is able to manage gratings (resp. tear plates, fence elements, etc) in their own database files indicating the exact weight per piece. Here, you can comfortably select and insert these elements.
Selection List
Here, you select a grating element for insertion. The dimensions are determined by the database and cannot be modified later. Click on this button to insert the grating element selected from the list. In order to do so, you have to click on the point of insertion. Click on this button to have distributed the selected grating element automatically within a boundary. In order to do so, you first have to click on the border (polyline) and then specify the alignment and the origin of distribution. See also under Roof and Wall Covering.
Page B.9 - 7
Insert Plates
Generation of Bent Plates To generate a bent plate, you first have to have inserted a flat plate. This plate determines the alignment of the bent plate. Now, click on the BEND button and another dialog opens.
Flange Length
Here, you enter the length of the segment in the direction of the bending angle.
Front Distance Edge Here, you enter the front offset in the direction towards the reference edge. Positive values mean that inwards the segment becomes smaller.
Page B.9 - 8
Insert Plates
Rear Distance Edge Here, you enter the rear offset in the direction towards the reference edge. Positive values mean that inwards the segment becomes smaller. Bending Radius The radius of the bend related to the neutral fibre (half of the plate thickness). To avoid problems with the volume modeller, the radius should always be a little bit more that half of the plate thickness. Bending Angle The angle of the bend; this is related to the reference segment (reference edge).
Correction Value Unwinding The unwinding is carried out using a correction factor. The correction is multiplied with half of the plate thickness. K = 0 unwinding on the inner radius K = 1 unwinding on the center K = 2 unwinding on the outer radius This correction factor is used for the whole bent plate. Length Calculation Here you indicate the method how the length of the butt straps to be added has to be calculated. Measured for flange length from the end of the bending segment outside edge from the outside edge of the base plate inside edge from the inside edge of the base plate center from the center line of the base plate up to the end of the butt strap Click on this button to rotate the current plate edge including the subordinate plate edges in positive direction around the reference edge. The rotation is effected with the angle specified in the neighbouring input field. Click on this button to rotate the current plate edge including the subordinate plate edges in negative direction around the reference edge. The rotation is effected with the angle specified in the neighbouring input field.
Page B.9 - 9
Apart from the adding of butt straps, you also have the possibility to create bent plates from existing plates. In order to do so, select the plates to be connected. Prerequisite for a correct connection of the plates is that you can generate a tangential transition between the two plates. Radius Inside Radius Delete Indicates the radius of the bend between the two plates. Indicates whether the radius has to be used on the inside or outside of the plate. The existing plate is deleted by taking it over into the bent plate.
Correction Value Unwinding Please refer to the explanations in the previous section.
Page B.9 - 10
Insert Plates Dependance of Segments The following example vividly illustrates the connections between the segments and their dependencies. You see the isometric depiction of a bent plate and the plan view on the base plate (1). First, the segment (2a) was added to the base plate (1) by using a bending angle of 45. Then, the segment (3) was added to segment (2a) by also using a bending angle of 45, but in addition it was equipped with a front and rear (positive) distance to the edge. Finally, the segment (2b) was added to the base plate (1) with a bending angle of 90. If you now delete or modify the segment (2a), you will also delete or modify the depending segment (3).
Page B.9 - 11
Insert Plates
Dialog Commands
ADD SEGMENT Click on this button to add a new plate edge to the plate. In order to do so, you have to click on the plate at the desired reference edge of a plate segment. This determines the alignment of the new segment. The new plate segment is always subordinate to the reference segment. If the reference segment is modified later, the new segment will also be modified in relation to this.
REMOVE SEGMENT Click on this button to remove an existing plate segment (including all subordinate segments). In order to do so, you have to click on the plate segment at any edge you like.
MODIFY SEGMENT Click on this button to modify an existing plate segment later. In order to do so, you have to click on the plate segment at any edge you like. Any subordinate segments of this plate segments will be modified too in relation to this.
CHECK BENT PLATE Click on this button to check an existing bent plate with regard to errors. In order to do so, you have to click on the bent plate at any edge you like.
Important Hint: Please take care that you dont modify the basic polygon of a plate (e.g. by adding an edge, or similar things) when you have already added segments for a bent plate. The reference edges of the segments would be modified as well and the consequence could be an undesired behaviour.
Page B.9 - 12
Insert Plates
Always ECS
If you want to insert a plate after an existing contour, you can insert it either according to the current UCS or according to the object contour. This button has the effect that you always insert according to the object ECS. The settings on the first page will be ignored. The file path to possibly existing database files for gratings. Click on the neighbouring button to comfortably select the path.
File Path
Grating Catalogue The desired database file for gratings. Close The dialog is closed after insertion of a plate.
Page B.9 - 13
Insert Plates
Page B.9 - 14
Insert Solids
Sphere:
PS_SOLID_SPHERE This command creates a sphere. First, you have to enter the central point of the sphere and then the diameter of the sphere or click it.
Cylinder
PS_SOLID_CYLINDER This command creates a cylinder. First, you have to enter starting and end point of the cylinder and then the radius or click it.
Page B.10 - 1
Insert Solids
Cone
PS_SOLID_CONE This command creates a cone or truncated cone. First, you have to enter starting and end point of the cone axis or click it and then the starting and end point radius.
Torus
PS_SOLID_TORUS This command creates a torus. This requires that you first click or enter the rotation axis and then enter the outer and inner radius.
Rotational Solid PS_SOLID_ROTATE This command creates a rotational solid from within any polyline. This requires that you first click the poly-line and then on the rotation axis. You can also indicate a rotational angle, around which the poly-line is rotated. Another option is that the poly-line can also rotate around the last drawn line segment, if you press the ESC-key when prompted for the Rotation Axis.
Conical Pipe
PS_SOLID_CONICPIPE This command creates a pipe that is conical on the inside and outside. First, you have to enter or click the longitudinal axis. Then you can enter the outer and inner radius at the respective starting and end point.
Pipe->Rectangle PS_SOLID_RECT2CIRCLE This command creates a transition from a circular to a rectangular cross-section. First, you have to enter or click the lower left and upper right point of the rectangle and then click the circle.
Page B.10 - 2
Insert Solids
Enveloping Solid PS_SOLID_HULL This command creates an enveloping solid formed by any points. This requires that you click the points that are to form the envelope. Using this command, you can create almost any shape (without arcs). Extrusion PS_SOLID_EXTRUDE This command creates a volume by extruding a poly-line, which you have drawn beforehand. You first click the poly-line and then enter the desired height. The poly-line is then extruded along positive Z-direction of UCS.
Page B.10 - 3
Insert Solids
Page B.10 - 4
3D Modifications
B.11 3D-Modifications
It may be necessary to correct the length of shapes and plates already inserted or to provide bevels, notches, etc. When inserting the component parts, you have paid attention to inserting the shape at the correct position using the correct alignment, e.g., you have positioned the axis on a system line. Very often component parts overlap and must be adapted subsequently. Additionally, it may be necessary to rework your model due to modifications... ProSteel offers a large range of commands for the modification of component parts. Some operations can (also) be executed using the standard AutoCAD commands, and the grips. Others, require the corresponding ProSteel commands. There are many different commands for a modification depending on purpose. In the following chapter, these commands are explained in detail. The modifications are divided into commands for all parts, commands only for shapes or only for plates, etc. When you select the command, the following main dialog appears with the commands for all parts.
Page B.11 - 1
3D Modifications
B.11.1
Cut at Line
Divide / Combine
This function allows complete shapes to be cut or extended at boundaries, just like the AutoCAD command for the stretching and cutting of lines. For this purpose, you first have to click the shape at the end to be cut and then select the line. The boundary is formed only by a construction line, which is arranged vertically to the active UCS, plane and thus creating a cut plane. If the plane is slanted, the modified shape will have a slanted plane, too. By using this function, shapes that are too long or too short can be adapted to fit after their insertion. When you have typed a value in the Distance field of the main dialog, the shape will be shortened by this value after it has been cut. Please note that the distance refers to a vertical distance between shape and cut plane . The shape is cut at an imaginary plane, the line being oriented vertically to the active UCS-plane. Working in a view simplifies your work, since the shape is cut at this line. If the shape could intersect with the line (i. e. you consider the line to be of infinite length!), the shape is cut. To extend the shape, hold down the ALT key while clicking the end to be extended.
Page B.11 - 2
3D Modifications
Cut at Shape
The shape is cut or extended at another shape. When the shape is cut, the shorter section is always cut off. Click the shape to be cut and then the shape along which this shape is to be cut. The plane actually hit by the centerline (or the extended centerline) of the shape to be cut will be the cut plane. If the centerline does not meet any surface, no cut can be made! Please note that a logical link is created between the parts if this option is applied. The result will be that if one part is modified, the cut will be automatically updated.
Divide a Shape
By using this function, you can divide a shape at a cutting line into two shapes. A single shape, a plate or several elements can be divided into two independent elements. To start with, select the shape to be divided. Then, click the cutting line. When you have entered a distance in the main dialog Distance, both new ends will be shortened by this value. Depending on the setting, you can divide several elements at the same time. However, please note that the distance refers to a vertical distance between shape and cutting line. Distance At Plane The two new shapes are shortened by this value at the cutting line. The arising gap has the double distance value. If this option has been checked, you are asked for three points, which have to form a plane. The parts are divided along this plane.
Page B.11 - 3
3D Modifications The cutting line may be any line. If the line is slanted, the shapes are divided accordingly. If you indicate only one point, it will be used perpendicular to the centerlines. The information for the parts lists is identical for both parts with that of the initial shape, except for the length. In order to master the course of the cut line better, it is recommended to work in one of the view. Example for Platform Design For example, you can easily create changed girders at platform constructions by first laying the shapes to be changed as a whole and then dividing them at their bottom trains. Vice versa, bottom trains can be removed rapidly and the changes at this position can be cancelled. Let us assume that you want to design a platform using the following shapes: platform beams IPE 300, platform edge girders IPE 200, headers HEA 120. Create a working area with these dimensions and insert the shapes at the construction lines Overlaps can be ignored! Change to the top view and use the dialog box for the processing of the elements. As an alternative, you can also process the Y-axes of the general overview in the front view. Since IPE 300 has a flange width of 150 mm, enter the value 75 in the Separation Distance field and click the button DIVIDE. Zoom the points of intersection one after the other, select the uncut part of the cross girder to be separated, and the construction line as cutting line. In the figure on the left, you see that you have several shape parts now that can be connected. You need not insert each partial shape and the risk for dimensional errors is eliminated. If you want to remove beams, you can easily close the gaps between cross girders and create a continuous shape by clicking the function Combine.
Page B.11 - 4
3D Modifications
Page B.11 - 5
3D Modifications
Specifies the width of the outlet. Specifies the height of the outlet. Specifies the depth of the outlet. Select the relative width position to the insertion point. Select the relative height position to the insertion point. Select the relative depth position to the insertion point.
Page B.11 - 6
3D Modifications
Wedge-Type Outlet
Width Height Depth Position Width Position Height Position Depth Horizontal Vertical
Specifies the width of the outlet. Specifies the height of the outlet. Specifies the depth of the outlet. Select the relative width position to the insertion point. Select the relative height position to the insertion point. Select the relative depth position to the insertion point. Select the position of the wedge tip in horizontal direction. Select the position of the wedge tip in vertical direction.
Page B.11 - 7
3D Modifications
Circular Outlet
Width Height Angle Position Width Position Height Position Depth Radius
Specifies the width of the outlet. Specifies the height of the outlet. Specifies the angle of the outlet. Select the relative width position to the insertion point. Select the relative height position to the insertion point. Select the relative depth position to the insertion point. Select whether the outlet has to be carried out as outer circle or as inner circle.
Page B.11 - 8
3D Modifications
Position
You still have the possibility to rotate the inserted notch or cut-out by any of the three coordinate axes. Just click the +90/-90 button, if you want to rotate the cutout in 90 steps. If you require a different angle just enter the value into the Rotation Angle field and then click the +PHI/-PHI button. The outer edge of the top flange is the cut-out insertion point, the expected cut-out is defined by edges.
Page B.11 - 9
3D Modifications
Polygonal Cut-Outs
Using this command, you can cut out shapes along any freely drawn contour (poly-line). Thus, you can e.g. create notches that are not covered by the program via the special notch function. You can also subtract one shape from another to create penetrations, e.g. to obtain slotted tubes, penetrated handrail posts or others. If you have entered a value in the Gap Spacing input field of the main dialog, the cut-out is regularly extended to all directions by the indicated value to gain some space for inaccuracies of production. In any case, the created polygon will be extended to the top and to the bottom in the UCS Z-plane. Therefore, please pay attention that your UCS has been selected accordingly. In case of a direct use of this function via the command bar, the current settings of the main dialog apply. Click this button if you have not yet a contour in form of a polyline or circle or arc. You can enter the different points as you like, but be careful that the lines dont overlap in the polygon. Click this button if you have already a contour in form of a poly-line, etc. Click this button if you want to subtract the contour of another solid from the selected object (penetration or solid to be subtracted). Complete Here, you select whether the solid to be subtracted has to penetrate the selected object completely or partially. This is not valid for solids to be subtracted. Here, you can indicate a gap by which the cut contour is increased before the subtraction.
Gap Spacing
If you have divided a shape using this function, you will not obtain two shapes. This has to do with the volume modeller of AutoCAD. You must take care not to create two parts of a shape - e. g., by prior shape shortening. If you want to obtain two shapes, please use first the function Divide and divide the shape at a suitable point.
Page B.11 - 10
3D Modifications In the following you can see two examples for the working of polygonal cut-outs: on the left, there is a normal poly-cut and on the right, there is a milling via a solid to be subtracted.
Create a Penetration Here is still another example for creating a penetration of tubes: On the first two pictures, you see the situation in the front view and in the top view (the cutting planes are switched off so that you can see the depth. Put the selection for Poly-Cuts on Remove and click the button POLY-CUT. Now click the big tube, then one of the small tubes in order to cut out the volume, Click the big tube again and then the other small tube, in order to cut out its volume, too.
in the third picture, you see the cut-outs in the big tube (the two slanted tubes have been omitted in this representation).
Page B.11 - 11
3D Modifications
B.11.2
Modify Shapes
Shortening Click this button to shorten a shape by picking two points. Their perpendicular distance to the center line specifies the shortening value. Click this button to shorten a shape by explicitly indicating the value. Click this button to shorten the shape by the value indicated under default. Default Enter the value of shape shortening according to default.
In all three cases, you have to pick the shape at the end to be modified. If you pick in the middle third of the shape length, each end is shortened by half the specified value.
Page B.11 - 12
3D Modifications
Extend These functions can be used analogously to shape shortening in order to extend a shape. However, this doesnt work if the selected end has been modified by a cut.
Mitered Cut Using this command, you can combine two shapes by means of a mitered cut, which can also be carried out as 3D-cut. The bisecting line determines the cutting plane. If the height of the two shapes differs, the outer edges are not aligned. Using this command, you can also carry out a mitered cut. The intersection points of outer and inner edges determine the cutting plane here. This means that even shapes of different height are correctly cut aligned. This function cuts two shapes in a way that an arc element of the shape type picked first can be inserted with the specified radius. Radius The radius of the arc element to be inserted; this radius can either be entered as absolute value or as many times the maximum diameter of the first shape. In this case, you enter e.g. *2. A gap of this thickness is kept between the shapes at mitered cuts.
Gap
Page B.11 - 13
3D Modifications
Please note that a logical link is created between the parts at these cutting commands. The result will be that if one part is modified, the cut will be automatically updated. Here, you see some examples for mitered cuts, which have been created using different variants:
Page B.11 - 14
3D Modifications
B.11.3
Modify Plates
Modify Contour
Use this function to add another edge to the plate. For this purpose, you have to pick the plate at the position to be inserted. Now, a new contour point will be created at the picked position, which can be moved using the grips. Use this function to delete an edge from the plate.
Use this function to transfer the contour of a plate to other plates. This function permits to adapt the basic polygon of a plate processed by cuts to the current form. The corresponding modifications become superfluous and are deleted. If may sometimes be easier to modify the edges of a nonprocessed plate. In addition, this can be useful for data export if modifications of the contour are not supported there.
Page B.11 - 15
3D Modifications
Mitered Cut These functions permit mitered cuts between two plates. Since they are identical with those of the shapes, you can refer to this chapter for more detailed information. Gap A gap of this thickness is kept between the plates at mitered cuts.
Page B.11 - 16
3D Modifications
B.11.4
Wall Processing
ProSteel permits you to create wall elements so that you can have displayed for example the neighbouring buildings of your construction as well, if need be. These functions help you for further processing the wall elements, e. g. to attach openings.
Windows/Doors Height Width Radius Breast Height Height of the window or door Width of the window or door The radius of the rounding of the upper edge of a window or door Breast height of the window Click on this button to insert a window opening into an existing wall element. Click on this button to insert a door opening into an existing wall element.
Page B.11 - 17
3D Modifications
Edges Click on this button to insert an additional vertical edge into an existing wall element. Click on this button to remove a vertical edge from an existing wall element.
Specify Height Click on this button to specify the height of a vertical edge at the upper or lower side of the wall anew. Afterwards, the wall is running diagonally from the neighbouring corner points to the modified corner point.
Click on this button to specify the height of a wall segment at the upper or lower side of the wall anew. Afterwards, the wall is running diagonally from the neighbouring corner points to the two modified corner points.
Page B.11 - 18
3D Modifications
B.11.5
Additional Settings
Multiple Selection Cut at line Cut at Object Divide Polycuts You can cut several parts simultaneously at one line without having to select the function once again. You can cut several parts simultaneously at another part without having to select the function once again. You can divide several parts simultaneously without having to select the function once again. You can cut an object simultaneously at several poly-lines without having to select the function once again.
Loop Cut at Lines Cut at Object The command Cut at Line is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Cut at Shape is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted.
Page B.11 - 19
3D Modifications
Divide Connect Shorten Lengthen Poly-Cuts Mitre Cut Insert Corner Delete Corner
The command Divide Shape is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Combine Shape is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Shorten Shape is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Extend Shape is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Polygonal Cut-Outs is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Mitred Cut is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Insert Corner is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted. The command Delete Corner is repeated until it is explicitly interrupted.
Miscellaneous Close Dialog The dialog is immediately closed after an action. Otherwise, you have to quit it manually, but you could at once select another command instead.
Page B.11 - 20
3D Modifications
B.11.6
Notches and shape cuts can be created automatically using pre-selectable distance dimensions. You may select from various variants and track your input directly in the drawing and change in real time if needed . All kinds of shapes (straight, bent, cranked) can be processed using this function.
Producing a Notch
For this purpose, you first have to click on the shape, which has to be notched, and then the shape specifying the contour. When you select the command, the connection is created on the base of your last setting. Now you can fit the connection in the appearing dialog; you can check the result immediately in the model.
Page B.11 - 21
3D Modifications
Layout
Here, you select the shape of the cope. The different variants are shown in the picture below:
On the upper left, the initial situation before coping is shown (the shapes are still overlapping), and on the upper right you see the contour. Pictures below from left to right: Fit Shape Start (the normal cope), Fit Shape Middle and Fit Shape End. Corner Layout Edge The copes at the shape radii are carried out with a beveled edge. Radial The copes at the shape radii are carried out with adapted radii. In the Radius input field, the determined radius can be modified later. Access Holes The holes are drilled in the inner corners of the cope. In the Radius input field, the radius of the drill holes can be preset. If Not Inner Edge is activated here, the dimensions for the distance between top and bottom flange inside resp. outside refer to the outside of the flanges. If Inner Edge is activated, the dimensions refer to the inside of the flanges. If Not Inner Edge is activated here, the dimensions for the distance between top and bottom flange edge refer to the outside of the flanges. If Center is activated, the dimensions for the distance refer to the shape end (the exact position depends on the Web Distance value).
Inner Edge
Both Sides Equal The bottom of the notch is carried out with the data of the top and the data are transferred into the fields. Exchange Sides The values of top and bottom are exchanged with each other so that you can turn the connection. Distances The following dimensions can be set for upper flange and bottom flange separately:
Page B.11 - 22
3D Modifications
In the Radius input field, you can indicate the radius of Drill Holes or Radial option. Clicking this button allows an unknown shape to be clicked. The flange thickness is then entered in the input fields for Top and Bottom Flange Inside. If you have entered a value in the +Distance field, this value will be added. Using this function, a flange distance can be swiftly determined without knowing the shape. As reference, you should select the setting Outer Edge. + Distance: This value is added to the result in the function GET FLANGE THICKNESS. By clicking this button, you can transfer the data of the current cope directly to several copes, which have to be created anew. You have to click all shapes first which have to obtain the cope. Then you have to click the shapes to be coped.
Page B.11 - 23
3D Modifications
Standardized Notches
List
This List shows previously defined notches from a database. You can create these database files using any dBASE-editor you like. You can previously define a certain number of the most frequent notches. In the different List Fields you can have a look on the data, which are the base of the connection. Apart from this you can select the desired notch by clicking an entry.
Page B.11 - 24
3D Modifications
Shape End creates a simple notch at the end of the shape, US-Cope creates a complex moment-cope-notch (see below). Here the following types are available as already described above: square, drill out and round off. The shape is shortened compared with its original length.
Both Sides Equal The notches are carried out equally on the top and on the bottom of the shape. Turn The notch is rotated by 90 compared with the longitudinal axis of the shape.
Center Hole-Flange Distance from the upper / lower notch to the flange of the shape. Diameter Diameter of the drill hole for drilling out or radius of rounding
Page B.11 - 25
3D Modifications
Center Hole-End Distance of the notch from the end of the shape without taking the web distance into consideration.
Page B.11 - 26
3D Modifications
Different from the notches described up to now, the default settings of this notch are transformed into a poly-cut. The option for corner treatment is not available here. The result then looks as follows:
Page B.11 - 27
3D Modifications
Web Distance Flange Thickness Angle of Intersection Flange Distance Center Hole-Flange Diameter Hole Center Center Hole-End
Page B.11 - 28
3D Modifications
B.11.7
Boolean Operations
For volume modelling, ProSteel does not use the AutoCAD volume modeller ACIS but the modeller which is used in Architectural Desktop as well. This modeller works faster and produces smaller graph files. Consequently, you cannot process ProSteel objects with the Boolean operations of AutoCAD (e.g. subtract their volumes). In case you do combine objects, there will be no errors, but nothing will happen! In order to give you the same performance range as with AutoCAD, all Boolean operations were redefined (see also the command Basic Solids). Another option is to use the ProSteel properties to convert the ProSteel objects into ACIS volume models and then to process them with AutoCAD. Your drawings will then become larger and more sluggish.
Add
PS_ADD This command creates a new volume by adding two existing volumes. You have to click both objects and the newly created object receives all parts list information of the object you clicked on first.
Subtract
PS_SUB This command creates a new volume by subtracting one or several volumes from an existing volume. First, you have to click the object from which the other volumes are to be subtracted. Then click the objects whose volume is to be subtracted (these will be deleted in the process!). The new object receives all parts list information of the object you clicked on first. Please note, that you will not create two independent objects in case you split the first object in the process.
Page B.11 - 29
3D Modifications
Cut-Set
PS_COMMON This command creates a new volume by using the cut-set of two existing volumes, i. e., the new volume is the part the two objects shared. You have to click both objects and the new object will receive all parts list information of the object you clicked on first.
Schnittmenge abziehen
PS_COMMON_SUB
Diese Funktion erzeugt ein neues Volumen durch Abziehen der Schnittmenge zweier vorhandener Volumina vom ersten Volumen. Es findet also ein Anpassen des ersten Teiles an das zweite Teil statt, wobei das zweite Teil aber erhalten bleibt.
Page B.11 - 30
Plate Editor
A special plate editor is available for processing of plates. This editor allows for modifying the contour by adding or separating poly-lines in a fast and comfortable way. You may see the poly-line as a plate of the same thickness and position like the plate to be processed. In addition, you can add chamfers and edges. All commands can also be carried out via the normal manipulation. The use of the plate editor is recommended when poly-plates have to be processed in complex situations because it can hide the other component parts and it automatically enters the plate level. When loading the function, click the plate to be modified first. Then a dialog appears where you can enter further indications with regard to the desired processing.
Page B.12 - 1
Plate Editor
B.12.1
Boolean Operations
Boolean Opera Here, you specify what kind of processing has to be carried out: either Add, Subtract or Common. Side Contour Select from which side of the plate the processing has to be carried out. You can use a polygon either as complete solid or as contour line. Please pay attention that the poly-line has to be closed, even if it is used as contour. If the poly-line has to be used as complete contour, you can enter an offset towards the contour. If the poly-line has to be used as milling contour, you can enter the width of the contour here. Here, you enter the depth of processing if the poly-line is not used completely continuous. If this option is activated, all other component parts are hidden at plate selection. This is valid from the next selection onward. The poly-line is used as solid with the plate thickness, i.e. continuous.
Page B.12 - 2
Plate Editor
Click this button to determine the contour via the different contour points.
Click this button to determine the contour by picking a polyline, a circle or an arc.
Page B.12 - 3
Plate Editor
B.12.2
Chamfer
Use this button to select the corresponding corner of the plate if you want to add a chamfer to a plate. Then, the input fields are released. Layout Here, you select which kind of chamfer has to be carried out: straight, convex or concave.
Radius/1st. Edge Here, you indicate the radius at convex/concave version or the length of the first edge at straight version. 2nd. Edge Here, you indicate the length of the second edge of the straight chamfer.
Page B.12 - 4
Plate Editor
Rounding Off
Use this button to select the corresponding plate edge to round off an edge. Then, the input fields are released. You can define the rounding off either via the radius or via the height of the rounding above the straight edge. Radius Min. Radius Height Max. Height Specify the rounding radius. Here, the program shows you the minimum radius that is possible. Specify the height above the straight edge. Here, the program shows you the maximum height that is possible.
Example for a plate with rounded off edge before and after the rounding off has been effected
Page B.12 - 5
Plate Editor
B.12.3
Edge Processing
This function serves for processing of one or more edges. The edges can be chamfered, rounded off, been equipped with a radius or seamed.
Use this button to select the corresponding plate edge to process an edge. Then, the input fields are released. Layout specifies the kind of processing. six different kinds of edge processing are available for selection.
The selected processing is made at the upper side of the plate. The selected processing is made at the lower side of the plate.
Page B.12 - 6
Plate Editor
The following parameters are valid both for top and bottom side of the plate. Var1 Var2 Selected Edge This value is either the length of the first edge, the rounding radius or the depth of the seam. This value is either the length of the second edge or the height of the seam. Here, you indicate from which edge to which edge the processing has to be made. When you click the edge and the side is switched on, the edges are displayed in a numbered way. You can select the processing area. If the starting value is equal to the end value, the processing will be carried out all around.
Select e. g. 0-1, 2-3 for the edges to be processed, when you want to process the two opposite sides.
Page B.12 - 7
Plate Editor
Page B.12 - 8
Page B.13 - 1
B.13.1
Layout
Select the general form of the drill hole field here. Rectangular In a rectangular drill hole field, the drill holes are arranged in a rectangular way around the insertion point forming rows and columns. Radial In a radial drill hole field, the drill holes are arranged in a complete or partial circle around the insertion point. Additional input fields are displayed allowing you to define round drill hole fields. Single Holes The position of each single hole can be determined individually.
Rectangular Drill Hole Field Definition In general, drill hole fields are described as follows: Number1*Pitch1, Intermediate Pitch1, Number2*Pitch2, Intermediate Pitch2,... Shape/X Dir Cross/Y Dir Description of drill hole field in shape direction, for plates in xdirection of the UCS. Description of drill hole field perpendicular to the shape direction, for plates in y-direction of the UCS. Rectangular drill hole fields are described by indicating number*pitch of the drill holes and any existing Intermediate pitches (separated by a comma). At a number = 1 you can omit the pitch.
Page B.13 - 2
Radial Drill Hole Field Number Radius Area Start Number of drill holes The radius of the circle where the drill holes are arranged around the insertion point The angle area throughout which the drill holes are distributed. The starting angle from which on the drill holes are distributed.
Further Default Parameters Diameter The bolt diameter is specified. It is taken from a list that can be edited, as you like. This list is stored in the directory.. \prg under pro_st3d.hdr. If you activate the option for individual diameter input in the global settings, you can also enter values not included in the list. If you dont insert any thread hole, you can enter here the clearance between bolt diameter and hole diameter. In the above list, you can also define a Workloose for the bolt diameters. However, you have to activate the use in the Global Settings / Bolts. You can enter any value here.
Addition
Rectangle Hole Axis If rectangle holes have to be inserted, you enter the length of the rectangle hole axis here. Layout Drill Through Drill holes are created from one material edge to the other. Drill Blind Hole The holes have only a certain length. Weld Crack This is a small marking. Specify the depth of the drill hole for the layout Drill Blind Hole. Indicates the flange to be drilled. You may either drill holes into the upper or lower flange or into both flanges. Upper/Lower flange results from the position of the component part and from the current z-axis. The insertion point is perpendicular to the shape centre before use. Thus you will always obtain symmetrical drill holes related to the shape centre.
Depth Flange
Shape Centre
Page B.13 - 3
Click this button to insert drill holes into several component parts simultaneously. You can select several parts at the same time; alignment is made according to the first picked part. Click this button to adopt the drill holes of one component part into another one. First click all shapes with holes to be transferred and then all shapes to adopt the hole. Using this function, drill holes from a copied connecting plate may be rapidly transferred to a shape. This option is only available if you didnt select the option Bolted Connection. If you keep the Shift-key pressed at component part selection, you can select a XRef component part.
You can also adopt a drill hole field with simultaneous bolted connection into a new shape so that the new shape is drilled first and then bolted. First select the properties of the shape and click on the EDIT button in the Drill Holes tab. The drill hole dialog described here will be displayed and you can adopt the drill holes with bolts using Bolts/Add. Monitor Here you can see the creation of the drill hole field and define the insertion point.
Page B.13 - 4
This hole group is entered in the drill hole description as follows: Input field shape / X Dir Input field cross / Y Dir 2*60,200,1*,200,3*40 2*100
If you only want to insert a hole group with single holes in longitudinal direction, just leave the box for crosswise direction empty.
If you want to insert a hole group in the crosswise direction only, you have to enter 1* in longitudinal direction in any case (for one hole).
One single drill hole field cannot cover mixed groups consisting of one and two holes in crosswise direction!
You can enter the predefined marking gauges of the shape by typing the letter W instead of a pitch, e.g. 2*W. If no specific marking gauge has been defined for the current shape, the program will prompt you to enter one.
Page B.13 - 5
B.13.2
Bolted Connections
Alternatively to drilling option, you can directly add a bolted connection to the component parts. For this purpose, you have to select at least 2 component parts the distance of which is not bigger than specified in the gap input field. All settings with regard to drill hole field, diameter, etc. are made on the first page.
Select the desired bolt style here. Maximum distance of one contact surface to the other; if the distance is bigger, no bolted connection will be created
Length Addition Length addition for the bolts Touch Plane Normally, drill holes are created along the z-axis of the current UCS. At bolted connection option, however, the program can be prompted to search for contact surfaces. Normally, these are the surfaces where a bolted connection is inserted. For this purpose, the UCS doesnt have to be placed normally on these surfaces.
Page B.13 - 6
In this example, the plate can be bolted to the shape although the UCS is not aligned normally to the drill hole direction. Single Hole Bolt The insertion of bolts into a part is allowed as well. Turn Update auto The bolts are turned before insertion. The connection is automatically updated if a component part has been modified. A logical link is created between the participating component parts.
Page B.13 - 7
B.13.3
Additional Settings
Here, you specify the kind of bolt to be inserted. The drill hole has one diameter at each position. The hole is drilled as countersunk hole. In this case, you can set the countersunk Depth and the opening Angle. The hole is drilled as step hole. You can determine the Depth of the step and the upper diameter additionally. The figure below shows you all three available layouts one beside the other.
Page B.13 - 8
This setting influences the later 2D-depiction. You can influence the insertion point of the drill hole using an offset related to the selected insertion point. In this case you can enter the offset separately for x, y. In this case you can enter the offset by means of distance and angle related to the insertion axis. In the case of shapes, the insertion axis is the longitudinal axis instead of the x-axis. The insertion point is perpendicular to the shape centre before use. Thus you will always obtain symmetrical drill holes related to the shape centre. During drilling, the crack lines of the participating shapes are displayed. After end of drilling they disappear again. During drilling, the centre lines of the participating shapes are displayed. After end of drilling they disappear again. If this field is checked, the drill hole is not interrupted at concave chambers, which occur due to inner contours. Thus, it is possible to drill through a square tube completely. Otherwise, only one side would be drilled. The drill hole is executed as thread hole. No Workloose is used and the drill hole is correctly displayed as thread hole in 2D depiction. In 3D depiction, additional lines are displayed to make the thread hole visible.
Shape Centre
Create Thread
Page B.13 - 9
B.13.4
Edge Distances
ProSteel can automatically verify the admissible edge distance during drilling of component parts. It is also possible to carry out this control manually for certain parts. If an automatic control has to take place, which is activated directly during drilling, you have to switch on the corresponding option in the global settings. You can specify the admissible edge distances of shapes and plates for each hole diameter in a table. The corresponding drill hole then will be verified by means of this table and the part will be marked in colour if the distance is too small. If the automatic control is activated, an info window appears during drilling. However, the drilling will be realized nevertheless.
In this table, you can assign the corresponding minimum distances for any existing drill hole diameter, separated according to shapes and plates. Click this button to start controlling the edge distances. You are prompted to select the parts. If the drill hole distances of a part are smaller than the selected distances, this part will be highlighted in colour. You can remove this marking using the command PS_REGEN. If you suppress any further display during automatic control, any existing smaller distances will not be displayed any more. This button serves for removing the lock of the display. If you have activated the Expert mode in the global settings, this button will be additionally displayed. It permits editing of the diameter table.
Page B.13 - 10
The corresponding diameter The specified edge distance for shapes The specified edge distance for plates
When you quit this dialog with OK, the indicated values are adopted into the table and this list is sorted anew according to the available diameters.
Automatic Control
If the automatic control of the edge distances has been activated and the program detects smaller edge distances during an operation, a warning message will be displayed. However, this warning is only a hint; the corresponding drill hole will nevertheless be inserted into the component part. Please note that this message might not appear before end of the action.
Page B.13 - 11
Page B.13 - 12
Bolts
B.14 Bolts
Bolting of component parts is the easiest form of automatic connections provided by ProSteel. In previous versions, the components to be bolted had to be drilled first.which now is not necessary any more. Of course, it is still possible to continue working with the existing combination of drilling/bolting. Another option is the creation of user-defined bolt styles as well as the check and update of the bolting via logical links (please refer to ->'Logical Links'). In some connection dialogs, a lot of settings are not necessary and you can set the bolts exactly according to your requirements. After all component parts, to be bolted with each other are selected, the program checks the position of the parts with regard to possible bolting (if need be, with regard to drillings which are situated one above the other and having an allowable tolerance; but it does not check possible mounting). Necessary bolt lengths are calculated and the bolts are inserted according to your default settings with regard to type and possible washers. Then, the bolts are adopted into a bolt list for later parts list.
Page B.14 - 1
Bolts
B.14.1
Bolting parts
The components are bolted automatically after part selection and selection of the bolt style. The holes in the component parts are analysed and the corresponding bolts are selected and inserted. After having loaded the function, you will get the following screen display:
Bolt style
Single hole Bolting Normally, at least 2 component parts are required for a bolting. Sometimes you only want to insert bolts without bolting them. This option creates bolts for each hole of the selected component parts without requiring a second part. Create dynamic Connection The selected component parts are connected with each other via logical links. The bolting is automatically updated in case of modification. Diameter Indicates the virtual hole diameter if you want to create a single bolt manually. This process was chosen to preserve the compatibility with standard bolting function. Indicates the virtual free play if manual insertion has been selected.
Work loose
Page B.14 - 2
Bolts
Length Addition Indicates the value by which the bolts are extended. This is valid for all kinds of insertion. Gap distance Indicates the maximum distance between two holes which are assumed to belong to the bolting. If this value is exceeded the holes cannot be bolted.
Angle difference This is the difference of the angles of the drilled holes in degrees. If this value is exceeded, the holes don't align and cannot be bolted. Colours bolt= indicates the colour of the bolt on the monitor, monitor= indicates the colour of monitor background. This button allows bolting of component parts. Select the desired parts and the bolts will be inserted into these component parts according to the existing holes. This button allows bolting of component parts. Select the desired parts as well as the area of bolting and the bolts will be inserted into these component parts according to the existing holes. This option permits manual insertion of a bolt. Select start and endpoint of grip length and the bolt will be inserted. This button permits to attach a single nut and/or disk without the corresponding bolt. To do so, pick the insertion point of the nut or washer and then the direction of the bolt head (where it would normally be). To attach a nut and/or washer directly at a round bar steel, first press the ESC-key, and then click the round bar steel at the desired end. This button allows rotation of one or several bolts. Select the corresponding bolts and they will be rotated. This button allows new weight calculation of the selected bolts on the base of their volume.
Page B.14 - 3
Bolts
B.14.2
Bolt Style
Here, user selects the bolt style, which is to be modified. This button opens the dialog for bolt definition.
nd
Washer
Activate this option if your style definition is to be equipped nd with a 2 washer. This button opens the dialog for definition of the 2 is only available if this option has been activated.
nd
washer. It
nd
Tapered Washer Activate this option if your style definition is to be nd equipped with a 2 wedge washer. This button opens the dialog for definition of the 2 wedge washer. It is only available if this option has been activated.
nd
Page B.14 - 4
Bolts Tapered washer Activate this option if your style definition is to be equipped nd with a 2 wedge washer. This button opens the dialog for definition of the wedge washer. It is only available if this option has been activated.
Washer
Activate this option if your style definition is to be equipped with a washer beneath the nut. This button opens the dialog for definition of the washer. It is only available if this option has been activated.
Nut
Activate this option if your style definition is to be equipped with a nut. This button opens the dialog for definition of the nut. It is only available if this option has been activated.
Safety nut
Activate this option if your style definition is to be equipped with a safety nut. This button opens the dialog for definition of the safety nut. It is only available if this option has been activated.
The current definition is stored in the drawing and in a file. If the style is modified and you leave this page without having saved the modifications, you are asked whether you want to save. Permits loading of the current style definition from a style file. All current definitions of the current style will be overwritten.
Page B.14 - 5
Bolts
Bolt Definition
When the button for bolt definition is pressed, the following dialog opens:
Indicates the current style Indicates which data file is used for bolts with this style. Only bolt files are displayed. Here you specify the entry of the bolt, which is to be written into the parts list and position flag. Two variables may be used: $(D) stands for bolt diameter and $(L) stands for bolt length. In addition, the following two variables are possible: $(GLM) for min grip length and $(GLX) for max grip length. This name is used for data export. The above-mentioned conditions are valid as well.
Export name
Material Tension
Here the bolt material is selected. Only those materials are listed which have been defined as bolt materials. Enter the tension as a percentage.
Page B.14 - 6
Bolts
Length Addition Enter the additional length of the bolts. The bolt will be extended by this value after length calculation. Layout Specify whether the bolt has to be a shop bolt or an assembly bolt. This specification has influences on the parts list. When an assembly list is created, only assembly bolts will be taken into consideration. Specify the units the data file is based on. Select the coating of the bolt. Select the colour of the bolt in the model. You may select a bitmap that is used in the selection lists of this style. Click on this button to open the AutoCAD-dialog for colour selection. When you have clicked on the corresponding input field before, you can comfortably select the colour. Click on this button to open the file selection dialog and you can select the bitmap for the bolt style. Countersunk head The bolt is displayed as countersunk bolt. Parts list entry Inner Hexagon No DM Check The bolt is adopted into the parts list. The bolt is executed as inner hexagon. For this bolt, a diameter check will not be carried out. Normally, all entered diameters which are found will be reduced to standard values. Thus e.g. a bolt with bolt diameter DM=12.5mm cannot be created.
Individual Mounting Space The bolt has a standard mounting space or the bolt style has an individual mounting space. Upper Area Enter the width of the mounting space at the bolt head either as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the diameter via *xx or as addition to the diameter via +xx. Enter the length of the mounting space at the bolt head either as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the length via *xx or as addition to the length via +xx.
Page B.14 - 7
Bolts
Lower Area
Enter the width of the mounting space at the bolt base either as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the diameter via *xx or as addition to the diameter via +xx. Enter the length of the mounting space at the bolt base either as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the nut height via *xx or as addition to the nut height via +xx.
Page B.14 - 8
Bolts
Nut Definition
Indicates which data files are used for nuts with this style. Only nut files are displayed. Here you specify the entry of the nut, which is to be written into the parts list and position flag. Two variables may be used. $(D) stands for bolt diameter, $(L) stands for bolt length. This name is used for data export. The above-mentioned conditions are valid as well. Here the nut material is selected. Only those materials are listed which have been defined as bolt materials. The nut is adopted into the parts list.
Page B.14 - 9
Bolts
Washer Definition
Indicates which data files are used for washers with this style. Only washer files are displayed. Here you specify the entry of the washer, which is to be written into the parts list and position flag. Two variables may be used. $(D) stands for bolt diameter, $(L) stands for bolt length. This name is used for data export. The above-mentioned conditions are valid as well. Here the washer material is selected. Only those materials are listed which have been defined as bolt materials. The washer is adopted into the parts list.
Page B.14 - 10
Bolts
Data file
Indicates which data files are used for washers with this style. Only washer files are displayed.
Parts Entry U-washer This definition is used in case U-shapes are applied. The same is valid for I-washers. Here, you specify the entry of the washer, which has to be written into the parts list and position flag. Two variables may be used. $(D) stands for bolt diameter, $(L) stands for bolt length. Export name Material Partlist entry this name is used for data export. The above-mentioned conditions are valid as well. Here, the washer material is selected. Only those materials are listed which have been defined as bolt material. The washer is adopted into the parts list.
Replace standard washer The standard washer is also executed as wedge washer for this definition.
Page B.14 - 11
Bolts
Use the indicated style to define the thread of the threaded rod. Indicates the diameter of the threaded rod. Indicates the end offset of the threaded rod. Rounds the overall length of the threaded rod to the indicated value. The threaded rod is inserted into the model by using 2 points.
Page B.14 - 12
Bolts
B.14.3
Sort
This dialog page serves for management of bolt style selection lists and for creation of new bolt styles.
Serves for creation of new bolt styles. After selection, you are asked for the name of the new style. Then, the style is created and is equipped with the settings of the current style. Allows loading of a style from the file. The style is inserted at the current position. The currently checked style is deleted without further query.
All style definitions stored in your corresponding files will be updated. The styles are stored as objects in the drawing. When the style definition is modified on the hard disk, normally the modifications are not transferred to the internal objects. They are carried out for all styles by this function.
Page B.14 - 13
Bolts
Page B.14 - 14
Insert Stiffeners
Insertion of Stiffeners
You can insert stiffeners either in views or in the global view. When you have selected normal stiffeners (i.e. stiffeners running vertically to the shape axis), you are prompted to specify the shape where the stiffeners are to be inserted. After selection, the program prompts you to specify the center of the insertion point of the stiffeners. Click the point you want on the shape or on a construction line. Your pick point is generally placed perpendicular to the shape axis. When you have selected Full Stiffener, the stiffener is inserted to fit. When you have selected Half Stiffener or To Measure, you are prompted to specify the fastening side of the stiffeners. Click the flange side with which the stiffeners are to be in contact. Lets assume that you have drawn the construction lines on the upper flange in the top view as shown on the left. If you click the line at any point, the pick point is always positioned perpendicular to the axis and used as the insertion point of the stiffeners.
Page B.15 - 1
Insert Stiffeners
Dimensions
Layout
Here you select the shape of the inner corners of the stiffeners.
Use Flat..
A flat steel is used instead of a poly-plate. The flat is processed by Boolean operations in a way as if its shape would be identical with a poly-plate.
Search Closest Flat The current polyplate is replaced by the closest fitting flat steel. No user-specific flat steel is created. Length Full Stiffener Half Stiffener By Length Here, you specify the length of the stiffeners. The stiffener height extends over the complete web height of the shape. The stiffener height stretches over half the web height of the shape where the side is determined by the picked side. The stiffener is given the height specified by you. Only values between 10-90% of the web height can be used.
Page B.15 - 2
Insert Stiffeners
Square Thickness
The height of the stiffener is determined according to the specifications, but the layout is a triangle shape. Thickness of the stiffener plate; this value is taken from the table or it can be entered freely if this setting has been activated. When calculating the stiffener dimensions, this is the distance to the flange side, i.e., the stiffener height is slightly reduced. When calculating the stiffener dimensions, this is the distance to the web side, i.e., the stiffener width is slightly reduced. This is the value for the stiffener length when you have selected the stiffener length To Measure. When calculating the stiffener dimensions, this is the distance to the outer edge of the flanges, i.e., the stiffener width is slightly reduced. If the stiffener is to slightly project towards the outside, type a negative value. The Round to value describes a rounding accuracy applicable to the width of the calculated stiffened plate. Rounding is carried out after calculation of the projection. Using this command, it is possible, e.g., to permit only dimensions divisible by 5, so that flat steel bars can be used. In the Radius input field you specify the radius of the ribbed plate at the shape radii. If this value is 0, the shape radius is imported. If you have selected the create Insert at Slant, the radius is bridged by a slanted edge. Click this button to move the stiffener with respect to the insertion point. After insertion, the stiffener first is placed in the middle of the insertion point. However, you can also align it to the upper or lower edge of the stiffener by clicking repeatedly on it.
Round to
Radius
Page B.15 - 3
Insert Stiffeners
Connect
On this page you specify the weld style in the case the stiffeners have to be welded directly. You can also attach weld cracks to mark the stiffeners in the shape.
Weld Style Flange Side Thickness Web Side Thickness Weld Mark
Specify the weld style to be used. The flange side of the stiffeners will be welded. If you want to overwrite the thickness of the selected style, you may do this here. The web side of the stiffeners will be welded. If you want to overwrite the thickness of the selected style, you may do this here. Here, you specify whether small drill holes serving as weld marks have to be inserted into the shape after insertion of the stiffeners. These weld marks then can be output in the workshop drawings or in the NC-data. None No marks are fixed. At Center - A mark is fixed at the center of the stiffener. At Edges - A mark is fixed at each of the outer edges of the stiffener.
Page B.15 - 4
Insert Stiffeners
Create Group
If this field is checked, the stiffeners and the shape are arranged to create a group. If the shape is already part of another group, the stiffeners are allocated to that other group.
Options
Angle insertion
If this field is checked, stiffeners can be inserted in the shape using a slant. At insertion, you are prompted for a line specifying the direction. The necessary extension of the stiffener width is automatically calculated.
Page B.15 - 5
Insert Stiffeners
Angle 2D-Section
Here you can enter the position angle related to the centerline. If this field is checked, an automatic 2D section is inserted directly at the stiffener. This section can be displayed during detailing. The cutting plane is situated slightly in front of the stiffener and it ends slightly behind the stiffener; the cutting direction is always in shape direction.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Oblique Stiffeners
In principle, the insertion of oblique stiffeners is the same as described above, except for the fact that you are prompted to define a position line of the stiffeners. Click a (construction) line showing the orientation of the stiffeners. Now, the stiffeners are inserted into the shape in an oblique position. The distances refer to the outer corners of the stiffener plates. If you select the command via PS_RIP_ANGLE, you will be prompted for the position line right during input and can then click it. Show the center line of the shape in the top view and use the virtual point of intersection without Z, in order to get an exact center point of insertion using the point of intersection of the axis and the construction line.
Page B.15 - 6
Plate Connections
Page B.16 - 1
Plate Connections
B.16.1
Layout of Plate
Specify the layout of the connecting plate. The following figure displays different connection types, which can be created.
Page B.16 - 2
Plate Connections
If you selected the Automatic option, the program decides which type to be used depending on the position of the shapes. The critical angle, which differentiates between, spliced and standard plate connection is approximately 45. If you want to obtain the Flange type, you have to set this option explicitly because otherwise always a plate connection at the web will be created.
Group Dimensions Width Thickness Length means the width of the plate (in case of I shapes: parallel to the shape flange). means the thickness of the plate. means a fixed length of the plate independent of the shape height. Entering the value 0 for the length, you can enter the plate length variably in the Offset Top and Offset Bottom fields as distance from the upper and lower edge of the selected shape. Gap means that an indicated space is left between the supporting shape and the plate. This allows you to consider e.g. finishing tolerances. means the distance from the upper shape edge. Positive values reduce the plate dimensions towards the middle. Negative values increase the plate dimensions beyond the shape. means the distance from the lower shape edge. Positive values reduce the plate dimensions towards the middle. Negative values increase the plate dimensions beyond the shape. Here, you can create a second plate with different dimensions than the first one. The input fields for the dimensions of the second plate are released after the option has been clicked. The inserted end plates are not created as flats but as polyplate.
Offset Top
Offset
Doubler Plate
As Poly-Plate
Rotate Connection In case of asymmetric plates you can define the plate position here. Use this option to turn the complete connection by 180 around the insertion axis, if upper and lower side were exchanged at generation of the connection.
Page B.16 - 3
Plate Connections
Equal Plates
If you want to insert two identical plates, you have to activate the option Double Plate and set the option Equal Plates. Now the dimensions of the second plate are the same as for the first one and two identical plates are inserted. Click this button to adjust the first plate to the cross-section of any existing shape. Click this button to copy the data of the first plate into the input fields of the second plate.
Gap
Indicates the width of the gap between supporting shape and plate. Horizontal means that the complete plate connection is shifted parallel to the flange of the connecting shape. Vertical means that the complete plate connection is shifted parallel to the web of the connecting shape.
Plate Offset
Direct Call of Plate Functions The different default types can be called directly as well. If you have selected the connection type Splice, you can define a separation line for a continuous shape by pressing RETURN or the right mouse button when you are prompted for the supporting shape.
Normal:
PS_ENDPLATE_NORM
As Splice:
PS_ENDPLATE_SPLICE
At Flange:
PS_ENDPLATE_FLANGE
Page B.16 - 4
Plate Connections
Drill Holes
Without Holes The connection plate is created without drill holes.
Group Vertical The drill hole spacing in a vertical direction (height) is determined. Depending on the entry, the values have different meanings. Examples are given at the end of the command description. Upside Here, you enter the distance of the upper row of holes from the plates upper edge. If this value is 0, and the value in the box Downside is also 0, the only entry that will be used is in the Middle field. Here, you enter the distance of the first and second row of holes from the upper and lower plate edge. The holes will be distributed uniformly between the two outer holes if this value is 0. The other rows of holes will be arranged in the same manner if the number is greater than 4. Here, you enter the distance of the lowest row of holes from the plates lower edge. If this value is 0, and the val ue in the box Upside is also 0, the only entry that will be used is in the Middle field.
Middle
Downside
Page B.16 - 5
Plate Connections
Offset
Here, you enter a simultaneous shifting of all rows of holes with respect to the plate upper edge. If you enter a negative value, shifting will be carried out with respect to the plate lower edge. If you have selected this option, the structure of the hole pattern input changes and a list with an input field appears. Depending on the number of holes, you can determine each distance individually by clicking the position in the list and by specifying the distance in the input field. Here you can specify at asymmetrical distribution from which position the distribution of drill holes starts.
Asymmetrical
Measured from
Group Horizontal The drill hole spacing in a horizontal direction (width) is defined here. Examples are given at the end of the command description. Left Here, you enter the distance between the outer left row of holes and the central left row of holes, if the number of rows is 4. Here, you enter the distance between the two inner rows of holes. The rows of holes are generally arranged centrally, unless they are offset by an entry in the Offset field. Here, you enter the distance between the outer right row of holes and the central right row of holes, if the number of rows is 4. Here, you enter a simultaneous shifting of all rows of holes with respect to the right plate edge. If you enter a negative value, shifting will be carried out with respect to the left plate edge.
Middle
Right
Offset
Page B.16 - 6
Plate Connections
Connect
Bolt Settings Bolt style Dia Workloose You can select the type of bolts (e.g., DIN 6914) to be used for the connection using this list. Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection. Here, you enter the required clearance of the bolted connection, in most cases 2 mm. Click this button to process the bolt style or to create a new one. Weld Settings Weld Style Weld... Specify the kind of weld seam. You can specify which weld seams have to be created in the model using the options Weld Flange Side or Weld Web Side. The Thickness of the different weld seams is specified in the corresponding input fields. Click this button to process the weld style or to create a new one.
Page B.16 - 7
Plate Connections
Page B.16 - 8
Plate Connections
Stiffening Plates
As Poly-Plate
All kinds of stiffening plates described here which normally are carried out as flats can be transformed into a poly-plate using this option. You can specify additional backer plates automatically or according to certain dimensions. Thickness, width and length can be specified separately. A cover plate can be created According to Girder in an automate way. The cover plate can be adjusted even further via thickness, edge distance and offset.
Backer Plates
Top Plate
Web Plates Web Plates Additional web plates can be generated as well. Indicate the position of the web plate by means of the option web plate left and web plate right. The size is specified by thickness, width and length. No/Dia. indicates the number and the diameter of the drill holes. The Hole Distance and the horizontal and vertical offset of the web plate to the plate centre can be specified as well.
Page B.16 - 9
Plate Connections
Stiffeners
On the side of the end plate, stiffeners are inserted into the supporting shape at the level of the flanges. Use this option to create additional stiffeners between the already created stiffeners. In the input fields, you specify the number and the distance to the upper and lower edge of the plate.
Support Stiffeners Here, you can insert additional diagonal ribs into the supporting shape. With the Height entry, you define the distance of the lower insertion point to the inner side of the flange. The prerequisite for generating this stiffeners is the use of a bottom train having a rib on the side of the bottom train an a cover plate. Click this button to select the command for insertion or edition of stiffeners. Here, you can modify the values and create new templates.
Page B.16 - 10
Plate Connections
Please note that the settings for stiffeners cannot be made independently here. You only select a template containing the necessary parameters. The advantage is that you have to define a certain kind of stiffener only once and then only select it by using its name. However, you mustnt forget that in case of modifying this page after having modified this stiffener template the existing stiffeners are updated as well (i.e. they will obtain the dimensions of the modified template). Stiffeners at Bottom Train Supporting Shape Here, you specify the stiffener in the supporting shape at use of a bottom train. Connecting Shape Here you specify the stiffener in the connecting shape at use of a bottom train.
Here, you see an example of an end plate connection with bottom train, cover plate and diagonal stiffener in the supporting shape:
Page B.16 - 11
Plate Connections
Bottom Train
You can add additional haunches and further stiffeners to each of the previous connections and create a strengthened connection. Bolted knees, etc. can be generated in a relative fast way.
Select Haunch
If the entry Top Haunch is checked, the haunch will be created on the upper side of the shape to be connected. If the entry Bottom Haunch is checked, the haunch will be created on the lower side of the shape to be connected. the length of the bottom train the width of the bottom train at the intersection side the width of the bottom train at the top side the width of the bottom train flange
Flange Thickness the flange thickness of the bottom train Plate Thickness the thickness of the web plate of the bottom train Facet Size chamfer preset at the supporting side of the web plate
Facet Horizontal specification of the horizontal part of the chamfer at the connection side Facet Vertical specification of the vertical part of the chamfer at the connection side
Page B.16 - 12
Plate Connections
Cropped Shape A cropped shape is used as bottom train instead of a haunch of flat steel or plate. Additional stiffening plates can be inserted for a cropped shape. The dimensions are defined as follows: Stiff. Plate... ... as Plate Indicate the dimensions of the stiffening plate: Width, Length and Thickness. The stiffening plate is not carried out as a shape but as a plate. A rectangular plate is inserted as bottom train.
Rectangular Plate
Perpendicular to Support A rectangular plate is inserted with the edges parallel to the support. As Poly-Plate Rib Support Rib Connection The inserted shapes of the bottom train are transformed into plates. In the supporting shape, stiffeners are inserted on the level of the bottom train. Select the style under Ribs. In the connecting shape, stiffeners are inserted on the level of the bottom train. Select the style under Ribs.
Page B.16 - 13
Plate Connections
Form Group
Form Groups and Notches Create Group With Bolts With Welds At insertion of the end plate connection, groups are automatically created out of the inserted parts. Bolts are added to the group as well. Welds are added to the group as well.
Safety Notches Safety Copes... For the end plate connection, you can specify at which position a safety notch has to be inserted. This is a standard process in Northern America. You can choose whether you want to attach the notch on the Top left, on the bottom left, on the top right or on the bottom right.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page B.16 - 14
Plate Connections
B.16.2
In the selection list, you can see the connections according to DAST, which is available for the selected shapes. You can control the basic connection data in this list, and the necessary shape stiffeners are displayed as well. Tension, Shear... Here, you can enter a maximum load for the connection (in KN) for the corresponding load type. In the list, only the connections suitable for these loads will be displayed. Plate List In this list, the possible connections according to DAST are displayed. Select the desired connection by clicking it. The individual list fields display the data on which the connection is based. You might have to shift the column size to view all data. After the selection, the connection is immediately updated with these data and the values are transferred to the other dialog tabs for possible adaptation.
No Connection Possible If - according to the guidelines - no connection is defined for the selected shapes, no dialog tab will appear after selection of the shapes to define the connection. In this case, you have to define yourself the dimensions of the connection.
Page B.16 - 15
Plate Connections
Meaning of the List Entries Designation Width Thickness Length Horizontal Vertical Diameter Bolt Standard Stiffeners Backer Strengthening Projection Af As the standard designation of the connection the width of the plate (parallel to the flange of the connecting shape) the thickness of the plate the length of the plate (parallel to the web of the connecting shape) the number of drill holes in direction of the plate width the number of drill holes in direction of the plate length the used bolt diameter the used bolt type additional stiffeners are required for this connection additional backer plates are required for this connection Strengthening is required for this connection. the projection of the plate beyond the shape to be connected the thickness of the weld seam at the flange the thickness of the weld seam at the web
Page B.16 - 16
Plate Connections
Page B.16 - 17
Plate Connections
B.16.3
User-Defined Connections
Just as the data for plates resistant to deflection and those subject to shear forces is recorded in databases, you can also create a database containing user-defined plate connections and later load these stored types using a selection list. In principle, this serves the same purpose as storing and then loading free plates with the template function. User-defined plate connections can display a larger amount of data in a more clearly organized structure because all parameters are visible in the view. You can also process or export the data with any standard dBASE editor. HINT: Take advantage of this option by creating a database with frequently utilized and maybe company-specific connections, which are then always available to all program users within your company. Since the dialog and process after creation of the database is almost identical except for the selection - with those for the plates resistant to deflection, you can refer to this chapter for the meaning of the settings (see Plates Resistant to Deflection). How to create the database is listed in the technical s upplement or just ask ProSteel dealer.
Page B.16 - 18
Seite B.17 - 1
Layout
Selected Column Display which Selected Column is processed at the moment. Plate Width Plate Height Width of the base plate Height or length of the base plate
Plate Thickness Thickness of the base plate Grout Thickness In this input field, you can enter an additional space between the "Base Plate" (point of reference) and lower edge base plate. Once you have entered the supporting shape from the "Base Plate", all length dimensions will be adjusted correctly.
Group Options In Shape Direction If this option is activated, the plate is always attached normally beneath the shape. If the shape is slanted in the space, the plate is slanted as well.
Seite B.17 - 2
Shorten Column The column is shortened by the lining value. Form Group As Polyplate The shape and the plate are arranged to form a group. The base plate is not formed as flat bar but as poly-plate.
Drill Holes
Group Inner Drill Holes Hole Distance Hole Distance Hole Diameter Distance of inner drill holes to the X-axis of the shape. Distance of inner drill holes to the Y-axis of the shape. Diameter of inner drill holes
Group Outer Drill Holes Hole Field Width Number of drill holes of the outer hole field in the X-axis of the shape and intermediate distance of the drill holes of the outer hole field in the X-axis of the shape. Hole Field Height Number of drill holes of the outer hole field in the Y-axis of the shape and intermediate distance of the drill holes of the outer hole field in the Y-axis of the shape. Hole Diameter Diameter of outer drill holes. Outer drill holes are only created if both axes have a valid description.
Seite B.17 - 3
Bolts / Dowels
On this page, you make the settings of anchor bolts or welds. Anchor bolts are only displayed as symbols and cannot be detailed.
Group Bolts Tie Bolts Label Anchor bolts are inserted for the inner drill holes. The designation of anchor bolts for the parts list; this name can contain two variables, $(ID) for inner diameter and $(OD) for outer diameter. Anchor bolts are inserted for the outer drill hole field as well, if defined. Dowel elements are created as volume bodies. You can specify a database file from which the dowel definitions can be taken. The dowels are taken over into the bolt part list. The dowels are not taken over into the DetailCenter.
Group Weld Settings Weld Style Flange Side Thickness Web Side Style name for the welds if a weld has to be effected. Welds are inserted at the flange of the shape. If you want to overwrite the style thickness, you can enter the desired thickness for the flange side here. Welds are inserted at the web side of the shape.
Seite B.17 - 4
Thickness
If you want to overwrite the style thickness, you can enter the desired thickness for the web side here.
Standard Definitions
Data base entries are saved for certain DIN shapes. If you have selected a shape having such entries, these will be displayed in this window. You can influence the selection by means of different selection criteria. Only data records corresponding to these criteria will be displayed.
Support Load
Enter the minimum load of supports which is known. The program searches the entries supporting this load or a higher load. The desired drill hole diameter for anchor bolts.
Hole Dia.
Concrete Quality Quality of concrete foundations Select a displayed data record by double-clicking on it. All data are set accordingly. Please note that only the plate dimensions and the inner drill holes are set. Other settings are not modified.
Seite B.17 - 5
Dowels
In addition, you can specify the type of dowel for fixing the base plates.
You can modify the execution of the dowel with the anchor bolt by modifying the values for diameter, length and key.
Assignments
As it is the case for each dialog creating component parts, here too, it is possible to make all assignments for each individual shape directly. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Seite B.17 - 6
Shapes
Seite B.17 - 1
Shape Class,...
Here you can specify the angle shape of the selected connection. Only shapes that are equal-sided angles and unequal-sided angles can be selected. The web angle will be made from bent plate steel instead of angle steel. Enter the required dimensions in the Thickness, length of Long Leg, length of Short Leg and Bent Radius input fields. The program will determine the actual length of the steel plate. Here you determine the side of the shape (Left or Right) to be connected to the web angle. If both have been checked, a web angle is created at each side of the web. The long and short side of the web angle are exchanged so that the long side is situated at the connecting shape. Here you indicate the distance to be kept between the end of the connecting shape and the supporting shape. Here you indicate the distance between the web of the connected shape and the web angles (normally 0 or a slight clearance). Here you indicate the distance the web angle is shifted from the axis of the shape to be connected, upwards or to the right (depending on the position). A negative entry will cause shifting in the opposite direction. Selecting one of the following options permits you to make additional specifications referring to the dimension. Means that the vertical offset is measured from the upper edge of the shape up to the upper edge of the web angle. The vertical offset refers to the lower edge of shape and web angle instead of to the upper edge. The vertical offset refers to the centre of the first bolt instead of to the edges of the web angle.
Use Flat
Position
Vertical Offset
Seite B.17 - 2
Distances
Number (All Directions) Shape Direction The number of drill holes in both sides of the web angle crosswise to the shape to be connected (in the original position parallel to the connecting shape). Connect. Shape The number of drill holes in the long side of the web angle (in the original position parallel to the shape to be connected). Support Shape... The number of drill holes in the short side of the web angle (in the original position cross-wise to the connecting shape).
Distances (All Directions) Inner Distances These distances refer to the outer edge of the angle shape for each direction. If you indicate an additional Slot Length in the input fields beside Number, the drill holes are carried out as slotted holes with the indicated slot length. If you have checked the field Absolute Inner Distance, the inner distance of the holes in the short leg means the distance between the holes. Dist. Between These distances specify the distance between two holes for each direction.
Seite B.17 - 3
Bolt Settings Bolt Style Dia. Workloose Select the bolt style (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Specify the bolt diameter for the connection. Enter the desired clearance for the bolt connection, usually 2 mm.
Diagonal Offset A shift of the bolt axes between support and connecting bolts. Gap Spacing Distance between the web of the supporting shape and the web angle. Click this button to edit the bolt style or to create it anew.
Seite B.17 - 4
Weld Settings Weld Style Weld... Specify the kind of weld seam. You can specify which seams have to be created in the model via Weld Side of Connecting Shape or Weld Side of Supporting Shape. The Thickness of the different weld seams is specified in the corresponding input fields. Click this button to edit the weld style or to create it anew.
Seite B.17 - 5
Cope
In addition, you can add a cope to the connecting shape. Here, you enter the specifications of the cope.
Cope
Select an already stored cope template or you enter the cope data directly.
Connect. Shape Here you define how the connecting shape has to be coped. You can select Upper Side, Lower Side or Both. Specify the necessary gap distance for the cope in the Gap field. Click this button to create or modify the cope template.
Safety...
Here you can specify whether a safety cope has to be carried out. In addition, the inserted angle can be shortened.
Seite B.17 - 6
Standard Data
In the selection list, you can see the web angle connections available in the database. In this list, you can verify the basic parameters of the connection data.
H(kN), Hz(kN)
You can select a web angle according to the DAST guidelines. Enter the desired load in the input fields. The possible connection angles will be displayed in the selection list. In this List, the possible connections filed in the database are displayed. Select the desired connection by clicking an entry. The basic data of the connection are displayed in the different List Fields.
List
Meaning of the List Entries Shape Bolt Dia Material Web angle shape Bolt type used Bolt diameter used Material designation of the web angle
Seite B.17 - 7
Transversal Dir. Number of drill holes cross-wise to the shape to be connected W1, W2, W3,... The meaning of the distances can be seen on the illustration of a cut-up web angle connection.
Seite B.17 - 8
Form Group
At insert of the web angle connection, the inserted parts are automatically arranged to form a construction group. Bolts and weld seams are added to the construction group as well. An individual construction group is created for each inserted web angle.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Seite B.17 - 9
Seite B.17 - 10
Shear Plates
Shapes
Thickness
Page B.19 - 1
Shear Plates
If this field is checked, the plate is cut at the connecting shape in case of bevelled shapes to be connected. If this field is checked, the plate is not inserted in shape direction at bevelled connecting shapes but always perpendicular towards the connecting shape.
Poly-plates are inserted instead of flats. If a flat is used, it will be created with the size length x 10 instead of with the size width x 10. (Example: FL 110x10 becomes BRFL 250x10) Specify the web side of the shape to be connected (left or right), which is to be used for attaching the web plate. If Both is checked, a plate is attached to both sides of the web. means that the vertical offset is measured from upper edge shape to upper edge web plate. The vertical offset refers to the lower edge of shape and web plate. If you have checked the field Up to 1st. Bolt, the vertical offset doesnt refer to the edges of the web plate but to the center of the first drill hole. In the input field Gap you enter the distance to be adhered to from the outer edge of the support shape to the outer edge of the shape to be connected. In the input field Vertical Offset you enter the distance of the offset for the web plate from the axis of the shape to be connected towards top or to the right (depending on position). Negative values effect an opposite offset.
Position
Gap
Vertical Offset
Page B.19 - 2
Shear Plates
Distances
Group Division in Shape Direction Number End Offset Connection Dist. Between. Number of drill holes in shape direction Distance of the last center of a drill hole to the end of the web plate on the side of the connecting shape. Distance of the last drill hole to the end of the connecting shape on the side of the support shape. Distance between two drill holes in the direction of the connecting shape.
Group Division in Transversal Direction Number Edge Distance Dist. Between Number of drill holes in transversal shape direction Distance of the drill holes to the outer edge of the web plate. Distances between two drill holes in the transversal direction of the connecting shape.
Page B.19 - 3
Shear Plates
Connect
Bolt Settings Bolts Dia Workloose Select the bolt style (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Specify the bolt diameter for the connection. Here, you enter the desired clearance of the bolted connection, mostly 2 mm. Click this button to process the bolt style or to create a new one.
Weld Settings Weld Style Here, you specify the kind of weld seam. Click this button to edit the weld style or to create a new one.
Weld...
Specify which seams to be created in the model using the option Weld Flange Side or Weld Web Side. The Thickness of the different weld seams is specified in the corresponding input fields.
Page B.19 - 4
Shear Plates
Cope
In addition, you can notch the connecting shape. Enter the corresponding specifications in this dialog box.
Notch
You can either select an already stored notch variant or you enter the data directly.
Cope Connect Here, you specify how the connecting shape has to be notched. You can select Upper Side, Lower Side or Both. Define the necessary gap distance for the notch in the Gap field.
Page B.19 - 5
Shear Plates
Standard Data
In the selection list, you can see the shear plate connections available in the database. In this list, you can verify the basic parameters of the connecting data.
H(kN), Hz(kN)
Here, you can select a shear plate according to the loads. Enter the desired load in the input fields. Then, the available connection plates will be displayed in the selection list. In this List the possible connections filed in the database are displayed. Select the desired connection by clicking it. In the different List fields, you can see the basic data of this connection.
List
Page B.19 - 6
Shear Plates Meaning of the List Entries Designation Thickness Material Dia Bolt Connection name Thickness of the web plate Material descriptions of the web plate The utilized bolt diameter The utilized bolt type
Shape Direction The number of drill holes along the shape to be connected. Crosswise MaH, MaHz W1, W2, W3,... The number of drill holes in perpendicular (crosswise) direction of the shape to be connected. Max. Load for this connection The following picture illustrates the meaning of the distances:
Page B.19 - 7
Shear Plates
Form Group
Create Group
At insertion of the shear plate connection, the inserted parts are automatically assigned to a construction group which is created. The bolts and weld seams are also added to that group. An own construction group is created for each inserted shear plate.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page B.19 - 8
Splice Joints
Page B.20 - 1
Splice Joints
Options
Gap Distance Bolts Dia Workloose Upper Side Lower Side Single Side
Here you indicate the distance between the two shapes to be respected. Specify the desired bolt style for the connection. Specify the desired bolt diameter from the list or enter the value directly if this option has been activated. This field is used to specify the hole clearance of the desired drill holes, which usually consists of 2 mm. If this field is checked, a plate connection is attached to the upper side of the shape. If this field is checked, a plate connection is attached to the lower side of the shape. If this field is checked, the splice joint is attached to the side of the second shape to be connected in the form of a welded connection. If this field is checked; an additional plate is attached to the inner upper side of the shape. If this field is checked, an additional plate is attached to the inner lower side of the shape.
Page B.20 - 2
Splice Joints
Diagonal
Use this option to create a bolted connection at one upper side and a welded connection at the other. For the lower side, it is just the opposite. If this field is checked, a plate connection is attached to the left side of the shape. If this field is checked, a plate connection is attached to the right side of the shape. If this field is checked, the web plate is assigned to a construction group together with the shape to be connected. If the shape is already part of another component group, the web plate will be assigned to the same group. If this field is checked, the bolts of the shape to be connected are also added to that group.
With Bolts
Top/Bottom
On the second page, you can enter the settings for the upper and lower splice.
Number Shape.. Indicates the number of bolts in shape direction Edges Outside Indicates the projection of the splices beyond the last bolt
Page B.20 - 3
Splice Joints
Indicates the distance from the starting point of the shape to the first bolt Indicates the distance from one bolt to the other
Number Cross.. Indicates the number of bolts transversal to the shape direction. Edge Outside Inner Distance Dist. Between Thickness Vertical Weld Indicates the distance of the plate beyond the outmost bolts Indicates the distance from one bolt to the other. If there are more than 2 bolts in transversal direction, this value indicates the distance from one outer bolt to the other. Select the plate thickness from the list. If you have activated the free selection option, you can enter this value directly. This value moves the splices in transversal direction to the shape. If this setting is activated, no bolts and drill holes will be inserted, but the parts will be welded with each other. Length settings are still valid. Here you specify the length of the splice to be welded. Enter your value here if you want to overwrite the thickness using the desired weld style. Select the weld style to be used.
Page B.20 - 4
Splice Joints
Left/Right
On the third page, you can enter the settings for the left and right splice.
Number Shape.. Indicates the number of bolts in shape direction at each side Edges Outside Edges Inside Dist. Between Indicates the projection of the splices beyond the last bolt Indicates the distance from the starting point of the shape to the first bolt Indicates the distance from one bolt to the other
Number Cross.. Indicates the number of bolts transversal to the shape direction. Edges Outside Inner Distance Dist. Between. Thickness Vertical Indicates the distance of the plate beyond the outmost bolts Indicates the distance from one bolt to the other. If there are more than 2 bolts in transversal direction, this value indicates the distance from one outer bolt to the other. Select the plate thickness from the list. If you have activated the free selection option, you can enter this value directly. This value moves the splices in transversal direction to the shape.
Page B.20 - 5
Splice Joints
Weld
If this setting is activated, no bolts and drill holes will be inserted, but the parts will be welded with each other. Length settings are still valid. Here you specify the length of the splice to be welded. Enter your value here if you want to overwrite the thickness using the desired weld style. Select the weld style to be used.
Data
When you have defined a database for the selected shape, another page will be displayed. There, you can select the desired entry.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page B.20 - 6
Purlin Connection
Bolted Connection
Number Transv. Here, you enter the number of drill holes in transversal direction of the purlin shape. Distance Transv. Here you can indicate the axis distance at two or more drill holes.
Page B.21 - 1
Purlin Connection
Number Length Here, you enter the number of drill holes in shape direction of the purlin course. Distance Length Here you can indicate the axis distance at two or more drill holes. Bolts Dia Workloose Offset Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection. Enter the clearance for the connection. Here, you can indicate an offset value for the bolted connection in longitudinal direction. If you enter positive values, the drill holes are moved in shape direction of the purlin course; negative values move them in the opposite shape direction. Any possible connections filed in the database are displayed in this list. Select the desired connection by clicking an entry. In the different list fields, the data on which the connection is based are displayed.
List
Page B.21 - 2
Purlin Connection
Purlin Socket
Drill Holes
Here, you specify the dimensions of the purlin socket as well as the drill holes of the connection. The meaning of the distances is displayed in the figure below:
Bolts Dia
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection between roof girder and purlin socket.
Page B.21 - 3
Purlin Connection
Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection between purlin socket and purlin course. Enter the clearance for the connection. The purlin socket and the roof girder are assigned to a construction group. If the roof girder is already belonging to another construction group, the purlin socket will be assigned to this other group. The bolts are assigned to the roof girder belonging to the construction group as well. The purlin socket is attached at the opposite side of the purlin course. Specify the dimensions of backer plates in the corresponding input fields. These plates have to be used between roof girder and purlin socket. If you enter the value 0, no backer plates will be created. Here, you can indicate an offset value for the bolted connection in longitudinal direction. If you enter positive values, the drill holes are moved in shape direction of the purlin course; negative values move them in the opposite shape direction. Any possible connections filed in the database are displayed in this list. Select the desired connection by clicking an entry. In the different list fields, the data on which the connection is based are displayed
Offset
List
Page B.21 - 4
Purlin Connection
Connection Plate
Drill Holes
Here, you determine the dimensions of the plate as well as the drill holes of the connection. The meaning of the distances is displayed in the following figure of a purlin connection. If you enter the value 0 for w2, only one hole will be created in longitudinal direction of the purlin course.
Length length of plate in shape direction of the purlin course. Height height of plate in vertical shape direction. Thickness - thickness of the connecting plate.
Page B.21 - 5
Purlin Connection
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection. Enter the clearance for the connection.
Supporting Plate An additional supporting plate is created perpendicular to the plate which can be determined separately. Click on this button to open the dialog for determining the dimensions of the supporting plate. Create Group The plate and the roof girder are assigned to a construction group. If the roof girder is already belonging to another construction group, the plate will be assigned to this other group. The bolts are assigned to the roof girder belonging to the construction group as well. The splice is attached on the opposite side of the purlin course. The plate is welded to the roof girder. In the Af input field, you can specify the thickness of the weld seam, and in the selection list you can indicate the type of the weld seam. Here, you can indicate an offset value for the bolted connection in longitudinal direction. If you enter positive values, the drill holes are moved in shape direction of the purlin course; negative values move them in the opposite shape direction. Any possible connections filed in the database are displayed in this list. Select the desired connection by clicking an entry. In the different list fields, the data on which the connection is based are displayed
Offset
List
Page B.21 - 6
Purlin Connection
Page B.21 - 7
Purlin Connection
The thickness of the supporting plate The length of the supporting plate in shape direction of the shape The height of the supporting plate in vertical direction of the shape
Inner/Outer Chamfer Here, you enter the horizontal and vertical dimensions of the inner (1) or outer (2) chamfer.
Weld Seam
The plate is welded to the roof girder. In the Af input field, you can specify the thickness of the weld seam, and in the selection list you can indicate the type of the weld seam.
Page B.21 - 8
Purlin Connection
Connection Shape
Length Number
The length of the shape in shape direction of the purlin course Here, you enter the number of drill holes in shape direction of the purlin course. In the input field w3 you can indicate the axis distance in the case of two or more drill holes.
Base Drill Holes Specify the distance of the roof girder holes to the outer edge of the purlin course. Lateral Drill Bolts Dia Dia Side Workloose Perpendicular Here, you indicate the distance of the drill holes in the purlin course to the upper edge of the roof girder. Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the list Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection between roof girder and shape. Here, you specify the bolt diameter for the connection between shape and purlin course. Enter the clearance for the connection. The shape is positioned in a perpendicular way in order to insert e.g. a U-shape vertically.
Page B.21 - 9
Purlin Connection
The shape is rotated by 90 around the longitudinal axis. The shape and the roof girder are assigned to a construction group. If the roof girder is already belonging to another construction group, the shape will be assigned to this other group. The bolts are assigned to the roof girder belonging to the construction group as well. The shape is attached at the opposite side of the purlin course Specify the dimensions of backer plates in the corresponding input fields. These plates have to be used between roof girder and shape. If you enter the value 0, no backer plates will be created. Here, you can indicate an offset value for the bolted connection in longitudinal direction. If you enter positive values, the drill holes are moved in shape direction of the purlin course; negative values move them in the opposite shape direction. Here, you can select the shape to be used for the connection. Special shapes can be used as well. Any possible connections filed in the database are displayed in this list. Select the desired connection by clicking an entry. In the different list fields, the data on which the connection is based are displayed.
Offset
Page B.21 - 10
Gusset Plates
Plate Thickness Specify the thickness of the gusset plate. Bolt Style Dia Workloose Offset Enter the bolt type. Indicate the hole diameter. Indicate the hole clearance. Here, you specify the value by which the gusset plate has to extend beyond the shape edges in transversal shape direction.
Page B.22 - 1
Gusset Plates
Gusset Pos
Here, you specify the position of the plate to be created, related to the connected shapes. If you have selected Plate Center, the gusset plate will be created in the center of the shapes. If you have selected Plate Upper and/or Plate Lower, a gusset plate will be created at the upper edge and/or at the lower edge of the shapes, depending on the selection. It is possible to connect shapes with two plates as well. If this field has been checked, it is not the edge of a limiting shape situated next to the gusset plate, which is used as borderline, but the opposite line. Iit is possible to design a gusset plate in a way that it overlaps e.g. the complete flange of a limiting shape. If this field has been checked, the shapes and the plate are not drilled. It is possible to combine them with each other using a weld. If this field has been checked, a group will be formed on the base of the gusset plate and the connected shapes. If the 'With Bolts' field has been checked as well, the bolts of the shape to be connected are also added to that group.
Limiting Shape
Weld Bracing
Use Existing Holes Existing holes are used instead of drilling new ones. Click on this button to add further shapes to the gusset plate connection. Now, the form of the gusset plate is calculated anew and the new shapes are also connected with the plate. Click on this button to remove a shape from a gusset plate connection.
Click on this button to add further shapes as limiting edges for gusset plate calculation. You can e.g. extend a gusset plate up to a support. Click on this button to remove an additional limiting edge.
Page B.22 - 2
Gusset Plates
Number of drill holes in shape direction. Distance of the shape edge to the first hole. Distance of one drill hole to the other in shape direction. Distance of the last drill hole to the edge of the plate.
Number Transv. Dir. Number of drill holes in transversal shape direction. Transversal Distance Distance of drill holes in transversal shape direction. Drill Hole Pos. Insertion axis of drill holes.
Please note that you can indicate all distances either as absolute values or as many times the amount of bolt diameter. Enter e.g. *2 for the double value to obtain many times the amount of bolt diameter.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog of the component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page B.22 - 3
Gusset Plates
Page B.22 - 4
Dynamic Bracing
Page B.23 - 1
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.1
Common Settings
Generalities
Shape Selection: Here you indicate the utilized shapes for the bracing bars. Enter the shape catalogue into the first selection box, the shape type into the second, and the shape size into the third. Plate Thickness indicates the thickness of the gusset plate. Edge distance Here you can specify the distance from the outermost edge of the bracing bar to the boundary edge of the bracing (this is most often a shape edge). this value is used to round off the length of the shape. Here you indicate the minimum gusset plate width at the shape. The position of the gusset plate in reference to the bracing plane can be specified with the fields Plate Position Front Edge, Center, and Rear Edge.
Page B.23 - 2
Dynamic Bracing
Form
Here you can determine the opening angle of the gusset plate towards the bracing bar at the shape Triangle bent. If this switch is checked, the bracing is designed in the shape of a cross stay. Otherwise, only one bracing bar is added to the clicked on system line.
Welded Bracing If this switch is checked, the bracing is welded in its entirety. No borings are added in that case. Form Group: Symmetrical: If this switch is checked, the individual bracing elements are formed into groups. If this switch is checked, the bracing is designed in the form of a cross stay and remains symmetrical if modified with its grips. Otherwise, every bar can be changed individually. If this switch is checked, no gusset plates are created at the supporting shapes. Dynamic: If this switch is checked, the bracing immediately depicts the modifications made in the dialog. If you would like to modify many values, you can deactivate this option for the time being. By clicking on this button, you can add additional boundary edges (lines) for the gusset plate calculation. This method enables you to lengthen a gusset plate up to the base plate, for example. If the vertical of a gusset plate end point cuts this boundary line, the gusset plate is extended up to this point. Otherwise, the nearest end point of the line will be accepted. To add a boundary edge, just click on a line or specify a line by indicating two points. To delete an additional boundary edge, just click on this button. To stop the creation of a gusset plate at the end of a bracing bar, just click on this button.
No Gusset Plates
Page B.23 - 3
Dynamic Bracing
Click on this button to include any bracing bar which doesnt belong to the bracing in the creation of a gusset plate. Click on this button to exclude any bracing bar which doesnt belong to the bracing from the creation of a gusset plate.
Page B.23 - 4
Dynamic Bracing
Bolts
Group Bolts Bolts Dm Work loose Group Holes Here you enter the number of borings and the spacing of the drilled holes to be observed. You can either specify absolute values or how many times the amount of the hole diameter. If the entries have to be a multiple of the hole diameter, put an asterisk (*) in front of the multiplier. Shape Direction The number of drilled holes in the direction of the bracing bar (on both ends). Edge-1 hole Hole-Hole Nth Hole-Edge Cross Direction
st
Specify the bolt type. Specify the hole diameter. Specify the hole work loose.
the distance from the end of the bracing bar to the first hole center in the direction of the bar. sets the space between the drilled holes in the direction of the bar. The distance from the last hole to the outer edge of the gusset plate in the direction of the bar. The number of drilled holes crosswise to the bracing bar.
Page B.23 - 5
Dynamic Bracing
Distribution
The distance between the drilled holes, crosswise to the bar direction.
B.23.2
Shape Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from shapes and gusset plates, select the folder SHAPE BRACING.
Page B.23 - 6
Dynamic Bracing
Group Shape Offset Shape Position Here you select the position of the shapes in relation to the gusset plates. Front- the shapes are located in front of the gusset plate. Back - The shapes are located behind the gusset plate.. Cross - One shape is located in front of the gusset plate and one behind. Centered - The shapes are located in the bracing plane. Double One shape each is located in front of and behind the gusset plate (total of 4 shapes for cross stay). Replaced One shape each is located in front of and behind the gusset plate with one being offset to the left and one to the right (total of 4 shapes for cross stay). 4-Times One shape is located on each side (front, rear, left, right), which makes a total of 8 shapes for cross stay. Shape distance the distance of the shapes for offset or 4-Times bracings. Rotation Angle Is used to specify a rotation of the shapes.
Shape Insertion Specify the insertion position of the shapes Centred - The shapes are inserted along the shape axis... COG Line - The shapes are inserted along the COG (Centre of Gravity) line. Pitch Line The shapes are inserted along the pitch line. Diagonal The shapes are inserted along their corner points Upper Edge Left up to Lower Edge Right.. Inverse Diagonal The shapes are inserted along their corner points from Lower Edge Left up to Upper Edge Right. Hole Position Here you set the hole positions in the shape. Centred - The holes are drilled on the shape axis. COG Line - The drill holes are drilled on COG line. Pitch Line The holes are drilled on the shape pitch line. Specify a projection of the central gusset plate extending past the shape edges of the bracing bars. Positive values increase the size of the plate whereas negative values decrease it. Here you can specify a value to be used to shorten the shapes after the bracing has been generated. If this field is checked, the shapes are mirrored and then inserted. At a cross stay and selected shape position 'Crossed', a common hole is drilled into the shapes that are crossing each other.
Offset
Page B.23 - 7
Dynamic Bracing
Divide All
If this field is checked, all shapes of a cross stay are separated at the center gusset plate.
Group Bind Plates Bind Plates Opposing shapes have batten plates as stiffeners. The following input fields can be used for a further description of the batten plates: The distance of the batten plates; the program divides the distances regularly according to this specification and the values are rounded up or down correspondingly.
Distance
Offset
In the field Offset, you specify the distance of batten plates from the shape edges. Positive values decrease the size of the plate whereas negative values increase it, i.e. the plate has a projection. The number of bolts which are used to connect each batten plate with the shapes. The distance from the end of the batten plate to the first hole center in the direction of the bar. The space between the drilled holes in the direction of the bar Diameter of bolting in the input field Dm the hole work loose of bolting The batten plates are not connected by bolts but by a weld. Indicate the weld style in the selection list. Indicate the weld thickness in the input field, if it differs from the default settings of the style. Click on this button to process the weld style or to create a new style.
Page B.23 - 8
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.3
Rod Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from tension rods, select the folder Rod Bracing. You can select a variety of different variations.
Layout
Tension Rod with Cam. A bracing with a traversing tension rod is generated. The shapes connected with the bracing are penetrated and fastened in the back with a tension element Offset The Offset field is used to specify the projection of the tension rod beyond the shape. The Hole Dia. field is used to specify the diameter of the oblong hole to be drilled. The Slot Axis field is used to specify the length of the oblong hole to be drilled. The Part Description field is used to specify a term for the tension element to be used with the parts list.
Page B.23 - 9
Dynamic Bracing
If the field Create Element is checked, the tension element is generated and displayed. The dimensions of the tension element can be specified in the input fields Width, Thickness and Radius.
Turnbuckle A bracing with two tension rods joined by a tension element is generated. A butt strap is welded to the end of the tension rod, which is used to connect to the shapes via a gusset plate. When you selected the version Sliced, the strap receives a slit and the tension rod is welded to the center. If, on the other hand, you selected Welded, the tension rod is welded to the strap. The Butt Strap Length field is used to specify the length of the strap. The Butt Strap Width field is used to specify the width of the strap. The Butt Strap Thickness field is used to specify the plate thickness of the strap. The Offset field is used to specify by how much the tension rod and the butt strap are overlapping. The Gap field is used to specify a gap between the cut out butt strap and the tension rod for production tolerances, if the 'Sliced' option has been selected. The Turnbuckle field is used to specify the length of the tension element. The Offset field is used to specify the length of projection. The Dm field is used to specify the diameter of the tension element. The Distance field is used to specify the distance of the tension element from the outer end of the bar. If the value 0 is indicated here, the element will be placed in the center of the corresponding bracing segment. The Part Description field is used to specify a term for the tension element to be used with the parts list.
Page B.23 - 10
Dynamic Bracing
Tension Rod A bracing with a tension rod is generated, which has a welded on connection element. The Butt Strap field is used to specify the length of the connection element. The Butt Strap Width field is used to specify the width of the connection element. The Butt Strap Thickness field is used to specify the thickness of the connection element. The Bolt Diameter field is used to specify the bolt hole diameter in the connection element. The Outer Radius field is used to specify the outer radius of the connection element. The Part Description field is used to specify a term for the tension element to be used with the parts list Beneath please find an example for the different variants of a tension rod bracing:
Bracing Catalogues
Databases may be generated for the tension elements of all three types. The terms and dimensions can be loaded from these databases. An additional folder Bracing Catalogues will be displayed where you can selec t a dBASE-file. After selection of a valid file, you can choose a tension element for the different versions from a selection list. This element is defined in the database. The dialog entries will then be filled with the corresponding values.
Page B.23 - 11
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.4
Pipe Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from pressure pipes and butt straps, select the folder Pipe Bracing. You can select a variety of different variations.
Gruppe Butt Strap Form Butt Strap Type Here you set the variant of the connecting butt strap. Inserted - The butt strap is welded into the pipe. Pipe sliced - The pipe is slit and the strap is welded at that point. Strap sliced - The strap is slit and the pipe is welded at that point. T-Shape A T-shape section is welded onto the pipe. You can select a shape in the Selection Lists depicted opposite. Endplates A head plate is welded onto the pipe and a butt strap is welded onto this head plate. Butt Strap Length Specify the length of the strap. Butt Strap Width Specify the width of the strap. Butt Strap Thick Specify the thickness of the strap.
Page B.23 - 12
Dynamic Bracing
Butt Strap Offset Specify the overlap length of the pressure pipe and the strap Escape Gap Shapes: Width of the gap between pipe opening and butt straps You can select the shapes in the selection lists, if you have selected 'T-shapes' as butt strap type.
Create Group with Pipe Forms a group out of a bracing. With Bolts The bolts are inserted into the group.
Group Endplates You can indicate further specifications for the head plate, if you have selected 'Head Plate' as butt strap type. Width Thickness Type Enter the width or the diameter of the head plate. Enter the plate thickness of the head plate. If the Edge field is checked, a square head plate is created with the same width as specified under 'Width'. If the Round field is checked, a round head plate is created with the same diameter as specified under 'Width'. If the Use Polyplates field is checked, the head plates are created as plates.
Assignments
The created component parts can receive different assignments such as material and so on.
Page B.23 - 13
Dynamic Bracing
Page B.23 - 14
Static Bracing
This command supports you when bracings have to be created. You can add bracing rods, drill and design the appertaining gusset plates, or have them designed automatically. The program always enters bracings in the active UCS plane, i.e. you should place the UCS with its origin into the desired bracing plane and align it parallel. Since the rods are aligned in accordance with the system lines, they should have been created previously. In case of a cross-stay with uniformly staggered rods, the middle of the system will be sufficient. The rods can be arranged alternatively. In contrast to the dynamic bracing, this bracing here doesnt react to modifications. However, it can be created individually piece-by-piece.
Page B.24 - 1
Static Bracing
B.24.1
Settings
Shape Definition
Here you select the type of shapes to be used. Here, you specify the resolution. Select the desired shape class from the selected types. Select the desired shape size of the selected shape class. Select the alignment of the gusset plates and thus of the bracing shapes with regard to the current UCS-system.
Page B.24 - 2
Static Bracing
Rod Position
Determine the position of the bracing rods with respect to the gusset plate. Front means on the positive Z-axis, Back means on the negative Z-axis, Both means on both sides and Centered means that a rod is positioned in the middle of the axis. Here you specify the position of the rod with respect to the insertion line (system line). You can insert the rod in the middle, on the gravity line or on the root line. You can insert the rod in its normal position or rotated by +90 degrees or -90 degrees. You can check the selected mode in the shape window of dialog field. You can insert the rod in its normal position or in a mirrored way. You can check the selected mode in the shape window of dialog field.
Rod Insertion
Rotation:
Mirror:
Bolts
The bolt style to be used The diameter from the bolt diameter table The clearance between bolt and hole diameter
Page B.24 - 3
Static Bracing
Number Shape Number Cross Drill Hole Pos. Distance Cross Weld Bracing
The number of bolts in shape direction The number of bolts transversally to the shape direction Here, you specify the position of drill holes in the rod. The distance from one bolt to the other in transversal direction. If this field is checked, the shapes and gusset plates are not drilled. The dimensions of the gusset plates, however, are determined as if drill holes existed. If this field is checked, the corners of the gusset plates are not bevelled but a rectangular plate is created. A group is formed for each rod. The bolts are also allocated to the group.
Edge Distance
The third page serves for managing the edge distances depending on the bolt diameter which have to be respected when the bracing shapes are installed.
List:
You can directly click on the corresponding entries and the processing mode will be switched on. Then you can directly enter the value.
Page B.24 - 4
Static Bracing
st
Edge- 1 Hole Hole Hole Hole Edge Limit Edges Bracing Rod
Distance of the outermost hole axis in the bracing rod to the rod front edge. Spacing of the hole axes in longitudinal direction Spacing of the outermost hole axis in the gusset Specify the desired distance of the bracing rods to the limit edges. Specify by which value the bracing rod has to be shortened after its insertion. Thus, the rod will be kept in tension.
Page B.24 - 5
Static Bracing
B.24.2
To a large extent, you can make the program automatically create the components of a bracing. However, it is possible as well to generate single components such as gusset plates, etc. individually. For this purpose, several individual functions are available which will be described in the following.
BRACING Click this button to generate bracing rods and gusset plates in one operation. However, this function is not suitable for the connection of several rods from different systems. In this case, you should use the individual functions instead. After the action has been finished, you return to the dialog.
SINGLE ROD Click this button to insert single bracing rods that are directly drilled.
DRILL ROD Click this button to drill existing shapes on their ends, according to the definitions in the dialog field. You must select the shapes for this purpose. You will return to the dialog field afterwards.
PLATE AUTO Click this button to create a gusset plate automatically. Select the drilled bracing rods that have to be connected and then click boundary lines for the plate edges. The program will try to find a suitable plate dimension by keeping the edge distances and the boundary lines.
Page B.24 - 6
Static Bracing
PICK PLATE Click this button to determine yourself the shape of the gusset plate. Select the drilled bracing rods that have to be connected and pick a point on the planned bracing end. Click the approximate position of the gusset plate. The edge distances will be displayed.
UCS If you have not yet aligned the UCS before using the command, you can do this subsequently: the active UCS plane (and consequently the plane of the bracing) will be determined by clicking 3 points. You will return to the dialog field afterwards.
Page B.24 - 7
Static Bracing
Creating a Bracing
Lets start out from the fact that you want to design a simple roof bracing. The diagonals are to intersect (without the gusset plate in the middle). Select the command for bracing and se lect the Plate Middle for the UCS position. Determine the position of the shape and the settings for bolts, plate thickness, etc. Since the two rods are to intersect, select the Front rod position beforehand. Then click the BRACING button. The program will prompt you to enter the system line of the bracing rod. Click one of the two system lines, e.g., the one leading from down below on the left to the top on the right. You must determine the limit edges of the bracing rod (i.e. the edges from which the outermost rod edge is to have the distance as defined in Options). Click the inner web line of the roof girder - as shown on the left. Repeat this on the other rod end. If you have clicked the wrong line, you can cancel this by entering the letter b (Back). When you have selected both limit edges, confirm this by pressing the ENTER key or by using the right mouse button. A dialog field will be displayed, which shows exactly the calculated rod length. You can round the value in the desired rod length field. The rod is now displayed with drill holes. You must now determine the gusset plates.
Gusset Plates
The program will prompt you to enter the boundary line for the gusset plate . You can control the shape by selecting these lines - some variants are shown on the left side depending on selection. You may need construction lines which have either been created beforehand or which can be shown using two points. You can confirm by pressing the ENTER key or by clicking the right mouse button. The next gusset plate can be created afterwards.
Page B.24 - 8
Static Bracing The first bracing rod is complete. The second rod is created in the same manner with the exception that you select the rod position Rear (to avoid intersecting rods). If you want to create a bracing with a gusset plate in the point of intersection, do not stagger the rods. Open, shorten, and drill the rods manually at the point of intersection. Create a single gusset plate with the function for the bracing (button PLATE AUTO or PICK PLATE).
Page B.24 - 9
Static Bracing
Page B.24 - 10
Haunches
B.25 Haunches
ProSteel automatically generates haunches by clicking two shapes or by picking points on a construction line. For instance, after having inserted a column and roof girder in the model, all construction lines that are necessary for a normal haunch have been created. In addition to the actual haunch, you can also create additional stiffeners using this function. These stiffeners then can be directly assigned to the corresponding groups (see Groups command). This command enables the creation of tapered haunch connections, i.e. adaptation of the upper and lower haunch chord to the support / connecting shape. Therefore the complete haunch creation is limited to one single function call.
Enter width and thickness of the haunch top chord. Enter width and thickness of the haunch bottom chord. Enter the thickness of the haunch web plate. If this field is checked, and you selected Bottom Train as haunch type, the haunch is not made from individual plates but from a coped shape. The shape size corresponds to the connection shape; all other shape size fields are then ignored. In the neighbouring input field, you can specify the distance from the bottom train at the end of the cropped shape (analogue to the Haunch Head Width).
Page B.25 - 1
Haunches
Bottom Stiffener If this field is checked, a stiffener is attached to the base point of the haunch of the support shape. You can select a stiffener type in the list displayed here. Just select a stiffener template, which you previously saved using the command Stiffeners.
Top Stiffener
If this field is checked, a stiffener is attached to the head point of the haunch of the connected shape if you selected Bottom Train as haunch type. You can select a stiffener type in the list displayed here. Just select a stiffener template, which you previously saved using the command Stiffeners.
Length,...
In the following figure, you can see the meaning of the inputs for haunch length, roof pitch, bottom width, head width and offset. A modification in the input field roof pitch has only an effect if a haunch has been created without supporting shape. In the input field Cone Width you enter a width to which the haunch tapers if required.
Create Group
If this field is checked, top flange, bottom flange and web plate are arranged to form a group
Bottom Train
If this field is checked, no top flange is created, e.g. for the construction of frame corners.
Cone
If this field is checked, a tapered haunch is created by fitting the width of the haunch flanges to the support and connection shape and then tapering them. Use the Cone Width field to specify a cone width if you have a specific value in mind. However, the Fixed Size field cannot be checked as well.
Page B.25 - 2
Haunches
Fixed Size
If this field is checked, the head width and any existing cone width are fitted to the shape to be connected. Inputs in these fields will be ignored in this case. If this field is checked and Bottom Train has been selected as haunch type, the haunch on the topside of the shape is selected. If the connection appears to be turned, you can rotate it here. Click this button and the data of an existing connection are transferred to the connection to be created now. You have to click the existing haunch connection to achieve the transfer.
Turn
Page B.25 - 3
Haunches
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page B.25 - 4
Connection Editor
Page B.26 - 1
Connection Editor
Group Display Length Here, you specify the length of the 3D-arrow for the connection symbol. The direction of the arrow shows from the connected part to the component to which it was connected. Here, you specify the diameter of the 3D-arrow for the connection symbol. Here, you specify the marking colour for the surrounding construction as AutoCAD-colour number. Since the construction only has to serve for your orientation, you should select a weak colour here so that the symbols can be easily recognized. The symbols themselves are displayed in green, red and yellow.
Diameter Colour
Group Options Hide... The selected objects are hidden to increase a clear view. You can hide work frames and structural elements (the construction lines of structural elements). Bolts are always hidden.
Standard Connections All standard connections are displayed as symbol. These are the normal connections such as end plates, etc. which are integrated in ProSteel. Cut Connections All cut connections are displayed. These are the cuts at objects or mitred cuts. COM-Connections All external connections realized via the COM-PlugIns are displayed. Delete with When a connection is deleted, all attached parts generated by this connection will be deleted as well.
Dialog-Commands
DELETE Click on this button to remove the selected connections completely, i.e. all component parts and processing actions created by means of these connections will be deleted as well. To do so, you have to select the connections by clicking on the symbols.
Page B.26 - 2
Connection Editor EDIT Click on this button to edit the selected connection. After the desired connection has been clicked via the symbol, the corresponding dialog of this connection opens and the values can be modified.
CLONE Click on this button to transfer the settings of a connection to another one. It is also possible to change the connection type if this is reasonable (e.g. you can replace a plate connection by a web angle connection). First, you have to select the connection the data of which have to be transferred to another one. All connections not being able to seize these data are hidden. Then, you have to select all connections having to take these data.
Verify Connections
If the Verify Connections option has been checked, all connections are verified with regard to collisions and marginal distances before being displayed as symbol. The status of this verification is displayed by means of the colour of the symbol. They have the following meaning: Green Yellow Red The connection is correct The hole distances are not observed The connection has collisions
Page B.26 - 3
Connection Editor
Page B.26 - 4
Group Structure
Various single components, bolts and special parts can be combined to form groups - i.e. a support with welded endplates and stiffeners. The groups can be hierarchically structured in subgroups, standard component part groups and assemblies. Each parent group can itself contain subordinate groups of a lower type. The group structure existing in the model is taken into account for the parts lists and when the model is automatically detailed and transformed into 2D workshop drawings. Many of the settings can be done separately for assemblies, component part groups, subgroups and single components. Certain functions apply to the complete group, even if you only select one part of the group. After the command has been selected, the main window opens where the available functions can be selected. Click on the corresponding button to apply them. Most of the commands can be directly selected via a separate menu command. To permit rapid processing of several groups one after the other, some functions are self-loading (loop version). If you want to cancel the function, you have to press the ESC-key or the right mouse button. In the settings, you can specify for which group commands a loop version is required and for which not.
Page B.27 - 1
Group Structure
Structure of Subgroup
Like standard component part groups, ProSteel-subgroups consist of a main part and the associated accessory parts. In practise, these subgroups mostly correspond to the purchase or stock parts that in a preassembled condition are again used in component part groups or in assemblies. Subgroups and standard component part groups are based on the same logic and therefore nearly behave identically.
Structure of Assembly
ProSteel-assemblies consist of any component parts without having a determined main part. This permits to form free groups of parts and structures. In addition, component part groups and subgroups can be inserted into an assembly as well. In order to do so, just insert the main part of the subgroup or of the material group into the assembly. In practise, assemblies mostly correspond to several material groups, subgroups and single parts which are combined on the site. For more detailed useful information about group structure and its application in practise for drawing generation, please refer to the different chapters of detailing.
Page B.27 - 2
Group Structure
B.27.2
Parts can be combined to form groups, and you can detach such groups by using the functions described here. All functions described below can be used equally for component part groups, subgroups and assemblies. This is why the functions are described only once. In the following, the term Group therefore is supposed to mean a material group, a subgroup or an assembly. It is also possible to store groups as block and to take them over into other drawings the structure will remain unchanged. Please note that special functions are needed in this case. The AutoCAD standard commands for blocks cannot be used.
Page B.27 - 3
Group Structure
Display as 1 Part
The group is displayed completely as one coherent part after selection(not available for assemblies).
Click on this button to dissolve a group. To do so, click any part of the group. Click on this button to delete all parts of the selected group from the drawing. To do so, click any part of the group. Click on this button to add or edit the parts list data. After the group has been clicked, the following dialog opens:
You can enter the parts list data of the selected group in the input fields. The position in the field Posnum has been taken over from the main part provided the Take Main Part Info field was selected. In addition, the outer dimensions and the overall weight of the group will be displayed. These input fields can also be accessed via the context menu Change PS Properties, when you select a part that belongs to the group.
Page B.27 - 4
Group Structure
Processing of Structure
Subsequent adding of parts to a group or removal from a group is possible as well. Click on this button to add new parts to a group. The complete group will be selected when you click any part of the group. Further accessory parts can be added by clicking them. Click on this button to remove existing parts from a group. The complete group will be selected when you click any part of the group. Then, remove the parts from the group by clicking on them.
Page B.27 - 5
Group Structure
Miscellaneous
Click on this button to choose whether the whole group has to be selected by selecting only one part of the group, or whether the parts have to be independent of each other. To do so, click any part of the group. Then, the mode will be switched over correspondingly and the current status will be displayed in command line. AutoCAD group mode is modified here in the group. This means that you can select the whole group by clicking only one part when e. g.moving it by means of standard AutoCAD commands.. You can switch on or off this behaviour using the AutoCADcommand for groups. All groups existing in the drawing are counted and the number is displayed in the Number input field.
Page B.27 - 6
Group Structure
B.27.3
Check Groups
Using the commands available here you can check the created groups, make the settings and modify the group data for the parts list.
This function checks whether all the groups have a main part. When a group without a main part is detected, this group is dissolved. In addition, when using the command Highlight Orphans you can make display the parts that dont belong to a group. Groups without a main part may occur when the main part was deleted and the group has not been detached. Click on this button to downgrade a component part group to a subgroup. However, this material group mustnt contain any subordinated subgroups. Click on this button to upgrade a subgroup to a standard component part group.
Page B.27 - 7
Group Structure
Mark Orphans
If this field is checked, all valid groups are hidden according to the specifications when checking a group. Parts that belong to no group are marked in colour. Coloured markings are removed once you select the command Regenerate or when you assign the parts to a group.
Release Single Part Groups If this field is checked; all valid groups consisting of only one component part are released when checking a group. You can search different groups by highlighting and zooming found groups or by hiding the other groups. Enter the position numbers of the groups to be searched in the input field. Then, select the parts to be searched (in most cases, you will select all of the parts in one field) and confirm your selection by pressing the ENTER key or the right mouse button. In the selection list, you can specify how the result has to be displayed. Several position numbers can be entered at the same time, provided they are separated by a decimal point. Complete position areas must be separated by a hyphen. If you search e.g. the positions No. 5 and 7 resp. 17 up to 28, you enter the value 5,7,17-28 in the Search Numbers field. When you use the command Regenerate, the other groups can be made visible again resp. the marking in colour is removed. The position number of a picked component part is taken over in the preset field for search. Selection List
Here you select how the result of a search has to be displayed. Hide All parts are hidden except the found parts. Zoom The found parts are highlighted. Zoom Extents The found parts are zoomed. Use this function to hide all parts of a group together (depending on the parameters for hiding). To do so, click any part of the group. When you use the command Regenerate or Display Parts, the parts of the group can be made visible again.
Page B.27 - 8
Group Structure
Use this command to make all hidden parts of a group visible again. Alternatively, you can also use the Regenerate function. Selection List Here you select which parts of a group have to be hidden. Main Parts - only the main part will be hidden Single Parts - all accessory parts will be hidden. All Parts - the whole group will be hidden. Click on this button to make display the hierarchic group structure of a component part. To do so, you have to click on the component part. Then, a dialog opens which informs you about the belonging to and the status of the main part. In this dialog, it is possible to highlight the group structures in colour.
An independent component part group is created with all single parts not belonging to a group. Click on this button to compare two component part groups with each other. To do so, you have to select the two groups to be compared. Then, a dialog appears showing you the result in detail (see also Positioning function): Compare+Modify Component part groups having the same position number, which however are not recognized as identical at comparison, will be corrected. The position numbers are modified according to the settings of positioning (see also Positioning command).
Page B.27 - 9
Group Structure
Display in ProSteel-Properties
When you process the parts of groups via the ProSteel properties and you change to the tab Group, the complete group will be highl ighted in colour for your information. You can choose different colours for main part and accessory parts. Use the global settings of ProSteel to specify what colours to apply. When it is a matter of nested structures (such as e. g. the component part group of an assembly), you will normally get the lowest group level at shape selection e. g. the properties of the own component part group. However, you may scroll up and down the structure and thus modify the parent group properties.
Page B.27 - 10
Group Structure
B.27.4
Settings
This page specifies the behaviour of the commands for group function. You can control the behaviour of each single command.
Part Selection
Here, you can specify the behaviour of part selection at the different functions. Multiple Each part has to be selected separately. All You select the whole group. For the marked functions the command is repeated in a loop without having to display the dialog again after each run. Operation of the different functions is facilitated in case of several parts. The dialog is automatically closed after the selected function is finished.
Execute in Loop
End Dialog
Page B.27 - 11
Group Structure
Page B.27 - 12
Positioning
B.28 Positioning
Positioning of the existing parts is one of the last steps before final detailing of the 3D model for workshop drawings. ProSteel can do this automatically for you. It searches parts of the same type and defines their number in the model. Of course, you can also assign position numbers manually. In the first step before detailing, only the number of pieces (quantity) and their position numbers must be defined. This data record is the basis for the parts lists, which can then be generated and printed at once. Later, when preparing the 2D parts, the position flags with the user-defined layout are attached to single parts and groups. In this version, the position flags as well as the height indicators and weld marks are related to the style. This means that the pre-setting how the position flag looks like can be set with a style. This style specifies the geometry and the display properties of the flag.
Page B.28 - 1
Positioning
B.28.1
Automatic Positioning
Automatic positioning is an important means for the creation of parts list. Separate position numbers or shipping numbers according to your specifications are automatically added to component parts and groups via this function. You can even integrate additionally bought or own software (a so-called Plugin) into the positioning of ProSteel.
PlugIn
You can select a Plug-in to carry out positioning in ProSteel. This PlugIn carries out the positioning exactly according to the guidelines of your company if you dont find an appropriate setting in ProSteel. Activate it using the button Use external PlugIn an d the automatic positioning then will be exclusively carried out by this external program and not by ProSteel.
Page B.28 - 2
Positioning
Type
Here, you enter the type of the position number. Numerical The position numbers are composed of numbers only. Alphanumerical - The position numbers are composed of letters only. The order then is A, B, ..., Z, AA, AB, ... etc. Mixed - The position numbers are composed of a numerical and an alphanumerical part. The numerical part is following the alphanumerical part, the order is A1, A2, ..., A9, B1, B2 etc. The number of numerical positions can be preset under Limits. If you want to position only certain component parts, you can apply a filter defining which elements of your construction have to be equipped with a position number or with a shipping number. Here, you see the single part position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the subgroup position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the group position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the assembly position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1.
Filter
Last Single
Last Subgroup
Last Group
Last Assembly
Last Connection Here, you see the connection position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Next Increment Send Number Enter the single part position number that has to be added to the first part to be positioned anew. Enter the automatic increase in numbers (normally the increment is 1). The automatic positioning either adds position numbers or shipping numbers. Use this button to select whether the function has to add position numbers or shipping numbers.
Page B.28 - 3
Positioning
Use XRefs
If external references have been inserted into the drawing, the component parts are also positioned in these external references. If you have selected an external PlugIn for positioning, you can add it using this button. The internal positioning of ProSteel is deactivated in this case. Click this button to reset the settings of all fields to standard values. Click this button to make further specifications for seizing the shapes etc. Another dialog opens which will be described in detail in the following. Click this button to add the position number for the single parts, subgroups, groups and assemblies. For this purpose, you have to select the parts to be positioned. The program checks whether they are of the same type and adds a position number according to your specifications. Click this button to add only the position numbers for the single parts. Thus it is still possible to make some modifications before positioning the groups, if need be. Click this button to add only the position numbers for the groups. Of course, the position numbers for the single parts have to exist already.
Use PlugIn
Positioning Results
When positioning is finished, a dialog opens where the position number and further parts list information is displayed for each part. Now, you can edit the proposed position numbers by doubleclicking the position number of the component part. Modifications are immediately adopted into the parts.
Page B.28 - 4
Positioning When single part positioning including the modifications is finished, the position numbers of the groups are placed. Double-clicking the position number in the column New Number can also modify the positions displayed.
Positioning
Filter
These kinds of parts are taken into consideration during automatic positioning. Check all kinds of parts (standard shapes, special shapes, poly-plates, bolts, miscellaneous) that have to be equipped with a position number in one process. If you have added parts list data to any graphical elements, these are included via Miscellaneous. Can also be taken into consideration at positioning and get a so-called ID. Naming of the links (connections) is created with the options below.
Connections
Only with Names Connections are only positioned, if they have been named before.
Page B.28 - 6
Positioning
1 Sorting List
st
Here, you determine the order of positioning. The selected parts are sorted in the indicated order according to the type of component part (shapes, plates, etc.). Put the type of part that has to be positioned first to the top, the next type to the second position and so on. In the example dialog of positioning, all shapes are seized first, then all special shapes, and finally the concrete parts. If there are several parts of the same type, these will be sorted nd according to the settings for the 2 criterion. Change the order of criteria by using the arrow keys. Here, you specify a subordinate order. Within each part type, st sorted according to the 1 criterion, the parts will be sorted according to the order specified here. If you have e.g. seized more than one shape - with the settings of the example dialog - these shapes then are sorted according to the length first; if the length is identical, they are sorted according to the weight, and so on. Then, the special shapes again are sorted in the same way, etc. Flats (which actually are shapes as type of part) are treated like any plates at positioning. Therefore, they are displayed together with any plates when a parts list is sorted according st to the 1 criterion. Click this button to specify the criteria for the detection of identical parts by means of parts properties like name, note, etc. Then, another dialog opens where you can check the properties relevant for differentiation:
nd
Sorting List
Flats like
Page B.28 - 7
Positioning
Further Options Overwrite Exist Existing position numbers are overwritten when assigning new ones. Equal Part De Single parts are checked for equality. If they are identical, they are assigned the same position number. Parts are considered identical when deviations with respect to dimensions and drill diameter are within the values given as reference tolerances. Group Detection The groups are checked for equality as well. Groups are considered identical when identical single parts are arranged in the same mounting position. However, single parts are only compared using their position number because positioning has already been carried out before. If parts are identical but have different position numbers, the groups will also be assigned different position numbers. Subgroups, assemblies and connections can be compared with each other in the same way.
Page B.28 - 8
Positioning
Save Single Part Pos.No. When a single part, which already has a position number, gets a new position number at positioning, the existing position number is saved in the field OrigPosnum in the parts properties. Save Group Pos.No. When a group, which already has a position number, gets a new position number at positioning, the existing position number is saved in the field OrigPosnum in the group properties. Weld Marks The attached weld marks are taken into consideration as well when the single parts are checked for equality. Weld cracks are small drill holes with parts that have to be mounted.
Include Subgroups Subgroups are completely included in the calculation of equality. Otherwise, only the main parts of the subgroups are used. First Main Part First, all main parts of groups are positioned (and sorted according to the sorting criteria within the groups), followed by the accessory parts (also sorted according to the sorting criteria). This can be deemed as an additional, even higher ranking sorting criterion. If this field is checked and you have entered a position number in the input field Start Accessory Parts at, positioning of the accessory parts will start at the defined position number. You may for instance start with 1 for main parts and with 100 for accessory parts. Groups Differentiation: When the group is assigned the position of the main part (normal case), it may happen that two different groups having the same main part are assigned identical position numbers. In such cases, the program will check in a second run whether or not the groups are really identical. If not, it will change the group position number.
Page B.28 - 9
Positioning 25 25.1 The changed group positions are identified by the index .1 etc. following their position number (i. e. 100.1 , 100.2 , ...). 25 25A - The changed group positions are identified by the index A etc. following their position number (i.e. 100A, 100B, ...). 25 MAX+1 Positioning of the changed group positions is continued after the highest position currently assigned. When the last group was position 50, the changed groups now have the positions from 51 onward. Main Part Group The position of the main part is taken over as group position. If necessary, the group position is changed afterwards during second check. If this option is not requested, but you rather prefer a separate number area, the numbers will start at the position entered in Start Groups at. Individual Positioning of Subgroups Subgroups are individually positioned from the specified position number onwards. For assemblies, the value in the field below is valid.
Page B.28 - 10
Positioning
Prefixes Here, an explanatory text can be entered before the positions of groups, subgroups and assemblies. It is possible to differentiate between support beams, girders and other groups, the differentiation always being related to the main part of the group. Columns Here, you enter the designation for all vertical shapes. In the attribute field Position Tolerance, you enter an angle within which the shape is still considered to be vertical. Here, you enter the designation for all horizontal shapes. In the attribute field Position Tolerance, you enter an angle within which the shape is still considered to be horizontal. Vertical and horizontal are always related to the model, i.e., to the XY-plane of the WCS. Here, you enter the designation for all other groups. The family classes prefix is set in front if the component part belongs to a family class and a prefix is planned.
Beams
Page B.28 - 11
Positioning
Tolerances to Recognize Equal Parts Geometry At recognition via geometry, all outer edges of a component part are determined and individually compared with each other. In the following, you will find a description of the tolerances specifying that two parts are recognized as identical. Here, you specify the tolerances for recognition of identical parts via geometry. You can positively exclude that e. g. rounding errors in the case of bevel cuts or notches lead to different parts. Minimum Line Length - Lines up to the specified length are not considered for a comparison. Length Tolerance Length deviations of two lines up to the specified length are not considered for a comparison. Drill Hole Tolerance Deviations of the drill hole axes up to the specified length are not considered for a comparison. Weight Tolerance Differences in weight between two component parts are ignored up to the indicated value.
> Tolerances
Page B.28 - 12
Positioning
Volume
A second method to recognize equal parts is the real volume comparison. Here, you carry out a detection of identical parts based on the volume of the component part. The tolerances can be set for groups and single parts as relative value to the compared volume (e.g. 0.1 percent for component parts and 0.2 percent for groups).
Connections Names These settings are used for naming the connections (positioned logical links). Consecutive Numbering The connections are numbered consecutively. PosNum+PosNum The name is built using a combination of the position numbers of the connecting and supporting shape. PosNum+Index The name is built using the position number of the connecting shape and a continuous index. For more detailed information about connections, please refer to the main chapter of detailing.
Page B.28 - 13
Positioning
B.28.2
Manual Insertion
After a position number has been attached to the component parts, no matter whether it has been attached automatically or manually, you can display this number and further parts list information at the part using a position flag. If a position number has not yet been attached to the parts, you can specify new numbers and enter them into the part. The dialog tab mostly corresponds to the tab of automatic positioning. Please refer to this section for a detailed description.
Style
Select the style of the position flag to be inserted if no separate style has been specified for the corresponding part type (or the command). This is the standard style. Here, you enter the type of the position number. Numerical The position numbers are composed of numbers only. Alphanumerical - The position numbers are composed of letters only. The order then is A, B, ..., Z, AA, AB, ... etc. Mixed - The position numbers are composed of a numerical and an alphanumerical part. The numerical part is following the alphanumerical part, the order is A1, A2, ..., A9, B1, B2 etc. The number of numerical positions can be preset under Limits. Here, you see the single part position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the group position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the subgroup position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Here, you see the assembly position set last. At the beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if you want to start counting at 1. Enter the single part position number that has to be added to the first part to be positioned anew.
Type
Last Single
Last Group
Last Subgroup
Last Assembly
Next
Page B.28 - 14
Positioning
Increment
Enter the automatic increase in numbers (normally the increment is 1). Click this button to reset the manual positioning to standard values. Click this button to assign the corresponding position flag styles to the selection commands described below. This style describes the depiction of the position flag, i. e. which information is depicted in which way. Then, the following dialog appears, the assignments of which are self-explanatory.
Scale
Enter the scale for display scaling of the position texts and other things. The scale should correspond to the scale of the detail. If a global scale has been defined, it will be automatically taken over here. Here, you specify whether a position flag has to be created in the paper area. In ProSteel, you have the possibility to add a position number and a shipping number to a component part. If this option is activated, the shipping number will be displayed in the position flag. The number specified here will be taken over as position number or as shipping number into the parts properties.
Enter
Page B.28 - 15
Positioning
SINGLE PART Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for single parts. GROUP Select the part to which a group position flag has to be attached. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for groups/subgroups/assemblies. GROUPS-SINGLE PART Select the part of a group to which a position flag has to be attached. Depending on the part hierarchy, the position flag is created with the set style for main part or accessory parts. BOLT Select the bolt connection to which a position flag has to be attached. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for bolts. SHORT POSITION Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached in form of a short position. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for short position. MOUNTING POSITION Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached in form of a mounting flag. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for mounting.
Page B.28 - 16
Positioning
FREE Select the insertion point to which a position flag has to be attached. Specify the position flag properties such as style, position number, etc. in the following dialog.
Attaching the position flag via FREE permits you to create position flags even without direct reference to a component part. You can make use of this option e.g. for position flags in 2D drawings the parts of which have been dissolved or drawn manually.
Page B.28 - 17
Positioning
B.28.3
This command serves for automatic distribution of position flags in views or in detail drawings. The properties stored in the component parts are displayed in a position flag according to the set style.
Scale
The scale specifies the size of the position flags to be entered. If e.g. the text height in a position flag style is indicated with 3,5, the position flag will be created with a text height of 3,5 * scale. The shipping number is selected instead of the position number of the part and entered into the position number. The distribution is made in the paper area and the position flags are created there. Click this button to start the automatic distribution of position flags. Select the parts to which position flags have to be attached. Then, the program starts distribution. Click this button to exchange the position of two flags.
Page B.28 - 18
Positioning
Page B.28 - 19
Positioning
Selection list
Here, you specify to which parts position flags have to be attached. After having selected a part type, you can choose a position flag style for this part type which has to be used to display the flag. No group sub parts means that group sub parts are not given a position flag. This is equally valid for subgroups and assemblies.
Distribution Dont care about collision At distribution the position flags are placed on the component part without verifying the surroundings of the part. This is the fastest distribution method, however the most inexact method as well. Iterations This value indicates how often a new position has to be searched for a position flag. The higher the value, the better the positioning result will be, but the longer the search for a suitable position of the position flag. The minimum distance between the insertion point and the end of the position flags guideline Your model is divided into different positioning sections with so-called local centres. The position flags are arranged in a circle around these centres and inserted. This value sets the minimum distance between two local centres. This value indicates the projection of the flag beyond the edge of the visible geometry. This value specifies the minimum distance between two neighbouring position flags. In this field, you specify how the position flags have to look like. The angle is measured between the guideline and the alignment of the text of the position flag. The angle is always indicated as angle area, because an exact angle specification cannot be carried out with distribution algorithm.
Number of Shape Sections For long shapes you can specify on how many positions except the center of the shape position flags have to be placed. At the value 0, the position flags are placed on the center.
Page B.28 - 20
Positioning
Compare Radius Here you specify the radius to be used for verifying the current position flag with regard to collisions with existing part geometry, position flags, elevations, texts or dimension texts. The bigger the value, the longer is the processing time. Options One Part per ... per Centre Only one position flag is inserted for a part having the same position or shipping number (depending on the setting). Only one position flag is inserted with the same position or shipping number (depending on the setting) for each local centre in the drawing.
Place Only Out The position flags are attached outside of the model geometry. Break Lines At Animation The guidelines are interrupted in the case of collisions with dimensions or texts. You can follow positioning procedure on screen if this option is activated. This may require a lot of time in case of bigger models and cannot be interrupted. Position flags referring to parts with identical position or shipping number are arranged to form a common flag. The insertion points mustnt exceed the maximum distance to form a group.
Group Flags
Group Distances The maximum distance up to which identical parts can be arranged to form a group. Guideline Show Count A separate guideline to the flag is created for each identical part of a group. If you have arranged position flags to form a group, you can select which number of parts has to be displayed in the Part Number of the flag. Normally, the sum of the combined parts is inserted. However, you can alternatively enter the entire number of all parts in the model having this position number.
Page B.28 - 21
Positioning
Distribution Procedure
The distribution of position flags takes into consideration the geometry of the component parts, texts and dimensioning objects. At first, distribution searches for the geometry within the compare radius around the insertion point of the position flags. Then, the position flag is created and placed on its origin. If the distributor doesnt find an appropriate position of the position flag (i n case of collision), the flag is moved at shapes along the centerline of the shape and a new insertion position is searched where no collision with existing geometry takes place. If there is still no appropriate position for the position flag, the flag will be created at a greater distance towards the insertion point i. e. the guideline is extended. If there isnt any appropriate place for the position flag, it will be placed at the originally destined insertion point (center of the shape). Working off flag distribution happens according to part size. First, the flags for the small component parts are created and then the rest of the flags in ascending order. Distribution algorithm may be switched off using the option Dont care about Collision. Flags for Main Parts and Groups Different kinds of depiction are possible when a flag has to be attached to the main part of a group or to the corresponding group. Since the settings are more complex, we will display the combinations here. 1. A normal group flag is attached to the main part, containing the data of the corresponding construction group.
Page B.28 - 22
Positioning
2. A group flag is attached to the main part, however containing the single part data of the main part.
3. A single part flag is attached to the main part, containing the single part data of the main part and a group flag, containing the group data is attached to it as
well. 4. A single part flag is attached to the main part, containing the single part data of the main part and a group flag, containing the data of the main part is attached to it as well.
Page B.28 - 23
Positioning
The default settings for subgroups and assemblies can be carried out similarly like the settings for groups.
Page B.28 - 24
Positioning
B.28.4
Here, you will find different commands for processing the position flags and for checking or searching for the position numbers.
Use this button to search for the highest group or part number in the selected component parts. The result is displayed in the neighbouring input fields. Click this button to search for component parts in the model. Enter the position you are looking for in the field Search Number. Use the options Hide, Check, Zoom Extents to select how the found result has to be depicted in the model. Use this command to delete position numbers in component parts and groups. For this purpose, select the parts the position numbers of which have to be deleted. You can specify in which part the number is deleted using the filters Single Parts and Groups. This command enters the current position number of the part as original position number. The original number can only be modified using this command. Use this command to add a second part to a common position flag.
Use this command to remove the arrow to a component part from a position flag.
Page B.28 - 25
Positioning
Use this command to interrupt the guideline of a position flag by specifying two points e.g. to not overwrite a text. Only one interruption per guideline is permitted. Use this command to remove the interruption from the position flags guideline. Use this command to take over the current part properties into the position flag. Use this command to look at the position numbers of the selected parts and to modify them. Press the ALT-key when loading the command to call the function for editing the position numbers of the group. When you press the STRG-key at component part selection, component parts without position number will be displayed in the dialog for processing as well. Use this command to compare two parts with each other. Select the two parts and the result is displayed in a dialog box.
Here, you see two results for comparing the position. In the left figure the parts are identical. In the right one they are not identical. In the dialog window, you can see in detail where the parts differ from each other.
Page B.28 - 26
Positioning
B.28.5
The drawing number of the workshop drawing can additionally be integrated as prefix or postfix into the position number (e.g. Pos 1234 100). In case of big projects, this permits a better identification of the component parts. The drawing number is added in a separate step after detailing, when the drawing numbers of workshop plans are knows and primarily serves for the depiction in overviews.
Default Format
Specify the default format with variables so that you can add additional text. $(DWGNUM) for the drawing number $(DWGIDX) for the drawing index
Here, you specify whether the drawing number has to be entered as prefix or as postfix of the position number. The drawing number of single parts is taken over into their position number. The drawing number of groups is taken over into their position number. The drawing number is taken over into the shipping number instead of into the position number. Click on this button to modify the position numbers. In order to do so, you have to select the component parts.
Page B.28 - 27
Positioning
B.28.6
You determine the depiction of a position flag by specifying a position flag style where the geometry, the content and the colours of the position flag are defined.
Style
Use this box to select the style you want to use for the depiction. Click this button to save the current settings.
Click this button to load templates via the templates management and to use them again.
Create Geo...
Block Geometry The depiction of position flags is specified by an AutoCADblock. You can select any block you like. Block Path Bitmap In this field, you define from which path the blocks for selection of position flag geometry have to be read. You can set a separate bitmap for a style to facilitate the recognition. This bitmap then is displayed in the selection box as well. Click this button to set the defaults of the depiction.
Page B.28 - 28
Positioning
Geometry Line Type Here, you define the kind of guideline to be used. None No guideline will be displayed. Line Only one line will be displayed. Arrow A line with an arrow will be displayed. Point - A line with a point will be displayed. Block A line with any block at the starting point will be displayed. Here, you can select the AutoCAD block, if you have activated the option Line with Block. Here, you define the kind of position number. None Only the number is displayed. Round The number is displayed in an oval. Rectangular Bubble the number is displayed in a field. Hexagonal Bubble The number is displayed in a hexagon. On Line - The number is displayed on the construction line.
Page B.28 - 29
Positioning
Text Type
Here, you set the type of shape designation in case of length indication. U100..160 - The designation is as follows IPE270..7890. U 100 160 The designation is as follows IPE2707890. U100x160 - The designation is as follows IPE270x7890. Format Template The designation is as indicated in the Format Template input field. Here, you determine the direction of the construction line with respect to the position text. Shape The alignment is parallel to the shape. Line You are prompted to enter a reference line by clicking. The text will be aligned accordingly. Horizontal The alignment is in horizontal direction. Vertical - The alignment is in vertical direction. Specifies the text style for the text of the position flag. Specifies the format for the user-defined shape designation if you have selected Format Template as text type. The following parameters are available. $(N) for part name $(L) for part length $(W) for part width $(T) for part thickness The result of the format string $(N) $(T)x$(W) would e.g. be plate 5x380.
Alignment
Prefix / Postfix
In the input field Prefix or Postfix you can enter a text which is displayed in front of or after the position or shipping number of the position flag. The default can be set independently of each other for both numbers. Specifies a text which is written between position number and shipping number, if both numbers have to be displayed as position number entry in the position flag.
Separator
Page B.28 - 30
Positioning
Layout
Here, you determine which part information to be displayed in the position flag. Total Number The number of these parts is displayed, e.g. 17 x IPE 270. Part Name The designation is displayed (e. g. the shape designation). Comment The comments of the parts list information are displayed. Length/Scale The length in the selected text type is displayed. Position Number The position number is displayed. Shipping Number The shipping number is displayed. Material The material designation is displayed. Item Number Any existing item number is displayed. Orig. Posnumber The fixed (former) position number is displayed.
Options No Line Dynamic No line is drawn beneath the text of the position flag. The depiction of the position flag is dynamically adapted to the current view.
Length For Group The entire length of the group is output instead of the part length. Sizes Here, you define the text sizes in mm for general lettering (Text Size) and for position numbers (Pos. Size). For printing, the AutoCAD text sizes are scaled according to selected scale. You set the corresponding colour for the flag as AutoCAD colour number using the fields Line, Number, Bubble und Text. If you enter -1 as value, the pre-setting will be used.
Colours
When you click a position flag via the context menu Change PS Properties, you can subsequently modify the properties of each single position flag. This tab will not be described here in detail because the possibilities for setting correspond to the parameters explained above.
Page B.28 - 31
Positioning
B.28.7
Management of Styles
In this part of the dialog, you maintain your position flag styles. You can create new styles, load , update or delete styles.
Use the displayed button to create a new position flag style. The style will be stored as *.sty-file together with the presettings in the directory for position flag styles. Now you can work with this style on all other pages of this dialog. If you want to work with a special style which is not stored in the drawing but on the hard drive, you can load this style using this button. Select the corresponding *.sty file in the directory of position flag styles and load the file. The style will be available at once. Use this command to remove a style that you dont need any more in the drawing.
Page B.28 - 32
Positioning
Click this button to change the display order. The display order of the style list is not sorted. You can specify the order yourself. For this purpose, use the two arrow keys to move the checked style up or down in the order. If you want to update the styles loaded in your drawing, use this function. Now, all styles in the drawing are replaced by the styles stored on the hard drive.
Page B.28 - 33
Positioning
Page B.28 - 34
Drawing Information
In the different text fields you enter general information on the project and on the drawing. Since these fields are selfexplanatory, they are not explained in detail. Here, you select a block using the SELECT button for entering data in its block attributes via the entry fields, provided you have assigned such entry fields to the variables of the block attributes. When the drawing border for the 2D workshop drawing has been entered as block using the ProSteel command Drawing Borders, you can select the block of the drawing borders. The entries may either be taken over into the title block (export), or the entries can be taken from the title block into the dialog (import).
Project Name
Page 0 - 1
Drawing Information Click on this button to retrieve the data of the entry fields into the block attributes of the selected block. Click on this button to retrieve the block attributes of the selected block into the entry fields.
Click on this button to define the variables assigned to the block attributes of the different entry fields. An identical dialog box will be displayed, where the variable names of the block attributes are entered. When you have selected the Prepared On, Checked On, or Released On fields and click this button, the current date will be entered
Page 0 - 2
Page B.30 - 1
B.30.1
When creating a parts list, you first select the parts to be processed, preferably parts of a group or, in addition, independent single parts. You can decide whether or not parts of your selection are to be included in the list - either collectively via the filter function during creation of the parts lists or individually for each part. If the Select button has not been clicked in the corresponding parts properties, the part will not be included in the parts lists, even though you have selected it. Since further processing and printing of the parts list is carried out with an extra function, you can register all required parts lists first and store them under different names.
Part Selection
Here, you select the parts on the basis of which a parts list is to be created. 3D-parts you select the parts from the model. 2D-position flags the parts list will be deducted from the position flags of a detailed workshop drawing. From modified 2D drawings you can generate new bills of materials.
Group Options
Page B.30 - 2
Verify Position... Only those selected parts will be taken over into the parts lists that have a valid position number. Only Group Parts Only those selected parts will be taken over into the parts lists that are assigned to a group. Subgroups Assemblies Only Selected Subgroups are included when the group structure of the parts list is created. Assemblies are included when the group structure of the parts list is created. Only the selected parts are taken over into the parts list.
Create Group Entry A group entry is written into the parts list only for completely seized groups. Start Part List Parts list processing is started immediately after creation of the parts list file. You neednt use this function separately if you want to continue your work directly. The angle of intersection is calculated by ProSteel according to the NC-guidelines of the DSTV. The parts are rotated that the straight end is situated at the front. Information about welds is written into the parts list file.
Combine Welds Identical welds are summed up to one single entry. XRef Group Bolts Bolts without ... ... Extra Without Weight Output File Bolts will be included in the parts lists, even if they have no position number. The additional parts for the bolts are separately specified in the list of materials. Bolts are imported into the parts list without indication of weight. The file for the list of materials is stored in the file displayed in the Name field in dBASE-format. By clicking the FILE button you can set the directory in the same manner as you use to do under Windows. The selected XRef-objects are included when the parts list is created.
Page B.30 - 3
Dialog-Commands
WITH BOLTS By clicking this button, you start part selection. The selected bolts will be considered as well. WITHOUT BOLTS By clicking this button, you start part selection. Bolts will not be considered, even though they have been selected. MOUNTING LIST By clicking this button, you start part selection. Only the main parts of groups including bolts will be considered.
Page B.30 - 4
B.30.2
After you have created one or several parts lists using the command Create Parts List you can further process the bills by using this command. The files of the parts list can be loaded, modified, formatted, and printed using this command. The substantial form generator makes it possible to freely design the formatting and layout of any parts list, add company logos, and preview the parts lists. You do not need any special knowledge about this utility since its normal operation is smoothly integrated into ProSteel's program environment. However, if you would like to customize the enclosed parts list forms to your individual needs, please read the online help of the form generator List & Label Designer, which will explain the customization of existing and creation of new forms in easy to understand steps. The following sections will describe how to generate and output a parts list first before discussing the individual options of the parts list processing method.
Page B.30 - 5
In the FILE menu click the menu option OPEN FILE and select the *.dbf-file you want to process. The directory and the file name should be known to you (have been previously defined with the command Create Parts List). The dialog box now fills with the parts list data. Each part (even construction group descriptions) is listed individually and unsorted; equal positions are not combined until the time of output. If there is an error in the parts list file (such as for example components with the number=0 or different parts with the same position number) the program creates and opens a file named stkerr.dbf where these errors are displayed. These parts won't be listed in the standard parts list. In the SETTINGS menu, click the menu option SET PARTS LIST HEADER and then enter the data for the parts list header. If you have defined order data previously (command Drawing Information), these data can be imported into the parts list header. Finally, click the OUTPUT menu and select the parts list variation (e.g. parts list of individual parts), which you would like to print. Depending on the settings, the program now prompts you for the layout for the parts list formatting and can then generate a print preview. All or specific pages are printed from within this preview.
Page B.30 - 6
Preview Here, you can see an overview about the most important functions required for printout and navigation within the preview. As the actual printout is completely taken over by the additional application List & Label, please refer to the online help of this program for more detailed information.
Zoom
Print page
Print All
Exit
You can, however; also directly print the parts list without preview or you can convert it into other formats like e. g. the Rich-Text-Format (RTF). To determine the output target, select in the output dialog of List & Label under Output on ... the desired target in the selection list and click on START afterwards to output the parts list.
Page B.30 - 7
The component parts list offers only a draft display of the entries. By doubleclicking an entry, another dialog opens listing all parts lists data for this entry. You can modify any data at this point, which are saved in the corresponding file immediately once you exit the window with the OK button. This means you are not working with just a working temporary buffer copy but with the actual file!
Page B.30 - 8
Page B.30 - 9
Now you will see a list with the existing form layouts in the form of templates as well as a description and preview of the form. If you would like to edit a form just double-click the file name and the utility program List & Label (see intro to this chapter) opens. A detailed description of the functionality would extend beyond the scope of this manual. Please see the online help of this utility program for further details. If you would like to create a new form, enter a new file name, which will return an empty form ready for editing. List Header By clicking this option, you can edit the header of your parts list. The program will give you first the opportunity to import data from the drawing information (see command Drawing Information) into the parts list header. Click this entry to set the filter conditions if you want to output a parts list with filtered data Only data meeting the filter condition are output in the parts list.
Filter
Page B.30 - 10
List Names
By clicking this button, you can preset standard print templates for single part, group and bolt lists. A dialog opens where you enter the print template files to be used as standard selection. You can also select these files by a File Selection Dialog. In addition, you can switch off error check here.
If the field Switch off Posnum Equal Part Detection has been checked, their position number only recognizes identical parts. If this field has not been checked (recommended), the parts are additionally compared with regard to name, length, etc. If these values don't match for component parts having the same position number, an error message is created.
Page B.30 - 11
Free ...List
Page B.30 - 12
Create Part Lists The following figure shows you an example of an component part group list displayed as preview in List & Label:
Page B.30 - 13
Page B.30 - 14
This command permits the creation of a parts list and its output in the drawing. Therefore, it is suitable for drawing-dependent parts lists in plans showing e.g. only one single group. Since this parts list is an "intelligent" object, modifications in the model can be automatically seized and displayed in the parts list. In addition, various formatting options are available which can be controlled directly. After having selected the command, select the desired parts first and then determine the desired insertion point of the list in the drawing by clicking a point. Then the following dialog appears where you can make the basic settings.
Page B.31 - 1
Style
Here, you select the name of the output style. This output style specifies the appearance of the output, i. e. which values are displayed in which lines, the size and position of the columns, etc. The Standard output style is created by the program and therefore is always available. You can create and manage as many styles as you like. Here you select a style and thus restructure the list by selecting a list entry. Here, you select whether the data have to be taken from normal 3D component parts or from 2D position flags. Select the type of parts list here. Single Parts List An own entry is created for each element. The data dont have any reference to each other; the quant ity of output parts corresponds to the seized parts. The determined number of groups is not (!) taken into consideration for selection. Group List Output as group list; here the data are output separately according to groups and the quantity of single parts is output as parts per group. Dissolved Group List A "real" single parts list is output taking into consideration the number of parts depending on the quantity of the corresponding group. Here, you specify the position of the parts list related to the previously selected insertion point. This value indicates in which tolerance ranges the length of component parts is compared and considered as identical. The scale of the output is specified. The size of the complete list output can be increased or decreased. If this button is activated, the list is generated on the current layer. Otherwise, it is generated on the layer specified by PS_TEXT in the configuration. If this button is checked, ProSteel is controlling all activities with regard to their influence on the parts list. When you delete an element or you modify the size of an element adopted into the parts list, the list will be calculated anew and updated. Please note that this option may require some time for calculation. Therefore, you should thoroughly consider whether you want to make use of this possibility and risk the inconveniences of speed. You have always the possibility to update the list manually.
Autom. Update
Page B.31 - 2
Check Position... If this option is activated only parts having a valid position number will be evaluated. Only Groups... Total Amount... If this option is activated only parts belonging to a group will be evaluated. If quantities are used, the total amount will be displayed.
Number*Quantity Groups The displayed amount results from the number of parts in a group multiplied by the quantity of these groups in the model. Total Amount at Total Values If total values have to be used at output, the total amount instead of the number is used at calculation. Bolts... Washers... Nuts... Safety Nuts If this option is activated, bolts having no valid position number will be evaluated as well. If this option is activated, washers will be evaluated and listed as separate parts. If this option is activated, nuts will be evaluated and listed as separate parts. If this option is activated, safety nuts will be evaluated and listed as separate parts.
Wedge Washers... If this option is activated, wedge washers will be evaluated and listed as separate parts. Without Weight Welds Add... Bolts are displayed in the parts list without indication of weight. Welds are displayed in the parts list. Identical types of welds are added in the parts list to a common length. Click on this button to add further component parts to the component parts list of the parts list. You then have to select the parts to be added. Click on this button to remove component parts from the component parts list of the parts list. You then have to select the parts to be removed. Click on this button to calculate anew and update the parts list. Here, you can force an update of the list if the automatic update option has not been activated.
Page B.31 - 3
Move to the second tab Display to edit a new created or existing parts list style and select the style to be edited. EDIT Click on this button to edit the selected style.
Page B.31 - 4
The name of the current style; all modifications are related to this style. Here, you see an overview of all displayed columns of the parts list. They are displayed in this order from the left to the right in the drawing parts list Click on this button to modify the line selected in the display list (parts list column). Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to add a new line (parts list column) to the end of the list. Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to add a new line (parts list column) in front of the checked line. Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to delete the selected line (parts list column) from the list. Click on this button to save the parts list style. Please remember to save the style after modifications; otherwise all modifications will be lost. Click on this button to modify the formatting of the summated text of the parts list. Then, another dialog opens.
Determines the text size in drawing units at a scale 1:1 Increases the height of the lines in question by a factor. Depending on the text style, the readability of the parts list is increased. Distance of the signs to the left margin at left-justified insertion. Distance of the signs to the right margin at right-justified insertion. Distance of the group list entries of group parts to the main part. Rotation of the whole list by the indicated degrees Indicates after how many lines a horizontal line has to be inserted. This only serves for a clearer overview. If this field is checked, the list is running from the bottom to the top, i. e. the column headers are below. At group lists, the groups are divided by horizontal lines. The settings under 'Block Size' dont have any influence in thi s case. All numerical values are aligned to the right margin.
Left Margin Right Margin Offset Rotation Block Size Move Up Divide Groups
Align Numbers
Page B.31 - 5
Fill up with Noughts All numerical values are filled up with noughts according to the indicated format length and digits after the decimal point. Header Text Style The header of the list is taken over to output. Select the desired text style. Please refer to the AutoCAD manual for more detailed information about AutoCAD text styles. Depending on the field selected here, the output is sorted in rising order from the column header onward. Causes a sorting in descending order from the column header onward. At sorting, the entries are separated in prefix and number and then sorted separately.
The display colours can be globally selected for all elements of the parts list. In addition, individual colours can be assigned to the different columns as well. Enter the colour directly by indicating the AutoCAD colour number or click on the desired input field and then on the SELECT button. Then, you can select the colour in the dialog as usual. Header Label Frame Hor. Lines Ver. Lines Colour of column headers Colour of column texts Colour of list frame Colour of the horizontal separation lines of the list Colour of the vertical separation lines of the list
Page B.31 - 6
Select the desired field from the data fields. The name of the column header resp. the first name if an entry has been indicated in input field Name2 as well. Two rows are available altogether. The second name of column header. Here, you enter the desired column width in text signs. The exact column width depends on the selected text style. The number of desired positions after the decimal point. Enter the text size of the column. If you have entered the value 0, the general text size of the list style is used. Enter the colour of the column text (colour number). If you have entered the value -1, the text colour of the list style is used.
Page B.31 - 7
Position
Enter the alignment of the column: Left, Center, Right or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, all texts are aligned to the left and all digits are aligned to the right. Enter the unit format Metric, Imperial or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, the default units of the drawing are used.
Units
Page B.31 - 8
Footer
Enter the desired foot lines. You can use pre-defined variables as well. The following variables are available as foot lines: $(N) $(F) $(L) $(LF) $(W) $(WF) $(P) $(PF) The number of lines is indicated. Multiplication factor addition in % Overall length of all parts without addition Overall length of all parts with addition Overall weight of all parts without addition Overall weight of all parts with addition Overall area to be painted of all parts without addition Overall area to be painted of all parts with addition
Addition
Percentage by which the determined values have to be increased. These increased values can be output by means of the variable $(xF). The number of desired positions after the decimal point. The distance to the corresponding margin. Enter the colour of the text (colour number). If you have entered the value -1, the text colour of the list style is used.
Position
Enter the alignment of the text: Left, Center, Right or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, all texts are aligned to the left and all digits are aligned to the right. Enter the unit format Metric, Imperial or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, the default units of the drawing are used. In the Prefix input field, you can indicate a prefix for the position numbers of group lines. In the Colour input field you can specify the colour of the group line. If the value -1 has been indicated here, the normal text colour will be used. These settings can be made separately for groups, subgroups and assemblies.
Units
Group Row
Page B.31 - 9
B.31.3
The management of the existing parts list styles is organized in the third tab Order.
Click on this button to load the selected style from the hard drive into the drawing. Click on this button to create a new list style. To do this you have to enter a style name (please pay attention that the name does not exist already). Then, this style is created with the settings of the style, which is current at the moment, and it will be used as new current style. The settings of the style can be individually modified afterwards. Click on this button to create a new folder for a clearer structure of your parts list styles.
Page B.31 - 10
B.31.4
Move to the forth tab Content to look at the content of the parts list and to modify it manually. To modify an entry, double-click the corresponding field and you can edit the entry.
Page B.31 - 11
Page B.31 - 12
Containment List
After having created groups in a drawing, you can make lists and insert them into the drawing. These lists can display the belonging of certain parts to component part groups. You can insert these drawing containment lists in the DetailCenter Express as well. First select the desired parts after having selected this command. Then, specify the desired insertion point of the list in the drawing by clicking a point. The following dialog appears displaying the basic settings.
Style
Here, you define how the list has to look like on the base of a style. The list templates are saved as template via the template management. Here, you specify the insertion point of the created list. You can choose between several insertion points. The list is placed on the current layer of the drawing instead of on the configuration layer.
Page B.32 - 1
Containment List
Scale
Specifies the insertion scale of the list. The scale affects text heights and distances within the list. Click on this button to add further parts to the component parts list of the drawing containment list. You have to select the parts to be added. Click on this button to remove parts from the component parts list of the drawing containment list. You have to select the parts to be removed. Click on this button, to calculate anew an update the drawing containment list. You can force an update of the list if automatic update has not been activated.
Page B.32 - 2
Containment List
B.32.2
Move to the second tab Display to edit a new created or existing list style. Select the style to be edited. EDIT Click on this button to edit the selected style.
Page B.32 - 3
Containment List
The name of the current style; all modifications are related to this style. Here, you see an overview of all displayed columns of the drawing containment list. They are displayed in this order from the left to the right in the drawing containment list. Click on this button to modify the line selected in the display list (column of drawing containment list). Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to add a new line (column of drawing containment list) to the end of the list. Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to add a new line (column of drawing containment list) in front of the checked line. Then, another dialog opens. Click on this button to delete the selected line (column of drawing containment list) from the list. Click on this button to save the style of the drawing containment list. Please remember to save the style after modifications; otherwise all modifications will be lost.
Determines the text size in drawing units at a scale 1:1 Increases the height of the lines in question by a factor. Depending on the text style, the readability of the drawing containment list is increased. The distance of the signs to the left margin at left-justified insertion. The distance of the signs to the right margin at right-justified insertion. The distance of the group list entries of group parts to the main part. The rotation of the whole list by the indicated degrees If this field is checked, the list is running from the bottom to the top, i.e. the column headers are below.
Separating Lines The groups are divided by horizontal lines. Header Text Style A column description is displayed for the columns of the list. Select the desired text style. Please refer to the AutoCAD manual for more detailed information about AutoCAD text styles.
Page B.32 - 4
Containment List
Invert Prefix
Causes a sorting in descending order from the column header onward. Separate prefixes can be predefined here for entries of groups, subgroups and assemblies.
The display colours can be globally selected for all elements of the drawing containment list. In addition, individual colours can be assigned to the different columns as well. Enter the colour directly by indicating the AutoCAD colour number or click on the desired input field and then on the SELECT button. Then, you can select the colour in the dialog as usual. Header Label Frame Hor. Lines Ver. Lines Colour of column headers Colour of column texts Colour of list frame Colour of the horizontal separation lines of the list Colour of the vertical separation lines of the list
Page B.32 - 5
Containment List
Select the desired field from the data fields. The name of the column header resp. the first name if an entry has been indicated in input field Name2 as well. Two rows are available altogether. The second name of column header. Here, you enter the desired column width in text signs. The exact column width depends on the selected text style. The number of desired positions after the decimal point. Enter the text size of the column. If you have entered the value 0, the general text size of the list style is used. Enter the colour of the column text. If you have entered the value -1, the text colour of the list style is used.
Page B.32 - 6
Containment List
Position
Enter the alignment of the column: Left, Centre, Right or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, all texts are aligned to the left and all digits are aligned to the right. Enter the unit format Metric, Imperial or Automatic. If 'Automatic' has been selected, the default units of the drawing are used.
Units
Page B.32 - 7
Containment List
Click on this button to load the selected style from the hard drive into the drawing. Click on this button to create a new list style. To do this you have to enter a style name (please pay attention that the name does not exist already). Then, this style is created with the settings of the style, which is current at the moment, and it will be used as new current style. The settings of the style can be individually modified afterwards. Click on this button to create a new folder for a clearer structure of your list styles.
Page B.32 - 8
Containment List
Page B.32 - 9
Containment List
Page B.32 - 10
Detailing
C Detailing
Page C - 1
Detailing
Page C - 2
DetailCenter
C.1
DetailCenter
Detailing 3D Models
The program generates the usual 2D views of the components for the workshop plans using the model, which means that the program will disassemble the model into its components, analyse the geometry of all the individual parts, and ascertains any existing but invisible edges. Then depending on the requirements or your selections the shape is displayed in several views and dimensioned and the position flag is attached. All of this takes place in a split second and in the background. Once the program has finished with one component, this component is deposited in a library in the form of a block clearly organized according to the individual construction groups and design sections. After this procedure has concluded you can use the program to help you with the layout of the parts on your drawing sheets. From here on, you can treat the parts as if they were the usual drawings generated with a CAD program but ProSteel offers you a few extra functions, which facilitate your work.
Intervention Options
You do not have to worry that you are going to be at the mercy of the program and that from now on all your drawings will reflect the wishes of the software designers. A vast number of parameters help you to specify the appearance of your mapped design. These parameters can be saved as data records and reimported depending on the type of drawing (overview, life-size, 1: 10 workshop details, etc). This saves you time by being able to detail several parts at once applying one of these styles that might already be enough to satisfy the requirements of your assignment. However, you can also detail small groups of components one after the other or even a single part in different styles. You always have access to the smallest detail.
Page C.1 - 1
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 2
DetailCenter
When you open the DetailCenter for the first time, a clear dialog box will be displayed with only a few settings. There is nothing more required after the adaptations to your personal requirements were made. As you know, you only want to get your shop drawings from the model. However, if need be, you can at any time penetrate deeply inside the drawing derivation. You can make a great number of settings, ask for information, and check drawings. The philosophy behind this development is that you can get the same result in various ways, that you can make a lot of modifications but you do not have to!
Page C.1 - 3
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 4
DetailCenter
DetailCenter Surface
The following page will give you an overview over the work area of the DetailCenter. This chapter includes an introduction and explains some of the basic detailing terms. The individual function areas are described later in special chapters.
Page C.1 - 5
DetailCenter
In general, the DetailCenter is divided into three main work levels. Usually, your building part or component will pass through all three levels until it is visible on the workshop plan in the form of a detail. However, your work in the different levels is limited to only a few mouse clicks, if all the basic settings of detailing are adapted to your requirements. Even if these works seem to be too awkward and involved for you, because you do not need the flexibility of the DetailCenter, you can use the DetailCenter Express. This part of the program once again combines the remaining steps until a workshop plan is created. Detailing is worked through according to a predetermined pattern. Detailing by one single mouse click became a reality. Level 1: Component Overview (Prepare) Here you will obtain an overview of the parts of the model and their functional associations and relationships. You can view construction groups, single parts or whole areas of the model all clearly structured in tree format. This is the place where you can manage and change detail styles and link your components with these styles as well as manage the modification mechanism. In addition, DetailCenter Express! Is started here. Level 2: Display Views Overview (Detailing) The second work level offers you an overview of the component or model views created by the program. You can add or remove views, display a preview and fine-tune the detail style. In this overview you decide what exactly is to be processed as a detail block and start the actual detailing process. Level 3: Detail Block Overview (Import) The third and last level features the detailed parts, which are located on your hard drive in the form of detail blocks. You receive an overview of the detail blocks of the current model (or other models) and decide which parts to import or integrate into which drawing. Placing the parts on a drawing sheet finishes the workshop plan, unless you would like to carry out a few adjustments manually. You can create automatic multiple sheets according to your own rules by means of InsertExpress! which can be started here.
Page C.1 - 6
DetailCenter
Work Tools
Each of the three levels offers access to a window with work tools using the function button bar. These tools are assigned to the corresponding area. In order to keep the display area of the construction parts lists as large as possible, many of the infrequently used functions and settings have been delegated to these subordinate dialogs.
Information Window
In addition, the context menu offers access to another dockable information window. All three-work levels are subordinate to this information window, which shows the current status of the selected entry. Depending on the list, this window displays the name and type of the part, data of detailing, insertion location, current status, and much more.
Context Menu
A supplement to every level is a level-specific context menu accessible through the right mouse button, which lists only those functions that are significant to the respective list. You will probably use the context menus quite often because they represent the fastest way to access a command.
Templates
As you already know from the other ProSteel functions, the basic settings of the DetailCenter can be saved as template for each level. The settings of work tools and of construction parts list are stored. These templates (as reference) may again be stored in a parent template together with the global settings for the DetailCenter. This allows individual configuration of the complete DetailCenter. Later, you only have to load the suitable configuration for the current working process.
Page C.1 - 7
DetailCenter
Favourites
After defining some of the templates as favourites for the complete DetailCenter, this allows fast selection from the favourite list. This is the most comfortable way if you have to change the setting frequently during one session.
Detail Styles
The detail styles are the cornerstone of the entire detailing process. They describe how a part is to look as a workshop detail or how the model is to appear as an overview. The content of the styles is described in detail in the chapter 'Detailing Styles'. The management and modification of a style is described in detail in the chapter 'Component Overview'. Just a preliminary note: A component without detail style cannot be processed and is ignored by the program when it comes to detailing!
Preview
The detailing of a selected part can be previewed from within the views overview or directly from within the model. This will create a small AutoCAD drawing displaying the exact result of the detail style settings applied to this part. The small drawing shows how the part will be detailed. This window and its drawing can be zoomed or queried for information because it is an independent AutoCAD drawing. Since you can now open this part's detail style, you can track the effects of different style settings in real time. We call this fine -tuning of the detail style. If you open the preview for another part, you do not have to close this window first. The content is updated automatically. After viewing the detail, the window must be closed manually. While the preview is open, most of the functions of the DetailCenter are inaccessible. Please remember: The preview might be hidden behind some other drawing because so many windows can be open simultaneously. Also consider the speed of your computer when viewing a great many details such as construction groups or entire overviews. Do not become impatient if your computer seems to be busy calculating for what seems like a long time. Even fast computers need a little computation time, but some of the latest computers will surprise you with the speed of the update.
Page C.1 - 8
DetailCenter
Scales
The first method allows for a simple and unscaled processing of the drawing and does not generate the scale until the time of plotting. Components can also be inserted (unlabeled!) into other plans easily and comfortably. The disadvantage of this method is that this involves some thinking, to keep different scales and the same text sizes within one drawing and still have to copy parts from other drawings. This is where the second method is more practical: You always plot using the scale 1:1, always use the same text size, and scale the parts to fit the plotting scales just as you would do when drawing by hand. This allows you easy management of different scales within one drawing. ProSteel permits both methods when detailing, but you have to stick to one or the other method within one drawing. This is because the dimensioning styles are the problem.
Dimensioning Styles
You define certain AutoCAD dimensioning styles in your model, which you can use within the detail styles for dimensioning. When detailing, the program creates a copy of the style, and from your settings determines the required text and length scaling. This style is assigned a new name indicating the length scaling and is used in the detail block. Although the program does set the dimension text into the dimension permanently, e.g. to evaluate contractions, you do want to receive an AutoCAD associate dimensioning after the detailing has been concluded; thus the copy. This also keeps your original style intact and you do not need to create separate styles for each individual scale.
Page C.1 - 9
DetailCenter If you want to work with the first method using a scale of 1:10, you will obtain a style with a text scaling=10 and with a length scaling=1. The name could be, e.g., PS_STD_1_10. Process another detail with different settings of the AutoCAD dimensioning style and you will obtain the same name for the style. No problems occurred up to now. Now insert both details into a drawing and the first one will win out because the name is identical. However, this is typical for AutoCAD and ProSteel has no intention of changing that. If you have problems with the dimensioning styles, you can be assured that this is due to not being consequent in this case. This is the reason you should make sure that your prototype file, into which you want to import the details, does not contain any dimensioning styles (if possible), and that the basic styles with the same name are also identical in different models if you want to mix together the details of different models. Do not change the size by only changing the scale (e.g., when manually dimensioning), but rather define a new style with a new name. This is the way it should be when using AutoCAD pure because there is a good reason for it: If you rescale the parts manually, you are simply exchanging the dimensioning style and all is well again.
Page C.1 - 10
DetailCenter
Single Parts
These are all parts that correspond to a real 3D-component part in the model and normally are the smallest unit of detailing. The DetailCenter itself, however, cannot differentiate between production parts and parts of additional purchase or on stock. A single part drawing can be generated of every ProSteel volume solid. In this drawing, the part edges, angles of intersection and drill holes are dimensioned. Normally the coordinate system of the component part defines the alignment of standard views, such as front view, plan view, etc. Weld shapes are an exception. They consist of several single components, but in most cases they are considered and treated as one component part.
Views
This is a three-dimensional arrangement of component parts in the model as they can be seen from a defined view direction and with a previously defined view depth, which is not to be confused with the component part views. An overview drawing is created in which the position of the component parts to each other and to existing reference axes (constructional axes) is dimensioned. Views are derived from the existing model views which were either created automatically by the workframe (PS_WORKFRAME), or which were added by you later.
Page C.1 - 11
DetailCenter
Isometric Views
These views show the model in a three-dimensional depiction and are often desired without the hidden edges. View direction is determined by the five global 3D-model views of the configuration. It is possible as well to add isometric views to individual details (e.g. groups). In this case, these are depicted as component part view together with the other partial views.
Anchorage Plan
This view refers to the plan view plane and shows the plan view including dimensions together with the depiction of the base plates and supports. As special feature, it is possible to use different scales for plan view and base plate details. The dimensioning of the holes can be referred to the plan view grid.
Page C.1 - 12
DetailCenter
Manual Details
In principle, these are also views of the model, but you can freely determine the involved component parts and the view direction during detailing. Manual details allow you to generate unusual views or special detail sections. As the name implies, you have to attach the dimensioning yourself and you dont have any possibility to have the view automatically checked with regard to modifications. Manual details dont appear in the component part list nor do they have their own detailing style. Scale and display of the component parts are, however controlled by a temporarily assigned detailing style during generation. It is true that after generation manual details can be inserted into the drawing in the same way like standard views.
Multi-Shapes
These are single parts consisting of several components that are normally treated and dimensioned like a single coherent component part (e.g. weld shapes). Depending on the situation it may be that these component parts are not ordered but individually produced. Therefore, in the DetailCenter you can consider a multi-shape as components. That means that it appears as an individual subpart in a component part group, but on the other hand you can still create single part drawings of the components. Therefore, it is necessary to activate the option Treat Parts as Single Parts in the 3D-component parts properties for the parts in question.
Page C.1 - 13
DetailCenter
Gusset Details
These are views on the model showing the involved component parts of a connection (2) or of a group of connections (1) as detailed section.
In most cases, the connecting elements such as plates, bolts, etc. can be completely seen whereas the connected shapes are only partially displayed. The connections are recognized via the existing logical links if at least one of these links is named with an identification code. A gusset detail appears as separate component part in the component part list of the DetailCenter and a detailing style can be assigned to it. Afterwards, you treat it in a similar way like a component part group.
Page C.1 - 14
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 15
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 16
DetailCenter Use of Group Structure In principle, there are nearly no limits for you how to group the component parts because the examples for application only represent few of the great number of possibilities. It is up to you whether you want to apply grouping according to construction for the order and the parts list or whether you only carry out a logical grouping for later 2D-drawings. Within the DetailCenter, you find a hierarchic tree structure of grouping and you can filter and sort the display according to the different planes. Each structure and subordinate structure can be detailed as separate detail and inserted in the 2D-drawing. The following example shows the practical use of group structure at detailing: A column of a storage rack builds an assembly (1) of two component part groups (1a) which are bolted with each other. The lower of the two groups contains two welded base points which here however are assigned to the group as subgroups (1b).
The detail drawing of the assembly (2) is showing the column of the storage rack standing and only with the main dimensions as a kind of total overview of the construction.
Page C.1 - 17
DetailCenter The detaill of the component part group (3) now displays the position of the addon parts in the component part group. The two base points are not dimensioned in a more detailed way, but they appear only as complete part.
The base points can be inserted into the drawing as separate detail of the subgroup (4) with detailed mounting dimensions. In case of stock items this could of course be omitted.
When the base point is manufactured together with the remaining group, you require perhaps single parts details (5) of the base plates which again can have a completely different detailing style.
Page C.1 - 18
DetailCenter Advantages of Assemblies The use of assemblies may also be useful in situations where normally you would use only groups. As groups always determine the alignment of the views as well as the direction of dimensioning according to their main part, you often get a very unfavourable combination for certain oblique constructions.
In contrast, a superior assembly permits free selection of alignment and thus also of dimensioning. In addition, you can of course also dimension the group in main part direction in this drawing.
For more detailed information on dimensioning of complex group structures, please refer to the chapter Detailing Style of this manual.
Page C.1 - 19
DetailCenter
Intelligent Details
The result of the detailing process is a detail, as you would draw it with standard AutoCAD. You can see centrelines, visible and hidden edges, holes, etc. and the part is still not a true flat line graphic. Intelligent details are still displayed as three-dimensional details when viewing the page containing individual parts or construction groups at a slant. However, when you print the part it appears completely two-dimensional The advantage is that you can subsequently add cuts or dimensions while taking any possible shape shortening into account. If you want to change the geometry subsequently, that is in the detailed part, you have to import the changes with the ProSteel functions if you still require the intelligent features. However, if you want to dissolve the detail in its entirety, you have to explode the component like a block. This gives you a group, which can be ungrouped to reach the lines. Of course, the consequence is that all of the intelligence is lost. Thus, omit this if at all possible. Overviews and manual details are an exception those are already non-intelligent line depictions.
Shape Shortening
During the detailing you can select whether you want to shorten any parts that are especially long. Contracted sections are then attached to those sections of a component that do not show any manipulations in a longer stretch and are actually of no interest. This gives you the opportunity to display the sections that are important for the detailing in an optimal size (because you can select larger scales) or show more components on a given page. The picture below clearly illustrates the difference. Both shapes are detailed with the same scale and scaled to the same length.
Page C.1 - 20
DetailCenter
The problem of shortening is the subsequent dimensioning with AutoCAD. However, if you work with the ProSteel dimensioning, you can consider any shortening at a later time because your work is object-related. This requires that the components are not dissolved down to the lines after detailing because then this property is lost!
Pick Helpers
The intelligent components of groups have the disadvantage that the individual parts of a detailed construction group are inaccessible if e.g. you want to move them subsequently. It would also not help to activate or deactivate the group using the AutoCAD-groups. This is why ProSteel features the "Pick Helpers, which you might view as a grip variation. If you do not have any part selected in the drawing and you access the context menu using the right mouse button, you will see the option ProSteel SETTINGS and the entry Pick Helpers. Use this entry to toggle the pick helpers on and off. Small little triangles now appear on the components, which you can now use to select and e.g. move the parts of a group. When working with the pick helpers, don't forget the following special feature: If a building component of a construction group is moved, a new drawing of the group is only created when you keep the ALT-key pressed during the movement. Otherwise, the drawing has to be regenerated to obtain the modified display.
Page C.1 - 21
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 22
DetailCenter
Group Display Type Display Type Here you select the fundamental type of display. ProSteel Standard the component parts are displayed in the usual group/single part structure. In addition, loose single parts and model views will be displayed as well. User defined you determine the hierarchy of the display individually, i.e. you specify in which order the parts have to be sorted according to which properties.
Available Display Fields Select the desired property field of a part, which has to be added to the tree structure.
Page C.1 - 23
DetailCenter
Selected Data Fields The currently selected property fields of the structure. The order corresponds to the hierarchy level in the tree display (sorting order). The property field corresponds to the type of this property. It depends on the data of the parts to be represented which entries will actually be displayed. If you have e.g. selected the length as property, an entry will be created on this hierarchy level for each existing shape length and all components having the same length will be subordinate to this property.
Group Display Filter Standard Filter Only those parts will be displayed that meet the specified filter condition. In the selection list, some pre-defined filter conditions are offered for selection, which however cannot be modified by you. Only those parts will be displayed that meet the specified filter condition. The filter condition here is completely user-defined. The selected properties for the structure and those for the filter dont have to be identical. It is for example possible to display a sorting only according to the length but filter out the component type rib completely with it.
User-defined Filter
User-defined Additional Filter An additional second filter; this filter is logically linked with the user-defined filter by AND, thus, a component part has to meet both conditions (and if need be the conditions of the standard filter).
Selection List
Select one of the filter templates that you specified in the corresponding list. Select Current Settings when you havent created any template and you want to use the current settings of the filter dialog instead. By clicking on this button you can edit the display filter or store/select a filter template.
EDIT
Page C.1 - 24
DetailCenter
Group Options Sort Order Here, you select the order of the entries. Ascending The entries are displayed in an ascending numerical or alphabetical order (1,2,3,4...). Descending The entries are displayed in a descending numerical or alphabetical order (...4,3,2,1). No Sorting The entries are not sorted. Each component part is displayed only once in the whole tree structure. The position numbers serve as criterion of comparison, separated in groups and single parts. If a part having the same position (e.g. a rib) is situated in two different group positions, this is only displayed in the first group. Each component part is displayed only once in the whole tree structure, but each single part of a group will be registered anew per group. If a part having the same position (e.g. a rib) is situated in two different group positions, this is displayed exactly once in each group.
Show Entries 1x
Group Display
Here, you select the way group parts will be displayed. As Group Structure The building components, substructures and bolts of a group are subordinate to the group entry. This allows an easy selection of any part of a group. Only Single Parts Only the actual parts of a group are displayed, but not the group entries themselves. Group and Single Parts The groups (as an entry without subordinate parts) and the actual parts of this group are displayed of equal value side by side. The advantage of this separation is that in case of a userdefined sorting you can arrange the group and the component parts separately. Otherwise, it wouldnt be possible to register the single parts in the case the group has not been registered. Nor would it be possible to separate e.g. in groups, substructures and building components of equal value side by side.
Page C.1 - 25
DetailCenter
With Pre-sort
The entries are preliminarily sorted according to views, groups, if need be, main parts /building components, substructures and loose single parts (depending on the selected group display), if you have selected ProSteel standard sorting. The entry of preliminary sorting is not displayed if it doesnt contain any further entry.
No empty Folder
Display Filter
The display filter allows a very detailed filtering of component parts according to their properties. You can describe any logically nested filter condition on the basis of the existing properties (there are no limits with regard to the complexity of the query). A standard filter and two filters of equal value (user-defined filter and additional filter) are available which are linked with each other by the logical AND. You may store these filter conditions as templates which can be easily selected. This allows you to prepare frequent filter conditions that are perfectly adapted to your application. Although each filter is logically nested by any condition such as 'All shapes longer than 5000, but no IPE270 or IPE240', it sometimes is easier to work with the additional filter, too. If e.g. no sheet metal plates are required for a task, you can exclude them permanently already via the additional filter. The user-defined filter then serves for your daily work and you can modify this filter without having to add the condition 'No sheet metal plates' each time.
Page C.1 - 26
DetailCenter
Group Comparative Term List Here, you see all property fields of the parts that may be used for the filter criteria. Each field can be used as often as you like. Select the desired field by clicking on it in the list. Then, the field name will appear in the display on the right. Display Fields Here, you specify a single comparative condition consisting of field name, comparative operator and parts data. Several comparative conditions may be combined with logical operators to build the complete filter condition. The current property field that can be modified by clicking on it in the list. Here, you select the comparative operator that links the property field and the parts data (content of the field) to build a comparative condition.
Page C.1 - 27
DetailCenter
Possible parts data (contents of the field) of the selected property field in a dropdown-list. Thus, impossible comparative conditions are avoided. It is possible as well to use the standard wildcards * and ? for variable signs in text fields.
When all of the three components of a comparative condition have been preset, you can add them to the complete filter condition by clicking on the INSERT button. Depending on the existing conditions and on the selected logical link, the appropriate brackets will be set.
Group Filter Condition Display Field The complete filter condition as logical link consisting of several comparative conditions. When you have already inserted a comparative condition, the active logical operator of the next comparative condition will be displayed, too.
Dialog Commands
OPERATOR AND By clicking on this button, you select the logical operator AND as logical link for the next comparative condition.
OPERATOR OR By clicking on this button, you select the logical operator OR as logical link for the next comparative condition.
BRACKETS Clicking on this button forces the program to manually add brackets to the filter conditions existing up to that moment. Brackets are always necessary if you want to link the complete result of a (partial) condition with another one, because the combination of (A AND B) OR C is different to A AND (B OR C).
Page C.1 - 28
DetailCenter
INSERT By clicking on this button you add the current comparative condition to the complete filter condition.
DELETE By clicking on this button you delete the comparative condition that was added last.
DELETE ALL By clicking on this button you delete the complete filter condition.
Page C.1 - 29
DetailCenter
This is the function bar of the component overview. Buttons no. 1-3 are available in each work level with the same function.
Page C.1 - 30
DetailCenter
Dialog Commands
RECURSION (1) By clicking on this button, recursive processing is alternatively switched on or off. If it is switched on, any processing applied to a parent entry in the component parts list (e.g. assign style) is also applied to all subordinate entries. Otherwise, only the selected entry is processed or all entries on the same level, if this option is activated in the model. STRUCTURE (2) Click on this button to open the dialog for display sorting of component parts list. Here, you can select the standard display or an individual structure and set user-defined filters. SETTINGS (3) Click on this button to open the dialog for the work tools where you can specify additional settings only for this work level. Depending on the work level, the global settings are valid, too, which can be defined separately. UPDATE (4) Click on this button to search the selected drawing once more. This is required if you activated a different drawing in the MDI environment or if changes were made to the current drawing (e.g. new position). EXPRESS (5) Click on this button to start the DetailCenter Express, to carry out a complete detailing according to a specified pattern.
Page C.1 - 31
DetailCenter
PREPARE (6) Click on this special action button to import all parts selected in the parts list into the view list and determine the views pre-selected in the detail style. Component views can be generated only for parts linked with a detail style. WORK LEVELS (7) Switch on a different work level by clicking on the corresponding tab. Any open dialog is updated accordingly. Here, you can switch over to the page for the global settings of the DetailCenter where you can specify the settings, which are valid for the whole DetailCenter or for several work levels. TITLE BAR (8) If you double-click on this area, the dialog switches from docked to free moving. Alternatively, you can also grab the dialog and pull it out while keeping the left mouse button depressed. SEPARATOR (9) Use this separator to enlarge the docked dialog. The drawing next to it will decrease in size accordingly. In addition, there is a scrolling bar between the two display lists (if two lists are available), which you can use for modifying the scale of the two lists. CLOSE (10) Click on this button to close the DetailCenter.
Page C.1 - 32
DetailCenter
Delete Detail Styles Select the detail style you want to delete from the list. Then use the context menu option Remove Detail Style. The detail style is now deleted from the list and the drawing. The styles exported to the hard drive are not affected. Please note that this deleted detail style is then no longer available for later sessions unless you have exported it to the hard drive before.
Page C.1 - 33
DetailCenter
Set and Remove Default Detail Styles Some detailing functions such as manual detailing require a default detail style. Just select the desired style, followed by the entry Set as Default Detail Style in the context menu. The current default detail style is identified in bold type. To modify the default detail style, just select another style and set this one as default detail style. To completely remove it, select the current default detail style, followed by the entry Remove Default Detail Style.
Load Detail Styles At first loading of the DetailCenter, only those detail styles are displayed in the list, which were saved in the drawing. You can, however, load additional style files (e.g. the defaults of certain customers), when you start detailing. If you then save the drawing, these additional styles will be permanently available in the drawing and will be displayed at the next loading. To load an additional style select the context menu option Load Detail Style. Now, you can select a style file by the file selection dialog. If you directly want to load all existing style files from the standard folder, then you select the entry Load all Detail Styles instead. This additional loading of styles is reasonable if you require a great number of different styles in your company all in all, but only a part of them has to be used per order. If you load a detail style existing in the model, the existing style will be overwritten. Kindly also take care of the hints concerning the modified file format at the end of this chapter.
File Format of Style File As the volume of a detail style considerably increased compared with earlier versions, from version 17.2 on the file will only be saved as binary file with the file ending *.stx. All commands for loading a detail style wait for the style files in this format. Hint: The former text files (*.sty) will not be supported any more from version 18.0 on and, if need be, have to be converted together with the previous version..
Page C.1 - 34
DetailCenter
Yellow
Green
Red
Page C.1 - 35
DetailCenter
Additional Checkmarks Checkmark Asterisk (*) A detail style has been assigned to the component part. the part in question is the main part of the associated group.
Information about the Component Parts The meaning of the different entries can be easily differentiated by means of the symbols, because single parts, sheet metal plates, groups, views, etc. have their own typical symbol. In addition to this, you can open a dockable information window via the entry Display Information in the context menu. This window informs you in detail about all properties of the part selected at that moment. This call can be found in the other work levels too. The content of this window is always automatically adapted to your current selection. Multiple Selection and Drag&Drop Use the SHIFT and CTRL keys to select multiple entries. This is a Windowsspecific function, which will not be explained here. Many operations can also be carried out using drag&drop. For example, by dragging a component list entry on a detail style, you can link the two. Selection of ProSteel Properties Via the DetailCenter, the properties of component parts can be directly modified in the model. Select the entry PS3D Properties in the context menu after having selected the desired list entries. For more detailed information about parts properties, please refer to the corresponding chapters of this manual. In principle, selection is as if you select the part(s) in the model and then load the properties. In combination with the sorting possibilities of the component parts list, however, it is possible here to modify e.g. only the material of head plates. If you are working with a big model, using the traditional way would be much more complicated. Dont forget to update the DetailCenter after a modification was made because the program doesnt carry out an automatic update deliberately.
Page C.1 - 36
DetailCenter
Reference to the Model (Search) The component parts list has a direct reference to the model drawing in both directions, which allows an easy and fast orientation. On one hand, the components of the entries selected in the list can be displayed in the model. This allows you to see directly which parts belong to a group, to a view, etc. To do this, select the option Display Parts Selection in the Model in the work tools. Now, select an entry in the component parts list and the assigned parts are colourfully checked in the model. Choose th e entry 'Model to remove the marking. On the other hand, a part selected in the model can be checked in the component parts list (and selected). To do this, pick the part in the model and select the menu point Search/Selection Single Part via the context menu of the right mouse button. Now, the list scrolls to the position with the assigned entry, the entry is checked and selected. The parent entries such as group list nodes etc. are "opened. Sorting Sorting of the component parts list always depends on the work tools settings. The numerical sorting of position within the sorting according to groups, part types, etc. is always carried out in three steps: At first, sorting is effected according to the main position number. This number again is sorted according to an existing position index. If additional prefixes are available, theses are sorted in the last step. Position numbers, which only consist of letters, are displayed at the beginning in an alphabetical order. If the filter 'Display Each Part only 1x is checked, only those positions are assumed to be identical which only differ in their part prefix unless the button 'Dont Use Position Number Prefix' has been activated. Standard Sorting: Pos AA Pos BC Pos 1-1 Pos 1-2 Pos TR 1-2 Pos 2-2 Pos ST2-3 Pos TR2-3 Pos 2-4 with Filter: Pos AA Pos BC Pos 1-1 Pos 1-2 (lapses) Pos 2-2 Pos ST2-3 (lapses) Pos 2-4
Page C.1 - 37
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 38
DetailCenter
If you assign style "A" to the model and 'Recursive' is activated, every entry is linked with this style. If 'Recursive' is deactivated, only the entries Outline, Complete Plan View, BG 100 and BG 101 are linked with this style, because they are located hierarchically immediately underneath the model. Since the model itself is only a sorting entry, it passes the association along to its subordinate entries. If you assign style "B" to the BG 101 and 'Recursive' is activated, every single part of this group is linked with this style as well. If 'Recursive' is deactivated, only this construction group is assigned style "B". Separate Detail Styles Select the parts in the list and then use drag&drop to pull them towards the top and away from the DetailCenter and you are finished! You can also select the parts and use the context menu to select the option Separate from Detail Style. Remember that parts without a detail style cannot be processed unless the parts belong to a group and you want to detail only the group views. Write-Protection Use the Set Write-Protection command in the context menu to write-protect certain entries. The entries are highlighted and cannot be overwritten with a new style or separated from a style. You have to remove the write-protection before change or delete the style of such an entry. The combination of recursive processing and write-protection facilitates assigning different styles to groups and single parts: Deactivate recursive and active write-protection and drag the "model entry on the group style. Only the groups are assigned a style (due to the recursive setting) and are then saved. Activate recursive and drag the "model entry on the single part style. The style association is passed on to all parts but the groups themselves are writeprotected. Hide Parts You can temporarily remove undesired parts from the component parts list to get a better survey. To do this, select the corresponding parts and then activate the menu point Hide Entry in the context menu.
Page C.1 - 39
DetailCenter
Visibility only refers to the component parts list. Dont mix up this f unction with the visibility classes in the 3D-model, which really hide the parts visually and thus switch to permanently invisible parts. When the DetailCenter is started anew or when you use the command UPDATE, all hidden entries will be visible again.
Page C.1 - 40
DetailCenter
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
Group Behaviour during Style Association Protect The entry is protected at once after association of a detail style and is shown in bold. It cannot be modified unless the protection is removed. The entry is hidden from the list after association of a detail style. Only the parts without association of a detail style are shown. The DetailCenter has to be started anew or updated to make the entry visible again. Remember that in case of hiding a group its single parts will be hidden too even if they do not have any style yet. The entry is immediately imported to the next work level (views) after association of a detail style. It is available for detailing.
Hide
Take over
Page C.1 - 41
DetailCenter
Group Behaviour during Update Restore Manual Changes During automatic update of 2D-drawings, the program tries to restore modifications which were made later in the details. Otherwise, the detail is displayed as completely new detailed according to the detail style. > Deleted Dimensions Dimensions or position flags deleted by the user are deleted again. You will find a more detailed description of automatic 2D-Update in a separate chapter of this documentation.
Page C.1 - 42
DetailCenter
Dialog-Commands
ADDITIONAL VIEW Click on this button to add further views to the selected component part or to create manual details. Then, another dialog opens (see also: Additional Views). After an entry has been checked in the views list, the corresponding parts for the manual detail are automatically selected. On the other hand, when you select the first entry of the list, you can select any part by clicking on it in the model. DETAILING Click on this special action button to detail all of the parts selected in the views list, including the mentioned partial views, and to store them on the hard drive as detail blocks. The created detail blocks then can be inserted in your 2D-drawings.
Page C.1 - 43
DetailCenter
Views List
Here, you will see all views of the imported parts in the form of entries, which can be checked for their current status. The display and sorting of the list depends on the settings of the display templates. Status Display The significance of these pictures matches the component part overview; please refer to that section for further details. If the view has already been detailed it is marked with a checkmark. Preview Before detailing you can display a preview of the detail or of a single view. Detailing will take place as it is displayed there. If you choose only one view you will see exactly that view in the preview. However, if you select the entire component or group, you will see all existing views of the part in an order determined by the program. To activate the preview, just select the corresponding entry and then select Preview via the context menu. After some computing time displayed by the status indicator, a drawing window opens containing the possible detailing as a preview. If the detail style dialog and the preview are open, you can now change the different detail style settings and check the effects of the modifications. If the detail style is not yet open, you can open the dialog via the context menu Edit with Detail Style. The correct detail style belonging to this view is then already selected. Add and Remove New Views Should you notice that the views displayed are too few or show an unfavourable line of vision on the part, you can add or remove any view. Just drag the view to be removed towards the top and away from the DetailCenter using drag&drop. If you select an entire component, the entire component will be removed; if you select the Detail Views entry, all generated views are removed. To add a view to a component just select the corresponding part and call the entry Additional Views via the context menu (see also: Additional Views).
Page C.1 - 44
DetailCenter
Detailing
To start the detailing just drag the desired parts onto the action button using drag&drop. The button will then temporarily turn red so that you know it is active. Let go off the mouse button and the parts are transferred. You can also highlight the parts and click on the action button with the mouse or select the entry Create 2D via the context menu. During detailing, the information line of views overview informs you about the estimated remaining time required for detailing the selected parts. This estimated time is based on the average value of the parts detailed in the current process and is an approximate value. .A detail block with the date and time of the detailing is created and saved on your hard drive every time the detailing process is activated. Every variation of the same type is thus still accessible later during the insertion process. You must save the model after the detailing has finished, since the modification management requires information that has to be written to the drawing. If you do not save the model, this information is lost.
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
Group Behaviour during Detailing Hide Part The part is hidden in the model after detailing. You can e.g. at a detailing via direct part selection see directly from the model which parts still have to be detailed.
Page C.1 - 45
DetailCenter
Front View based on the Global Front View (B) To avoid exchanging up and down you can determine two global front views. The view in the direction of the nearest part coordinate axis is assumed as front view of the corresponding shape. To avoid the view on a cross-section you can define an alternative front view, which mostly has been rotated by 90.
Page C.1 - 46
DetailCenter
You obtain the result that the position is always independent of the insertion direction of the part (base plates are always at the bottom), but the front view once can show the web and once the flange depending on the rotation of the shape in the view. Tough, parts that are situated further back in construction are displayed as seen from inside. Select the entry Set Global Reference View in the context menu of the component parts list to specify the global front views. Then, you have to click into the model to get the cross hairs for selection. After that, you select the desired view direction of the front view and then the alternative view direction. When you press the ESC-key instead of selection the views are reset to the default values (0,-1,0) and (1,0,0). The current values are displayed in the information window. Front View based on the Outside of the Model (C) This variant is similar to the global front view. The difference is that instead of specified reference views you always choose the part coordinate axis, which show most clearly from the center of construction to the outside. This means that the front view is always what you would see from the outside if you looked towards the center of the whole construction. This method largely corresponds to human imagination, but depending on the rotation of the shape, once the web and once the flange can be displayed. The following example shows the effects of the selected main view on the 2Ddisplay of a shape:
Page C.1 - 47
DetailCenter
Positions 1-4 have been inserted at a rectangular, the Y-axis of the part is showing to the top and the Z-axis is showing in shape direction. The views A and B are the specified global front views. Depending on selection, you will get the front view displayed on the right. Specify Individual Front View (D) The last variant is that you can specify for each individual part separately which part coordinate axis has to serve as front view. In general, you can decide to use variant (B) or (C) and align unfavourable parts individually and independently. Select the entry Set Individual Reference View in the context menu of the component part list to specify an individual front view. Then, you have to select the desired part to get the cross-hairs for selection. After that, you choose the desired view direction of the front view. When you press the ESC-key instead of selection the individual front view of the part is deleted. The current value is displayed in the information window. Select the entry Reset All Reference Views in the context menu of the component parts list to delete the specifications for all component parts simultaneously.
Page C.1 - 48
DetailCenter
Other Views
You have the option to add additional views to a part or to create manual details from entire model areas. Since the manual details are actually free views, they too are controlled via this dialog. You have access to this function via the button DDITIONAL VIEW or via the entry Additional Views in the context menu. The following dialog window is also a non-modal dialog which means that you can change your part selection in the views list of the DetailCenter at any time.
Group Detail Style Selection List The detail style that has to be used for a manual detail. When you select the option 'From 3D-Component Part', the style assigned in the component part list will be used. If the component part doesnt have a detail style, or if it is a view with freely selectable parts from the model, the default style will be used instead. It this style has not been defined, a manual detail cannot be created. By clicking on the small button on the right side of this field, you can edit the selected detail style. Please note that only those detail styles are displayed which have been classified for use in manual details .
Page C.1 - 49
DetailCenter
Group Given Views Input Field List Here, you can change the names for free views. The available views, which can be added to the part, are displayed here. Select the desired view by clicking on it in the list. Already existing views are highlighted and cannot be selected.
Group Selection Input Field Here, you see the currently selected detail style, which is used for a manual detail. Click on this button to define the view level for free views by picking in the model. Click on this button to add the selected view to the selected part. By clicking on this button, you can create a manual detail of the selected part or of any part selection from the model. The points picked during definition of a view plane are projected onto the current view plane.
Add View If you want to add one of the six basic views, just select the corresponding view from the list and click on the ADD button. To add a free view, just select one of the free views 'View A to View F' from the list. The input field above can be used to change the name to get a more suitable one. Then, click on the PICK VIEW button to specify the UCS (origin, X- and Y-axis) to pick any view or use the ESC key to import the current view on screen. Finally, click on the ADD button. The added views are treated during detailing just like directly created views and automatically further processed.
Page C.1 - 50
DetailCenter
Manual Detail from the Model Select the first entry 'Detail Views in the views list of the DetailCenter to create a manual detail with any part selection from the model. Now, click on the MANUAL DETAIL button and enter a name for the detail in the then opening input field. Then, pick any view by specifying the UCS (origin, Xand Y-axis) or use the ESC key to import the current view on screen. After that, you are prompted to select the parts, which are to be processed for this manual detail. A window similar to the preview opens, which displays the parts as 3D objects for now. You can now dimension manually, attach position flags or any 2D-lines and texts. Manipulations of these 3D-parts are possible as well since they are only copies from the model. Then you click on the modified CREATE 2D button, and the 2D-projection calculation for the 3D-parts is carried out. Of course, you can continue to work in this window, but you will not have the intelligent properties of the components available. Once you have finished your additions, save the window without renaming it. If you do rename it, the unique allocation for the DetailCenter is no longer active.
Manual Detail from Components You can also create a manual detail from construction groups or single parts without having to select the parts specifically in the model. Just select the entry of the desired part in the views list. The rest is the same as for the manual detail from the model apart from parts selection.
Page C.1 - 51
DetailCenter
C.1.10
If you have detailed all of the parts you can then insert the generated detail blocks into the workshop plans. You will see the saved detail blocks in this last work level, the insert list. Since most of the important points have already been discussed under Component Overview, here are just a few special commands of this work level.
Dialog Commands
UPDATE Click on this button to search the current output directory of the DetailCenter once more. This is required if you detailed a new model drawing or if a manual copy of a complete detail folder was entered into the output directory.
EXPRESS Click on this button to start the InsertExpress for automatic insertion of detail blocks into the workshop plans as collective tabs according to a specified pattern.
Page C.1 - 52
DetailCenter
EXCHANGE Click on this button to exchange a detail block inserted into the 2Ddrawing for its detailed version with another detail style. Thus it is possible to exchange unfavourable detail styles of detailed component parts for more suitable ones without explicit assignment, detailing and insertion.
Page C.1 - 53
DetailCenter
List of Details
Here you will see all of the generated detail blocks as their own separate entries with date and time when they were created and you can check their current status. The display and sorting of the list depends on the settings of the work tools. Status Display The significance of these pictures matches the component part overview; please refer to that section for further details. If the detail block has already been inserted, the entry is marked with a checkmark. Preview Before inserting the detail block, you can display a preview. To activate the preview, just select the corresponding entry and then select the entry Preview via the context menu. A new drawing window opens displaying the result of the detailing in the form of a preview. This detail block can be processed as well. In case of modification, you mustnt change the name of the drawing on any account. Otherwise the detail block cannot be identified any more. Delete Detail Blocks Click on the corresponding list entry and select the entry Delete...Entry via the context menu to delete a detail block. Then, the selected detail block will be deleted in the detail library and will not be available any more.
Page C.1 - 54
DetailCenter
Insert Detail Blocks To insert detail blocks just drag the desired details onto the action button using drag&drop. The button will then temporarily turn red so that you know it is active. Let go off the mouse button and you can start inserting blocks. You can also highlight the parts and click on the action button with the mouse or select the entry 2D-Insert via the context menu. Insertion Every inserted detail block first appears in the current target drawing in its origin and can then be moved to the desired position within the drawing (sticking to the checkmark). You can open several drawings and click on a drawing to set it as the active one before inserting the blocks. Any details will then be displayed there. You can track the parts you have just inserted if you have opened the info window. You can ignore this part insert or cancel the entire insertion process. Target Drawing In order to activate the modification mechanism the program has to know, into which drawing you are inserting the details. You cannot insert parts until the drawing has been saved. You should refrain from making any subsequent drawing name or folder changes as well. Although the DetailCenter has a verification function for lost drawings or details, you will save yourself a lot of time and effort by just leaving the plans where they are. The location for saving the plans should be considered beforehand. Revisions Once the details have been inserted into the drawing you can manually revise the drawing. Please remember that the single parts and groups are intelligent details. For further information please read the comments in the corresponding chapter of this manual. Ideally, you should optimize the detail style of the detailing in such a way as to eliminate any revisions. Only then the modification mechanism can function correctly, since subsequent changes in the details are otherwise lost if you select the modification function. It is however true that there are modifications which are automatically kept, too.
Page C.1 - 55
DetailCenter
US-Mark Numbering
During insertion, you can issue component part numbers according to a US drawing standard. These marks (mostly consisting of sheet number, component part code and a continuous index) serve for identification of the workshop drawings of the parts within the model and within the parts lists. As in practice, each of these marks has an individual structure; they are based on a definition file describing the structure and value range of the marks. In the settings, you can select the current definition file to be used under 'US-Mark Numbering. At first insertion, a small dialog opens if the 'US-MarkNumbering' option has been activated. This dialog can be docked beside the DetailCenter. The active fields depend on the default settings in the definition file. For each new inserted detail a component part index is counted up according to definition file. However, this index can be changed at any time. The resulting number (e.g. a1) will now be entered in the model into the field Shipping Number of shape characteristics and in the 2D drawing into the field Shipping Number of Position Flag. The position flag display is changed to Shipping Number. Click on the button NEW DRAWING to count up the index for the drawing number and the component part index will be reset to its start value. You can continue insertion in another drawing sheet. Drawing Synchronization When you are inserting the detail blocks, the insert information is saved to special files of the detail library. After all, it could be that you did not open the model when inserting blocks and opening the drawing in the background can be quite frustrating because very large models especially require a long computing time for this operation. Every time you open the model, the model drawing is compared and synchronized with these data. You should never delete these files until the synchronization process is finished and you have saved the model. The modification mechanism cannot function reliably if the program lacks the information telling it which part has been inserted into which drawing. Your work is better protected, if you do not delete the blocks and folders until after the assignment is completed.
Page C.1 - 56
DetailCenter
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
Group Behaviour during Insertion Remove Detail Block Each inserted detail block will be deleted on the hard drive immediately after insertion. However, this is only possible if the model drawing is open at the same time, as the program has to make some entries here. Please remember that the model drawing has to be saved afterwards. US-Mark Number Display Fields You can issue mark numbers as they are usually used in the USA at insertion. Here, you see the definition file used for mark numbers including a short description. This file includes the format description of the numbers. If the program or project path is an element of the information, the part will only be displayed there as <prg> or <prj>.
Page C.1 - 57
DetailCenter
C.1.11
Global Settings
In addition to the settings of the different work levels, you can use this page to make the fundamental settings of the DetailCenter. However, you will also find special default settings, which are valid for several work levels at the same time and which are set centrally.
Page C.1 - 58
DetailCenter
Group Behaviour during Opening Load Model When the DetailCenter is opened, the model is automatically analysed and the component part structure is displayed according to all default settings in the component parts list. Since this process may require some time in the case of big models, this function can be deactivated. You also can select the analysis of the model structure manually at a later moment via the button UPDATE in the component parts list. The group dimensions are calculated anew when the model structure is analysed. If you created e.g. a parts list before and the data therefore are current data, you may reduce loading time of the DetailCenter by switching off this option. When the model structure is analysed, all bolts of groups existing in the component parts list will be displayed as well. This allows an easy check of the used bolts, but the resulting great number of parts has a negative effect on the speed. This setting doesnt, however, influence the information about the bolts in-group details. When the model structure is analysed, the view levels of the working areas are also displayed as entries in the component part list. Normally, only planes are seized which also contain ProSteel component parts. The view planes containing no ProSteel component parts are seized as well. This option should be used when a master drawing is used the component parts of which are exclusively integrated via XREFs. When the model structure is analysed, horizontal projection, plan view and anchor plan are also displayed as entries in the component part list.
Recompute
Bolts
Workframes
>Blanks too
Standard Views
Connection Gusset When the model structure is analysed, the gusset points of the construction (e.g. several connections) are also displayed as entries in the component part list.
Group Behaviour during Selection Show Part The part (or complete groups) clicked in the list is (are) highlighted in the model. When another entry is selected, marking switches over to the new part.
Page C.1 - 59
DetailCenter
Synchronize Detail Style The program selects exactly the detail style the currently checked entry has in the component part resp. views list. When the dialog window for processing of detail style parameters is open, the corresponding settings are also directly displayed there. > List of Detail Styles dependent The detail styles displayed in the component part list depend on which type of part is checked. If you have checked for example a single part, only the styles classified for single parts will be displayed. Style classification is effected in detail style dialog. The result is that only the styles appropriate for the component part or function will be displayed later. > Parameter dependent The displayed parameter pages in the detail style dialog depend on the type of the checked component part. If you have e.g. checked a single part, the pages for groups will not be displayed. Synchronize Part List The DetailCenter is always updated to match with the active model drawing, if several drawings are open. Since this process may require some time, you can switch off this option in the case of big models. Update can be selected manually via the UPDATE button in the component parts list. In addition, you often dont want to update the lists while you are only looking up something in another drawing.
Group Others Update Preview The preview of a detail is automatically updated when you modify a parameter in the detail style dialog window. In case of many modifications, it is however reasonable to deactivate the update first and to select it manually afterwards. External plugIn's will be integrated which allow an individual adaptation of the detailing results. A plug In-manager and additional dialog windows allow you to control further defaults which may be completely different depending on the supplier. At the moment however, there are no plugIn's supported.
Use PlugIn's
Page C.1 - 60
DetailCenter
Search Joints
Here, you enter the maximum distance up to which the different single connections (these are recognized via the logical links) are combined to a connection gusset. For more detailed information please refer to Gusset Details in this chapter.
Modeller-Tolerance Here, you set the tolerance for contour calculation of the modeller. In some rare cases it may be that the contour cannot be determined correctly at 2D-derivation. This especially occurs when component parts having very small angles are rotated towards view direction. If you detect an incorrect behaviour or if the error message "Can't calculate Extents" is displayed in the command line of AutoCAD, you can set here a smaller tolerance value . Ground Zero Here, you enter the height level which correspond to the X-Yplane in the model with the height Z=0 (world coordinates). For detailing of groups and overviews it is thus possible to display correct height dimensions. Thus, you can start with a model at z=0 which should however correspond to the height level -700 of a building plan for the coordinate dimensioning. Here, you enter on which height (z-coordinate) the plane for the plan view and for the anchorage plan has to be laid in the model (world coordinates). When you indicate the value <min>, the deepest point which exists in the model will be taken. The effect will be that any concrete foundations beneath supports existing in the model dont have an influence any more. Here, you enter how the connection gussets have to be displayed. Only Gusset only the entry for the complete gusset is displayed. As Structure The entry for the complete gusset is displayed and, subordinate to this gusset, the single connections, too. Thus it is easy to check which connections are combined.
Connection
Page C.1 - 61
DetailCenter
Multiple
Here, you enter how combined weld shapes are displayed. Only Shape Only the entry for the complete weld shape is displayed. As Structure The entry for the complete weld shape is displayed and, subordinate to this shape, the single components, too. Thus it is easy to check out of which components the shape consists. In addition, it is possible to create each single component individually as a detail. Here, you enter a general format template for the position number of weld shape components. This number is used as an alternative, if there isnt any position number known f rom the 3D-model. For more detailed information please refer to Weld Shapes in this chapter. Here, you enter the distances for the plan view plane and for the anchorage plan of the sectional area.
Pos. No.
View Depth
Group Display Templates Parts Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the component parts list. In the display field, the currently selected template is displayed. Click on the small button (...) on the right side of the display to select another template. Click on the small button (x) to reset the display to standard display. Only the templates you created before via display sorting of component parts list will be offered for selection. If, in the mean time one of these templates has been changed, the modified display will be shown, too. Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the views list. Selection is analogously to the one for component parts list. Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the insertion list. Selection is analogously to the one for component parts list
Views
Insert
Page C.1 - 62
DetailCenter
Group Configuration Files Application Path Here, you can see on which path the details will be stored later. A subordinate directory with the model name is created there. You can modify the path by double-clicking on the field. It is however recommended to avoid modification of the path unless it is absolutely necessary! Here, you see the complete path of your ProSteel installation. If other displayed paths are further subordinate directories of this program path, the corresponding part is only displayed there as <prg>. Here, you see the complete path of your current project in the case that project management is used. If other displayed paths are further subordinate directories of this project path, the corresponding part is only displayed there as <prj>. Here, you see the desired translation file for drawing labelling. In the display field, the currently selected file is displayed. Click on the small button (...) on the right side of the display to select another file. Click on the small button (x) to reset the display to standard default. If the program or project path is an element of the information, the part will only be displayed there as <prg> or <prj>. Here, you see the definition file used for US-mark numbers. This file includes the format description of the numbers. Selection is analogous to translation file.
Program Path
Project Path
Translation File
US-Mark-Number
Dialog-Commands
TEMPLATE Click on this button to save your settings of the DetailCenter in a template or to select one of these templates. In this template, the individual settings of all work levels as well as the global settings are saved. Display sorting and filters can only be processed by indicating the corresponding templates in the global settings of the DetailCenter. When you have defined one of the templates as favourite, this allows fast selection from the neighbouring selection list.
Page C.1 - 63
DetailCenter
C.1.12
Automatic Translation
ProSteel permits a multilingual labelling of drawings, which is controlled by a translation database. This database can be freely edited so that it is possible to add any language you like. The form of the translated terms (e.g. only as abbreviation) can also be adapted to the corresponding requirements. Before you can work with the translation database, it has of course to contain the currently used terms. For this reason, the model can be searched automatically for new terms of the object properties (like name, note, etc).
List
Here, you can see the terms of the database, which have to be translated. If you click on one of these terms, it will be displayed in the Original Text field and you can add or revise the translation. Please note that only those terms are displayed, which exist in the database at the very moment. Therefore you have to update the database after having modified the model. Here, you select the language, which has to be translated. Here, the current entry from the list will be displayed the translation which you can edit.
Page C.1 - 64
DetailCenter
Translation
Here, you can enter the translation of the currently selected term. Click on the INSERT button and the entry is accepted as translation into the selected language. If the term has already been translated into the selected language before, the translation will be displayed. Click on the MODIFY button and the translation will be modified correspondingly. If this field has been checked, all entries available in the database are displayed in the list of the terms, which have to be translated. If this field has been checked, only those entries are displayed in the list of which a translation into the selected language is not yet available. Here, you see the path of the translation database. Click on File button to modify the database. Click on this button to modify (select) the translation database. Click on this button to save the translation database.
All Entries
Unknown Entries
File Path
Click on this button to add a new language to the database. Click on this button to add the entry in the Translation input field as translation of the Original Text entry in the selected language. Click on this button to replace the current translation in the Translation input field as translation of the Original Text entry in the selected language. Click on this button to delete the current translation of the Original Text entry in the selected language.
Page C.1 - 65
DetailCenter
Update Database
After having modified the model, you should search the model for new terms for the translation database. These terms are taken from the object properties so that own comments or component part names for the position flags etc., which were inserted there, can be translated. The program tries to synchronize the entries with those of the shape database of ProSteel so that not modified shape names are not displayed in the translation. Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter to search in the model. Click on the entry Enlarge Translation from Model. The model is searched for new terms and these are imported.
Page C.1 - 66
DetailCenter
C.1.13
This function permits you to transfer the drawing numbers saved in the drawing database or the file paths of the workshop drawings to the component parts properties of the model drawing. It is possible to display the drawing numbers of the processed details in the position flags of an overview. In addition, it would also be possible to export the parts data via ProSteel standard interface and to have them evaluated by foreign programs.
Start Transfer
Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter to click on the entry Take over file Paths. Then, you still have the possibility to verify the drawing database of the model, if in the meantime you moved some details or modified the drawing numbers. After the drawing verification was finished (or if you dont want this option) the following dialog opens:
Group Data Selection Data Selection Here you specify which data have to be transferred into the component parts properties. In addition, you can still add any extra text. Drawing Number The drawing number of the corresponding 2D drawing will be transferred.
Page C.1 - 67
DetailCenter
Only File Name Only the file name of the 2D drawing is transferred (without specification of the path). File Path The complete file path including the drawing name of the 2D drawing will be transferred. Only Text Only the specified text of the 'Prefix' input field would be transferred. Prefix Here you can specify a text which has to be placed in front of the real data or which has to be transferred as only text (option Only Text). Here you can specify a text, which has to be placed behind the real data.
Postfix
Group Target Target Here you specify into which property fields of the parts the data have to be transferred. Note 1 The data are transferred into the note field 1 of the parts properties. Note 2 - The data are transferred into the note field 2 of the parts properties. Only the data of the corresponding group are transferred to each part in the model; e.g. detailed stiffeners are marked with the reference to the corresponding group drawing. The data are transferred to all component parts having the equal position number (separated according to single part and group) and this even if only the workshop drawing to one of these positions exists. In all component parts, the contents of the selected property field are removed before transfer is started. All existing entries are overwritten, this would, however, permit to transfer and display the drawing numbers of all parts first and then only the drawing paths of the groups (the drawing numbers of the single parts would thus be deleted again).
Group Links
Equal Positions
Remove before
Now, click on the OK button to transfer the current entries of the drawing database in the component parts properties.
Page C.1 - 68
DetailCenter
C.1.14
Drawing Verification
Each time when you insert some details in a drawing, a dependence of the component part on the workshop drawing and vice versa will be saved in the drawing database of the model drawing. These saved dependences later permit an automatic update of the workshop drawing or the transfer of drawing numbers to the component parts properties of the model. These links are the reason for your having to enter a valid drawing name of the destination drawings before insertion of details. It is also the reason for your having to save the model after insertion. Nevertheless it may be that you have to modify the physical position of the 2Ddrawings after the complete detailing was finished. This is the case if you have to save them in an assembly folder of the order in the network. In addition, it may be that you want to move some details from one drawing to the other in order to add some completions or just because there is not enough place in the drawing any more. However, if the model has saved the wrong dependences, and the DetailCenter thus cannot function completely as it should, you can correct this subsequently. This correction partly is carried out automatically, partly by means of your manual support. It is divided into the two areas Drawing Path Verification and Detail Verification.
Start of Verification
Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter and click on the entry Check Dependences. After the note that this function may require some time and that if need be you can cancel the function the verification starts. At first, it is verified whether all paths of workshop drawings saved in the drawing database still exist. Then, the drawings, which were not found, are displayed in the dialog. Now, you have the possibility to set the paths or drawing names anew.
Page C.1 - 69
DetailCenter
Group Invalid Drawing Paths Click on this button to change the path of all displayed drawings at the same time and start a new search. Then, the list either contains the remaining drawings, which are still lacking or the verification function changes to detail verification. If you only changed the physical position of the plans on the hard drive, you dont have to make any further corrections. Click on this button to change the path and/or file name of a certain drawing selected before in the displayed list. If a drawing was renamed or if a certain drawing was saved on another physical place, you can thus make the necessary corrections. Click on this button to ignore the selected drawing during the following verification. Thus you can also remove deleted drawings. Please note, however, that you cannot add further drawings. If therefore you copied and renamed a drawing, please assign the new name to it instead of ignoring the drawing. After verification of paths was finished, and any necessary corrections were made, the program passes on to the verification of the details contained. It is now verified whether all details are contained in the original or now modified drawings.
Page C.1 - 70
DetailCenter All the details, which were not found, are now displayed in the list. You have thus the possibility to link any moved details anew or to remove deleted details.
Group Details not Found Current Search Path The current search path used for the Search Detail' option is displayed in this field. You can modify the path by clicking on the right button beside the display. Click on this button to search for any details not found in the drawings of the current search path. For this purpose, each drawing will be opened in the background and searched for all listed details individually. Please note that each file having the extension *.dwg will be opened, as it could be a workshop drawing. This means that also any existing ProSteel-models or other AutoCAD-drawings will be opened. You should therefore take care that only 2D-plans with details are in the list to avoid unnecessary waiting periods.
Click on this button to specify the new drawing where a certain detail is which was selected before in the list. Then, it is verified at once whether the detail is really situated on the new drawing.
Page C.1 - 71
DetailCenter
Click on this button to ignore the selected detail; the original entry is kept. Thus you can also remove deleted details as you can remove the detail hints from the drawing database after end of verification. Please note, however, that you cannot add further details. If therefore you moved a detail, please assign the new drawing to it instead of ignoring the detail.
End of Verification
After the verification has been finished, the assignment is structured anew and the drawing database is updated. You still have the possibility now to remove the ignored or invalid detail hints from the drawing database. If you refrain from doing this, the original entries of these details will be kept and you can repeat the verification at a later moment.
Including Ignored
If this field has been checked, the detail hints on ignored drawings will be taken into consideration, too for correction (all details giving a hint of these drawings are set as ignored details). Otherwise, these are not affected in order to avoid destroying hints to temporarily moved drawings. If this field has been checked, the hints of 2D-drawings of all ignored details will be removed as well. The data base entry with possible further information is however kept. If this field has been checked, the data base entries of any details, which were not found, will be completely removed. Otherwise, only the hints of 2D-drawings of these details will be removed.
Delete Ignored
Delete Invalid
When you click on CANCEL in this dialog, the data base will not be modified.
Page C.1 - 72
DetailCenter You can repeat the verification process at any time you like by means of correction. Thus you can first look at the result of drawing verification in a text file ( model name_LogFile.txt) which are situated in the subdirectory ..\detail of your ProSteel installation. There, you will find a list of all workshop drawings linked with the model as well as the status of the details expected to be there.
; ProSteel for AutoCAD Drawing Verification ; ------------------------------------------[HEADER] Verification file=h:\testmodel.dwg [drawing file: h:\testmodel_views.dwg] Status=moved or deleted view hall_FRONT=can not be found [drawing file: h:\testmodel_details.dwg] Pos 2 (HE 140 B)=valid Pos 47 (PLATE 10x137...191)=not found BG 3 (HE 200 B)=valid BG 9.1 (HE 200 B)=valid
Page C.1 - 73
DetailCenter
C.1.15
Direct Detailing
The ProSteel DetailCenter can also be used to detail parts directly from within the model or display a preview of the detail. This means dimensions of construction groups can be checked, or only a few selected parts within a complex building, which are urgently needed, can be detailed. Perhaps area classes have not been used, but it is now desired to detail a special truss. Large models pose the problem of being able to identify this part directly. The DetailCenter offers a few helpful tools, but the following method is even easier: To detail a component part directly from within the model, select a default detail style first, so that parts without a detail style can be detailed. Now highlight the parts to be detailed within the model and then select the context menu via the right mouse button. Depending on the parts selected, a preview can be created from a single part or a group or these parts or groups can be detailed directly. Select the desired function from the context menu.
Page C.1 - 74
DetailCenter
Processing of Nested Structures You can only select the next higher hierarchic plane. Therefore, if you have selected a component part of a subgroup, only this subgroup can be detailed as component part group. On the other hand, at detailing of an assembly including add-on parts only the directly subordinate single parts resp. groups will be processed. Direct Detailing If you want to work with direct detailing, you will be prompted to specify if all of the selected parts without a detail style are to be linked with the default style first. If you confirm this question, these parts will be highlighted in the DetailCenter as well since the linking is permanent. If you answer no to the question, only those parts are detailed, which already have a detail style. The parts will then be directly detailed or the preview is displayed. Direct Detailing with Insertion If additionally valid and saved 2D-workshop drawings are open, the parts can even be inserted into the drawings directly after detailing. In the context menu, a list of the valid drawings will be displayed in a subordinate tab of the corresponding detailing selection (respectively the entry Detail Library for 'Not Insert'). If such a drawing is selected, you will directly reach the insertion mode for the selected drawing after detailing has been finished. The parts can be placed there.
Page C.1 - 75
DetailCenter
C.1.16
Modification Management
The modification management is one of ProSteels special DetailCenter features. Once the model has been detailed and any resulting detail blocks have been distributed to the different workshop plans, the detailing or processing is considered finished. The next time you load the model most of the entries will appear in green this colour signifies that the detailing of these parts matches the original parts of the model. However, if you have changed parts of the model they will be shown in red. This tells you that the detail blocks (and thus maybe the workshop drawings as well) are no longer current and have to be updated. The program performs this update. Status Indicator Valid Details Blue Green A detail block of this part has already been created. However, it has not yet been inserted into a 2D drawing. A detail block of this part has already been created and inserted into a 2D drawing.
Modified Details Yellow Red A detail block of this part has already been created. However, it has not yet been inserted into a 2D drawing. A detail block of this part has already been created and inserted into a 2D drawing.
Page C.1 - 76
DetailCenter
Update Drawings
Any parts highlighted in red can be updated automatically. Select a specific component or a parent and only the parts contained in these are updated. If you select the "Model" entry, all parts are updated. Selecting the context menu after having selected the part, use the entry Update only modified 2D-drawing to activate the modification mechanism. However, if you want to force also an update of non-modified (green) parts to replace e.g. the detailing by another detail style you have to select the entry Update 2Ddrawing in the context menu. One by one, all of the affected drawings are opened in the background, the parts are newly detailed and inserted directly into the original drawing position, replacing the old ones. Should you have one of these drawings open at the time, you can watch this replacement happen live right in front of you. Subsequent Modifications Depending on the settings in the work tools of component overview, modifications of the details, which you carried out later, will be adopted again. This is of course only possible to a limited extent. At the very moment, moving of position flags, weld marks, height indicators and of dimension texts in all 2D-drawings as well as modifications of sketch display at overviews are adopted. If a dynamic drawing parts list possibly exists, it will also be updated in the case the component parts have changed. Please note, however, that only the position of the dimension text can be restored (in the case that you sorted out unfavourably placed texts), but not the dimension itself or modifications of the dimension text. To avoid a reset of such modifications, you can protect them against update. This procedure might take some time to complete; then all plans are once again current and the latest detail blocks are ready for insertion. Use the Display only Latest Blocks option for the insertion to place the details. You should remember, however, that the modification mechanism functions optimally only if the tips and notes from the previous chapters are observed and if you proceed correspondingly at 3D-modelling and positioning as well. You should, therefore, work through those chapters very diligently.
Page C.1 - 77
DetailCenter
Anchorage Point
In the 3D-model, it is possible to use the command Set Anchorage Point to create an anchorage point which can serve as a reference point for the inserted overviews. The result will be that the modified detail blocks are inserted congruently relating their anchorage points. If you place e.g. a horizontal projection, a longitudinal section and a crosssection aligned with each other and you dont make use of an anchorage point, the views will probably be displaced towards each other when up-dated. Normally, they are inserted in a centered way and the center point of course moves when the size of a single view is modified. Use the Anchorage Point option for the insertion position in the detail style at detailing to make use of the anchorage point. For overviews, this should always be done beginning with the first detailing when the deternination of views is required. If need be, it may also be modified. Here you see a 3D-model and three detailed views which have been favourably placed towards each other after insertion. Now, the drawing is up-dated after a modification, first with and then without anchorage point. The anchorage point (A) has been inserted at the highlighted spot into the 3Dmodel. In the views, the position has also been highlighted to make things clear.
Page C.1 - 78
DetailCenter
Afterwards, the construction is modified so that the overall dimensions (and thus the sizes of the views) change. After the update without anchorage point the position is clearly shifted from the highlighted reference line (manual completions would of course remain at the former position). Due to the additional dimensioning chains, the longitudinal view and the gable view shift towards each other in the base plane.
On the other hand, when the update is carried out with anchorage point, the position of the elements towards each other is kept as it was in the original drawing. The base planes remain aligned to each other and manual completions at unchanged parts remain still suitable.
Page C.1 - 79
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 80
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 81
DetailCenter Group Selection-Filter Selection-Filter Here, you can enter the filter for automatic object selection. Only those objects will be taken into consideration, which meet the filter condition. Select Objects You specify manually by your selection, which objects have to be protected or released. No filter will be applied in this case. All Objects All objects in the drawing are automatically selected without applying a filter. Processing of course only refers to dimensions, position flags, weld marks and height indicators. Dimension Only dimensioning objects are automatically selected in the drawing. Each Flag All position flags, weld marks and height indicators are automatically selected in the drawing. Only Position Flags All position flags are selected in the drawing. Only Weld Marks All weld marks are selected in the drawing. Only Height Indicators All height indicators are selected in the drawing. Click on this button to activate the protection against update for the selected objects unless it already exists. If you have checked the entry Select Objects as selection filter, the desired objects have to be selected first. Click on this button to remove the protection against update for the selected objects if they have one. If you have checked the entry Select Objects as selection filter, the desired objects have to be selected first. Of course, this function has to be applied in the 2D-workshop drawings and not in the 3D-model. Please also remember that you cannot compare the protection against update with a blocked layer. If the dimension to be protected was only on a blocked layer, it would be kept there, but the newly created (synonymous) dimension would not be deleted.
Page C.1 - 82
DetailCenter
Reset Modifications
Before the first detailing takes place, the drawing should be initialized, i.e. it should be set to zero. This will ensure that the modification mechanism functions optimally. This can of course always be done if you want to continue your work on a neutral state. As the component parts in the model remember their modification even during modelling, it may be that the corresponding markings have already been set. This could cause some irritations. Select the entry Reset Modification Code via the context menu of component parts view to reset any existing information about model modification. The entries, which details are situated on which drawings, are kept as well as the already detailed detail blocks. Please select the entry Initialize All Anew from the context menu to reset the model completely. Initialize Component Part selectively resets the currently selected component part. Please note, however, that now any information will be deleted (unless the assigned detail styles)! It will then no longer be possible to ask the model where the different component parts were inserted or to insert component parts already detailed but not yet inserted. This complete initialization is reasonable if you made some detailing beforehand as a test or for a meeting and you now want to create the final workshop plans.
Page C.1 - 83
DetailCenter
Drawing List
At any time, ProSteel can create a drawing list giving you a survey on the inserted details and their status of modification. This drawing list is based on the current entries in the drawing database and on the status of the so-called modification flags of the component parts. Therefore, it is recommended to verify the drawing first. The program automatically offers this drawing verification after the function has been selected. It is of course also possible that hints which were recognized as invalid shall nevertheless remain valid because the drawings have only been moved temporarily. Creation of File Select the context menu of the component parts list and click on the entry Output of Drawing List. A text file (Modelname_DrawingList.txt), will be created in the subdirectory.. \detail of your ProSteel-installation containing first a survey on all 2D-drawings and the number of inserted details. If one of these details has been checked as modified in the DetailCenter, this drawing is reported as being modified. Therefore, this statement doesnt mean that the drawing has actually already been modified. It means that it still has to be modified. In addition, you will find a detailed list per drawing, which details (position numbers) are contained and which of them has already been modified in the model. On the following page, you will find an example of a drawing list. Since an external program via code words might evaluate the content of this list, the output of these key words is always in English. As you can see in the example, there are 6 single parts (2 of them modified) and 2 groups in the drawing with drawing number ABC_PL03. Therefore, the drawing is checked as being modified.
Page C.1 - 84
DetailCenter
; ProSteel Drawing List ; ----------------------------------------------------[HEADER] Created=02-04-2003 * 11:34 AM ModelFile=h:\testmodell.dwg FileContent=Drawing list and object reference Drawings=3 DrawingNumber|Changed |Parts |Groups |Views |DrawingFile =============|========|========|========|========|======================== ABC_AN01 |no | | |2 |h:\testmodel_view.dwg ABC_BG02 |yes | |5(3) | |h:\testmodel_bg.dwg ABC_PL03 |yes |6(2) |2 | |h:\testmodel_plates.dwg [h:\testmodel_views.dwg] DrawingNumber=ABC_AN01 Changed=no Parts= ChangedParts= Groups= ChangedGroups= Views=Hall_SEI_R,Hall_X_1 ChangedViews= [h:\testmodel_bg.dwg] DrawingNumber=ABC_BG02 Changed=yes Parts= ChangedParts= Groups=3,7,10,31,49 ChangedGroups=3,7,31 Views= ChangedViews= [h:\testmodel_plates.dwg] DrawingNumber=ABC_PL03 Changed=yes Parts=35,38,40,43,45,46 ChangedParts=40,46 Groups=50,55 ChangedGroups= Views= ChangedViews=
Page C.1 - 85
DetailCenter
C.1.17
This function allows new detailing of detail blocks directly in the workshop drawing by simple selection. This permits you for example to assign a better detail style to some unfavourable details still during insertion.
Settings Display Field List Here, you see the currently selected detail style used for replacing. The available detail styles for new detailing. When you have activated the option List of detail styles dependent on Part in the global pre-settings of the DetailCenter, only the styles are displayed here which have been classified for the corresponding type.
Page C.1 - 86
DetailCenter
Click on this button to process the currently selected detail style. The detail block is replaced with the modifications. Please note however, that this function actually changes the detail style of the model. If it is still required, you first have to make a copy and use this copy to replace the detail block. Click on this button to detail the detail anew with the currently selected detail style; then it is replaced in the drawing.
Replace a Detail Block To replace a detail block you have to open the corresponding 2D-workshop drawing (with the inserted detail blocks) as well as the original 3D-model drawing. Now select the entry Replace 2D-Detail Block in the context menu of the component part list. Then pick any element of the detail block you want to replace and the dialog opens. Now you can modify the current detail style or select another style from the list. Afterwards, you press the UPDATE button, and the detail block will be automatically replaced. Further detail blocks to be replaced can be selected directly from the dialog. Since the last selected block remains connected, you can assign another style to it if the result didnt meet your requirements. When modifying detail style parameters please dont forget that you change the detail style from the model. Replacing takes place as follows: The selected block is detailed anew (this is why the model drawing has to be opened) and then it replaces the former block in the drawing. If you assign a new style as well, this modification will be transferred into the model and the component part will be permanently linked again with the desired style. Therefore, dont forget to save the model drawing afterwards.
Page C.1 - 87
DetailCenter
Page C.1 - 88
Detailing Style
C.2
Detailing Style
Saving Styles
Normally, the detailing styles are saved together with the 3D-model of the drawing. This means that you always have to save your model if the modifications of detailing styles are to be kept permanently. In addition, there is the possibility to write a detailing style as file on the hard drive and to re-import it. It is also possible to replace only partial sections of a style. This permits you to exchange, update or transfer the detailing styles of different models. Furthermore, you can create a collection of detailing styles and use in the model only a selection of those styles, which are required for that moment. As the volume of a detail style considerably increased compared with earlier versions, since version 17.2 the file will only be saved as binary file with the file ending *.stx due to long loading times. All commands for loading a detail style wait for the style files in this format.
Page C.2 - 1
Detailing Style
To allow a clear view, some of the tabs have subordinate tabs themselves which are accessible via a button or via a context menu (right mouse key) and which are used for further settings. in most cases, these are settings which depend on the selection on the corresponding dialog tab. The commands of the dialog frame are the ones all dialog tabs have in common. Only the new specific commands will be described here. The other commands are found in the general description of ProSteel-dialogs.
Page C.2 - 2
Detailing Style
Dialog-Commands
SAVE When you click on this button, the complete detailing style is saved in a file on the hard drive. This file has the name of the style and the file ending *.stx. It is possible to load this file later into this or into another model or to transfer it to thirds. SAVE AS Click on this button to save the detailing style under another name on the hard drive. Your detailing style copy automatically gets the name of the style pre-set here as file name. It is possible to load this file later into this or into another model or to transfer it to thirds. UPDATE PREVIEW When you click on this button, preview detailing of a detail is calculated anew and updated if the window is open. Within the DetailCenter you can look in a preview on the effects of a detailing style for detailing of a detail. Normally, this preview is automatically updated at each modification of the detailing style. However, if you have e.g. a very complex overview which requires a lot of time or if you want to modify a lot of parameters, you can switch off the automatic update and release it manually.
Page C.2 - 3
Detailing Style
Tab Common
Group Display Projection Method Here, you specify the system according to which the different part views (front view, plan view, top view, etc.) are aligned towards each other. Method 1 (E) The distribution of the views is effected according to DIN. Method 3 (A) The distribution of the views is effected according to American standard. Here, you specify the alignment of the details at detailing. At groups, the main part specifies the alignment of the whole group. Horizontal The parts are aligned horizontally when detailed. Vertical The parts are aligned vertically when detailed. Like Model AutoCAD aligns the parts during detailing according to their WCS position, which means that a slanted support remains slanted.
Alignment
Page C.2 - 4
Detailing Style Front View Here, you indicate how the front view of a component part has to be specified. The other views then derivate from this front view. From Component The element coordinate system of the component part is used for the determination of the front view. From Global Views The global views are used for the determination of the front view. Outside Model The view from the outside into the model is used for the determination of the front view. Individually per Part The individually fixed front view of a part is used for the determination of the parts front view. If it has not been defined, the element coordinate system will be used instead. Single parts views are displayed according to the views of the corresponding groups, if existing. The left view of a stiffener is e.g. the view onto a plate (normally this would be the plan view), because the left view of the group would show the stiffener in this way. Only the first view of the part is displayed corresponding to the group; all other views are tilted according to standard related to this modified view. The details are transformed into pure AutoCAD line diagrams. Intelligent properties of the 2D-details of course wont be available any more. Poly-plates are always temporarily transformed into ACIS elements for detailing to allow for better dimensioning of radii. The plate properties in the model are not affected by this. The parts keep their original size and only the text is scaled for output on a printer /plotter. Here, you set the scale of your details. Depending on the selection under Dont Scale Parts either the part or the text size is scaled. Please remember the hints under 'DetailCenter/Generalities Concerning Scale and Dimensioning Styles'.
Like Group
True 2D Lines
ACIS if Plates
Page C.2 - 5
Detailing Style Group Add Dimensioning Position Flags Weld Flags Labels Dimensioning texts and lines are attached according to the settings entered in the DIMENSIONING tab. Position flags are attached according to the settings entered in the POSITION FLAGS tab. Welding symbols are attached according to the settings entered in the WELDING SYMBOLS tab. Additional label texts are attached according to the settings entered in the ADDITIONAL TEXTS tab.
Group Partial Views Automatic Selection The program automatically displays the required views according to the existing detailing processes of the part. Thus, all detailing processes can be displayed and dimensioned. In addition, you can add the basic views, one or more global isometric views and the unwinding (only in case of bent plates). These views will be used in any case.
Page C.2 - 6
Detailing Style Cut A cut is made in this view frame for any model views you like. Position, cut depth and displayed parts are determined by means of this frame. You can choose the views to be generated from the six existing basic views. In addition, you can add one or more global isometric views and the unwinding (only in case of bent plates). Here, you also pre-set the desired views for the overviews of detailed points; for standard overviews, however these settings havent any meaning, Here, you pre-select which views have to be created during the detailing process. In the DetailCenter, you also have the possibility to delete views or to add further views.
Default
> Selection
Group Visual Depth Max. Depth Here, you can indicate a visual depth up to which the subparts are seized at construction group display. This filter can be switched on separately for the different views to limit the depth only at left and right views. When displaying construction groups, the visual depth for the selected view is limited to the value specified under 'Max. Depth'. Please note, however, that unlike cut areas at views nevertheless the complete component part will be displayed. The specification of this value only serves as depth filter for seizing of the complete component part.
Here, you specify the distance of the basic views incl. dimensions and text towards each other if several views are to be generated within one detail block.
Distance Isometries Here, you specify the distance of the isometric views towards the basic views and towards each other. Distance Unwinding Here, you specify the distance of the unwinding of a bent plate towards the basic views. Detail Style Isometry If need be, you specify another detailing style here with which an isometric view has to be depicted. If you indicate This Style, no separate detailing style will be used.
Page C.2 - 7
Detailing Style Isometry Position Here, you specify the position where the isometric views have to be depicted with reference to the basic views. They can be positioned above, below, on the left or on the right side of the basic views.
Detail Style Unwinding If need be, you specify another detailing style here with which an unwinding has to be depicted. If you indicate This Style, no separate detailing style will be used. Unwinding Position Here, you specify the position where the unwinding has to be depicted with reference to the basic views. They can be positioned above, below, on the left or on the right side of the basic views. Insertion Position Here, you specify the grip point for the later insertion of detail blocks. Select where to position the detail block from the 9 striking insertion points below-left up to above-right (also for 2D-Update). When the additional option anchor is used here, it is possible to update the detail at overviews without having to modify the position of geometry. For more detailed information about the anchorage point, please refer to chapter DetailCenter / Modification Management.
Combination of standard views with an isometric view (A) which is depicted with its own detailing style. The isometry here only shows the position flags so that they can be omitted in dimensioning.
Additional depiction of unwinding of a plate (B) and an isometric view (A) with regard to the basic views at a bent plate.
Page C.2 - 8
Detailing Style
Group Single Parts All Single Parts The detailing style is visible everywhere where single parts are concerned. Otherwise, it will not be displayed. If this option is deactivated, the visibility can be limited even further to certain types. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of straight shapes. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of bent shapes. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of end, base or other connection plates.
> Plane Poly-Plates The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of polyplates (except for stiffeners). > Stiffeners > Others The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of stiffeners. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of a part which is not seized by the above filters (e.g. 3D-solids).
Page C.2 - 9
Detailing Style Group Component Groups All Component Groups The detailing style is visible everywhere where it is a matter of component groups. Otherwise, it will not be displayed. If this option is deactivated, the visibility can be limited even further to certain types. > Straight Shapes The detailing style is only visible when the main part of the group is a straight shape. > Bent Shapes > Supports The detailing style is only visible when the main part of the group is a bent shape. The detailing style is only visible when the main part of the group is a straight shape and a support (longitudinal direction parallel towards the global Z-axis). The detailing style is only visible when the main part of the group is a straight shape and a cross girder (longitudinal direction parallel towards the global X/Y-plane). The detailing style is only visible when the main part of the group is of a part which is not seized by the above filters. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of subgroups of groups or assemblies. In principle, these are also groups with special properties. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of socalled assemblies.
Assemblies
Group Views All Views The detailing style is visible everywhere where it is a matter of views on the model. Otherwise, it will not be displayed. If this option is deactivated, the visibility can be limited even further to certain types. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of the plan views from the working areas or of the global plan view respectively of the global ground-plan.
Page C.2 - 10
Detailing Style > Views > Anchor Plans > Others The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of the model views from the working areas. The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of the anchor plan of the model. The detailing style is only visible when the view is a model view which is not seized by the above filters.
Connecting Gusset The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of the gusset details from the model. Manual Details The detailing style is only visible when it is a matter of manual details from the model. Of course, these details cannot appear in the component parts list of the DetailCenter. However, you can decide whick detailing styles shall have to be displayed for selection in the function for the manual details.
Others Style selectable Description Style Class The detailing style is not submitted to a certain filtering and is visible everywhere. Here you can enter a description of the detailing style in order to explain its function in a more detailed way. Here you can assign the detailing style to an existing style class. It will be displayed in the selection list of the DetailCenter with a coloured icon so that you can faster identify the essential task (e.g. detailing style for single parts, for groups, etc.).
C.2.4
Page C.2 - 11
Detailing Style
2D-Display
These dialog tabs offer the opportunity to specify the display type of the component parts (centerlines, drill holes, hidden edges, etc.), which line types have to be used and which special default settings have to be valid for the different detailing types.
Tab Common
Group Add Visible Edges Invisible Edges 2D-Bolts > Real Bolts 2D-Weldmint All visible lines are displayed according to their line type. This field should always be checked. The invisible lines are displayed according to their line type. The put in bolts are depicted by a bolt symbol. The bolts are depicted as real view with nut and bolt head. The welding joints imported to the model are depicted as weld symbol.
2D-Elevation symbols The height indicators imported to the model are depicted.
Page C.2 - 12
Detailing Style Special Parts Special parts inserted into the model are depicted. These may be any parts (such as e.g. blocks) containing ProSteel component part caracteristics. Real Cross-Sections The shape cross-sections are depicted with their exact radii otherwise, the simplified depiction in the form of straight lines is selected. > At Dimensioning At dimensioning, all edges and radii of cross-section display are used. Otherwise, only the outside dimensions are depicted.
Bearing Bar Direction A symbol for the bearing bar direction is attached (which corresponds to the lengthwise direction of the grid) if it is a matter of plates having a grid. > Symbol Size Here, you enter the size of the symbol, which is used for the direction of the plate grid.
Group Shape Shortening Shape Shortening Shapes are compressed in areas without detailing and a shortening symbol is attached. Whether a shape can be shortened depends on its detailing processes and on the limits specified by you hereafter. The gab in the shape or the distance between the lines if a shortening symbol with two lines is used. Shortenings are to be attached starting at this length. You can use your page optimally by displaying the shapes as long as possible. The shape has to be shortened by at least this value to even activate any shortening. The maximum number of shortenings inserted into the shape. Shortenings cannot start at the edge or margin area but can only start this indicated distance from the edge. This prevents shortening a shape without detailing too much.
Page C.2 - 13
Detailing Style Shortening Symbol Here, you select the symbol, which has to be inserted into the shape at shortening position. Single Line The symbol is a simple straight line. ZigZag Single The symbol is a serrated, wave-like line. Double Line The symbol is a double straight line with the gap set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field. ZigZag Double - The symbol is a serrated, wave-like double line with the gap set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field. Only Gap There is no symbol depicted, but only a gap with the distance set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field. Break Symbol Here, you select the symbol, which has to be inserted at the break edge of the completely cut-off shape end. Please also refer to Shortening Symbol.
Group Others Hatching Size Hatching Angle Hatching Pattern Here, you specify the hatching scale. This is the line distance for line hatching. Here, you enter the angle of hatching. Here, you enter an AutoCAD hatching pattern to be used for cross-section hatching.
Page C.2 - 14
Detailing Style
Group Drill Hole Axes Axes View > Excess Length Axes Plan View At a view on the drill hole the axis is depicted. Here, you specify the excess length of the axis beyond the outside edges of the shape. At a plan view on the drill hole the two axes (horizontal and vertical) are depicted. In the selection list, you can specify whether all holes, only the visible holes or the invisible holes have to be displayed or whether there has to be no display at all. Here, you specify the excess length of the axis beyond the drill hole depiction. The two axes lines are rotated by 45 to prevent that they overlap with dimension lines or others.
Group Drill Hole Depiction Hides only Axes The hidden (invisible) drill holes are depicted using a dotted line in plan view. Otherwise, only the axes are depicted if these are chosen for display. However, if you selected Old Standard, the axes are always displayed. The holes are depicted according to their diameter as either circular holes or hidden edges. Otherwise, only the axes are displayed if these are chosen for display. The hole depicted is completely filled.
> Filled
According to Style Template The drill holes are displayed with a depiction which can be defined freely. Thus it is possible to get your own depictions (e.g. true to no scale or symbolic), too, depending on the current hole diameter for the application of different standards and special cases. > Symbol Size > Style Template The symbol size according to the hole style template. The desired hole style template for depiction. Create a hole style template in the function for hole depiction and just load it here. Use the neighboring button to get direct access to the dialog for the creation of hole style templates.
Page C.2 - 15
Detailing Style
Group Colour and Line Type 2D-Line Definition Here, you select the source of the definition of line type depiction. It describes which line type and colour the lines of a component part have in 2D-depiction. From Detail Style the definitions come from the settings on this page. From Configuration the definitions come from the configuration file of ProSteel. From File the definitions come from a separate definition file. Here, you define which colour has to be used for the three types of component part lines (visible, invisible and center line). Use the AutoCAD-colour numbers. Here, you define which line type has to be used for the for the three types of component part lines (visible, invisible and center line). The line depiction is realized on the same layer name as assigned to the original component part in the 3D-model. Otherwise, it is realized on layers for visible or invisible lines.
Colour
Line Type
On Part Layer
Page C.2 - 16
Detailing Style
Dialog-Commands
SELECT COLOUR Click on this button to open the AutoCAD-standard dialog for colour selection and you can select the colour number in the diagram.
Page C.2 - 17
Detailing Style
Group General: With Center Lines Excess Length The center lines of the component parts selected on this dialog tab are displayed. Here, you specify the excess length of the center line beyond the two ends of the shapes.
Group Special Shapes Special Shapes Roof-Wall Shapes Combi Shapes Weld Shapes Center lines for special shapes are depicted. Center lines for roof-wall shapes are depicted. Center lines for combi shapes are depicted. Center lines for weld shapes are depicted.
Group Others Shape List Select for which types of different standard shapes the center lines have to be depicted by highlighting them in the list.
Page C.2 - 18
Detailing Style
Tab SingleParts
Group Add Cross-Section Standard Shapes Special Shapes Roof-Wall Shapes Combi Shapes Weld Shapes At End Plates Additional cross-sections are added to the views of standard shapes. Additional cross-sections are added to the views of special shapes. Additional cross-sections are added to the views of roof-wallshapes. Additional cross-sections are added to the views of combishapes. Additional cross-sections are added to the views of weld shapes. In the plan view of a base or end plate, the cross-section of the welded shape is displayed.
Position Cross-Section In the selection list, you define on which side of a partial view the cross-section of the shape has to be displayed. Left Side The additional cross-section is displayed on the left. Right Side The additional cross-section is displayed on the right.
Page C.2 - 19
Detailing Style
Group Others Direction Symbol Display Origin The direction symbol is displayed at main parts. The zero point reference of coordinate dimensioning of the single part is displayed as reference point or at American dimensioning option as special symbol for Running dimensions. Here, you enter the size of the symbol.
Page C.2 - 20
Detailing Style
Tab Groups
Group Cuts Display Sections 2D-cuts (manual or automatic at e.g. stiffeners) inserted into the main part are added as additional view to the group. Here you have to differentiate between 2D-cuts in the model and 2D-cuts in the details: 2D-cuts inserted in the model only define whether and how a detail has to be cut at detailing process. Only manually added cuts are displayed. Cuts automatically determined by the program are not depicted. Cuts having an identical display are only depicted once. The cuts are not depicted on the left and/or on the right of the main view (mostly the front view), but beneath the last views, one beside the other. Cut arrows are displayed outside of the last dimensioning chains. Otherwise, they are fixed directly at the part even in front of the dimensioning chains. Here, you can select a template describing the display of cut labeling. These templates can be defined within the command Insert 2D cut.
Symbol Outside
Symbol Template
Page C.2 - 21
Detailing Style Labeling Cut Code Here, you indicate the cut designation (without the code letter for cut) that has to be used for labeling the cut views Here, you enter the code letter (or number) that has to be used to describe the first cut of a group. All other cuts of this group will be counted accordingly in increasing order.
Group Neighboring Parts Display The neighboring parts of a group are also depicted. These are the parts where the group is connected, which however dont belong to this group any more.
With Position Flags The position flags of the neighboring parts are also inserted in the view. Detailing Style Search Area The detailing style used for displaying the neighboring parts. The size of an imaginary box around the whole group. Everything inside of this box will be displayed as neighbouring part up to the edges of this box. You may define the box in the three input fields separately for X-, Y- and Z-direction of the group.
Group End Plates: Display A single part detail of the end plates will be depicted with displayed connection shape on the corresponding side of the group, if end or base plates exist.
With Component Group Style The end plates are depicted with the detailing style used for the component group. Otherwise, they are always displayed with their own detailing style. View Direction Here, you specify the view direction of the end plate detail related to the group. Inside The shape to be connected is depicted as cut. Outside The shape to be connected is depicted as hidden. Above The shape to be connected is depicted as cut together with base plates and as hidden together with end plates. The distance of the end plate details towards the other views of the group.
Min. Distance
Page C.2 - 22
Detailing Style Group Others Display Origin The zero point reference of coordinate dimensioning of the group is displayed as reference point or at American dimensioning option as special symbol for Running dimensions (RD). Here, you can enter the size of the reference point. The RD symbol characteristics at American dimensioning option are specified in dimensioning parameters.
Show Northern Direction A mark is displayed at the group showing the alignment with regard to a global northern direction. In the global settings, the American dimensioning style has to be activated. With Part Number The US-part number or position number as well as the quantity of pieces is shown together with the longitudinal dimension chain. However, the US-part number has to exist already, i.e. the option is not activated unless an update has been made. In the global settings, the American dimensioning style has to be activated.
Indicate Mounting Position In the case of stiffeners and web angles, it is specified whether these are situated on the front or back side of the web or on both sides of the web (in case of identical parts). To recognize identical parts, the parts have already to be equipped with a position number. Only a simple comparison is made here by means of position number and position of the parts center.
Page C.2 - 23
Detailing Style
Tab ConnectingGusset
Group Selection and Cut Selection with Box All component parts situated within the indicated box are depicted. Otherwise, only the parts belonging to the main connection of the gusset are displayed. Enter the size of the selection box in the input fields X, Y and Z. The distances refer to the component part coordinate system of the main shape and are measured from the center of the main connection. Here you select the distance to be used for cutting the depicted shapes. At Selection Box The selected parts are cut off at the borders of the selection box. At Cut Box The selected parts are cut off at the individual borders of a cut box. The result will be that e.g. the supports are depicted a little bit longer, but no other component parts of this extended area will be depicted. Enter the size of the cut box in the input fields X, Y and Z. The distances refer to the component part coordinate system of the main shape and are measured from the center of the main connection.
Cut at Box
Page C.2 - 24
Detailing Style
Group Others System Point The system points (work points) of the involved connection shapes are depicted. These are the points of intersection between the center lines of the individual connection shapes and the main shape such as e.g. a support. Here, you enter the symbol size.
For more detailed information about how to create a gusset detail, please refer to the chapter DetailCenter/Gusset Details of this manual.
Page C.2 - 25
Detailing Style
Tab Views
Group Part-Filter Shapes Shapes are displayed in the view unless it is a matter of the types that are set separately in the filter. Normally, this option should be activated. Distinguishing between the different component parts is of course possible only if these have been generated with the associated functions as well. Otherwise, a web angle created as manually drilled angle steel would be interpreted as a normal shape. Poly-plates are displayed in the view unless it is a matter of stiffeners or bracing plates. Stiffeners are displayed in the view. Bracing plates (gusset plates) are displayed in the view. Web angles are displayed in the view. End plates are displayed in the view. Base Plates are displayed in the view. Special parts are displayed in the view (e.g. ACIS-3D solids). Component parts having been created with the application ProConcrete 3Dare displayed in the view.
Poly-Plates Stiffeners Bracing Plates Web Angle End Plates Base Plates Special Parts Concrete Parts
Page C.2 - 26
Detailing Style Only Within Only those parts are taken into consideration which are situated completely or at least up to their half within the work frame. Thus you can make a special selection out of the area otherwise, all parts are shown which are situated on the level of the work frame (i.e. in the way you would see them in reality.
Base Plate at Sketch Head and base plates are displayed if the option Sketch or System Lines has been selected under display variant. Otherwise, they are always displayed. Use XRef The parts added to the model via XREFs are displayed and dimensioned as well. The above mentioned display filters are also valid for these component parts. Please refer to your AutoCAD documentation where you will find a description how to work with XREFs. Here, you can exclude small parts from selection by specifying the distance of the most distant and farthest removed, opposing corners. If the corner distance is smaller than the indicated value, the part will not be recorded. This setting is unimportant if the value 0 has been entered here. None of the parts are then filtered with this function.
Group Display Variant Standard View Sketch Drawing The overview is displayed as standard 2D-depiction where all hidden edges are correctly determined. The construction components are only hinted at as sketch drawing. It is not absolutely necessary that this sketch drawing has to be seen from the beginning till the end of a component part. It is possible that only the center line is displayed. Here, you specify the distance the beginning of the sketch drawing has to have from the insertion point of the shape. If you indicated a relative length smaller than 100%, this is also the beginning of the center line. Here, you specify the length of the sketch drawing as relative value related to the shape length. The rest will only be displayed as center line.
Page C.2 - 27
Detailing Style As Objects These component parts are displayed as intelligent 2Dobjects. At this method, however, the hidden edges are only displayed correctly in relation to the corresponding part. Hidden edges, which are created due to other components, cannot be calculated. This method is suitable if you want to attach position flags later. By means of shape characteristics, it is also possible to indicate individual depictions per component part if an exact display of hidden edges is not so important e.g. in overviews for discussions. Only the center lines of shapes are displayed as static system, plates and similar component parts are not displayed. An anchor plan with alternatively two different scales is generated. Display of the base plates can thus be depicted in an enlarged display. In addition to the anchor details, the supports are also displayed as cross-section.
> Supports As Object The supports in the anchor plan are displayed as intelligent 2D-Objects. > Details S1 Here, you enter the scale of base plate details in the anchor plan. However, an anchor plan can only be generated if you have linked the view Anchor Plan in the component parts list with this style setting. The generated view is not put into x/y plane (z=0), but it is aligned and placed in the same way like in the model. This permits the insertion as overlapping in an already existing 3D-model (e.g. for facilities construction). The option is not available when the view output is scaled.
At original Position
Group Visual Depth View Frame Dialog Default > Front/Back The visual depths assigned to the work frames are used for views. The visual depths specified in this dialog are used for views. Enter the visual depths Front and Back, which have to be used for the views.
Page C.2 - 28
Detailing Style Max. Distance Enter the maximum distance another work frame is allowed to be removed from the current view to be interpreted there as construction axis for axis display and dimensioning. Enter a displacement the plane used for the view has to have from the actual work frame (in view direction). If the view plane doesnt have to be exactly in the work fra me plane, this will save you an additional view.
Displacement
Dialog-Commands
FILTER By clicking on this button, you can define a filter of your own from other parts properties apart from the previously defined filters of the group Part Filter. Then, a dialog opens for entering the filter condition.
The shape description can be used as filter criterion. The terms available for selection are displayed in the list. The part family can be used as filter criterion. The part families available for selection are displayed in the list. The part is displayed if it corresponds to another type in the second list (logical OR). The part is not displayed if it corresponds to another type in the second list (neg. OR). When you click on this button, the selected entry of the first list will be adopted in the second list.
Page C.2 - 29
Detailing Style When you click on this button, the selected entry in the second list will be removed again from this list.
Page C.2 - 30
Detailing Style
Page C.2 - 31
Detailing Style The neighboring figure shows you the different variants: The standard front view shows the supports 1, 2 and 3 as view unless the visual depth of the work area reaches up to support 4. The cranked view only shows the supports 1 and 4 in the area of the indicated visual depth. If there were parts on the thick, black cutting line, they would be displayed as cut.
The detail point overview shows the construction 5 in the selected views (here front view and view from the right), the cutting depth results from the rd corresponding 3 dimension of the cube. The result of detailing process for the different kinds of overviews is displayed in the following figure. The display of dimensions, position flags, etc. depends on the selected detailing style. Example (A) shows the standard view, example (B) the cranked view and example (C) a detail point overview consisting here of three partial views.
Page C.2 - 32
Detailing Style
C.2.5 Dimensioning
Here, you can indicate all of the settings for the dimensioning of the components. Since this is a rather complex area, the settings are distributed among several subordinate dialogs within this main group. In addition, you will find completing dialog boxes and commands which can be opened directly from the different pages or via the context menu of the right mouse key. Dimensioning settings occupy an important place in the detailing style and contribute a great deal to the quality of workshop drawings. Therefore it is important that you have a closer look to their way of working. The following chapters first will give you a survey on the functioning and on the terms before the different options will be described in detail. Common or similar things will only be described once due to a better clarity.
Extended Conception
It is for the first time that a new conception for automatic dimensioning was introduced with version 17.1. The distribution of ProSteel all over the world led to considerably increasing demands on a flexibly adaptable dimensioning. The idea of previous versions was to cover a wide range of variants with a few fixed default settings by intelligent automatic mechanisms. An increasing number of exception-buttons, however, meant increasing confusion. This is the reason why the new conception now permits precise default settings for the different sections so that you can better adapt your detailing style to the construction and to necessary drawing standards. With version 18.0, this new conception has once again been modified to facilitate the proceeding of settings, quality remaining unchanged. On the other hand, this had the result that many times the amount of new dimensioning possibilities has been created. At the same time, the program has been adapted to the extended group structure of ProSteel. At first glance, the great number of parameters and possibilities will perhaps frighten you. However, when you take a closer look, you will fast find out that the default settings for dimensioning follow a standardized logic and that therefore things are logically repeated. The example on the following page shows dimensioning of a complexe component part group as it now is possible with the new detailed setting structure automatically and without further follow-up treatment.
Page C.2 - 33
Optimum Prerequisites in 3D-Model The prerequisites for practise-oriented dimensioning are already generated by appropriate steps during 3D-modelling. The references between the different component parts are generated by means of logical links. However, when you have deleted them afterwards, it is not possible any more to determine all relations via detailing and dimensioning can less get its bearings. Appropriate insertion or reference lines which can still be modified later generate the prerequisites for the desired measuring references. Thus, when you want to have a correct dimensioning of openings, disturbing edges, etc., just set the corresponding reference edges already in the model. Of course the right modelling function, too decides on the later result of dimensioning. When you want e.g. to have recognized end and base plates as such, you have to create them with the corresponding 3D-function, too.
Page C.2 - 34
Detailing Style
Dimensioning Structure
ProSteel dimensioning is divided into several main groups for single parts, component part groups, model-views, etc. which can be set independently of each other. Within each main group, there are still other subordinate groups the parameters of which are also independent of each other. Trans-sectoral settings facilitate the common use and reduce the number of necessary parameters e. g. dimensioning of the main parts of component part groups are controlled via single parts setting.
Page C.2 - 35
Detailing Style However, this structuring is only the major selection of parameters. Each subordinate group itself again consists of an inner structure with independent default settings for the different detailing processes (of single parts) or for the different component parts (of component part groups or model-views). Each single component part or detailing type permits individual default settings for different dimensioning directions and component part views. However, a considerable repetition degree is reached here. Inner Structure Here, you see the inner structure of a subordinate group as it exists for dimensioning of add-on pieces in component part groups.This is the structure with the most variants as the dimensioning of a component part group has to take into consideration a lot of different conditions. In the following, we will therefore describe the essential matters with the help of the settings for dimensioning of a component part group. As you can see it is possible to preset a different dimensioning point for shapes in bent component part groups (radial) compared with the standard component part groups (linear). For stiffeners things may again be different.
Page C.2 - 36
Detailing Style
Dimensioning Groups
You can generate any dimensioning groups with identical settings you like by using the component parts of the inner structures. The advantage is that identical settings for different component parts can fast be made or modified. The number of parameters still allows a clear view. At the same time, an essential limit of previous versions is superseded: synonymous component parts which were differently modelled in the 3D-model can be dimensioned together by means of one setting. Let us take stiffeners in a shape here as an example which have once be manually created as polyplates and once by using the stiffener function. Nesting Complex group structures such as e.g. an assembly can consist of several component part groups and subgroups. Nesting in dimensioning (individual dimensioning) permits complete dimensioning even of subordinate groups within a parent group. Additional detail drawings can thus be omitted. As there is only one set of parameters per hierarchy type available for subordinate structures, individual structures can be excluded or limited in dimensioning via filter. Typical applications of nested dimensioning are for example the dimensioning of the detailings of add-on parts in groups or the dimensioning of the position of component part add-on parts in assemblies.
Besides the add-on dimensions (1) of polyplates, this detail of a component part group still has an individual dimensioning like a single part dimensioning (2).
Page C.2 - 37
Detailing Style
Dimensioning Groups
All essential parameter settings are made per partial sector via freely definable dimensioning groups with any assignment of component part types, i.e. you can define if need be how complex the structure of dimensioning has to be. Compared with previous versions, this proceeding is considerably more practise-oriented because first you decide (a) how you want to dimension and then (b) which component parts have to be dimensioned in this way. In the easiest case of component part group dimensioning only the settings for the overall dimension and the settings of a common dimensioning group for all add-on parts independent of their type is available. However, if a more complex dimensioning is required, you can add further dimensioning groups or special dimensions as you like and thus specialise the default settings even further. Define Guidelines for Dimensioning In principle, a dimensioning group complies with a clear guideline for the component parts to be dimensioned. By means of the parameter set of the group you define how the component parts have to be dimensioned. This parameter set is divided into different rules for straight and bent dimensioning directions, favourable and unfavourable views, etc. By means of the assigned component parts you define which component parts have to be dimensioned with these rules. This can either be a very general selection (e.g. all shapes) or a very special selection (e.g. sheet metal plates bigger than 200x200 mm). Dimensioning is worked off according to the principle of exception: All component parts or detailings for which no own rule has been defined, are treated together with the settings of the so-called standard group. This group exists in any partial sector of dimensioning and permits a fast selection at identical rules. If certain component parts dont have to be dimensioned, they have to be assigned to a group as well, because No dimensioning is a kind of rule, too. For example, you could define the different rules for all component parts having to be dimensioned and then set the standard group to No dimensioning. Special Component Part Groups, Detailings and Special Dimensions Each component part can be assigned to a standard dimensioning group. However, apart from their common properties shapes and sheet metal plates also have features which dont mean anything to the other of both types.This is the reason why in a standard group only the common properties of dimensioning are available.
Page C.2 - 38
Detailing Style If you want to make use of the extended properties, you can e.g. insert a shape dimensioning group to which exclusively shapes can be assigned. However, this group offers many more setting possibilities especially just for shapes. The detailings of single parts (drill holes etc.) as well as certain other dimensions are dimensioning rules to which nothing else can be assigned. However, here it logically is a matter of dimensioning groups as well which can be added if need be. These very often are very special groups and can only exist once per dimensioning area. The overall dimension of a detail is also a special dimension. As it is often required, it is a kind of standard dimension which always exists. Multiple Dimensioning Normally, a component part is dimensioned only once, e.g. drill hole dimensioning. This option is already known from previous versions. The flexible structure now also permits multiple dimensioning of component parts. Thus it is possible to (a) dimension all shapes via the drill holes as you did up to now and (b) to dimension certain shapes additionally via the center axes by using completely independent default settings. Multiple dimensioning of a straight shape. The outside girders are equipped with an additional dimensioning chain via the center axes..
Multiple dimensioning of a bent shape. The connection plates are equipped with an additional dimensioning chain with the measures of angle towards the edge of the component part.
Page C.2 - 39
Detailing Style The following example of an assignment shows the structure of a more complex dimensioning. Three additional dimensioning groups with independent rules are defined and an additional special dimension is fixed.
default setting for all shape types (standard group, added as an option) Additional dimensioning for U- and C-shapes for completion, i.e. multiple dimensioning (special shape group, added as an option)
default setting for all sheet metal plates and stiffeners (standard group, added as an option)
default setting for all other component parts (standard group, always existing) system dimensions of the construction (special dimension, added as an option) overall dimension of the construction (standard group, always existing)
As the standard group has to process all other component part types, this in principle is a standard dimensioning group.
Copy Settings Most of the dimensioning groups can be copied within a partial sector. At first, no component parts are assigned to this copy, even if there are already some assignments in the original group. Copies have always the same type, i.e. if the original group is a shape group, the copy again is a shape group, too. Then, you can rename the copy and assign the desired component parts to it. Special dimensions and single part detailings can exist only once and therefore cannot be copied.
Page C.2 - 40
Detailing Style Standard Default Settings When a new dimensioning group is created, it is equipped with standard default settings which in most cases produce proper results. You can always reset a group into this standard state if it appears to be hopelessly altered. In addition, it is also possible to create a complete standard default setting for each partial sector of dimensioning (e.g. dimensioning of add-on parts in groups). Apart from the settings, this standard default setting also contains an assignment of component parts. The standard default setting has been optimized for typical support/girder constructions and is a good starting-point for user-defined adaptations. The standard default settings were defined by the manufacturer and cannot be modified in order to find a uniform starting position at each user and at any time. Kindly make use of the standard loading functions of the detailing style to define your own standards. Conversion of Former Drawings Models which were created with version 17.1 or 17.2 had a fixed default setting of independent parameter records. When you open these models with version 18.0, a separate dimensioning group will be created for each of these parameter records so that the behaviour will be analogous to the previous version in case of parameter modifications. You can of course remove groups which are not required or modify the assignment of component parts afterwards. If desired, you can thus sum up identical default settings to a common group.
Page C.2 - 41
Detailing Style
Dimensioning Areas
ProSteel differentiates different dimensioning areas which you can imagine as independent local areas. The respective alignment is determined by the involved component parts and influences the indications of place and direction in the dialogs. As an option, there is also a forced horizontal or vertical alignment independent of the position for each part dimensioning in a dimensioning area.
Local Areas in Component Part Groups Within a view that means e.g. the front view these areas can exist several times except for the global area.
Global Area (1) These are all dimensioning chains which are situated outside the component part group and which describe the position of the subparts with regard to the main part. The horizontal alignment is always determined by the main part of the group and the smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular which you could draw around all component parts in direction of the main part. Since the inner measures which are perpendicular to it are always fixed at the corresponding add-on piece (inner measures), they are assigned to the local area if distances have been specified. The checked example here shows the area below the group.
Page C.2 - 42
Detailing Style Local Area (2a and Connection Area (2b) These are all dimensioning chains which are situated inside the component part group and which describe the position of the subparts with regard to their direct reference part. In case of dimensioning of subparts with local reference (2a), the horizontal alignment is determined by the corresponding reference part and the smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular around this reference part. In case of aligned dimensioning of subparts (2b), the horizontal alignment is determined by the corresponding add-on piece and the smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular around this add-on piece. . Here, you see a comparison of the three possible variants by which the butt strap can be dimensioned as an add-on piece of a component part group. The measures according to variant (1) and (2a) are alternatively possible; the measures according to variant (2b) can be attached in addition. Individual Dimensioning (3) These are all dimensioning chains which are situated inside the component part group and which describe the production measures of individual subparts. The horizontal alignment is determined by the corresponding subpart and the smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular around this subpart. Additional Views (4) These are all dimensioning chains which are situated outside the component part group in possible additional views so that here it is strictly speaking a matter of another global area. These additional views are for example the turned down endplates (here production measures) or cuts and details (here dimensioning of position). The horizontal alignment is determined by the alignment of the view and the smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular which you could draw around all component parts in this view direction. The notion inside here refers to a typical setting of measuring distances. At corresponding default settings, these inside dimensioning chains can actually be situated outside of the group as well. If the main part of a component part group or the local reference parts are bent shapes, the dimensioning direction or the surrounding rectangular will follow this bend.
Page C.2 - 43
Detailing Style Individual Areas in Complex Group Structures When the corresponding detail is a complex group structure (such as e.g. an assembly), individual dimensioning is not exclusively limited to production measures of single parts. Within an assembly, the contained component part groups can be dimensioned individually as well as it is the case with standard component part groups (see Nested Dimensioning). In this case, several independent types of individual areas exist which can be managed separately. Each of these areas would correspond to the global area of the corresponding substructure if you displayed them as separate detail.
Assignment It depends on the kind of 3D-modelling whether a component part can be reliably assigned to a local area. Most of the ProSteel functions create logical links between the involved component parts. By means of these links it is possible to determine which component part has been connected to another component part and by means of which connecting component parts this connection was realized (e.g. web angle). Thus, the assignment connected part and reference part is clearly defined. When you cut however for example two shapes by means of a cutting line so that they match with each other, no logical link will be created there. In this case, you can force a relation of the component parts by the manual link (PS_MANUAL_LINK). The manual link should also be used when the automatically created link of a connection can - for whatever reasons - not be evaluated for determining the relations. When the assignment cannot be determined and you selected a local reference of the component part, the component parts in question will be assigned to the global area.
Page C.2 - 44
Detailing Style Local Areas in Overviews Different local dimensioning areas can be determined for overviews, too. They are however not realized via component part relations but via a geometrical analysis of shape dimensions. The shapes are classified according to length and position and then possible segments are built after an evaluation. Finally, these segments are brought together to local areas within certain tolerance ranges. You can preset the parameters for area analysis in detail; we have, however, to admit that this requires a high degree of experience.
The above figure shows the plan view on a platform construction as it is automatically dimensioned by using several local areas. You can make separate settings for horizontal and vertical shapes as well as for shapes visible in cross-section each one in longitudinal and transversal direction. In addition, there is another global out-lying area having its own default settings. Only those shapes are dimensioned in common dimensioning chains which are situated completely or partly in one of these areas, if these should also be assigned to the inner area.
Page C.2 - 45
Detailing Style The global outer/inner area is determined by means of a simple snap area without special analysis algorithm. Outer Area (1) The global outer area is a uniform area which is seen from the overall dimensions of the view to the inside. The dimensioning chains are always situated outside of the view. Inner Area (2) The remaining area is the global inner area. Depending on the default settings, the dimensioning chains are always situated inside or outside of the view or the shapes are completely excluded from dimensioning. Alternatively, you can have determined local areas by means of an analysis algorithm and dimension them instead of the global inner area (but in addition to the global outer area). Local Area (1) Here, you see a local area with vertical alignment containing the complete platform part on the left side. Altogether, the example contains three areas (1x horizontal, 2x vertical). Subdivision of Areas (2) (3) Each local area can again be divided further. Then, each segment (2) resp. (3) contains its own dimensioning chain.
The direction of the local area (horizontal dimensioning direction) is determined by the proportions of sides. The limit for a direction change to main direction is at 2/3 of the long side. If there is, however, a further subdivision of the area in segments, direction change will not be effected any more.
Page C.2 - 46
Detailing Style
Page C.2 - 47
Detailing Style The example on the previous page shows a component part group with the main part (1) and several add-on shapes (2) and (3), which for their part are containing stiffeners (4). A local dimensioning reference with Component Part Start as refererence point was selected for dimensioning the stiffeners. As you can see, dimensioning is done along the component parts containing the stiffeners and each dimensioning chain starts near the reference part. In this example, the component part (2) is situated above the main part (1) and the component part (3) is situated below component part (2). Position of Dimensioning Chains You can either by force preset the position of the dimensioning chains within an area or you make select them automatically. Component parts can be dimensioned on the side on which with regard to their reference part they are situated. In addition, a favourable side is defined, depending on the position, as it is displayed in the following figure:
Dimensioning chains which are situated close together can be summed up according to rules which have to be defined. Thus, a clear drawing will be possible and collisions of dimensions will be avoided right from the beginning.
Page C.2 - 48
Detailing Style
Page C.2 - 49
Detailing Style
Primary View (1) At shapes except for flats this is the view showing the component part in its longitudinal direction. At plates or flat steel shapes, on the contrary, it is the view, showing the component part in plan view. Secondary View (2) At shapes except for flats this is the view showing the component part in its cross-section. At plates or flat steel shapes, on the contrary, it is the view, which normally shows the thickness. Please dont forget that the differentiation is made via the coordinate system of the component parts. If it differs for whatever a reason from standard, you will get different results with regard to quality.
Page C.2 - 50
Detailing Style
Sometimes a mixed dimensioning, i.e. a combination of linear and bent dimensioning chains is possible at the same time (as displayed in the above example) which you can gather from the following table. Dimensioning Variant Detailing in single parts Single part measures of main parts in comp. part groups Single part measures of subparts in comp. part groups Add-on measures of subparts with global dimension reference Add-on measures of subparts with local dimension reference Linear Measures Yes Yes depending on type Yes depending on type Radial Measures Yes Yes depending on type Yes depending on type
If simultaneous dimensioning is not possible, only the preset settings will be used for the type in question; selection depends on the current reference shape. Thus it is possible to use always the outer edges of subparts in case of straight reference parts and to indicate only the angles in case of bent shapes together with local dimension references.
Page C.2 - 51
Detailing Style
Edge Group
Connecting Shape
The example on the following page shows some important reference points of dimensioning chains. Web angle dimensioning could be made on the starting point of the group (1) or on the starting point of the main part (2). Dimensioning on the edge of the reference part would dimension the two web
Page C.2 - 52
Detailing Style angles on the left on point (2) and the web angles on the right on point (3) in case of edge group, this would be the points (1) and (4). In the present example, however, the variant connecting shape was selected and thus you obtain the two dimensioning chains (A) as result. Dimensioning chain (B) results from the fact that, in addition, the reference points are dimensioned, too.
Dimension Point (Target Point) The target point of dimensioning is determined by the component part to be dimensioned or by the detailing (e.g. drill hole). Depending on the kind of component part or detailing, you often have a great number of different options for selection. Most of the options are self-explanatory so that we will only describe some common features here. For more detailed information, please refer to the short descriptions of the different sections. The importance of the component parts reference edges depends on the dimensioning direction of the dimensioning chain (see also: Indications of Place and Direction). From top to bottom, the example shows the dimensioning chains reaching from the beginning of the component part to the reference edges front edge, rear edge, outer edge, inner edge.
Page C.2 - 53
Detailing Style Here, too the center of the reference part in question is the dividing line for the options inner edge and outer edge. To allow fast and practical dimensioning of different shapes, an automatic selection of dimension points is available (depending on the component part) which is sufficient for most cases. Here, you see the defaults for the different shape types, positions of component parts and directions of dimensioning chains:
Apart from dimensioning on the insertion-reference point, on possibly existing drill holes or even on combinations of both, you can select some special forms as target point. The example shows the dimension point contact area for the dimensions in longitudinal direction. The edge which is turned to the reference or connecting shape will be dimensioned.
Additional Dimensions You can add different additional dimensions to each dimensioning chain. These are added later to obtain closed dimensioning chains. The additional dimensions permit uniform dimensioning running; on the other hand the dimensioning reference can be made clearer, you can eliminate insignificant remaining dimensions and thus reduce the number, when you don t use them.
Page C.2 - 54
Detailing Style
American Dimensioning
When you selected American Style as general default setting for dimensioning, you obtain additional labels and dimensions as they are common in the USA. At the moment, only a limited configuration of these additions is possible. They depend on the importance of the component parts in the model. Together with the generally available settings, you have thus the possibility to create drawings according to these standards, too.
Connecting Condition (1) You are informed about the used shapes and hole distances for web angle connections. However, this is only the case, when the web angles belong to the component part group. Control Measures (2) (3) At girders, the residual measures related to the system points of supports are indicated as negative values (2) and the distance between the system points (3). When it is a matter of supports, only the height level will be indicated. Information about Main Part (4) Data concerning shape and length of the main part are added to the dimensioning chain containing the overall length of the component part group. Rebound (5) The distance between the main part and the overall measure of the component part group is indicated as individual dimension. Reference Point (6) The origin of the group for coordinate measures is indicated by the symbol RD and reference arrow instead of by a simple point.
Page C.2 - 55
Detailing Style
Page C.2 - 56
Detailing Style
On the following pages, you will find a detailed description of the different part areas, their settings and additional functions.
Page C.2 - 57
Detailing Style Structure of Part Areas The following survey shows all independent part areas of dimensioning in standard dialog display. When you selected the intelligent arrangement of parameters, some of these areas are hidden or they are situated on another position of the tree structure. However, it is always exactly the same data record.
General default settings which are valid for all areas (e.g. distance of one dimensioning chain to the other, dimensioning styles, dimensioning of drill holes etc.)
Dimensioning of single parts details, individual dimensioning of the main parts in groups Dimensioning of group and subgroup details, individual dimensioning of groups and subgroups and single parts in assemblies, individual dimensioning of subgroups in groups; individual dimensioning of add-on parts in groups Dimensioning of assembly details Dimensioning of connection details Dimensioning of overviews and anchor plans
The arrangement corresponds to the hierarchic structure of the part area. By selecting an entry, you directly reach the parent or subordinate dialog tabs of the corresponding part area. As e.g. the entry Cut is situated below the entry Reference Points in the part area Group, the dimensioning chains for intersections in groups are set here.
Page C.2 - 58
Detailing Style
Group Dimensioning Group Type Group Here you select the type of dimensioning group. General Group for each component part type Group Shapes for straight and bent shapes Group Polyplates for all plate types and stiffeners Group Connecting Part for end plates, web angles, etc. Group Subgroups for special subgroups the name of the group in the selection tree
Group Name
Page C.2 - 59
Detailing Style Group Labelling Type Labelling Here you select the type of labelling for the dimensioning chain. You can choose between None, Automatic, Group Name and User-defined Default. Here you indicate which dimensioning chains have to be equipped with a labelling. Here you enter a suitable labelling text if you selected the option User-defined Default.
For more detailed information about labelling, please refer to the section Labelling of Dimensioning Chains in this chapter. You can add or copy any number of component part groups and assign component parts to them. If need be, it is thus possible to build very complex dimensioning structures.
Add Special Dimensions and Detailings Select the entry Dimensioning Groups / Add Special Dimensions or Dimensioning Groups / Add Detailing in the context menu to add special dimensions and, at single parts, the detailings, too. The selection dialog already described under Component Part Groups appears where you can select the corresponding special dimension or detailing. The offered selection depends on the part area of dimensioning. You can add special groups only once and they cannot be copied. Already inserted groups therefore are not displayed any more for selection.
Copy, Rename and Delete In order to do this, you first have to select the desired group in the tree structure and then call the context menu. When you copy a component part group, a new group of the same type will be created and all parameter settings will be adopted (possibly existing assignments of component parts will however not be copied). Select the entry Dimensioning Groups / Copy. Then, you can rename the copy and assign the component parts. Rename the group using the entry Dimensioning Groups / Rename. Enter the new name directly in the tree structure. Delete the group using the entry Dimensioning Groups / Delete. In case of component part groups, it may be that the component parts once registered by this group will be processed by other groups.
Page C.2 - 60
Detailing Style Assign Component Parts Depending on the type, certain component parts can be assigned to any standard dimensioning group or to the special component part groups. Select the desired group and then click the entry Add Component Parts in the context menu. The following dialog opens:
The content of the selection lists depends on the type of dimensioning group, on the settings and on the component parts already assigned to. Group Selection Lists Upper List Subtypes Here you select the principle component part type (main type) such as shapes, plates, etc. you want to add. Here you select a subtype with which you can limit the selection of the upper list. However, subtypes are not available for all component part types. Thus you can limit an assignment e.g. only to all U-shapes. Select the entry All Shape Types if you dont want to limit the assignment.
Group Size Area Length, Width,... Enter an area with which you limit the selection in the fields From and To. If you enter the value 0 in both fields, this size will not be taken into consideration.
Page C.2 - 61
Detailing Style Group Component Part Description Class Here you enter the component part description (or a part of it together with wildcards) with which you limit the selection. In the 3D-model you can add a description to any component part which you can use for your own classification here. Thus, you are independent of the built-in types, but you can make use of both in combination. Here you enter a name (or a part of it together with wildcards) with which you limit the selection.
Name
Group Others Only New Parts If this field has been checked, already added component parts are not displayed any more, even if they are situated in other dimensioning groups. Comparison is only made via main type so that the complete type is hidden even if there had been a limitation before. Thus, you can see which types have not yet been seized by dimensioning. In this case, multiple assignments are not possible (any more).
Multiple Assignments If this field has been checked, component parts or areas of component parts can be added several times unless it is a matter of the same dimensioning group. For more detailed information about multiple assignments and wildcards, please refer to section Automatic Assignment Check in this chapter.
Click on this button to add your defaults as new assignment or to modify the selected assignment accordingly.
Page C.2 - 62
Detailing Style
The neighboring example shows the dimensioning of a construction having approximately identical shape types and shape lengths. With the help of component part description, you can nevertheless automatically generate a dimensioning which shows the connection of the component parts with each other in a reasonable way. Modify and Delete Assignment First select the desired assignment in the tree structure and then call the context menu. Modify the assignment using the entry Modify Part. Then, the above-described dialog for assignments opens where the current setting is displayed. Now, you can modify the data and make new assignments. Delete the assignment using the entry Delete Parts. It may be that the component part or the part area will be processed by other groups.
Page C.2 - 63
Detailing Style Automatic Assignment Check When component parts are assigned, the program automatically checks whether the type, name or size areas overlap and therefore the result would be an indefinite assignment. If this is the case, the new assignment will not be accepted and an error message will be displayed. The check is made at each insertion or modification of assignments and depends on the option Multiple Assignments. If this option has been activated, the check is only made in the current dimensioning group the assignment can be repeated in another group of the part area. If multiple assignments option has been deactivated, the program checks the complete part area by means of all groups that a component part will be registered only once. The following diagram shows some examples of desired assignments:
Existing Assignment Shapes Shapes Shapes, only L-Shapes Shapes, up to 2000 mm length Shapes, up to 2000 mm length Shapes, up to 2000 mm length Shapes, Name=HEA* Shapes, Name=HE* Additional New Assignment Shapes Shapes, only U-Shapes Shapes, only U-Shapes Shapes, from 1500 to 2500 mm length Shapes, from 100 mm height onward Shapes, Name=HEB* Shapes, Name=HEB* not possible not possible OK not possible not possible OK not possible
The symbol ? can be used as wildcard for any single character in the name or in the component part description. The symbol * can be used for any sequence of characters. It is true that you can use the symbols as you like, but a correct check with regard to overlapping only takes place for the symbol * at the beginning and/or end.
Page C.2 - 64
Detailing Style Labelling of Dimensioning Chains Many dimensioning chains can be equipped with a labelling text indicating which component parts, detailings or situations are dimensioned. This text may be controled individually per group via dimensioning groups if a labelling is generally provided there by the program and it has been switched on globally (see dialog tab General Info). In the global area of the usual dimensioning of add-on parts or detailing most of the dimensioning chains can be equipped with a labelling text. At nested individual dimensioning, it often has been internally deactivated. The mentioned labelling consists of additional functional info texts. The possible indication of hole diameters at separated dimensioning chains is not affected by this. You can directly enter individual data with regard to the labelling text when inserting the dimensioning group. If you want to modify the data later, you have to select the dimensioning group and then call the command labelling of dimensioning chains in the context menu. Then, a dialog opens, identical to the dialog for generating a dimensioning group. Labelling Types None Automatic No labelling texts are added to the dimensioning chains. A labelling text is added to the dimensioning chains, and this text is automatically defined by the component part types or detailings analogous to previous versions. The labelling text corresponds to the name of the associated dimensioning group or to the assignments. If Separate Dimensioning Chains have been defined for a component part group, the text corresponds to the name of the assignments (main type). The labelling text corresponds to your own default which can be entered in the labelling text field. Thus it is possible to use e.g. short texts or completely different texts.
Group/Assignment
User-def. Default
Select Direction Both Directions Only Horizontal Only Vertical A labelling is added to horizontal and vertical dimensioning chains. A labelling is added only to horizontal dimensioning chains. A labelling is added only to vertical dimensioning chains.
Page C.2 - 65
Detailing Style Examples for Dimensioning Structures Beneath please find some examples for different dimensioning groups and assignments: 1) Here a general default Outside Edges for Each Component Part is created simply and fast via standard group.
2) Dimensioning via drill holes at dimensioning chains separated by type is desired for poly-plates and shear plates; all other component parts have to be dimensioned via the center axes (via standard group).
3) The result here corresponds to the second example, dimensioning of shape axes however has been defined via a separate independent group. The standard group doesnt have any effect at these parts.
Page C.2 - 66
Detailing Style
Individual Default Settings The dialog tab consists of two essential areas: On the left, you select the desired dimensioning group the settings of which you want to modify. To create and edit dimension groups you have to use the rightmouse menue. On the right, you can make separate settings for horizontal and vertical dimensioning direction. Each possible combination can be set independently of the other so that the content on the right changes depending on selection. However, not all combinations are available in all dialog tabs..
Page C.2 - 67
Detailing Style Selection Range Selection Tree (1) Click on a list entry to select the dimensioning group or the component part assignment you want to work on. When it is a matter of add-on dimensions in groups, the possible assignments of component part types and sizes, which can be dimensioned separately, are displayed in the list. When it is a matter of production dimensions at single parts, all selected detailings are displayed which can be dimensioned. Dimensioning Area (2) Here, you select the dimensioning area and the reference direction where the component parts in question have to be dimensioned. Area Selection Global In principle, the component parts are dimensioned in the global area, i.e. outside of the component part group and with the alignment of the main part. In principle, the component parts are dimensioned in the local area, i.e. with the alignment of the corresponding reference part. If the component part in question is directly connected to the main part of the group, it will be dimensioned in global area. On the other hand, if it is connected to another subpart, it will be dimensioned in the local area of this part. The component part in question is dimensioned in global area, if it is directly connected to the main part of the group. Otherwise, it will not be dimensioned. The component part in question is not dimensioned, if it is directly connected to the main part of the group. Otherwise, it will be dimensioned in global area. The component part in question is not dimensioned, if it is directly connected to the main part of the group. Otherwise, it will be dimensioned in the local area.
Local
Global+Local
Global+Ignore
Ignore+Global
Ignore+Local
Alignment According to Ref. Horizontal The component part is dimensioned according to the reference direction of the area selection. The component part is always dimensioned in horizontal and/or in vertical direction, independent of its reference part. However, this option is not available for all cases.
Page C.2 - 68
Detailing Style Sum Up Dimensions (8) Here you select whether the component parts summed up in a common dimensioning group have to be dimensioned together, too or whether a separate dimensioning chain has to be created for each part. Decrease Order of Precedence (3) Click on this button to move the selected entry one place down. If a dimensioning group has been selected here, the complete group will be moved. Otherwise, the component part will be moved within the dimensioning group. If there are several dimensioning chains per page, the list order corresponds to the order of the dimensioning chains in the drawing. Special dimensions will always be added to the part at the end, even if they are placed at another position. Increase Order of Precedence (4) Click on this button to move the selected entry one place up. If a dimensioning group has been selected here, the complete group will be moved. Otherwise, the component part will be moved within the dimensioning group. If there are several dimensioning chains per page, the list order corresponds to the order of the dimensioning chains in the drawing. Special dimensions will always be added to the part at the end, even if they are placed at another position. Linear/Radial Dimensioning Direction (5) Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for linear or radial (bent) dimensioning chain. You work on the settings the symbol of which is currently displayed. Selection symbol for Linear / Radial
Primary/Secondary View (6) Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for primary or secondary view. You work on the settings the symbol of which is currently displayed. Selection symbol for Primary / Secondary
Page C.2 - 69
Detailing Style Normal/Aligned Dimensioning (7, single parts and groups) Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for normal or aligned subpart dimensioning. Normal dimensioning is assigned to the global or to the local area, depending on selection, and the aligned dimensioning is independent of this. You work on the settings the symbol of which is currently displayed. Selection symbol for Normal / Aligned
Outside/Inside Area (7, views) Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for outside or inside area at overviews. You work on the settings the symbol of which is currently displayed. Selection symbol for outside / inside area
Page C.2 - 70
Detailing Style Adjustment Range Longitudinal Direction (A) Here, you determine the default settings for the position of the dimensioning chain and the used reference points in horizontal dimensioning direction. The values of the currently selected dimensioning chain are displayed. Transversal Direction (B) Here, you determine the default settings for the position of the dimensioning chain and the used reference points in vertical dimensioning direction. The values of the currently selected dimensioning chain are displayed. The meaning of Horizontal and Vertical refers to the direction of the used dimensioning area any may locally differ from main direction. The offered possibilities of the different selection lists depend very much on the part area and on the selected dimensioning group. Settings Reference Part (I) Reference Part (II) Target point of dimensioning; in most cases, this is a special point, but it can also be a rule such as e.g. drill holes. If need be, you can give further information about the selected part reference.
Reference Connection Reference point of dimensioning; dimensioning chains start here. Additional Dimensions These dimension points are added to the dimensioning chain later and/or occasionally completed as separate dimensioning chain. Style Variants Here you can select the dimensioning style variants as combination for relative dimensions and coordinate dimensions.
Pos. Dim. Chain (I) Position of the dimensioning chain with regard to the component part or to the reference part Pos. Dim. Chain (II) Here you can limit the display of the dimensioning chains to certain main views of the component part (front view, plan view, etc.) or to a certain position.
Page C.2 - 71
Detailing Style Coordinate Meas. Execution of coordinate measures resp. certain dimensioning chains are excluded from coordinate dimensioning. Since radial dimensioning chains as well as inside areas of overviews dont support any coordinate dimensioning, an alternative is imposed on this input field: Circular Measures Execution of radial dimensioning
Info Line Labelling Information about the current setting of labelling for the dimensioning chains of a dimensioning group: You can enter the data immediately when the dimensioning group is created or later in the selection area via the context menu.
On the following two pages, you will find a table with the most frequent options which are available in the selection lists. In addition, there is a short explanation of the meaning. The selected example refers to inputs for subpart dimensioning of shapes, you can, however, transfer the information to the other component parts or detailings. For an explanation of other special options, please refer to the description of the corresponding dialog tabs.
Page C.2 - 72
Detailing Style
Reference to Component Part (I and II) No dimensioning Outer edges Center of component part Drill holes Each hole First hole Last hole First + last hole Reference point Reference points Front edge Rear edge Inner edge Outer edge Contact edge Inner edge Outer edge Both edges Inner + slope Outer + slope Reference point + drill holes Outer edges + drill holes Drill holes or outer edges Arc center Automatic depending on type Reference Connection Standard Reference point Border reference parts Border / Edge reference part Border Group Beginning reference part Beginning group Middle reference part Center reference part Connecting shape At the bottom/on the left of the reference part or reference point (depending on global default setting). The projected insertion-/Reference axis of the reference part Next of the two reference points of the reference part Next outer edge of the reference part Next outer edge of the complete group Near edge of reference part in dimensioning direction Near edge of complete group in dimensioning direction Geometrical center of reference part Center of the circle if circular shape, otherwise geometrical center System point of the axes of reference part and component part/connecting shape The component part is not dimensioned Both outer edges in dimensioning direction Geometrical center All holes Only the first hole in dimensioning direction Only the last hole in dimensioning direction The first and last hole in dimensioning direction The projected insertion-/reference axis Both reference points Near edge in dimensioning direction Far edge in dimensioning direction Near edge seen from center of reference part Far edge seen from center of reference part Contact edge to reference part (near web) Contact edge to reference part (outside) Contact edge to reference part (web and outside) Inner contact edge and length of gradient Outer contact edge and length of gradient Combination reference point and drill hole Combination outer edges and drill hole Outer edges if there are no drill holes Center of the circle if circular shape Reference point depending on shape
Page C.2 - 73
Detailing Style
Additional Dimensions None Ref. part / connecting shape Group Group and reference part Reference points Reference part + ref. points Group + reference points All additional dimensions Style Variants No style variants LIN1- / COO-2 etc. The program always uses the basic styles Combinations of different style variants No further additional dimensions Outer edges of reference part Outer edges of complete group Outer edges of reference part and of complete group Both reference points of the reference part Outer edges and reference points of the reference part Outer edges of the group and reference points of the reference part Reference points of the reference part and outer edges ref. part + group
Position of Dimensioning Chain (I) To part position Opposite part position Always below Always above Regular Favorable side Unfavorable side Front edge Rear edge Inner edge Outer edge Center Front edge + border Rear edge + border Inner edge + border Outer edge + border Center + border Side on which the component part is lying towards the reference part Opposite side on which the component part is lying towards the reference part Below reference part Above reference part Increase number of dimensioning chains below and above reference part regularly Favorable side of the component part towards the reference part Opposite to the favorable side of the component part towards the reference part Near edge in area direction Far edge in area direction Near edge in area direction seen from the center of the reference part Far edge in area direction seen from the center of the reference part Center of the component part Like front edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position Like rear edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position Like inner edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position Like outer edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position Like center, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
Page C.2 - 74
Detailing Style
Position of Dimensioning Chain (II) In each view Only 1x best view Only if orthogonal Only if diagonal Only if perpendicular Only if parallel Only in front view Only in top view Only in front view Only in rear view Only in left view Only in right view Except for in front view Except for in top view Except for in front view Except for in rear view Except for in left view Except for in right view Dimensioning in each main view of the detail If one dimension of the component part is dimensioned, new dimensioning will not take place Dimensioning only if component part orthogonal towards the reference part Dimensioning only if component part diagonal towards the reference part Dimensioning only if component part perpendicular towards the ref. part Dimensioning only if component part parallel towards the reference part Dimensioning only in front view of the detail Dimensioning only in top view of the detail Dimensioning only in front view of the detail Dimensioning only in rear view of the detail Dimensioning only in the left view of the detail Dimensioning only in the right view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in front view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in top view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in front view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in rear view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in left view of the detail Always dimensioning except for in right view of the detail
Page C.2 - 75
Detailing Style Adopt Primary Default Settings When you want to use the same default settings as selection for primary and secondary view, you can select in the secondary settings the option like primary as component part reference. Any modifications in the primary settings then will be valid for the secondary view, too.
Copy and Reset Functions Since you can define up to 6 different dimensioning variants for a single list entry, some auxiliary functions are available which can facilitate the setting task. You have access to these functions by calling the context menu of the right mouse key in the selection list of the selection range. Copy Selection of Primary The settings of the primary area for the currently selected group are copied into the secondary area as far as longitudinal and transversal direction are concerned. However, this is only valid for the currently selected dimensioning area. This function is reasonable when you want to modify only one value in the secondary view compared with the primary view. Deactivate Selected Group The component part reference of the currently selected group is set to No dimensioning for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all dimensioning areas. For secondary views it is set to the option Like Primary. Thus, you can easily deactivate dimensioning of component parts without having to remove the whole group. Deactivate All Groups The component part reference of all existing groups is set to No dimensioning for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all dimensioning areas. For secondary views it is set to the option Like Primary. Thus, you can easily deactivate complete parts of dimensioning without having to remove the whole group. The use of the deactivate functions in practice facilitates the optimization of existing settings, because you can rapidly deactivate the entries without having to look for them by means of the different selection possibilities.
Page C.2 - 76
Detailing Style Selected Group Standard Values All settings of the currently selected group are reset to the internally specified standard settings for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all dimensioning areas. These correspond to the initial values at creation of the corresponding dimensioning group. All Groups Standard Values All settings of all existing groups are reset to the internally specified standard settings for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all dimensioning areas. These correspond to the initial values at creation of the corresponding dimensioning groups. Create Complete Standard Default Setting A complete, internally specified standard setting is created for the selected part area of dimensioning. This setting contains the creation of dimensioning groups to be selected including the component part assignments (as far as possible) as well as the setting with standard default settings. Please note that all existing dimensioning groups, component part assignments and settings will be lost when this function is used! The use of the standard settings functions in practice facilitates the building of user-defined dimensioning structures, because it is always possible to return to a clearly defined initial position in case of unsuccessful setting attempts.
Page C.2 - 77
Detailing Style
Style Variants
The allocation of style variants permits you to design a more clearly structured dimensioning. Outer dimensions can be emphasized with larger texts or different dimension ranges can be colored. You could also use dimension chains with tolerance specifications for hole dimensions or, in case you anticipate many tight dimensions, you could also work with smaller text. There are many ways to use this option to your advantage. Definition and Assignment of Style Variants One of the existing style variants can be assigned to each dimension chain, independently for relative dimensioning and coordinate dimensioning. However, it is selected as a combination for both types simultaneously via selection list. A dimensioning style is assigned to a style variant in the general settings for dimensioning so that you can read the proceedings on the corresponding dialog tab. Compared with a direct selection of dimensioning style, the advantage of the proceeding via style variant is that you can modify the dimensioning style for several dimension chains together (e.g. after import of detailing style parameters). If you only want to modify the text sizes, you can also make use of the "auto" setting, because here a style with smaller and bigger sizes (factor 0.7 or 1.4) will be automatically created from the selected dimensioning style for standard size. However, if you also want to modify the colors or select other text sizes, you have to select a separate AutoCAD dimensioning style. Combinations (Selection) No Style Variant: Always Variant 1: STD / COO-1: The corresponding basic style is used for relative dimensions and for coordinate dimensions. The corresponding style variant 1 is used for relative dimensions and for coordinate dimensions. The corresponding basic style is used for relative dimensions and the correspoinding style variant 1 is used for coordinate dimensions. The corresponding style variant 1 is used for relative dimensions and the correspoinding basic style is used for coordinate dimensions. The corresponding style variant 1 is used for relative dimensions and the correspoinding style variant 2 is used for coordinate dimensions.
LIN-1 / STD:
LIN-1 / COO-2:
Page C.2 - 78
Detailing Style
Individual Filter The dialog tab consists of two essential areas: On the left side you select the desired dimensioning group the settings of which have to be modified. The dimensioning groups can also be managed via a context menu. On the right side you can specify the filter settings for the parameter record of individual dimensioning.
Page C.2 - 79
Detailing Style Selection Area Selection Tree (1) Here you select the dimensioning group or component part assignment you want to work on by clicking an entry. The assignments of component part types and sizes forming an individual independent filter group will be displayed. Dimensioning Area (2) Here you select the reference direction to which a limitation of alignment (e.g. only perpendicular) refers. Setting Area Component Part and Parameter Filter (A) Here you determine the default settings for component part and parameter filter. The values of the currently selected dimensioning group will be displayed. You can only exclude properties, i.e. if the function has not been generally activated in the parameter record, the default setting doesnt have any effect h ere. Settings Part Reference (I) Here you specify whether an individual dimensioning has to be effected for the assigned component parts. If it is the individual dimensioning of a group, filtering takes place via the main part of this group. Detailings or add-on parts are dimensioned. The overall length is dimensioned. The overall width is dimensioned. The hole diameters are labelled.
Pos. Dim. Chain (I) Here you can limit the individual dimensioning to certain views of the component part to be dimensioned. Pos. Dim. Chain (II) Here you can limit the individual dimensioning to certain views of the actual detail (front view, plan view, etc.) or to alignments with regard to the reference part. Filter Here you can specify additional filter conditions.
On the following page, you will find a table with the most frequent options which are available in the selection lists. In addition, there is a short explanation of the meaning.
Page C.2 - 80
Detailing Style
Reference to Component Part Default Reference Points Default Hole Dimensions Default Contour Dimensions No Detailings Dimension No Dimension Hole Labelling Default Labelling No Labelling Position Dimension Chain Only Primary Only Secondary Primary+Secondary Filter No Filter Each Part 1x No additional filter has been activated. Parts having the same position number are only dimensioned 1x. The component part is only dimensioned if it is visible in primary position. The component part is only dimensioned if it is visible in secondary position. The component part is dimensioned in primary and secondary position. The drill holes are labelled according to the defaults settings for labelling. The drill holes are not labelled Detailings or add-on parts are dimensioned as specified. Only drill holes are dimensioned as specified. Only contour dimensions are dimensioned as specified No detailings or add-on parts are dimensioned. The overall length/width is dimensioned as defined in Reference Points. The overall length/width is not dimensioned
Example for Individual Dimensioning Let us assume that you have a shape, a poly-plate and some more add-on parts in a group. As for the shape, you only want to dimension the drill holes, but the poly-plate has to be dimensioned completely and the other component parts havent to be dimensioned at all. In order to do this, you create two dimensioning groups and assign Shapes to the first and Poly-plates to the second as component part type. All desired dimensioning options are now permitted in the parameter record, i.e. all detailings and the overall dimensions as well and they are set accordingly. Now, activate the dimensioning group with the assigned shapes only for Default Hole Dimensions, and the dimensioning group with the assigned poly plates for all possible options. Deactivate the dimensioning group Standard to exclude all remaining parts from dimensioning.
Page C.2 - 81
Detailing Style
Tab Common
Group Dim Chains Method Here, you define the fundamental method of automatic component part dimensioning. Steel Standard Standard dimensioning of ProSteel; however, only ProSteel component parts will be evaluated. Steel US - Additional information is added to dimensioning chains and details as common in the USA. Only ProSteel component parts will be evaluated Concrete Standard - Standard dimensioning of ProSteel; however, only ProSteel component parts will be evaluated. Steel + Concrete Standard - Standard dimensioning of ProSteel; however, all component parts will be evaluated Steel + Concrete US - Additional information is added to dimensioning chains and details as common in the USA. All component parts will be evaluated. As far as the difference of US-dimensioning to standard default settigs is concerned, please refer to a separate section of this chapter for more detailed information.
Page C.2 - 82
Detailing Style Kind of Dimensioning Here, you select the kind of distance measuring between the different dimensioning points. Relative customary relative dimension chains are attached. Coordinates dimensioning chains are attached with continuous dimensioning to a fixed reference point. Mixed relative dimension chains and at the same time here included the corresponding coordinate dimensions are attached. However, you have the option to exclude certain freely selectable dimensioning chains from coordinate dimensioning. The dimensioning is created as really associative dimensioning without text overwriting as far as possible. In case of manual manipulations dimensioning is automatically adapted to the measured values. The program will position the dimensioning texts in a better way according to the settings on the page Optimization. Optimization can be switched off later if you want to displace the dimensions manually according to another method or if you do not expect overlaps. You will then obtain the dimensions on the position where AutoCAD would place them automatically. At hole dimensioning each individual hole diameter gets its own dimension chain. The dimensioned hole diameter then is indicated on the dimension line. Small welding cracks will be assigned their own dimensioning line. This is a minor option if Divide Hole Rows has been selected because here a distinction is made between diameters anyway. At hole dimensioning the hole diameter is indicated on the dimension construction line if Divide Hole Rows has been selected. The things located by dimension chain are written as additional text to the end of dimension line. The text depends on the settings for dimensioning groups.
Associative Dim.
With Optimization
Diameter on Line
> Hole Assignment If this field has been checked, a text is added to inform about the assignment to position (top/bottom) for dimension chains of drill holes which are divided according to depth position (Zdirection). Gradient Reference Angle measures can be indicated as gradient instead of as angle. Here you enter the reference value for calculating the gradient.
Page C.2 - 83
Detailing Style Group Standard Dimensioning Style and Coordinate Style Upper Selection List Here you can select the dimensioning style (AutoCAD) to be used for the dimensioning in question. This style is going to control all properties such as text colour, text size, etc. For radii and angles the corresponding subordinate style of an AutoCAD dimensioning style can additionally be used. Variant 1 / 2 / 3 Here, you can indicate three alternative styles to be assigned as style variant to different dimension chains. If you have selected the entry Auto Smaller', a copy with smaller text sizes (factor 0.7) is generated from the basic style. If you have selected the entry Auto Larger', a copy with larger text sizes (factor 1.4) is generated from the basic style. Style variants allow you e.g. to emphasize overall dimensions or to use smaller texts when space is limited.Please also refer to section Style Variants in this chapter. Here you select the kind of coordinates. Rotated Dimensioning Chain The coordinates are attached beside the second construction line as a measure which is rotated by 90. Some parameters of dimensioning style are modified at this occasion. Like Dimensioning Style The coordinates are attached in the indicated dimensioning style without any modifications. AutoCAD Coordinates The coordinates are attached in the indicated dimensioning style without any modifications as real AutoCAD coordinates. Any possibly existing coordinates dimensioning chains are summed up to one dimensioning chain per dimensioning side and attached completely outside. Mixed dimensioning chains are transformed into standard relative dimensioning chains.
Coordinates
Coordinates Extra
Page C.2 - 84
Detailing Style
Group Holes in Plan View Diameter The hole diameter is written beside the hole groups. If the value doesnt change, the diameter is only indicated once per hole row or complete hole group. The text is always aligned in main dimensioning direction. Enter the text size for labeling here. Here, you can indicate the distance of the insertion point of diameter labeling from the hole. This distance is measured from the border of the hole. Here you can enter the angle between the insertion point of diameter labeling and the hole. The value 0 corresponds to the main dimensioning direction. You can indicate positive (rotating to the left) and negative values. Common axis lines are displayed within the hole groups if the Divide Hole Groups setting has been checked. Only those holes are dimensioned which are visible in the corresponding view. At a plan view for example, the holes of the shapes bottom flange are not dimensioned unless they were visible due to gaps in the upper flange.
> Angles
Page C.2 - 85
Detailing Style Divide Top/Bottom The drill holes of upper and bottom side of the component part are dimensioned in an individual dimension chain. The assignment refers to the relative position towards view plane (Z=0). Here you can select how to dimension and label oblong holes. You may choose between different combinations of hole axes and hole lengths to dimension according to production. For more detailed intormation please refer to the general explanations with regard to oblong holes
Oblong Holes
New Dimensions to Here, you enter the distance from one hole group resp. drill hole dimensioning to the other at which a new (redundant) dimensioning has to be carried out. This permits a clearer dimensioning of far away positioned identical hole screen dimensions as the dimension chains resp. the indications of diameters are repeated.
Group Holes in View As Back Pitch You enter the back pitches including the diameter of the parallel drill holes. Continous constant back pitches are displayed as a group. Here, you enter the text size for back pitch labeling. Here, you can indicate the distance of back pitch labeling from the edge of the component part. Positive values signify a labeling outside the component part, negative values signify a labeling inside the component part. Beginning and end of a hole group are displayed by a marking. Here you can select how to dimension and label oblong holes. You may choose between different combinations of hole axes and hole lengths to dimension according to production. For more detailed intormation please refer to the general explanations with regard to oblong holes
New Dimensions to Here, you enter the distance from one back pitch to the other at which a new (redundant) dimensioning has to be carried out. This permits a clearer dimensioning of far away positioned identical back pitches as the indications are repeated.
Page C.2 - 86
Detailing Style Group Gusset Plates Holes in gusset-plates are dimensioned in groups with reference to the system axes of the connected shapes. You can make the basic settings here. For more detailed information, please refer to the general explanations with regard to gusset-plate dimensioning. > System Axis > Offset System > Offset Plate > Gradient The system axes of the shapes connected via gusset-plate are displayed. The extension of the displayed system axis beyond the system point. The extension of the displayed system axis beyond the edge of the plate. The gradients of the shapes connected via gusset-plate are displayed.
Group Miscellaneous
Hole Group Reference Here, you select how to dimension drill holes in main parts or in subparts (only length direction) if the option hole group reference has been selected there. None hole group reference is completely deactivated. Connecting shape The hole groups are refered to the intersection points with the axis resp. reference line (depending on the default setting) of the corresponding connecting shape. First hole The hole groups are refered to the first hole of the hole group in dimension direction. Last hole The hole groups are refered to the last hole of the hole group in dimension direction. For more detailed information, please refer to the general explanations with regard to hole group reference. Of Reference Point The reference points of the shapes are used for determining the reference points of connected shapes. Otherwise, their center axis is used. Connecting Shapes The reference points of the connected shapes are dimensioned in a separate dimensioning chain if in groups subparts dimensioning is refered to it.
Page C.2 - 87
Detailing Style > Coordinate Dim. Here, you select how to dimension the reference points of the connected shapes with coordinate measures. None No coordinate measures are attached. Origin Detail Coordinate measures are attached and measured from the origin of the group (main part). Origin Model Coordinate measures are attached and measured from the origin of the model Thus, it is possible to get e.g. at supports the absolute height in the model as coordinate value. Here, you can specify the maximum distance up to which a hole in the subpart or main part is assigned to the corresponding reference point of the connected shape or hole group.
Search Area
Oblong Holes The horizontal dimensioning and labelling of oblong holes depends on the kind of production. Four independent variants are available here beside the option No Dimensioning (for manual dimensioning) and the option According to Hole Type (not yet supported at the very moment): Hole Axes The hole axes are dimensioned and the hole distance is indicated at labeling.
Hole Length The outer edges are dimensioned and the hole length is indicated at labeling.
Hole Center+Hole Axes The center of the hole is dimensioned and the axis distance is indicated at labeling.
Hole Center+Hole Length The center of the hole is dimensioned and the hole length is indicated at labeling.
Page C.2 - 88
Detailing Style Hole Group Reference Hole group in component parts, here mainly in component part groups, get further reference dimensions in addition to the standard add-on dimensions of subparts. In this example, a connecting butt strap is dimensioned with reference to the holes. Add-on Dimension in Component Part Group (1) The butt strap is dimensioned with reference to the connecting shape, here to its insertion reference point. Hole Group Reference (2) The connecting shape is selected for hole group reference as well. Alternative Possibility (3) (4) Alternatively, the hole group reference can also be made to the first hole (3) or to the last hole (4). The drill holes are always dimensioned with relative measures at hole group reference, selection of coordinate measures, however, influences the dimension of hole group reference (2). Gusset-Plate Dimensioning Drill holes in gusset-plates of component part groups can be dimensioned as displayed in the example. In most cases, this dimensioning serves for drawing control, if single part drawings are generated. Longitudinal Direction (1) Here, the reference point of dimensioning is the edge of the plate. In addition, the dimensioning chain is completed to the system point (3). Transversal Direction (2) Here, the reference point of dimensioning is the system point (3); however, a reference to the edges of the plate is possible as well. The defaults are displayed as additional entry in the selection list for component part types of group dimensioning and therefore can be attached in addition to standard dimensioning of poly-plates.
Page C.2 - 89
Detailing Style
Group Dimensioning Area Selection List In the selection list you choose the dimensioning area you want to work on. The current values are entered in the input fields on the right. Global Area The global outer area of dimensioning. Local Area The local inner area of dimensioning; as vertical dimensions of a component part group are always local, they are controled here as well. Connection Area The local inner area of dimensioning at aligned dimensioning. Individual Dimensions... The different inner areas at individual dimensioning within component part groups, etc. Manual Dimension Points The areas of manual dimension points.
Group Distances Most data can be indicated here independently for horizontal, vertical and inner dimensioning direction. The fields on the left correspond to horizontal direction (main direction), the fields in the middle correspond to vertical direction (transversal direction), the fields on the right correspond to inner direction (independent direction). To 1st. Dim. Chain Here, you enter the distances from the outer limit of the st component up to the 1 dimension line.
Between Dim. Chains Here, you enter the distance between the individual dimension lines of an area succeeding the first line.
Page C.2 - 90
Detailing Style Construction Line to Component Here you enter the distance from the start of construction lines up to the outer limit of the component or of the dimensioning area in question. Entering the value 0 will not cut the construction lines at the edges but they are extended to the corresponding points to be dimensioned. If you selected Fixed Construction Line Length option, the meaning of the fields changes, and you enter the length of the dimension construction lines. Construction Line to Dim. Chain Here you enter the distance of the construction lines of a successive chain up to the previous dimension chain. Entering the value 0 will not cut the construction lines at the previous dimension chains but they are extended to the outer limit of the component or of the corresponding area to be dimensioned. Fixed Line Length If this field has been checked, the construction lines have exactly the length specified in the input fields Length of Construction Lines. If this field has not been checked, the dimension chains are cut at each other with the distances indicated in the distance fields. Here you indicate the minimum distance hole group dimensioning or subpart dimensioning may have up to the end of the component before it is moved to the outside.
Edge Horizontal
Group Tabular Survey In the diagram, you see a survey on all available settings to be able to control them at a glance. Information about horizontal and vertical dimension is summed up (Horizontal/Vertical). Rows Columns the different parameters for setting the different dimensioning areas
Please refer to the corresponding chapters of the introduction to dimensioning for the meaning of the different dimensioning areas and of individual dimensioning (nested dimensioning).
Page C.2 - 91
Detailing Style
Group Text Display No Inch Signs Adapt Text Size The inch signs are suppressed at dimensioning in the imperial system (foot/inches). A dimension chain is automatically changed to the style variant 1 Auto smaller (x0.7), if thus collisions can be avoided. If the dimension chain has already this style variant, no modification takes place. If a dimensioning style has been assigned to style variant 1, this style will be used instead, even if it wouldnt have such a favourable text height which might be! The text size for dimension chain labelling. This text is placed in front of the coordinate dimensions, if you have selected origin model as dimension reference. The horizontal distance of the RD symbol from the reference edge of the component part at American dimensioning. The size of the RD symbol at American dimensioning. Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text of the RD symbol has to be displayed at American dimensioning. Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text of the RD symbol has to be displayed at American dimensioning.
Page C.2 - 92
Detailing Style Colour Diameter Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text of the hole diameter has to be displayed.
Colour Gage Dimension Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text of the gage dimension has to be displayed Colour Mounting Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text of the mounting of subparts has to be displayed
Group Build Groups Same Dimensions Several consecutive identical distances are combined into one shared dimension, e.g. 3 dimensions 100 are combined into one dimension with the dimension text 3x100. Here, you specify the number of identical dimensions from which on they are combined in a group. Here, you specify which text has still to be added to the number (if you enter e.g. x, youll get 5x100).
Similar Dimension Lines Dimension chains containing few dimensions (e.g. one single drill hole) are integrated into another dimension chain. It may be that something different has been dimensioned in this other dimension chain (e.g. outer contour). The overall dimensions are excluded from this. Group Text Position Dont alternate Only Above Above and Below The text remains on its original height on the dimension line and is only optimized according to the other default settings. The text is moved only above the neighboring text so that they overlap horizontally, but not vertically. The text is moved above and below the dimension line so that they overlap horizontally, but not vertically.
Above Dim.Help Lines The text is moved across the construction help lines if it does not fit in between above the dimension line (even if otherwise not colliding with any other neighboring dimension). No text between... The text is supposed to be colliding and optimized if it does not fit in between above and below the dimension line (even if otherwise not colliding with any other neighboring dimension).
Page C.2 - 93
Detailing Style Move Outer Dimensions Outside The two outer dimensions are moved beside the dimension line in horizontal direction. Move Inner Dimension Horizontal The inner dimension texts are moved horizontally across the construction help lines into a neighboring dimension if there is enough place.
Group Distances Smallest Distance Here, you enter the smallest length to be dimensioned. If the distance to be dimensioned is smaller than this value, it will be added to the next dimension. In the field on the left you enter a value indicating how close together dimension texts within a dimension chain may be without triggering the collision alarm. In the field on the right you enter a value indicating how close together dimension texts may be at a neighboring dimension when moved into this. Thus, a movement can be avoided if there might be any possibility of confusion of dimensions due to the small distance.
Min. Dist. Between... Here, you enter a value indicating how close together dimension texts of different dimension chains may be without triggering the collision alarm. Sum up Here you enter the maximum distance up to which subpart dimension chains in transversal direction at groups are summed up to a common dimension chain.
Page C.2 - 94
Detailing Style Max.Snap Area Here, you enter the maximum distance up to which a component part is still assigned to the border area of a group. This influences the arrangement of dimension chains at local dimensioning.
Group Diagonals Angle Min./Max. Here you enter the minimum and maximum angle the shape must resp. is allowed to have towards main dimensioning direction to be recognized as diagonal. This option permits you to prevent that e.g. a roof girder is dimensioned as diagonal. Here, you enter the minimum length the shape must have to be recognized as diagonal. Shapes of flat steel are not recognized as diagonal and excluded from diagonal dimensioning. You can thus prevent that e.g. a top chord of a haunch is dimensioned as diagonal.
The picture below shows the different optimization settings for texts in dimension chains:
Page C.2 - 95
Detailing Style
Tab SingleParts
Group General Radius Circle radii of component contours are dimensioned. If defined, the subordinate radius style of the selected AutoCAD dimensioning style is used At selection of Standard option for the reference to the component part, the dimensioning is related to the reference point of the component part. Otherwise, it is related to the outside edges.
Reference Point
Page C.2 - 96
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach single part dimensions in the detail and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general descriptions of defaults for dimensioning chains. List of Dimensioning Groups The following dimensioning groups can be added:
Modifications Outer Contour Inner Contour Drill holes as plan view Drill holes as view Angle of intersection Radius center Special Dimensions Reference Points US-cope Part Groups Fittings Dimensions of the position of integrated fitting elements at concrete panels Dimensions of the position of the two reference points American lengths and depths for copes at the end Running of outer contour Running of inner contours (inner sections) Drill holes which can be seen as visible or invisible hole circle Drill holes which can be seen as intersection or hidden solid Diagonal edges of components in the outer contour Centers of radii in outer and inner contour
Page C.2 - 97
Detailing Style Special Forms of Dimensioning Apart from the usual dimension of outer contour and drill holes over length and width of the component part, you can select different other forms of dimensioning for single parts, too.
Outer Contour / Inner Contour Standard Individual outside Individual inside Standard + Individual outside Standard + Individual inside Min / Max Standard + Min / Max Drill Holes Common Reference to Edge Hole Groups Common + Edges Hole Groups + Edges Angle of Intersection Angle towards Vertical Line Angle towards Horizontal Line Bevel Symbol The angle towards the imaginary vertical reference line (opening angle) The angle towards the horizontal component direction (material angle) Bevel symbol (triangle) of the edge related to reference length or -height Normal dimensioning over the drill holes in dimensioning direction The holes are dimensioned to the next edge of the component part Groups of identical holes are dimensioned once in transversal direction Combination of standard dimensioning and reference to edge Combination of hole group dimensioning and reference to edge Normal dimensioning over the outer contour in dimensioning direction Each edge is individually dimensioned in its alignment; placing outside Each edge is individually dimensioned in its alignment; placing inside Combination of Standard and Individual edges outside Combination of Standard and Individual edges inside Min/Max contour dimensioning (see outer contour) Combination of Standard and Min/Max (see outer contour)
The following examples show you the results of the different extended forms of dimensioning for single parts: Reference to Edge (1) and Individual Edges (2) The holes are related perpendicularly to the following edge of the plate; the edges of a plate are dimensioned individually.
Page C.2 - 98
Detailing Style Min/Max (1) At a hollow shape, the maximum extension of the interior wall (A) is dimensioned with the dimension chain (C) and the minimum extension is dimensioned with the dimension chains B. Possible cut-outs havent any influence.
Min/Max (2) At a standard shape the longest exterior area on the upper and lower side is dimensioned with a single measure at a time despite the cut-outs.
Reference to Edge Inside/Outside The outer contour is dimensioned with the combination of standard dimensioning and individual edges inside (only the diagonal edges are dimensioned with individual measures). The inner contour is dimensioned with the combination of standard dimensioning and individual edges outside (all edges are always dimensioned with individual measures).
Common Drill Holes (1) The drill holes are dimensioned in a common dimension chain at the edge.
Hole Groups (2) Inner hole groups are dimensioned separately in their own dimension chains.
Page C.2 - 99
Detailing Style
Group General Equal Cope 1x Remarks Create Remarks > Up/Below > Start/End > Type Copes with the same dimensions are dimensioned only once. Generally added annotation (if need be, it is replaced by automatically created annotations). An annotation is automatically added to the dimensioning to indicate identical copes. Annotation which is added above and below in case of identical copes. Annotation which is added at the beginning and at the end in case of identical copes. Annotation which is added for more than two identical copes.
Group Left Side Measure Selection Here you indicate, whether the dimensioning of the cope has to be indicated in the form Length x Depth of cope or in the form depth x length of cope. This text is placed in front of the dimension. This text is added to the indicated measure.
Prefix Postfix
Detailing Style Group Right Side Measure Selection Here you indicate, whether the dimensioning of the cope has to be indicated in the form Length x Depth of cope or in the form depth x length of cope. This text is placed in front of the dimension. This text is added to the indicated measure.
Prefix Postfix
Dimensioning of cut-outs according to this scheme is often used in the USA and replaces a detailed dimensioning of outer contour for standard-shapes with copes at the end.
Detailing Style
Tab Groups
Group General Main Part > Main Part First The main part of the component part group is dimensioned with the most important dimensions like a single part. The first dimension chains in the global dimensioning area of the component part group are the dimension chains of the main part; otherwise the dimension chains of the subpart The dimension chains of the main part are attached directly to the component part. Normally, they are also attached in the global area. In case of very extensive groups it is however reasonable to select this option. The position of subparts in the group is dimensioned. Within a view, identical part dimensions are dimensioned only once in transversal direction. Otherwise, each subpart is again dimensioned redundantly. The additional tilt endplate details are dimensioned like a single part as well. The dimensioning of subparts is related to the reference point of the main part unless no other defaults were made at the corresponding places. Otherwise, it is related to the outside edges of the main part.
Detailing Style
Group Detail Dimensioning For Add-on Parts Subparts in component part groups are dimensioned in separate local areas together with the most important dimensions like single parts. You can enter further specifications on a separate page of this parameter group. Subgroups in component part groups are dimensioned in separate local areas together with the most important dimensions like component part groups. You can enter further specifications on a separate page of this parameter group.
For Subgroups
Dimensioning of Main and Subparts In the following examples, you see favourable selections for arranging main and subpart dimensioning in a component part group:
The standard setting, i.e. to dimension everything outside the group, is the optimal setting for this component part group. Main part dimensioning (1) is made first, followed then by subpart dimensioning (2). The flange of the haunch (3) however is dimensioned with local part reference.
Here, on the contrary, individual subpart dimensioning has been selected for the subparts (2) and for the main part (1) the dimensioning direct to part has been activated. Standard subpart dimensioning, however, has been deactivated.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail (front viw, plan view, etc.) and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains.
List of Dimensioning Groups The following special dimensions may be added apart from the different component part groups for shapes, poly-plates, etc already described in the introduction:
Special Dimensions Reference Points System Dimensions Diagonal Dimensions Manual Dimension Points Local reference planes Additional dim. gusset plate Position dimensions of the two reference points of the main part System dimensions of the components connected to the main part Length and system dimensions for diagonal shapes Manual dimensioning objects from the 3D model for groups Position of reference planes (connecting shapes) at reference to the connecting shape Additional dimension for drill holes in gusset plates
Detailing Style Special Forms of Dimensioning Some additional dimensionings for diagonal shapes as well as system dimensions may be added via special dimensions. System points here are the points of intersection of the center axes of connected shape and reference shape.
Diagonal Dimensions Length System distance System length System Dimensions On system position Own dim. chain (secondary) Primary dim. chain (secondary) System point Plate edge The position of the dimension chains depends on the position towards the axis of the main part System dimensions of secondary position always get their own dim. chain System dimensions of primary/secondary position only get one dim. chain Reference to the system point of reference part and hole field direction Reference to the plate edge situated next in hole field direction Overall length of the diagonal Distance of the end points to the system point which is situated next Distance of system points
Diagonal and System Dimensions Here you can see some examples of diagonal and system point dimensioning: Diagonal Dimensions Here you see the length of a diagonal (1), its distances to the two system points (2) and the system length (3). In addition, dimensioning of the system points (4) of the main part has been added.
System Dimensions Here you see the system dimensions of connecting shapes which are in primary (1) and secondary (2) position to the main part. Separated dimesion chains have been selected.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach single part dimensions in the tilt endplates of the detail and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for single part reference points.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach add-on dimensions in the section views of the detail and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for group reference points.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach individual single parts dimensions in the main views of the detail. You also determine which fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views. The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here. For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of the default settings for individual dimensioning.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for single parts reference points.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the subgroups for which you want to attach individual add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views. Filtering is made via the main part of the subgroup. The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here. For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of the default settings for individual dimensioning.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the add-on parts for which you want to attach individual add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail (front view, plan view, etc.) and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for groups reference points.
Detailing Style
Tab Assemblies
Group Detail Dimensioning For Add-on Parts Loose single parts in assemblies are dimensioned like single parts in their own local areas together with the most important dimensions. You can enter further instructions on a separate page of this parameter group. Groups in assemblies are dimensioned like groups in their own local areas together with the most important dimensions. You can enter further instructions on a separate page of this parameter group. Subgroups in assemblies are dimensioned like groups in their own local areas together with the most important dimensions. You can enter further instructions on a separate page of this parameter group.
For Groups
For Subgroups
> Parameter Selection Here you indicate which area of reference points in groups has to be used for dimensioning of subgroups. Like Groups The settings for the reference points of standard add-on parts are used. Like Subgroups The settings for the reference points of addon parts in subgroups are used. Depending on the importance of the subgroup, you thus obtain a uniform dimensioning at multiply nested groups within an assembly.
Detailing Style Components of Structural Dimensioning Assemblies are the most complex structure within ProSteel. Dimensioning accordingly is rather extensive if you make use of all possibilities offered by individual dimensioning. All directly subordinate structures within the assembly are treated like one single component part, i.e. a complete group is dimensioned on its maximum dimensions. If you want to dimension the inner structure of such a group, use individual dimensioning instead. Since group dimensioning including possible subgroups requires a great number of parameters, no separate independent parameter record will be available any more in the part area assemblies. In this case, the program falls back on the settings for groups.
The following picture shows the reduction to subordinate structures. You see the complete assembly (1), the group (2) contained in the assembly and the subgroup (3) which again is contained in the group.
Detailing Style If you now look on the different sharets of dimensioning, you will recognize very well that the different areas are independent of each other. Since you can globally deactivate complete areas, even complex structures can be clearly set without losing track. Basic Dimensioning The group here is considered as a whole and globally dimensioned using the default settings Reference Points. Each individual dimensioning of the assembly has been deactivated. Group Dimensioning Here, the basic dimensioning has been deactivated and the individual dimensioning for groups in assemblies has been selected. For groups the dimensioning of subgroups contained in these groups has been deactivated. Subgroup Dimensioning Here, the basic dimensioning has been deactivated and the individual dimensioning for groups in assemblies has been selected. There, however, all add-on parts have been deactivated and only the individual dimensioning of subgroups has been selected.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the component parts or main and subgroups for which you want to attach individual add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail (front view, plan view, etc.) and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. A complete group is dimensioned over its outer dimensions like a single component part. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for groups reference points.
List of Dimensioning Groups The following special dimensions may be added apart from the different component part groups for shapes and poly-plates, as well as a general group already described in the introduction:
Special Dimensions Diagonal Dimensions Manual Dimension Points Length and system dimensions for loose diagonal shapes Manual dimensioning objects from the 3D model for assemblies
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the groups for which you want to attach individual add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views. Filtering is made via the main part of the group. The groups can either be standard component part groups (these are groups which themselves can contain subgroups) or they are explicitely named subgroups on the same hierarchy level as the standard component part groups. The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here. For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for individual dimensioning. No separate independent parameter record is available for the individual dimensioning in assemblies. In this case, the program falls back on the parameters for groups or subgroups in component part groups. If it is an individual dimensioning of single parts, the corresponding parameter record for groups will be used as well. Apart from a reduction of parameters a constant drawing view of component part groups between (a) complete assemblies with individual dimensioning or (b) individually displayed component part groups of this assembly will be guaranteed by this assuming that both groups are using the same detailing style.
Detailing Style
Tab ConnectingGusset
Settings Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach individual single part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views. The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here. For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for individual dimensioning. The details of connecting gussets mainly show the connection elements such as endplates, webangles etc. of the connections. The involved main shapes are only displayed as section. Therefore, dimensioning is limited to an individual dimensioning of the involved connection elements and of the final detailings of shapes.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine the dimension points and the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimension chains as well as to the default settings for single parts reference points.
The neighboring figure shows a gusset built out of the endplate connection of two girders and a support. Dimensioning of drill holes in the view is related to the system axis of the connected girders. Reference to edge has been selected for the cut-out in the shape. The filters of individual dimensioning permit a perfect separation of the settings also they have the parameter record in common.
Detailing Style
Tab Views
Group General Connect Dimensions Similar inner dimension chains which are situated close together are connected to one common dimension chain each. At System Axis Outer Edge Steel Display Areas Only the distances of the axes of the outer shapes or of the constructional axes are considered as overall dimensions. The meaning of the option At System Axis also refers to the reference point View of dimensioning. The determined dimension areas (if local areas have been activated) are displayed in colour for control purposes. This option is only an auxiliary for the configuration of the local areas and should normally be deactivated.
Group Filter For Outside Edge Steel Here, you have the possibility to exclude certain parts from the calculation of outer dimensions to prevent it from increasing e.g. by the projection of base plates. Endplates horizontal End and base plates in horizontal direction (width) are not taken into consideration. Endplates vertical End and base plates in vertical direction (height) are not taken into consideration.
Detailing Style Poly-plates horizontal Poly-plates and stiffeners in horizontal direction are not taken into consideration. Poly-plates vertical Poly-plates and stiffeners in vertical direction are not taken into consideration. Counter Type horizontal The shape type opposite to the view (i.e. at views the shapes in cross-section display and at plan view the shapes in view display) in horizontal direction is not taken into consideration. Counter Type vertical The shape type opposite to the view (i.e. at views the shapes in cross-section display and at plan view the shapes in view display) in vertical direction is not taken into consideration.
Group Dimensioning Areas Dimensioning Area Here, you determine the principle method for component part dimensioning in views. Standard All shapes are dimensioned outside the view. Only Outside Shapes which are situated in the defined outside area are dimensioned outside the view. All other shapes are not dimensioned. Outside and Inside Shapes which are situated in the defined outside area are dimensioned outside the view. Shapes which are situated in the remaining inside area of the view are locally dimensioned. Outside and Area Analysis Local inside areas of the view are automatically determined according to your defaults. Shapes which are situated in the defined outside area are dimensioned outside the view. Shapes which are situated in the determined inside areas are locally dimensioned. You can give additional information on a separate page of this parameter group. For more detailed information about inside and outside areas of a view, please refer to the general explanations of local areas in overviews. Area Sizes Here, you indicate the distance from the corresponding outer edge of the view to the inside up to which a shape is still assigned to the outer area.
Detailing Style > Outer Fields > Inner Field Here you enter the distances of left, right, lower and upper side individually. Here, you enter the size of the sections into which a local inner area is additionally subdivided. Each section can contain its own local dimension chains. The size is an approximate value and can be bigger or smaller in reality. If you enter the value 0, the areas are not subdivided any more. For more detailed information about inner and outer areas of a view, please refer to the general explanations concerning local areas in overviews.
Filter for Overall Dimension Normaly, ProSteel uses all shapes to determine the outer dimensions. For practice-oriented dimensioning of overviews, however, it is often reasonable to exclude certain shapes from the determination of overall dimensions. The example shows a typical form of dimensioning, when e.g. the outer dimensions are taken from drawings which are part of a quotation or which have been realized by an architect and these shall be found in the approved plans. Base Plates (1) The base plates are included into the determination in vertical direction, but excluded in horizontal direction. Counter Type (2) The wall latch-bolts are also excluded in horizontal direction. As the type of overview drawing is a view (global Zdirection visible), the cross-sections are the counter type.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach overview dimensions in the view and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chains. List of Dimensioning Groups The following special dimensions may be added apart from the different component part groups for shapes and poly-plates, as well as a general group already described in the introduction:
Special Dimensions Construction Axes Outer Edge Steel Diagonal Dimensions Manual Dimension Points The existing construction axes (frame working area) of the view Outer dimensions of steel construction related to the border axes Length and system dimensions for diagonal shapes Manual dimensioning objects from the 3D model for overviews
Detailing Style Special Forms of Dimensioning Dimensioning of overviews differs a bit from dimensioning of groups with regard to possible reference points and position of dimension chains, especially if local areas are used. For the dimension points (target points), however, nearly the same possibilities are available as at shapes in construction groups.
Reference Connection Start View Start Construction Axes Start Area Edge View Edge Construction Axes Edge Area Component Part Next Construction Axis Additional Dimensions View Construction Axes View + Construction Axes Area Middle Middle Top / Left Middle Bottom / Right Half Top / Left Half Bottom / Right Top / Left Bottom / Right To Inside To Outside Each Alignment Only if horizontal Only if vertical Only if orthogonal Only if diagonal Outer edges of the overall view in dimensioning direction Utmost visible construction axes in dimensioning direction Outer edges and utmost visible construction axes in dimensioning direction Outer edgesof the corresponding local area in dimensioning direction Geometrical center of the area A little bit above resp. left of the geometrical center of the area A little bit below resp. right of the geometrical center of the area In the middle of the upper resp. left half of the area In the middle of the lower resp. right half of the area Above resp. left of the area Below resp. right of the area Near area edge seen from the center of the overall view Far away area edge seen from the center of the overall view Dimensioning in each alignment towards the reference direction Only dimensioning if part horizontal (parallel) towards reference direction Only dimensioning if part vertical (perpend.) towards reference direction Only dimensioning if part rectangular towards reference direction Only dimensioning I fpart diagonal towards reference direction Left resp. lower side of the overall view Extreme left resp. lower visible construction axis Left resp. lower side of the corresponding local area Side of the overall view which is situated next Outer visible construction axis which is situated next Side of the corresponding local area which is situated next Extreme left resp. lower dimension point which is used (self reference) The next visible construction axis in dimensioning direction
Detailing Style
Area Assignment (Only Inner Area) According to Belonging Separate Outer Area Common Outer Area Position of dimension chains in the belonging outer or inner area Position of dimension chains in the outer area, separate dimension chain for inner area Position of dimension chains in the outer area, common dimensions
In the following figure, you see a simple example for dimensioning a view including construction axes display. The first dimension chain from above shows the dimensioning of the shapes related to the construction axes, the second dimension chain shows the dimensioning of the construction axes and the third dimension chain shows the dimensioning of outer edge steel (2600). The overall dimension (3000) is measured over the outer axes. Construction axes 1 and 3 could be hidden in the settings for overviews. In this case, they wouldnt be dimensioned.
Detailing Style
Settings Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single part dimensions in the anchor details and determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains. For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of defaults for dimensioning chain and of defaults settings for single part reference points.
Reference to next Constructional Axis The holes of the anchor plates refer to the construction axis which is situated next.
Reference to Connecting Shape The holes refer to the center of support. The center of support itself refers to the construction axis which is situated next.
Coordinate Dimensions The coordinate dimensions refer to the absolute position in the plan view (origin of axes dimensioning).
Detailing Style
Group Analysis Shapes Analyse Type Here, you determine how to define the final local areas from the analysis. Main Direction Only the analysed main direction of dimensioning is used to build an area. Transversal Direction Only the analysed transversal direction of dimensioning is used to build an area. Overlay Single New areas are built by overlaying the areas of the analysed main and transversal direction. Overlay Groups New areas are built by overlaying the areas of the analysed main and transversal direction. Then, bordering areas are new combined. The minimum number of direction-determining shapes which must exist when comparing the length classes in one direction to decide which is the main direction of dimensioning. The relative difference in length with regard to the longest shape of a higher class to permit building of a new lower class The minimum length of the shape to be used for analysis at all The maximum distance of one shape end to the other to be connected to an imaginary continuous shape. The maximum offset of the center axes of two parallel shapes to be connected to an imaginary continuous shape.
Min. Count
Detailing Style
Group Extend/Combine Area Max. Distance to Border horizontally If the distance to the next bordering edge in analysis direction is smaller than this value, the previous area in this direction will be extended up to the new border. Max. Distance to Border vertically If the distance to the next bordering edge transversal to the current analysis direction is smaller than this value, the previous area in this direction will be extended up to the new border. Combine Max. Wide Width a section (disk) at least has to have in analysis direction to be processed as separate area. Otherwise, the previous area will be extended perpendicularly completely up to each of these borders if the width is also bigger than the value brought into line. Max. Distance for Collect Maximum distance between two areas which came into being by overlaying to be collected again to a common area. Min. Number of Border Shapes This number of direction-determining shapes of high classes has to be used at least for building the borders of the area. Otherwise, the shapes of the next lower class will be used as well. Min. Total Size Minimum length and width of a new area by overlaying. Smaller areas are assigned to the previous neighboring area.
Method of Analysis The analysis of the local areas is made by cutting the whole view in thought in several disks. These are limited by those shapes which visually appear as continuous shapes. The resulting imaginary shape lengths are classified according to their length and starting with the longest class the number of direction-determining shapes is compared until a clear majority is found. This determines the cutting direction and thus (perpendicular to it) the main direction of dimensioning.
Detailing Style Now the possible sections are collected in analysis direction via pre-defined minimum widths. The final area size is limited by the shapes which are running transversally to the cutting direction. Finally, possibly existing bordering edges are brought into line. An overlaying permits to build new areas out of the intersection of main and transversal direction. Here, too a collection and bringing into line can be made (however only in cutting direction). Thus, empty areas (e.g. notches) are better taken into consideration. Unfortunately, there is no generally applicable solution with fixed parameters which can be used for all kinds of constructions. Therefore, it is inevitable to make some experiments with the parameters, especially in case of complexe constructions, until a favourable division is reached.
Detailing Style
Tab PositionFlags
Group General Pos. Flags First Only 1st Part View The position flags are attached before part dimensioning so that they are near the part. In case of several partial views of a detail, the position flags are only attached to the first view (except for possible 2D cuts and folded end plates). Position flags are also attached to all 2D-cuts. Position flags are not attached to component parts, which are visible as cross-sections in the view. A position flag is also attached to polyplates and stiffeners in model-views (overviews). Here, you select the aligment of the position flags in the detail drawing. Horizontal all position flags are aligned horizontally. Vertical all position flags are aligned vertically. According to style all position flags are aligned as indicated in the distribution style.
Detailing Style Group Position Flags For Main Parts For Group Parts A position flag is attached to the main parts of construction groups. A position flag is attached to the subparts of construction groups.
For loose Single Parts A position flag is attached to the component parts not belonging to a group. For Bolts A position flag is attached to the bolts of a construction group. Pos.Flag Template Here, you select the template for automatic distribution of position flags. The template controls what has to be displayed in the individual position flags, how the flag is structured and according to which criteria the distribution in the detail or in the view is effected. You create a distribution template in the positioning command and only load it here. Click on this button to move directly to the dialog tab for setting the distribution templates. You can modify the selected template or create new ones. Please note that you have to save a modified template first before the modifications become valid.
Detailing Style
Tab WeldingSymbols
Group General At End Plates The welding symbols of the inserted welding joints are displayed in single parts views for base and endplates, if the connection shape is shown, too. The welding symbols of the inserted welding joints are displayed in group views. The welding symbols of the inserted welding joints are displayed in group views for folded end plates.
Group Welding Symbols Pos. Flag Template Here, you select the template for automatic distribution of welding symbols. The template controls what has to be displayed in the individual welding symbols, how the flag is structured and according to which criteria the distribution in the detail or in the view is effected. You create a distribution template in the positioning command and only load it here. Click on this button to move directly to the dialog tab for setting the distribution templates. You can modify the selected template or create new ones. Please note that you have to save a modified template first before the modifications become valid.
Detailing Style
Group Sorting You will find the meaning of the different settings in the description of distributing position flags in the chapter about positioning.
Group Options Group Flags > Group Distance Flags having the same content are combined to a common flag if they are situated within group distance. Distance two identical flags may have to be combined to a common flag.
> Always Guideline For each flag for which a guideline is created; otherwise only one guideline will be created altogether for the combined flags. Layer Layer on which the welding symbols have to be created.
Detailing Style
Tab AdditionalText
Group Detail Description Partial View Scale The name of the partial view is displayed. The detailing scale is displayed. If you have selected Partial View and Scale, both are used to create an entry in the form of "Front View (M1: 10)". Here, you specify which text is positioned in front of the scale (if you enter e.g. M 1:, you will get M 1:10). The total quantity of component parts in the model is displayed. Of course the quantity of parts is only valid after previous positioning. Here, you specify which text is still added to the number (if you enter e.g. x, you will get 5x). If you want to have an independant text for number 1, you indicate the complete output separated by comma in front of the postfix (e.g.SINGLE,x). The name of the component part or view is displayed. The length of the component part is displayed. The material designation of the component part is displayed. If you have simultaneously checked Shape Description', 'Shape Length' and Material' , all are used to create an entry in the form of "HE 200 B...7800 RST-37-2".
> Postfix
Detailing Style Change Note Position No. > Prefix Shipping No. Remarks The modification status of the component part is displayed. The position number of the component part is displayed. Here, you specify which text has to be positioned in front of the position number. The shipping number of the component part is displayed. Comments are displayed, which have been assigned to the part e.g. with "Change Properties".
Group Language Standard One Language Two Languages The drawing is exclusively labeled in the original language of the program installation. The drawing is labeled in the language chosen as First Language in the selection list. The drawing is labeled in the two languages chosen as First Language and Second Language in the selection list. The two terms are displayed separately, divided by oblique stroke, e.g. "Ansicht A / view A". The selection 'Standard' as language corrsponds to the original language of the program installation.
The translation of the terms is based on a translation database with a translation 1:1. If the corresponding term is not defined there, the original language of the program installation is used instead. If there are identical terms at bi-lingual labeling, only one term will be displayed.
Group Text Sizes Normal Text Text Scale Text at Shape Text Style Here you enter the text size for the label. Here, you enter the text sizes for the position number, view and scale text. Here, you enter the text size for the text label at shapes in overviews. Select the text style (script) which has to be used for displaying the text entries in the selection list.
Detailing Style
Group Construction Axis Display Axis The axes descriptions of the work frames perpendicular towards the current view are displayed. Text sizes and display form are adopted from the work frame properties. The actual axis is also displayed as 2D-line in the corresponding view. Only those axes are displayed which are situated within the determined overall dimensions of the view including a snap range. Here, you enter the relative length of the axis line (in %) related to the overall dimensions. Normally, the axis line is running towards the outer edges of the display (= 100%). If you enter a value bigger than 100, the line will be extended over these edges. If you enter a value between 1 and 100, the line will only partly be displayed from the bottom resp. from the left, e.g. to hint only at it in views. Here, you enter the distance of axes label towards the last outer dimension chain. Here, you enter a snap range up to which the axes situated outside the overall dimensions are still displayed.
Length (%)
Detailing Style Group Shape Label Display Labels > Also End Plates > Also Flats Component part name and material are written to the corresponding shape at overviews. Base and end plates are labeled as well. Shapes out of flat steel are labeled as well.
> Also Cross-Sections Shapes which are seen as cross-sections are labeled as well. > Distance from Plane The relative position of the upper edge or front edge of the shape is added to the corresponding view plane unless being situated at the same level. Default Text Here you can indicate an additional text for the elevation. The variable $(E) will be replaced by the current measured value. The text O.K.=$(E) will then e.g. be displayed as O.K.=+50.
Dialog-Commands
FILTER By clicking on this button, you can define a filter of your own from other parts properties apart from the previously defined filters of the group Shape Labeling. Then, a dialog opens for entering the filter condition. The filter settings are identical with the filter for selection of parts to be displayed in overviews. Please refer to this chapter for description (see also: 2DDisplay/Views).
Detailing Style
Detailing Style
DetailCenter Express
C.3
DetailCenter Express
The DetailCenter-Express! is an extension of the DetailCenter to carry out recurring detailing tasks as fast as possible. In the actual DetailCenter, you can make exact detailing settings and you can decide for each component part separately whether and how it has to be detailed and placed on drawings. On the other hand, the DetailCenter Express! works off the complete detailing according to a pre-set pattern. Start such a detailing pattern with the preparation of the model for detailing and complete it with clearance work functions after insertion of the 2D-details in the workshop plans. You can define the patterns for different tasks by means of templates and then carry out the detailing with a single mouse click . As you perhaps know already from the installation assistants of this and other programs, the DetailCenter Express! will guide you through the necessary settings for the detailing pattern. You only can start detailing after having made all necessary settings. For this purpose, the dialog offers you different pages one after the other which can vary depending on your default settings. In this manual, we can therefore only describe any possible pages in the order of their being displayed. It can, also be that one or more pages dont exist due to your default settings.
Page C.3 - 1
DetailCenter Express
Click on this button to display the following page. Click on this button to start detailing. Detailing will be worked off according to your current settings. In the selection pages, you can watch in a display what is in process at the very moment. It is true that you can work with AutoCAD or other applications during detailing process, depending on the computing capacity of your hardware. We recommend, refraining from this! After the DetailCenter Express! has completed its work, you are informed about it in an info box.
Page C.3 - 2
DetailCenter Express
Starting Page
This page is always displayed first. Here, you will set which tasks have to be done for you by the DetailCenter Express!
Here, you specify which corrections have to be made first before style assignments and detailing will be started. Here, you can connect loose single parts and group parts with detail styles. Here, you can connect standard groups and subgroups with detail styles. Here, you can connect assemblies with detail styles. Here, you can connect views of work fields as well as plan and top views and anchor plans with detail styles.
Page C.3 - 3
DetailCenter Express
Here, you can have the parts detailed as detail blocks. Here, you can insert detailed detail blocks into workshop plans or activate the single sheet drawing output of details. If single sheet drawing has been selected, the parts will be detailed in any case. Detailing therefore has not to be activated extra. Here, you can set which corrections still have to be made after end of detailing.
Clean Up
To give you an example: If you want to put out all stiffeners and plates as well as the groups as DIN A-4 single sheet drawings, independent of already existing style assignments, select the following entries on the starting page: Prepare Detailing (to delete former assignments), Connect Single Parts with Detail Style, Connect Groups with Detail Style and Insert Detail Blocks/Single Sheet Drawings. There you will make the further settings. Please note that the DetailCenter Express! always works off the complete component parts list. The list is worked on as if you had transferred the complete model for detailing.
Prepare Detailing
On this page, you will set which tasks have to be done before starting all further steps.
Page C.3 - 4
DetailCenter Express
Cancel Write Protection Any existing markings are cancelled. Thus you can be sure that all component parts will be seized by the following actions, if desired. Delete All detail styles, which have already been assigned before, will be separated from the parts. Thus you can be sure that a detail style will be assigned only to the component parts selected in the DetailCenter Express!. All modify flags set by the program will be reset to initialize the model. All pointers referring to detailed or inserted detail blocks entered in the model drawing will be deleted. Former detail blocks in the detail library of the model will be deleted.
If all fields on this page have been checked, your model drawing will be completely initialized. It is the same as if a detailing never took place before. Depending on the time of application of the DetailCenter Express! it is, however, also reasonable to exclude some points.
Page C.3 - 5
DetailCenter Express
Upper List
Here, you choose the desired detail style to assign to the corresponding component part type. The parts can of course only be recognized as such if they were created, with the corresponding ProSteel functions. Here, you select the component part type you want to assign a detail style to. Here, you see the current assignments. These can be removed again or modified. Click on this button to assign the detail style displayed in the selection list to the component part selected in the left or right list. Click on this button to cancel the assignment of the component part type checked in the right list.
At style selection, you can differentiate between the detail styles currently existing in the model drawing and the detail styles saved on the hard drive. If you select a detail style from the hard drive (marked with a [HD:] put first, e.g. [HD:] plates), it will be automatically loaded and it will replace the style possibly existing in the drawing.
Page C.3 - 6
DetailCenter Express
Upper List
Here, you choose the desired detail style to assign to the corresponding group type of standard groups. The type depends on the main part of the group; for subgroups, however, only a common detail style can be used.
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
Page C.3 - 7
DetailCenter Express
Upper List
Here, you choose the desired detail style to assign to all assemblies and connecting gussets existing in the model.
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
Page C.3 - 8
DetailCenter Express
Upper List
Here, you choose the desired detail style to assign to the corresponding view.
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
Page C.3 - 9
DetailCenter Express
Part Family Single Part At the connection of single parts, the program first uses the style of a part family assigned to this part. If there isnt any part family assigned, or if this part family hasnt a detail style of its own, the standard assignment will be used. Part Family Group At the connection of groups and subgroups, the program first uses the style of a part family assigned to this group. If there isnt any part family assigned, or if this part family hasnt a detail style of its own, the standard assignment will be used. Assignment An already existing style assignment of the part will not be overwritten. A detail style is only assigned to parts without any detail style.
Page C.3 - 10
DetailCenter Express
Detailing
On this page, you make the default settings, how the component parts have to be detailed. If you choose the automatic single sheet output, you dont have to make any additional settings here.
Only one detail block is created of each position number, divided into single parts and groups. Detail blocks of the same part existing in the detail library are overwritten. Here, you select which component parts or component part groups are to be detailed, if a detail style has been assigned to them. This can be the complete detail or even only some components of a detail..
Component Parts Selection The following details or components of a detail can be individually selected or dropped:
Overviews Assemblies ...main groups ...subgroups ...single parts Groups ...main parts ...build. components ...subgroups Other single parts Connecting gusset model views, horizontal projection, anchorage plan etc. as overview drawing complete assembly as assembly drawing groups in assemblies as group drawing subgroups in assemblies as group drawing single parts in assemblies as single part drawing complete group or loose subgroup as group drawing main parts in groups or in loose subgroups as single part drawing building components in groups or in loose subgroups as single part drawing subgroups in groups as group drawing loose single parts not belonging to a group as single part drawing connecting gusset as gusset detail
Page C.3 - 11
DetailCenter Express
Insert Details
On this page, you make the default settings, how the worked out detail blocks have to be inserted into the drawing. In addition to the actual insertion task, the DetailCenter Express! also permits to fill in the frame field of the drawing frame as well as to create a parts list. You can select the drawing frame etc. on the following pages.
A drawing will be created for each single detail block. At single sheet output, the existing detail scale is adopted to the drawing sheet (the default setting of the detail style is ignored). At single sheet output, a suitable drawing frame is searched for the existing detail block. several details are automatically arranged on a drawing sheet according to your default settings. The title block of the drawing frame is filled with the corresponding specifications. on the drawing frame, a list is created displaying the information about belonging of the parts (e.g. in which groups a certain single part is contained). A parts list of the displayed details is created on the drawing frame (parts list related to the drawing).
Parts List
US Mark Number At insertion, the US mark number is directly created according to the current setting in the DetailCenter.
Page C.3 - 12
DetailCenter Express
Page C.3 - 13
DetailCenter Express
Left List
Here, you select which component parts or component part groups are to be detailed and inserted, if a detail style has been assigned to them. This can be the complete detail or even only some components of a detail.
For more detailed information about the drawing frames and how to prepare them for the output of title block and parts lists, please refer to the chapter Automatic Single Sheet Output further on in this manual.
Page C.3 - 14
DetailCenter Express
All detail blocks belonging to an assembly are inserted in one or several sheets. All detail blocks belonging to a group or subgroup are inserted on one or more sheets. The created detail blocks are sorted ascending by their position number and then inserted into the drawing. Single parts, group details and overviews are inserted separately on different drawings.
Page C.3 - 15
DetailCenter Express
The detail blocks are inserted in lines or in columns into the drawing. Maximum number of failed insertions before the output is continued on the next page. 0 means that, if a detail block doesnt fit on the sheet, the detail block is immedia tely inserted on a new sheet. Grating for the insertion algorithm in X-direction; the bigger the selected value, the faster the dispatch is carried out. Grating for the insertion algorithm in Y-direction Minimum distance of one detail block to the other
Page C.3 - 16
DetailCenter Express
The component parts are displayed without scale. The settings in the detail style are ignored. You can specify different drawing frames for groups and polyplates. You can specify another frame for details in upright format. Here you see the file on which the valid drawing scales are based if you have selected the option Optimized Scale at single sheet output. . Here you see the file on which the valid drawing frame definitions are based. Here you see the file on which the valid definitions for US mark numbering are based if you have selected the option Use US Mark Numbering. Here you see the directory where the finished workshop drawings are stored.
Output Path
You may modify the files and paths of the templates by clicking on the small button on the right beside the corresponding display.
Page C.3 - 17
DetailCenter Express
Selection Lists
Here, you choose the desired frame type for the output. Only the borders defined in the sheet pattern file will be displayed. It is always the set standard frame which will be used under Drawing Frame unless there is an exception for the corresponding detail at single sheet output. At multi sheet output, you principally can only specify one drawing frame.
Page C.3 - 18
DetailCenter Express
Model Data
The order data for the frame field are transferred from the drawing information table of the models. Otherwise, another page will be displayed where you can specify the most important order data.
Store Drawing Number The file name of the workshop drawing is identical with the drawing number in the frame field. Otherwise, the current position number is used at single sheet output or a describing name at compilations. Drawing Count User Variable Here, you enter the page number for the drawing which has to be created next. Here, you can enter any text you like which will be entered into your drawing number, depending on whether you make use of the corresponding variable or not.
Drawing Number Here, you can indicate another definition of the number if you temporarily want to modify the default of your sheet pattern file.
Page C.3 - 19
DetailCenter Express
Drawing Name
Here, you can indicate another definition of the drawing name, if you temporarily want to modify the default of your sheet pattern file. Here, the current definition of the drawing number of the sheet pattern file is displayed for your information. Here, you see the current continuous number for your information.
The variables at drawing number and drawing name permit you a mixed structure of fixed and current values. Please refer to the chapter 'Automatic Single Sheet Output' for a description of the templates for drawing number and drawing name and the used variables.
Page C.3 - 20
DetailCenter Express
Input Fields
Here, you can enter the desired data. Then, they are inserted into the frame field.
Page C.3 - 21
DetailCenter Express
Clean Up Detailing
On this page, you make the default settings, which tasks have to be done after end of detailing or style assignment.
Remove
All detail styles, which are not connected with a detail, will be removed from the model drawing. Copies on the hard drive are saved. Entries existing of manual assignments in the view list of DetailCenter will be deleted. All inserted detail blocks existing in the detail library will be deleted. If this field is not activated, the detail blocks e.g. of the single sheet output can still be used for other purposes. The model drawing is saved after completion of the DetailCenter Express! Otherwise, you have to save it manually to avoid that the information about the worked out and inserted details will be lost.
Save
Page C.3 - 22
DetailCenter Express
Scale File
If you selected the Optimized Scale option, the scale selection of the program is based on the entries in the scale file. You can thus create specific files for different customers and be sure that no other scales will be used at the output. In the DetailCenter Express! you can create specific defaults with different files for your customers. The file is a text file having the extension .scl, which can also contain some comments marked with a semicolon at the beginning of the line. The default file is in the subordinate folder of your ProSteel installation.
Page C.3 - 23
DetailCenter Express
Structure of a Sheet Template File The file is divided into the areas header, frame field attributes and the actual frame definitions. All entries consist of a group name in pointed brackets and the data group of keyword, equals sign and the following data.
[GROUP NAME] Keyword1=Data1 Keyword2=Data2 ...
You neednt fill in entries, which are not required, or the complete entry can be omitted.
Page C.3 - 24
DetailCenter Express 1) Header Area, Group Name [HEADER] You enter a short name under the keyword Name (for later program options) and a short file description under the keyword Description. The description will then be displayed in the selection page of the DetailCenter Express! 2) Frame Field Attributes, Group Name [TITLEBLOCK] Here, you specify which current program data will be transferred into which block attribute of the frame field at running time. You can thus even specify your own defined frame fields with your own attributes. For more detailed information about how to assign block attributes to blocks, please refer to your AutoCADdocumentation. You can assign block attributes to the following keywords. Depending on the settings in the DetailCenter Express! these are filled with the current values (Express) or with the drawing information of the model drawing. In addition, you can connect some of the properties of the corresponding detail with block attributes. This allows you e.g. to refrain from a position flag or detail labelling at single parts and thus to obtain more space for display.
FileName Customer ProjectName ProjectNumber JobName JobNumber DrawingName DrawingNumber DrawingPage DrawingIndex DrawingScale DoneBy Date CheckedBy CheckedDate ClearedBy ClearedDate Specification 1-4 Note 14 DetailPosNumber DetailShipNumber DetailName DetailMaterial DetailLength DetailWeight DetailCount DetailNote DetailFamilyClass complete path of the created 2D-drawing (Express). client (Express). project name of the model project number of the model order (Express) or order name of the model. order number (Express) or number of order number of the model. component part description with position number (Express) or drawing name of the model. drawing number (Express) or drawing number of the model. sheet number (Express). drawing index (Express) or drawing index of the model. scale (Express). 'done by' (Express) or 'signed by' of the model. 'done on' (Express) or 'signed on' of the model. 'checked by' of the model. 'checked on' of the model. 'cleared by' of the model. 'cleared on' of the model. 'LV Pos 1' etc. of the model. 'comment 1' etc. of the model position number of the detail shipping number of the detail designation of the detail material designation of the detail length of the detail total weight of the detail total number of the detail note field 1 and 2 of the detail component part family name of the detail
Page C.3 - 25
DetailCenter Express 3) Drawing Number Definition, Group Name [DRAWINGNUMBER] Here, you define according to which pattern the drawing number and the file name of the drawing have to be structured. You can mix fixed and variable parts and build the designations of variables as you like, (in order to avoid e.g. identical names with used terms). In the first two entries Drawing Number Template and Filename Template you indicate the definition, consisting of fixed values and the variable symbols which are mentioned in the following. You may use your own template for the file name if your drawing number has to contain signs, which mustnt be used in a Windows-file name. If you dont fill in the field 'Filename Template', the specified drawing number will be used instead as file name.
Drawing Name Template DrawingNumberTemplate FileNameTemplate ProjectNumberSymbol JobNumberSymbol DrawingNumberSymbol DrawingPageSymbol DrawingIndexSymbol DwgNumberCodeSymbol PositionNumberSymbol GroupPositionNumberSymbol ObjectNameSymbol ObjectTypeSymbol YearSymbol MonthSymbol DaySymbol DrawingTypeSymbol UserVarSymbol DefaultObjectType ColumnObjectType BeamObjectType StiffenerObjectType WebAngleObjectType StandardPlateObjectType ConnectionPlateObjectType BasePlateObjectType MainPartDrawingType SubPartDrawingType GroupDrawingType SinglePartDrawingType OverviewDrawingType definition for the drawing name definition for the drawing number definition for the file name variable for the project number variable for the order number variable for the drawing number of drawing information variable for the continuous sheet number variable for the modification index variable for the frame code of the frame definitions variable for the position number of the detail variable for the position number of the parent group variable for the component part name variable for the component part type variable for the current year variable for the current month (numeric, 1-12) variable for the current day (numeric, 1-31) variable for the drawing-type variable for the free text from the fill frame field dialog text for component part type, Others except the following types text for component part type, Support text for component part type, Horizontal support text for component part type, Stiffener text for component part type, Web angle text for component part type, Poly-plate text for component part type, Head-plate text for component part type, Base plate text for drawing type, single part drawing for main part of group text for drawing type, single part drawing for sub part of group text for drawing type, group drawing text for drawing type, single part drawing without group text for drawing type, overview drawing
Page C.3 - 26
DetailCenter Express
If you want e.g. to obtain a drawing number containing your companys name "ABC", the year, the drawing type "BG" for groups or "ET" for single parts as well as the position number (each one separated by points, such as e.g. ABC.2002.BG1000), you have to define the following fields. All other fields dont have to be filled in.
DrawingNumberTemplate=ABC.#J#.#DWG##POS# FileNameTemplate=ABC.#J#-#DWG##POS# PositionNumberSymbol=#POS# YearSymbol=#J# DrawingTypeSymbol=#DWG# MainPartDrawingType=ET SubPartDrawingType=ET GroupDrawingType=BG SinglePartDrawingType=ET ...(additionally because of the points)
As already mentioned before, you can define the designations of the variables, as you like. Of course it is recommended to use special symbols there, too for better identification or in order to avoid a wrong replacing of text. ( #POS# instead of only POS). 4) Frame Definitions, Group Name [NAME1], [NAME2] etc. Here, you enter which drawing frames are used and specify the insertion areas of details and parts lists. Each available frame obtains an own group. The group names then will be displayed in the selection lists of the DetailCenter Express! . Please note: The keywords Path, SizeX, SizeY, Area1 and Area2 have to be assigned with current values; otherwise the frame will not be accepted for selection.
Path complete path of drawing frame; If you enter a file name without path, the file will be expected in the subordinate folder of ProSteel SizeX the dimensions of the drawing frame in X-direction SizeY the dimensions of the drawing frame in Y-direction Area1 the insertion area of details as 2D-points; specify the lower left and the upper right corner of the area in the format (x1,y1)-(x2,y2) Area2 the area of the title block of the drawing as 2D-points ExcludeArea1 exclusion area as 2D-points where no detail block can be inserted ExcludeArea2 exclusion area as 2D-points where no detail block can be inserted ExcludeArea3 exclusion area as 2D-points where no detail block can be inserted ExcludeArea4 exclusion area as 2D-points where no detail block can be inserted Later, the exclusion areas can e.g. be used for the insertion of parts lists. DwgNumberCode The code of the drawing frame; this code can be adopted into the drawing number
Page C.3 - 27
DetailCenter Express
If you define your own frames, please note that the lower left point of the drawing frame has the world coordinates (0, 0) and that you store the drawing in top view on the frame. The positive X-axis is showing to the right, the positive Y-axis to the top. Enter the frame field as a block with the name of the drawing file (i.e. as block 'dina4', if the drawing frame has to be saved as 'dina4.dwg'.
Page C.3 - 28
DetailCenter Express
Insertion Areas of a Sheet Template File The following example once again shows you the most important specifications of a frame definition:
The parameters used for multi sheet output are described in chapter InsertExpress.
Page C.3 - 29
DetailCenter Express
Drawing List
At single sheet output, a drawing list is automatically created as text file (*.txt) and as DBASE-file (*.dbf). The file is saved in the ProSteel detail folder under the drawing name of the model. You can see the position of the corresponding part and the file name of the created drawing in this file. The drawing number, scale (and whether it is suitable) and drawing frame are displayed as well. The data depend on the selected type of single sheet output.
DetailCenter Express! drawing list ---------------------------------Output date: 13.09.2007 Output path: d:\ps18.0\detail Output mode: Best scale Job number: Model drawing: e:\dwg\halle.dwg 1.) created group drawings Pos |Scale |Max |Dwg-Number |Dwg-File ====|======|====|=============|========== 100 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A3-Bl.7 |BG100.dwg 101 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A3-Bl.23 |BG101.dwg 103 |1:15 | |DWG-A3-Bl.20 |BG103.dwg 104 |1:10 | |DWG-A3-Bl.4 |BG104.dwg 105 |1:15 | |DWG-A3-Bl.18 |BG105.dwg 2.) created single part drawings Pos |Scale |Max |Dwg-Number |Dwg-File ====|======|====|=============|========== 1 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.6 |Pos1.dwg 2 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.22 |Pos2.dwg 5 |1:10 | |DWG-A4-Bl.3 |Pos5.dwg 6 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.17 |Pos6.dwg 7 |1:5 | |DWG-A4-Bl.16 |Pos7.dwg 8 |1:10 | |DWG-A4-Bl.14 |Pos8.dwg 12 |1:10 | |DWG-A4-Bl.8 |Pos12.dwg 14 |1:5 | |DWG-A4-Bl.1 |Pos14.dwg 15 |1:2.5 | |DWG-A4-Bl.21 |Pos15.dwg 16 |1:2.5 | |DWG-A4-Bl.2 |Pos16.dwg
Page C.3 - 30
InsertExpress
C.4
InsertExpress
InsertExpress is an extension of the DetailCenter allowing carrying out the permanently returning tasks of insertion and distribution of detail blocks on one or several drawing sheets as fast as possible. In DetailCenter Express you can carry out a complete detailing starting with definition and assignment of a detail style up to single part drawing, whereas InsertExpress helps you with the insertion of already created detail blocks. You can save the created insertion patterns as templates and use them again later in individual or batch insertion mode. With the help of the templates, you can define the pattern for different tasks and then carry out detailing with a single mouse click. As you perhaps already know from DetailCenter Express, InsertExpress is guiding you through the necessary settings for an automated insertion pattern. You cannot start the insertion until all necessary settings have been made. For this purpose, the dialog offers you various pages one after the other which may differ depending on your pre-settings. In this manual, we can only describe all possible pages in the order of their appearance, it may be that one or more pages dont exist according to your pre-settings.
Page C.4 - 1
InsertExpress
Click on this button to show the previous page. Click on this button to show the next possible page. Click on this button to start detailing which then will run according to your current settings. In the area of selection pages a display appears allowing you to observe the currently running process.
Page C.4 - 2
InsertExpress On this starting page, you select in the selection list whether you want to use InsertExpress in manual or batch insertion mode. In Manual Insertion Mode, you can define a specific insertion process that will then be carried out. You can save the settings of this manual insertion as template and use it again later in manual or batch insertion mode. In Batch Insertion Mode, you can select one or more templates that will then be carried out one after the other in InsertExpress. You will find a more detailed description of the different operation modes in the following chapters. Below, you can see a typical batch page with several automatically inserted details:
Save Templates You can save all settings for insertion like in most ProSteel functions under a file name in the templates management of InsertExpress so that you can use them again later.
Page C.4 - 3
InsertExpress
All detail blocks saved under the selected library are inserted. All detail blocks checked in the browser have to be inserted. All detail blocks displayed in the browser are inserted. In the following field, you can define a list of search filters that are used for searching in the selected detail library. The found detail blocks are inserted later.
Note: To be able to use the option Takeover Selection from Browser, you have to select the detail blocks to be inserted before starting the InsertExpress. You should pay attention to the status of the Recursive button on the ins ertion page in the DetailCenter.
Page C.4 - 4
InsertExpress
Click on this button to transfer the selected entry in the left list to the right filter list. Click on this button to remove the selected entry in the right list. Click on a list entry to process the selected filter condition.
Page C.4 - 5
InsertExpress
Define Filter
You can define the filters and store them as template on the insertion sheet in the display options of the DetailCenter. A possible filter selection may look as follows to filter out all straight shapes type HE.
Then the filter can be saved under a certain name (e.g. HE-shapes) using the template management. This name will be found later in the above-displayed filter selection.
Page C.4 - 6
InsertExpress
Insertion Options
After having defined which detail blocks have to be inserted, the next step is to specify what has to be done in the drawing when the blocks are inserted.
Title Block
The title block on each drawing sheet has to be filled out according to the specifications which still have to be made in the following.
US Mark Number An US mark number is generated for each detail block which later will be entered automatically as shipping number in the model drawing.
Page C.4 - 7
InsertExpress
Dispatch in Assemblies A set of drawings is generated for each assembly. Detail blocks not assigned to an assembly are not inserted. Dispatch in Groups A set of drawings is generated for each group. Detail blocks not assigned to a group are not inserted. Ascending Separated All selected detail blocks are inserted ascending by their position number. Detail blocks are inserted one after the other separately. At first, all single parts are inserted, then all groups (without their single part drawings) and finally the overview drawings. These are inserted ascending by their position number.
When you have selected the option Insert Separated by Single, Group, View, the following options are available in addition as well.
Page C.4 - 8
InsertExpress Single Parts The single parts are inserted separated from each other and ascending by their position number in the following order: - Shapes - Poly-plates - End and Base Plates - Stiffeners - Bent Shapes - Other Component Parts Here, the group details are dispatched on different drawings, separated according to type: - Supports - Cross Girders - Other Standard Shapes - Bent Shapes - Other Groups The views are dispatched as follows: - Working Areas - Ground Plan - Plan View - Anchorage Plan
Groups
Views
At first, all above-mentioned part types are collected per type and then inserted one after the other in ascending order each on a separate drawing sheet (or more, if necessary).
Page C.4 - 9
InsertExpress
If this number of detail blocks couldnt be inserted into the current drawing, a new drawing will be started. Grating distance for the insertion grating in x-direction Grating distance for the insertion grating in y-direction Minimum distance of the detail blocks after insertion The detail blocks are inserted in columns or in lines.
Note: The parameters specified here control the output accuracy; they can however also have a considerable influence on the time needed for the insertion process. Failed Insertion At a failed insertion, the detail block is inserted outside the drawing on the coordinate (5000, -5000). The rest of the drawing remains empty.
Page C.4 - 10
InsertExpress
Output Specifications
Certain parameter files control the following selection parameters for drawing insertion. The description of the files can to a large extent be found in the chapter DetailCenter Express. In the following, we will only describe the parameters necessary for InsertExpress in the chapter Technical Details.
Scale File
Here, you see the file which gives rise to the drawing scales.
Border Frame File Here you see the file which gives rise to the drawing frame definitions. Mark Number File Here, you see the file which gives rise to the definitions for the US mark number, if you have selected the option Use US mark number. Detail Output Here, you see the directory where the finished workshop drawings will be stored.
You can modify the files and the paths of the specifications by clicking on the small button on the right side of the corresponding display.
Page C.4 - 11
InsertExpress
The drawing sheet into which the detail blocks have to be inserted. The scale that has to be the base for the output drawing file. Indicates whether the loaded drawing has to be enlarged. In this case, the scale text is only entered into the title block.
Note: If you want to work with scaled (bigger or smaller) drawing frames or true to life sizes, please take care that all detail blocks to be inserted here have the same scale like the drawing. Otherwise, type sizes and symbol scaling (position flags, labelling...) will not match together. The best is to detail all detail blocks in a smaller size (1:xx) and to use the option Do not Scale Frame. Then, everything will be ok.
Page C.4 - 12
InsertExpress
Start DWG Counter at Here; you enter the sheet number of the next drawing to be created. User Variable Here, you can enter any text that will be inserted into your drawing number, depending on whether the corresponding variable is used.
Drawing Number Here, you can indicate another definition of the number if you temporarily want to modify the specifications of the sheet template file. Drawing Name Here, you can indicate another definition of the drawing name if you temporarily want to modify the specifications of the sheet template file. Here, you see the current definition of the drawing number of the sheet template file for your information. Here, you see the current continuous number for your information.
Page C.4 - 13
InsertExpress
Then, the indicated values are entered into the header of the drawing corresponding to the sheet template file.
Page C.4 - 14
InsertExpress
Finalising Works
Finally, you can specify whether you want to delete the detail blocks after insertion.
Note: When the detail blocks are deleted here, the insertion information cannot be transferred into the model and an automatic update of the 2D-drawing would not be possible any more.
Page C.4 - 15
InsertExpress
Page C.4 - 16
InsertExpress
Double Click
Edit Templates
You can also edit the existing templates in batch insertion mode by double clicking.
The edited template is saved. By clicking on this button, you save the current state of the template in the template management. Editing process is interrupted
Page C.4 - 17
InsertExpress
Important Parameters Area1 Area2 Drawing area where detail blocks may be inserted (have to have a valid value). Area of the header (has to have a valid value). In this part of the drawing, no detail blocks are inserted.
ExcludeArea 1-4 Drawing areas where detail blocks mustnt be inserted. Later, these areas may e.g. contain parts lists, company stamps or other information about the company. The example shows the most important areas. In addition, the meaning of the detail distance (dialog specification) is displayed as well.
Page C.4 - 18
InsertExpress
Drawing Directory
At the output of collected sheets, a drawing directory is automatically created as text file (*.txt) and as dBASE-file (*.dbf). The files are stored under the name of the model or under InsertExpress.txt (resp. dbf) in the detail directory. At the next output with InsertExpress both files are overwritten.
DetailCenter Insert Express! drawing list ---------------------------------Output date: 27.02.2006 Output path: C:\Programs\Bentley\ProSteel\R18.0\autocad 2008\detail Job number: A23-5674F 1.) inserted drawings Pos |GroupPos |Name |GroupName |Scale |DwgFile
========|=========|=====================|==============|=========|========== 01 |01 |IPE 400 |IPE 400 |1.000000 |C:\Program 02 |02 |RRK 250x150x8 |RRK 250x150x8 |1.000000 |C:\Program 03 |03 |RRK 250x150x8 |RRK 250x150x8 |1.000000 |C:\Program . . 2.) error report Pos |Info ========|=====
In this file, you can see position, group position, name and group name of the corresponding component part as well as the file name of the created drawing and the scale. If an error occurs during insertion, this will be indicated, too.
Page C.4 - 19
InsertExpress
Page C.4 - 20
Cranked 2D-View
C.5
Cranked 2D-View
You can insert cranked views into the model if you require cuts and views through your models that are not situated on one plane. During detailing, they are treated like standard plane views; they show, different depths of the model simultaneously in one view and allow hiding of unwanted or less interesting areas. Example for a cranked view (here only as view): In the 2D-view, the supports A1, B1 and C2 are displayed.
Add Cut
After starting this function, you first have to click on the start of polyline (intersection line) and then add the other points of the intersection line. Please pay attention that the line doesn't intersect nor that it is running backwards. In addition, the segments have to be perpendicular to each other. Otherwise, you don't obtain a satisfactory result. Terminate the entry by pressing the right mouse key if you do not want to add any further points. Now, you are prompted to specify the direction and depth of projection by clicking on another point (in relation to the start). All areas of the component parts, which are intersected by the polyline, are later displayed as cut all areas which are situated within the intersection depth, are displayed as standard projection. Then, the following dialog appears which is also opened in case of modification of a cranked view via ProSteel properties.
Page C.5 - 1
Cranked 2D-View
The name of the cut. Here you specify the projection depth of the view. Here you specify the height of projection of the view. All areas that are situated outside of this height are not displayed. Here you specify the colour of intersection line. The height of projection will be displayed as well so that you can check the coverage area. The depth of projection will be displayed as well so that you can check the coverage area. Together with '3D-display' you obtain a three dimensional display of the cranked view. The parts that are within the coverage of the cut are displayed. All other parts are hidden. The hidden parts are displayed again.
Page C.5 - 2
North Symbol
C.6
North Symbol
This function allows you to add a benchmark to your model, which may be evaluated later in different ways. At the moment, US-benchmark-symbols are available to help with the assembly of girders by indicating their alignment during installation. The point of the compass, which indicates north, is situated at the left side of the symbol or above if it is aligned horizontally (or at the upper end if it is aligned vertically).
Page C.6 - 1
North Symbol
Options:
In the input field Elevation above, you can enter a reference height corresponding to the model coordinates, z=0. Select the layer on which the benchmark has to be displayed in the Layer selection list. In the input field Block path, you may indicate a path to previously defined benchmarks if you don't want to apply the built-in symbols. Click on the File Select button and a Windows file selection dialog will be displayed where you can select the block folder. Alternatively to the built-in symbols, you can also use any block as a symbol. The Y-axis of this block then corresponds to northern direction; it will be inserted with the corresponding rotation. If the field Symbol is checked, the built-in symbols will be used for displaying the north arrow. You can select the desired symbol in the selection list. In the input field size, the scaling of the symbol can be defined. If the field Block is checked, an external block will be used for displaying the north arrow. The scale factor of the block is entered in the input field Scale. Normally, the blocks of the folder entered in the input field Block path will be used. Then, you may select the existing drawings as blocks which have to be used. If the field "Display only DWG Blocks" is checked, you can select the blocks already contained in the drawing as blocks which have to be used. Select the block which has to be used as north symbol in the selection list block.
Symbol:
Block:
The above-mentioned inputs describe the display of benchmark in the model (which may exist only once), whereas the following dialog page describes the display of alignment in the shapes. On one hand, the benchmark has to be inserted into the model and, on the other hand, the option 'Benchmark' has to be selected in shape properties, otherwise the alignment of a shape cannot be displayed.
Page C.6 - 2
North Symbol
Horizontal Alignment
Here, it is possible to select either the built-in symbols or external blocks. As the proceeding is the same as already mentioned concerning the actual benchmark, we don't repeat these settings here, but only describe the additional options. Settings The display for the alignment symbol for the points of the compass is set here. In the input field End Offset, you enter the distance between the insertion point of the symbol and the left resp. lower end of the shape. In the input field Center distance, you enter the distance between the insertion point of the symbol and the center of the shape. In the input field Colour, you enter the colour of the symbol as AutoCAD-colour number.
Horizontal is valid for horizontal girders and vertical is valid for vertical girders.
Page C.6 - 3
North Symbol
Vertical Alignment
Settings
The display for the alignment symbol for the upper edge of the component is set here. In the input field End Offset, you enter the distance between the insertion point of the symbol and the left lower edge of the shape. In the input field Offset, you enter the distance between the insertion point of the symbol and the upper edge of the shape. In the input field Colour, you enter the colour of the symbol as AutoCAD-colour number.
User-defined Symbols
You have to define an AutoCAD-block in your model drawing or as external drawing (wblock) containing the block attribute LABEL to apply user -defined symbols. This attribute is filled with the current text for alignment.
Page C.6 - 4
North Symbol
Shape Labelling
Annotations:
Enter the text which is to be displayed in the represented symbols in the input fields for the points of the compass and for Upside. The global view of the DetailCenter can be set here. Check the corresponding point of the compass in order to set the global view.
DetailCenter:
Page C.6 - 5
North Symbol
Page C.6 - 6
C.7
Some steel constructions are very complex so that the system is not always able to determine the suitable dimensioning automatically. Often it is even not possible to find all suitable points because important reference measures such as, weld check measures, or similar values have to be defined individually and are not automatically known to the system. For this purpose, you can define dimensioning points directly in the model for the derivation of group drawings or overviews; the system has to be forced to dimension them. In contrast to the subsequent manual dimensioning of 2D workshop drawings, the advantage of this function is that they can be updated at an automatic 2D-update.
Group General View: Here, you specify how the dimensioning points have to be depicted in the 3D-model. Only Points Only the two dimensioning points and a short connecting piece will be depicted. With Line Apart from the dimensioning points, the connecting line is displayed as well. This facilitates checking of the corresponding measured points. With Text The directly measured dimension is additionally displayed as check text. Please note that these default settings dont have any influence on the depiction in the 2D-plans.The dimensioning objects there are subsequently replaced by a usual standard measure of ProSteel.
Page C.7 - 1
Here, you specify the size to be used for depiction of the two measured points. Here you specify on which layer the object has to be inserted. The picked points are projected onto the current view plane. Thus, an object snap into the depth is avoided. The command is carried out as a loop. You can insert several manual-dimensioning objects one after the other without having to call the function again each time.
Group Options Horizontal Vertical A measure is created in dimensioning direction of the group or of the overview that runs from the first to the second point. A measure is created perpendicular to dimensioning direction of the group or of the overview that runs from the first to the second point. When there is more than one target point, the dimensioning direction is determined by the first added target point. A direct (e.g. diagonal) measure is created in the group or overview, running from the first to the second point.
Direct
Baseline Dimensioning When you have seized a reference point with several target points, each target point will get its own dimension (starting from the reference point). Otherwise, reference point and target points are created as continuous dimension chain. In Groups In Views ECS-System The dimensioning object is evaluated in the group to which it has been assigned. The dimensioning object is evaluated in the overview drawing where it is included. The coordinate system of the dimensioning object is displayed in the model so that you can check the position.
By highlighting both entries an identical dimensioning object can appear both in a group drawing and in an overview.
Page C.7 - 2
Beneath, you see an example of the variants in case of multiple dimensioning points: The dimensioning points which first seem to be similar in the 3D-model (above) create different results in the 2D-drawing (below). For both objects, only the Horizontal dimensioning direction has been activated. The dimensioning object on the left here has been created with the option Baseline Dimensioning so that all dimensioning points refer to the left reference point (1). On contrast, the right dimensioning object has been created without this option, and a continuous dimensioning chain (2) is created with the right reference point.
Dialog Commands
SINGLE Click on this button to add a single dimensioning object consisting of the start and target point. You first have to click on the group this dimensioning object is to be assigned to. Then, you click on the start and afterwards on the target point of dimensioning. SEVERAL Click on this button to add a dimensioning object with a reference point and several target points. You first have to click on the group this dimensioning object is to be assigned to. You then click on the base point of dimensioning and afterwards the other dimension points. Pressing ESC key ends adding further dimension points. Page C.7 - 3
Selection of Views
In principle, dimensioning objects have to be assigned to a group or to an assembly, even if the dimensions only appear in an overview drawing. At use in nested group structures, they are always assigned to the lowest hierarchy and controlled by means of their parameters at detailing. If you pick e. g. the subordinate part of a subgroup which is part of a standard component part group, the dimensions will only be displayed in the detailing of the component part group, when manual dimensioning points have been activated there for subgroups. At the later detailing, the dimensions are only displayed in the view that corresponds to a view at insertion (or to the opposite direction). Therefore, you should insert a dimensioning object on a component part in the view in which later you want to see the length to be dimensioned. Hint: When the dimension doesnt appear in the desired view, it was probably inserted in a wrong UCS plane and perhaps the dimensioning points were only corrected later. You can check this by making display the coordinate system of the dimensioning object. Its X/Y-pane has to be parallel towards the view plane. If you want to see the length in two views that are not opposite to each other, from view direction, you have to add the dimensioning object for a second time.
Page C.7 - 4
C.8
The logical links are required for dimensioning and recognition of neighbouring parts. These are created during most ProSteel processing functions. However, if there isnt any link between two component parts, a so -called manual link can be placed between the parts. The only task of thi s link is to create a dependency; it hasnt got any additional function. To create a manual link, first select the attached part of the connection (this should be the adjacent part, e.g. the latch-bolt) and then the part that it has to be connected to (e.g. the support). A logical dependency between the component parts is created which is important for dimensioning.
Page C.8 - 1
Page C.8 - 2
Global Scale
C.9
Global Scale
Like AutoCAD, ProSteel works in drawing units according to the scale less method, a natural scale of 1:1 being assumed (i.e. a drawing unit corresponds to one millimetre natural size). Any detailing with respect to the 2D shop plans, however, is prepared in a scale you entered beforehand. However, if you want to attach e.g. position flags later that have been entered in the original size (mm) in the pre-settings you must set a scale in order to ensure uniform sizes of these elements and a uniform aspect of your drawings. This so-called Global Scale basically corresponds to the later plot scale of your drawing. When the program needs a scale and no special scale is entered, the global scale will be adopted. When using the command, the following prompt is displayed in the command line Previous ProSteel Scale = 1.0000 Please enter the new default scale 1: ? The current scale is displayed. Now enter the new scaling factor to be used for your work. When you enter e.g. the value 10, the default scale 1:10 will apply. Do not confuse the global scale with the length scaling. The global scale refers to the later printout of the drawings and scales text sizes, symbol sizes, etc.
Page C.9 - 1
Global Scale
Page C.9 - 2
Drawing Border
Page C.10 - 1
Drawing Border
Click on this button to generate a new entry beneath a gusset which had been selected before.
Click on this button to generate a new gusset beneath a gusset which had been selected before. Click on this button to work on the selected entry..
Click on this button to delete the selected entry or gusset with all contained subordinate entries. Scale Activate Limits The drawing border is inserted in the scale entered here. If this field is checked, the drawing limits are put on the edge of the border to avoid drawing outside of the border. Here, you load the selected entry and the drawing block into the model area. Here, you load the selected entry and the drawing block into the paper area.
Creation of Entries
Select the main point and either press the right mouse button for the subordinate menu or the button CREATE. The following dialog opens:
Page C.10 - 2
Drawing Border
Enter the path to the block to be inserted. Enter the width of the block if you want to work with active limits. If the field Active Limits has been checked, these values are preset as limits with the specified scale. It is of course possible as well to specify different values for the limits. Enter the height of the block if you want to work with active limits. If the field Active Limits has been checked, these values are preset as limits with the specified scale. It is of course possible as well to specify different values for the limits. Here, you can enter a comment for identification.
Height
Comment
Click on this button to select the block via a file selection dialog. Then, the path is entered in the input field block path.
Click on this button to select the standard sizes for width and height by means of a dialog.
After these data have been inserted, a new subordinate entry is displayed in the tree, which still has to be named. Then, the entry is created and can be used immediately.
Page C.10 - 3
Drawing Border
Page C.10 - 4
Manual 2D-Cut
Here, you enter the text without the cutting code that has to be used as designation. Enter e.g. Cut. Enter the desired cutting code such as e.g. the letter A. Select an AutoCAD-text style for the labels. Select the AutoCAD-layer the text and the cutting symbols have to be created on. Select the line type to be used for the depiction of the cutting line.
Page C.11 - 1
Manual 2D-Cut
Detailing Style
Select the detailing style to be used for the depiction of the component parts (e.g. shadings etc.)
Colour Symbol/Text In the input fields for Symbol and Text you enter the colour of the cutting arrow and of the text. You can either specify the colour directly by entering the AutoCAD colour number, or you click on the desired input field and then on the SELECT button. Then, the AutoCAD dialog for colour selection is displayed where you can select the colour directly. Text Size Create Block Complete Groups Here, you enter the size of the label text. A common block is formed consisting of the cutting arrows and the codes. Otherwise, they are still single lines and text. If his option is activated, always the complete group will be selected even if only a single component part of the group has been selected.
Dialog-Commands
LINE Click on this button to create a cut through component parts along a line to be selected. Select the parts to be depicted, then the cutting line. Then, you have to indicate the depth of the cut. If you press ESC here, only a cut at the corresponding position will be made. Otherwise, the parts will be cut at the position and the projection of the rest will be displayed. After having created the cut and after having attached the cutting code, you can place the result anywhere you like. OBJECT Click on this button to create a cut on the base of a cut object. This may be a view frame or an offset cut. You only have to select the object; selection of the parts is carried out automatically.
UCS Click on this button to create a cut of 3D component parts at the current UCS. After selection of the parts, the cut is created at the XY-plane of the current UCS.
Page C.11 - 2
Manual 2D-Cut
Position Flags
Apart from the actual cut display, it is also possible to attach position flags in manual cuts. In addition, you can add component part information to 2D-lines to enable the attachment of position flags at a later moment.
Position flags are additionally attached. Select the distribution template for the position flags which you created before using the function for position flags. Scale for the size of the position flags The component part data of the original 3D-elements are added to the created 2D-elements so that it is possible to attach position flags later.
Page C.11 - 3
Manual 2D-Cut
Group Symbol Symbol Continued By Side Arrow Size The cutting code is created as a symbol consisting of cutting arrow and code. The two partial lines are connected through the cut part. The cutting code is written beside the cutting arrow; otherwise it is written above the cutting arrow. Specify the size of the arrow.
Distance/Length Here, you specify the distance of the cutting lines, from their beginning to the utmost bordering edge (e.g. the dimensioning), and what has to be the length. Group Block Block A freely selectable block is used for the cutting code instead of a cutting arrow. In the input fields Top Block and Down Block you see the selected block path. You can assign a block drawing by clicking on the SELECT button.
Page C.11 - 4
Manual 2D-Cut
Block Path
Here you indicate the directory with the files containing the block definitions for the cutting arrows. Select the directory via the neighboring button. Here you select the block for the upper cutting arrow. Here you select the block for the lower cutting arrow.
Example of a Cut at a Group The edge of the cut is located in front of the left stiffener and the depth of the cut extends beyond the head plate you see all of these parts from the right; the shape is cut and the drill holes are invisible.
Page C.11 - 5
Manual 2D-Cut
Page C.11 - 6
Manual Dimensioning
Page C.12 - 1
Manual Dimensioning
Group Settings Alignment Here, you set the general direction of dimensioning. Horizontal The dimension chain is always running in Xdirection. Vertical The dimension chain is always running in Ydirection. Line The dimension chain is running in the same direction like a pre-set line. To carry out the function, click on the line determining the direction. You can use this method to dimension e.g. along a cut edge. As picked The dimension chain is running in the direction specified by the two points first picked. This is e.g. reasonable if you want to dimension diagonal holes in a gusset plate. Like Part The dimension chain is running in the same direction like the length direction of a component part. This is the optimal method to dimension along a diagonal shape by clicking on the shape. Arc Dimension You can dimension the length of an arc. Angle Dimension You can dimension an angle.
Page C.12 - 2
Manual Dimensioning
Origin
Here, you specify which origin is used for alternative coordinate dimensioning. Auto The dimensions are preferably related to the lower left point of the reference parts coating or to that of the groups main part. If it doesnt exist, they are related to the current UCS. Default The dimensions are related to any point specified by you. UCS-Origin The dimensions are related to the origin of the current UCS. Part The dimensions are related to the lower left point of the reference parts coating or to that of the groups main part. Start Dimension Chain The dimensions are related to the beginning of the dimension chain.
Reference Point Here, you specify whether a reference part has to be used for dimensioning. This is necessary to evaluate shape shortenings correctly. However, the part has to be an intelligent 2D part. No A reference part is not used for dimensioning and all lengths are evaluated in the measured length. Default A pre-set part is used as reference part. Thus, you dont have to select it each time you apply this command. This option helps you to dimension more complex groups. Select You are always prompted for the reference part, which then has to be selected. At arc dimension, the included angle is additionally entered as well into the dimension. At arc dimension, the reference radius is additionally entered as well into the dimension.
Continuing Dim. Chain A dimension chain can be built continuously by clicking on individual points. If this field is not checked, you have to continue dimensioning single distances and you can obtain a dimension chain with gaps. Scale automatic The settings for scale and object scaling are automatically determined by the global scale and by the reference part. If your work has been logical according to ProSteel (either unscaled details and global scale for plot or scaled details and scale 1:1 for the plot), incorrect default settings are avoided. No Scaling The parts to be dimensioned are not scaled. Thus, the original measured lengths can be used. However, if the field has not been checked, all measured lengths are multiplied with the indicated scale under 'New Scale'.
Page C.12 - 3
Manual Dimensioning
New Scale
The scale used for converting the measured lengths and text sizes depending on the settings for part scaling under Parts Not Here, you enter e.g. the value 10 if you have selected the scale 1: 10 with object scaling at detailing. The details now have been decreased by factor 10.
Group Fence Chains Outside Dimensions The outside edges of the seized component parts are evaluated as fence points and dimensioned in a dimension chain. Shape Center Shape Edges Overall Dim. Starting and end points of the shapes are created as fence points and dimensioned in a dimension chain. The corner points of the coating are evaluated as fence points and dimensioned in a dimension chain. An additional dimension chain is created stretching over the overall dimensions of the fence chains.
Group Coordinate Measures At Overall Dim. Normally, the coordinate measures for overall dimensions are omitted at automatic detailing or part dimensioning. If this option has been selected, these are displayed as well to allow e.g. in overviews to specify the position of component parts related to a reference point by means of the overall dimensions of these parts. If this option has been checked, always positive coordinate measures are indicated. You can obtain a relative dimensioning around a reference point when the direction is not important. If this option has been checked, the coordinate measure having the value 0 is displayed in a dimension chain. Deactivation is reasonable if the origin (reference) is only indicated once. If this option has been checked, the first coordinate measure is displayed in a dimension chain. Deactivation is reasonable if you want a connection with an existing dimension chain or an identical starting point has only to be indicated once.
Always positive
Display Zero
Display First
Page C.12 - 4
Manual Dimensioning
Display Last
If this option has been checked, the last coordinate measure is displayed in a dimension chain. Deactivation is only possible if you have a dimension chain of normal measures and simultaneously existing coordinate measures.
Others Info Window Depending on the selection, you are informed about the type of dimension chains, global scale of the drawing, pre-selected origin of coordinate dimensioning and pre-selected component part for part reference. Here, you select the detailing style controlling the settings for dimensioning style, optimization, etc. At automatic part dimensioning, you also specify the points of a part or of a group to be dimensioned in the detailing style. Therefore, at identical detailing style the result of automatic detailing and automatic part dimensioning are in no way different.
Detailing Style
Dialog-Commands
SINGLE PART Click on this button to dimension a shape or any plate automatically. The relevant points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings in detailing style and the dimension chains are attached. You have to click on the part to be dimensioned. If the Choose Position option has been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any position you like. For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended for most cases, you can, however, specify other directions as well. GROUP Click on this button to dimension a group automatically. The relevant points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings in detailing style and the dimension chains are attached. You have to click on any part of the group you like. If the Choose Position option has been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any position you like. For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended for most cases, you can, however, specify other directions as well.
Page C.12 - 5
Manual Dimensioning END PLATE Click on this button to dimension an end plate automatically. The relevant points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings in detailing style and the dimension chains are attached. You have to click on the end plate first and then the connecting shape (this is the shape to which the end plate belongs). If the Choose Position option has been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any position you like. For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended for most cases, you can specify other directions as well. INSERT DIMENSION Click on this button to insert new dimensions in an existing dimension chain. The other dimensions will be adapted. Select all dimensions belonging to this chain. Then you have to pick a dimension as reference dimension for the position of the dimension chain. If this demand is only confirmed with RETURN, the first dimension of your previous selection will be used.
Page C.12 - 6
Manual Dimensioning
Now the program filters the dimensions, which are not situated in a line with this reference dimension. Dimensions of other dimension chains may also belong to your selection (e.g. due to Crossing the selection). Now, the dimension chain will be reconstructed and you can then insert the new dimensions. DELETE DIMENSION Click on this button to delete a dimension from an existing dimension chain. The other dimensions will be adapted. Selection of the dimension chain and of dimensions is identical with the dialog command INSERT DIMENSION it has not to be described once again. MODIFY DIMENSION CHAIN Click on this button to modify the style of a dimension chain, e.g. to convert it from normal dimensions to coordinate measures or to modify the detailing style. Selection of the dimension chain and of dimensions is identical with the dialog command INSERT DIMENSION; it does not have to be described once again.
SINGLE DIMENSION Click on this button to attach a single dimension. Linear Dim: Click on the first and second dimension point as well as the position of the dimension line. The dimension is aligned according to the direction. Depending on the settings for direction and part reference, you still have to click on a reference line and/or a reference part.
Arc Dimensions: Click on the centre of the arc first and then the starting point and end of the arc (the end will be corrected correspondingly). Afterwards, you pick the dimension line position. An arc is principally looked on counter-clockwise from beginning to end. Angle Dim.: Click on the vertex of the angle first and then the end of the first and second side. After you pick the dimension line position. An angle is principally looked on counter -clockwise from beginning to end.
Page C.12 - 7
Manual Dimensioning DIMENSION CHAIN Click on this button to attach a dimension chain out of several dimensions. Click on the position of the dimension line first and then the points to be dimensioned. The dimensions are aligned according to the direction. Depending on the settings for direction and part reference, you still have to click on a reference line and/or a reference part. If you selected the option As Picked for the direction, the first two dimension points determine the direction of the dimension chain. If you selected the option Continuing Dimension Chain, you are dimensioning according to the AutoCAD-dimensioning function Continue. If this option has not been activated, you continue indicating pairs of points for all dimensions following the first one. You can obtain an interrupted dimension chain with several dimensions. FENCE CHAIN Click on this button to create a fence chain dimensioning. The dimensions are aligned according to the direction. Depending on the settings for direction and part reference, you still have to click on a reference line and/or a reference part.
CHANGE DETAIL STYLE Click on this button to open the dialog for setting parameters for the detail style. If you move to another style in the Detailing Style selection list, the display in the detail style dialog will be updated as well.
LOAD DETAIL STYLE Click on this button to load a detail style from the hard drive into your drawing. Select the desired style file (*.sty) in the file selection dialog (*.sty). A new loaded detail style at the same time is the current detail style of dimensioning and it is displayed in the Detailing Style selection list. SPECIFY ORIGIN Click on this button to define the origin (reference point) of coordinate dimensioning for the time of a ProSteel session. Click on the corresponding point in your drawing. This is reasonable if dimensioning has to be made e.g. within an overview or a more complex group. Select the setting Default under Default Origin if all following coordinate measures have to be calculated related to this reference point.
Page C.12 - 8
Manual Dimensioning SPECIFY REFERENCE OBJECT Click on this button to define the reference object for shape shortening etc. for the time of a ProSteel session. Click on the corresponding part in your drawing. This is reasonable if dimensioning has to be made e.g. within a more complex group. Select the setting Default under Part Reference if all following actions requiring a reference object have to be related to this selected part.
Dimension Chains
During the acquisition of the measurement points the dimension chains are able to capture the points correctly even if the dimensions have been indicated in a different sequence or if the dimensions overlap. The picture below illustrates the interconnections:
Example (1) shows a dimensioning using the Continuing Dimension Chain option and the following sequence: First, click the distance C/F, then point D, and finally point A. Example (2) shows the result if the first dimensioning is like (1) and the next input is the dimensioning of the distance from the dotted line to point B. The Combine Identical Dimensions from 3 on option in the detail style is active as well (since A/B, B/C and C/D were created!) Example (3) shows a dimension chain without t he Continuing Dimension Chain option. The following was dimensioned: the distance A/C and then D/E. A new measurement of the distance B/F would now divide the distance of 400 and create a second measurement from point E to F.
Page C.12 - 9
Manual Dimensioning
Page C.12 - 10
Manual Dimensioning
Page C.12 - 11
Manual Dimensioning
Page C.12 - 12
Elevation Flags
The style used for displaying the elevation. The elevation is inserted on the selected layer. The dynamic of the flag is switched off after insertion. This is meant for application in 2D-mode, to avoid moving a view that forces an update of the displayed values. Indicates the scale used for displaying the inserted elevation symbol in the drawing. The length scaling for the distance value; it is also possible to attach elevations in scaled details.
Page C.13 - 1
Elevation Flags
A symbol is created within a group, which will be output as elevation at later detailing.
Click on the button representing the desired measurement and the elevation can be inserted. First click on the definition point (measuring point) , then you can position the elevation symbol (ORTHO is activated automatically) and finally, you position the dimension text (ORTHO is deactivated again when it was in the OFFposition before the function was selected).
Page C.13 - 2
Elevation Flags
X, Y, Z-Coordinate Here you enter the coordinates of origin for Length (Y), Width (X) and Height (Z) measurements. The picked points will then be referenced to these coordinates. Usually you enter the origin of the corresponding work frame . The coordinates can also be defined in the drawing using the mouse.
Page C.13 - 3
Elevation Flags
Elevation Depiction
Use this box to select the style to be applied for the depiction. The depiction of elevations is specified by preset parameters in this dialog.
Block Geometry An AutoCAD block specifies the depiction of elevations. Any block can be selected. Block Path Bitmap In this field, you specify from which directory the blocks for selecting the geometry of the elevations have to be read. You can set an own bitmap for a style for easy recognition. This bitmap then is displayed in the selection box as well. Click on this button to save the current settings as style. Click on this button to load a style for the elevations and thus to use it again Click on this button to modify the display of the elevation if Create Geometry has been selected. ,
Page C.13 - 4
Elevation Flags
Geometry Definition
Line Type
Lines means that the elevation symbol is represented as a line triangle. Filled Triangle means that the elevation symbol is represented as a partly filled triangle. You can indicate a certain text format with a variable $(V) for the measurement to the elevation. The variable then is replaced by the current value. Presets the text style to be used for depiction of the texts in the elevation. The indicated notes are output as text together with the elevation.
Default Format
Group Options Guide Line Dynamic The elevation has a guideline to the definition point. The elevation is visibly displayed during insertion process.
Page C.13 - 5
Elevation Flags
The elevation symbol is turned upside down (point to the top, e.g. for the indication of lower edges). The thousand position is separated from the other digits by a point, i.e. 2.500 instead of 2500. If you require the digits after the decimal point, this option should be deactivated.
Group Sizes Symbol Size Text Size After Decimal Pre-Decimal the size of the elevation symbol. size of text of elevation data The number of digits after the decimal point of the calculated value The number of digits in front of the decimal point of the calculated value, if the value is smaller than the number of pre-decimal digits, the rest is filled up with noughts.
Group Colours Colours Use the fields Line and Text to set the corresponding colour for the height object. -1 as value means that the presetting is used.
Page C.13 - 6
Elevation Flags
Style Management
Your elevation styles are managed in this part of the dialog. New styles can be created; existing styles can be loaded, updated or even deleted.
Press the above-displayed symbol to create a new elevation style. The style then will be saved by means of presetting in the directory for elevation styles as a file having the ending *.sty-file. Now you can work with this style on all other pages of this dialog. If you want to work with a special style, which is not in the drawing, but stored on the hard drive, you can load it using this function. Select the corresponding *.sty-file in the directory of elevation styles and load the file. The style will be available at once. If you dont require a style any more in the drawing, use this function to remove it. Click on this button to modify the order of the display. The order in the display of the style list is not sorted. You can specify your own sorting. For this purpose, use the two arrow buttons to move the highlighted style towards the top or towards the bottom of the order.
Page C.13 - 7
Elevation Flags
Page C.13 - 8
Weld Symbols
Page C.14 - 1
Weld Symbols Weld Style Layer The style used for displaying the weld seams. The weld seam is inserted on the selected layer.
Thickness Top Side Here, you can overwrite the value of the welding thickness of the style to create different thicknesses with identical default settings. Thickness Bottom Side Here, you can overwrite the value of the welding thickness of the style to create different thicknesses with identical default settings. Scale Indicates the scale used for displaying the inserted weld symbol in the drawing. Click this button to insert weld symbols. For this purpose, select the start point of the guideline and the insertion point of the flag. Click this button to insert a weld seam. For this purpose, select the start and the end point of the weld seam and the weld seam will be created with the specified style. Click this button to attach a weld flag at an existing weld seam. Select an existing weld seam and then specify the insertion position of the weld flag. Click this button to attach another guideline at a weld flag. First select an existing weld flag and then draw the new reference arrow to its target point.
Click this button to weld component parts with each other. Select two parts to be welded. ProSteel now creates a weld group with the corresponding weld seams using the specified settings for weld groups (see also Form Weld Groups). Click this button to define the properties of a weld group.
Page C.14 - 2
Weld Symbols
Create Group Treat as one With Welds Min. Weld Length Gap
A new group is formed out of the two component parts, unless it already exists If this option has been activated in the CAD system the group is set on this selection mode. The weld seams are integrated into the group as well. A weld seam created using this command may not be shorter than the indicated length. The minimum gap between these parts is specified. If the gap is bigger than the specified value, the parts will not be welded. The value should not be equal 0 to avoid problems with tolerances.
Page C.14 - 3
Weld Symbols
Weld Style
Use this box to select the style that has to be applied for the display. Created Geometry The depiction of weld symbols is defined in this dialog by means of specified parameters. The depiction of weld symbols is defined by means of any AutoCAD block that can be selected. In this field you specify the block path for selecting the geometry of the weld symbols have to be read. You can set your own bitmap for better recognition of the style. This bitmap is displayed in the selection box as well. Click this button to save the current settings as style.
Click this button to load a style for the weld symbols and to use it again. Click this button to specify the general settings of the weld symbol or the weld seam.
Page C.14 - 4
Weld Symbols Click this button to specify the special settings for the upper side of the weld symbol (upper weld seam). Click this button to specify the special settings for the lower side of the weld symbol (lower weld seam). Click this button to specify further settings for the evaluation in the parts lists.
Line Type
Here you specify the type of the guideline. No Line No guideline will be displayed. Line The guideline consists of only one single line. Line with Arrow The guideline has an additional arrow at the origin of the line. Line with Point The guideline has an additional point at the origin of the line. Line with Block The guideline has an additional block of any kind at the origin of the line. Here you can select the AutoCAD-block, if the option Line with Block has been selected. Here you indicate the AutoCAD text style for the labels.
Page C.14 - 5
Weld Symbols Options Select the type of weld seam. All around The weld symbol is added for an all around weld seam. Field Weld The weld symbol is added for an on-site seam. Replaced - The weld symbol is added for an alternating weld seam. Staggered Staggered entries are displayed instead of an extra symbol for an alternating weld seam. Tail The weld symbol is added by using this sign. Size of the label text Size of symbol representation. Enter the scale for the data in the entry fields Text Size and Symbol Size. When selecting this function, the default scale is entered automatically. Specify the colour numbers for the Line, the Symbol and for the Text.
Colour
The thickness of the weld seam. A prefix placed in front of the thickness of the weld seam. The length of the weld seam Here you can indicate a gap in the weld seam.
Page C.14 - 6
Weld Symbols Comment Add. Length Symbol Toward Position Symmetrical Here you can indicate a comment to the weld symbols. Additional length details In this list, you can select the type of the weld seam (flat-flap weld, HV weld, etc.). Indicates whether the weld seam has to be carried out in this way The bottom side data corresponds to those of the top side (only available in top side).
The weld material which has to be used The created weld seam has to appear in the parts list. The weight of the weld seam per length unit. The price of the weld seam per length unit.
Page C.14 - 7
Weld Symbols
Style Management
In this part of the dialog, your weld styles are managed. You can create new styles, load styles, update or delete styles.
Press the above symbol to create a new weld style. The style then will be stored as *.sty file with the default settings in the directory for weld styles. Now you can work with this style on all other pages of this dialog. If you want to work with a special style which is not stored in the drawing, but on your hard drive, you can load this style using this function. Select the corresponding *.sty file in the directory for weld styles and load the file. The style will be available at once. Use this function to remove a style, that is not required any more, from your drawing. Click this button to change the order of the display. The order in the display of the style list is not sorted, but you can sort yourself. Use the two arrow keys to scroll the highlighted style up or down in the order.
Page C.14 - 8
Weld Symbols Use this function to update the styles loaded in your drawing. All styles in the drawing are replaced by the styles stored on the hard drive.
Page C.14 - 9
Weld Symbols
Page C.14 - 10
Short 2D manually
Select this command and you will be first prompted for the shape to be shortened which you have to click. Then you are prompted for the starting and end point of the shortening, which you can either enter or pick. If you press the ESC-key instead, the shortening is automatically determined and carried out, as it is the case for detailing. If you want to dimension the shape manually later, you can then consider the shortening as well. Note: In some cases it may be that the command doesnt work as it should. In this case, check whether the drawing elements you want to treat are blocks (which cannot be dissolved). You first have to dissolve these blocks before you can go on.
Page C.15 - 1
Short 2D manually
Page C.15 - 2
2D-Cutout
C.16 2D-Cutout
Using this command, you can cut any 2D lines at a polyline at the same time. After selecting the command, you have to pick the points of the polyline. The same command functions are available as when drawing a polyline. Then, all of the lines extending past the polyline are cut off at this line. When you want to use this function to cut out intelligent ProSteel-2D-objects (such as shapes after detailing), you first have to explode them into AutoCADlines. However, dont forget that after that the obje cts have lost their properties.
Page C.16 - 1
2D-Cutout
Page C.16 - 2
Hole Display
Hole Display
Indicates the currently selected hole display style. The selected hole display style is edited independently for plan view and view on a hole. Then, a list appears with the assignments of diameters to display.
The path where the blocks for hole display have been stored. A symbol, which facilitates the recognition of the corresponding style in the selection list Saves the current definition in the drawing and in a file; when you modify the style and you leave the page without saving, you are asked whether you want to save the modifications. Permits loading the current style definition from a style file; all current definitions of the current style will be overwritten.
Page C.17 - 1
Hole Display
The current data record is edited. Then a dialog opens to select the blocks for the different hole types.
Click on this button to add a new entry at the end of the list that can be processed. Click on this button to remove the selected entry from the list.
Page C.17 - 2
Hole Display
The minimum diameter from which on the selected display will be used. The maximum diameter up to which the selected display will be used. Here, you select the block to be used for displaying the different hole types Normal, Countersunk, Step and Threaded Hole if the hole is a visible hole in the drawing. You select the block to be used for displaying the different hole types Normal, Countersunk, Step and Threaded Hole if the hole is a hidden hole in the drawing.
Hidden
Page C.17 - 3
Hole Display
Style Management
In this part of the dialog, your hole styles are maintained. You can create new styles, load, update and delete styles.
Click on the displayed button if you want to create a new hole style. Then, the style is saved with pre-settings in the hole style list as *.sty-file. Now you can work with this style on all other pages of this dialog. When you want to work with a special style which is not saved in the drawing, but on the hard disk, you can load this style using this function. Select the corresponding *.sty-file in the hole style list and load the file. The style is immediately at your disposal. This function allows you to remove a style which is not needed any more in the drawing.
Page C.17 - 4
Hole Display Click on this button to modify the display order. The display order of the style list is not sorted, but you can define the sorting yourself. Use the two arrow keys to move the checked style up or down the order. This function allows you to update the styles loaded in the drawing. All styles in the drawing are replaced by the styles stored on the hard disk.
Page C.17 - 5
Hole Display
Page C.17 - 6
Automatic 2D-Cut
Add Cut
After having loaded the function, you first have to select the shape, where a cut is to be inserted. Then, you have to click a point on the cutting plane. The cutting plane will always run through this point perpendicular to the center line. Finally, you are asked for depth and direction of cut, which will be defined by clicking on another point. On one hand, you indicate the view direction of the cut and on the other hand, you determine its depth (this point will also be perpendicular to the center line). The resulting cutting planes will be displayed dynamically during selection for control reasons. The depth of the cut decides how much of the components situated behind the cutting plane is to be displayed.
Page C.18 - 1
Automatic 2D-Cut
Modification of Cut
Cuts can be modified or deleted from Shape Properties.
Here, you see the number of cuts existing in the shape as well as the number of the current cut. If this field is checked, the cut will be taken into account during detailing. It is possible to exclude a cut without having to delete it. Here, the depth of the cut can be modified. Alternatively, this can be done by using the AutoCAD-grips on the cut-symbol which are displayed when the cut is selected. Here, you enter the view direction of the cut. Shape direction: The cut runs from the indicated cutting plane in shape direction. Opposite direction: The cut runs from the indicated cutting plane opposite to the shape direction. Cutting plane always remains at the same position. If you want to reverse the cut completely, select the option Turn Round. This option hasnt any meaning here. It is provided for the extension ProConcrete 3D.
Cut Depth
Alignment
Zone
Page C.18 - 2
Automatic 2D-Cut
Create Cut
This option hasnt any meaning here. It is provided for the extension ProConcrete 3D. Click on this button to delete the selected cut from the shape.
This button exchanges insertion point and back limit point. This means that the cutting plane now is the end of cutting depth and the end now is the cutting plane.
If you defined more than one cut, you can change to the next cut by using this button. If you defined more than one cut, you can change to the previous cut by using this button.
Page C.18 - 3
Automatic 2D-Cut
Page C.18 - 4
Flatten Viewport
Any name with which the viewport can be displayed in later versions in the DetailCenter as well. Handle of the viewport Here you predefine the kind of part selection for output. Manual Selection at output, you are asked to select the parts which have to be visible later in 2D-output. Automatic Selection (recommended) the program automatically determines the component parts visible in the viewport and carries out a flatten viewport command. The output is cut off at the borders of the viewport, the visual depth of the viewport is taken into consideration, here. With Selection Set You specify which component parts have to be adopted into 2D-depiction using the + and button. All Component Parts All component parts being in the model area of the drawing will be selected for output. Any possibly existing XRefs will always be completely selected as well in all cases. You can realize the output either in model or in paper area. We recommend output in paper area.
Output
Page C.19 - 1
Flatten Viewport
After the 2D-output was created, all layers in the viewport are switched off except the layers required for the depiction of 2Doutput. Click on this button to add or remove component parts to/from selection set for 2D-output.
Click on this button to carry out the calculation of the hidden edges. This button is only visible after selection of a valid detailing style. Click on this button to delete again the drawing elements which had been newly generated together with the creation of the hidden edges. The layers in the viewport are switched on again.
Here an example for output with automatic selection in paper area. The position numbers were inserted into the drawing before in paper area.
Page C.19 - 2
Flatten Viewport
Detailing Style
Here, you specify the detailing style to be used for displaying the hidden edges.
Page C.19 - 3
Flatten Viewport
Page C.19 - 4
Miscellanous
D Miscellanous
Page D - 1
Miscellanous
Page D - 2
D.1
Here, you can enter your parts list data and then, this part will be recognized as ProSteel component part. You can modify this property using the properties command. You can use it at positioning and in the parts list as well. However, a 2D-depiction cannot be generated when no volume parts are contained.
Page D.1 - 1
User-Defined Component Parts Special Shapes By using the special shape management of ProSteel, you can add your own custom shapes to the program which will then be processed like pre-defined standard shapes. These special shapes can be saved in any number of catalogues containing any number of shapes, i. e., you can establish same sorting as with standard shapes. The selection menu then shows catalogue names as a shape type and the shapes contained in each catalogue appear as shape size, making it easy to choose between different system shapes. You can create special shapes as combination of existing shapes or by using a drawn cross-section or a variant (qualitative generation instruction) with corresponding data base.
These are two examples of possible special shapes. The left shape was drawn as a cross-section and then stored as a special shape, the right one is a combination of two U-shapes.
Page D.1 - 2
User-Defined Component Parts In addition, you can store each shape in three different display modes (low, normal and high which must be created individually). You thereby avoid having to deal with a confusing number of lines when working with rather complex shapes like in the left example, but you can show the complete shape if needed. Nonetheless, you can always select the ProSteel standard display modes (only center line, envelope, etc.) without having to change any parameters. Here, you see the dialog for special shape management. It is organized in a tree structure and consists of 4 main tabs for the different types of special shapes.
Each of these branches can contain subordinate directories and each subordinate directory can have any number of special shape definitions. However, you cannot make any further subordinate division. Select a shape and the stored cross-section will be displayed on the right monitor. Creation of a Catalogue Select one of the tabs to layout a catalogue and use the right mouse button. A subordinate menu is displayed offering you the option to layout a catalogue. A subordinate directory is created and you can edit the name. Creation of a Special Shape A special shape layout is made analogously to the layout of a catalogue. Select the desired catalogue and use the right mouse button. Then, you can select the option Layout Shape. Enter the name and the shape appears as an entry. This name is the access name and not the name, that later will be displayed in a parts list.
Page D.1 - 3
User-Defined Component Parts Please note that until now you only created a blank cover that has to be filled with creating a resolution. It is not before then that the special shape has been filed. If you dont do that, the blank shape cover will be removed at next selection. Layout of a Depiction Resolution After the layout of a blank special shape definition has been affected, you have to define a resolution. Select the shape and use the right mouse button again.
Here, you select the desired resolution. If resolutions have already been defined for the special shape, you can modify the defined resolution using this method. Definition of Cross-Section Defining the closed and the not crossing contour of the cross-section normally creates a special shape. Depending on the setting, this can be done using polylines or individual lines and arc segments. Alternatively, you can define special shapes of regular wall thickness (e.g. cold rolling shapes) by means of an open poly-line and by specifying the thickness. See Settings.
Page D.1 - 4
User-Defined Component Parts After selection, choose your outer contour and the possibly existing inner contours. You can utilise any number of inner contours that must not cross the outer contour and must not have any intersection points between each other. Now, the program automatically calculates the possible standard insertion points of this shape (center line, envelope). Finally, you can still define a center line which can be used alternatively and further insertion points.
After end of the geometrical definitions, now the property dialog for specifying the parts list data will be displayed. Enter the name of the parts list, notes, material, etc. Starting from the cross-section drawing and the entered material data, the program calculates the weight in kg/m and displays it in the entry field Weight. You can determine which shape data will be applied to the standard parts list. It is also possible to change the calculated weight. When you have defined a user-defined center, you also specify here whether it is used to determine the center line or whether the calculated center line has to be used.
Then, the special shape is saved and can be used by you in the 3D-model. As you can see, the defined resolution is displayed. You could repeat this procedure with different resolutions or modify any existing resolution afterwards as described above.
Page D.1 - 5
Settings
Selection Mode Here, you specify whether the contour selection has to be effected via an existing poly-line or via selection of individual segments. Shape Thickness When you have selected an open poly-line, the contour will be created along the poly-line with the indicated thickness. The poly-line is the neutral fibre. Shape System Here, you select whether the following created shapes have to be available only for steel (ProSteel), only for concrete (ProConcrete 3D) or for both applications.
Page D.1 - 6
Roof-Wall-Shapes
The creation of roof-wall-shapes is identical with the creation of general special shapes. The only purpose for dividing them is to have a clearer survey and still another feature of differentiation.
Combination Shapes
Combination shapes are not created using poly-lines or line elements. You have to arrange the shapes in the WCS in the way they have to be built later for definition. The best is to apply short shape pieces (e.g. with a length of 100 mm) in the cross-section. Please note, however, that they mustnt be mirrored.
The definition of a combination shape is analogous to that of the other special shapes, with the exception that you are not asked for poly-lines but for the shapes contained. Select the decisive shape first, and then the other ones. An inserted combination shape has the same properties like an individual shape. In contrast to standard shapes, you can dissolve the combination shapes into their individual parts and any processing of the individual segments is kept. Combination shapes are especially suitable for planning tasks or for tasks where several partial shapes have to be processed analogously (such as e.g. at the construction of fronts of buildings).
Page D.1 - 7
Page D.1 - 8
Enter the file name of the corresponding database file. Enter the display variant LOW, NORMAL or HIGH. Optional entry, see command description Starting point of the outer poly-line ..further polygon description Starting point of the 1st. inner poly-line ...further polygon description Additional insertion points, up to 16 pcs. You can only define one set of insertion points, i. e. you cannot define 16 points for each resolution! End of a depiction variant New depiction variant, if required ...
For the description of the polygon segments, commands for lines and arcs are at your disposal which can be described with relative or absolute coordinates. LINEAR_TO(dx, dy) Line segment from the last indicated point in relative coordinates x and y (analogously to AutoCAD-line input)
LINEAR_AT(x, y)
Line segment from the last indicated point in absolute coordinates x and y (analogously to AutoCAD-line input)
ARC_TO(r, phi)
Arc segment from the last indicated point, tangential at this point with the indicated radius r and the arc angle phi in degrees. A positive angle causes a rotation to the right, a negative angle causes a rotation to the left.
Page D.1 - 9
Arc segment from the last indicated point, tangential at this point with the indicated center point cx and cy as well as the end point ex and ey in absolute coordinates each.
Normally, the special shape is described using one or more closed poly-lines. However, an easier description can be selected for thin-wall-shapes (cold-rolled shapes in most cases). You can specify the wall thickness d by indicating the command THICKNESS=d and only have to describe the neutral fibre (open polygon) of the cross-section. The program then automatically calculates the required closed polygon. Create Database (Shape Sizes) In the database, a common DBASE-file, you only have to file the data records of the different variables and some information about the parts list.
Field 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8... n Field Name KEY NAME NOTE1 NOTE2 ITEM MATERIAL WEIGHT FIELD1 FIELD2 ... n Field Type Text Text Text Text Text Text Double Double Double Content
ProSteel-shape designation (access key) Shape name (display, parts list) annotation field 1 annotation field 2 item number Material index, not implemented at the moment weight per meter value of the first variable ($1) value of the next variable ($2...$n)
Page D.1 - 10
Page D.1 - 11
Click this button to remove the currently selected plate from the definition.
Page D.1 - 12
This option displays which plate is checked as current plate at the moment. There is a separate display on the monitor. The number of plates is displayed. The width of the current plate is indicated. The thickness of the current plate is indicated. The item number of the current plate is indicated. The material of the current plate is indicated. If this option is activated, the shape is treated like the contained individual parts at positioning, parts list and detailing. You have access to the subordinate properties of each single plate without having to explode the shape. When you dissolve the shape, it is verified whether flats can create the included sizes. Then, flats will be created instead of poly-plates. Here, you can define whether you want to see and modify the insertion points of the current plate or whether you want to see and modify the insertion points of the reference plate. The current plate will be aligned correspondingly. The x position of the insertion. This can either be relative to the origin or to an insertion point of a reference plate. The y position of the insertion. This can either be relative to the origin or to an insertion point of a reference plate. The rotation of the plate around its insertion point. Depending on the setting, you can see here the insertion point of the current plate related to the reference point or the selected reference point at the reference plate. If this field is checked, the insertion point is relative to a reference plate. The number of the reference plate. The number of the insertion point of the reference plate.
Check Flats
Monitor Point
Page D.1 - 13
Specifications for the top flange Specifications for the bottom flange Specifications for the web plate If this option is activated; the shape is treated like the contained individual parts at positioning, parts list and detailing. You have access to the subordinate properties of each single plate without having to explode the shape. If you dissolve such a shape and you have modified the web in a way that the flanges have to be bent, they normally are built like arc shapes. If this option is activated, straight flange segments will be created. When you dissolve the shape, it is verified whether flats can create the included sizes. Then, flats will be created instead of poly-plates.
Create Flange
Check Flats
Page D.1 - 14
At the very moment, 34 shape types to be processed and created are available in all for selection.
Page D.1 - 15
Each number indicates a parameter the value of which is entered in the dialog. By means of preview, you can control at any time how your shape has to look like. Afterwards, the shape can be saved and the properties of the special shape can be indicated.
Page D.1 - 16
BlockCenter
D.2
BlockCenter
BlockCenter is an effective tool for creation and management of any blocks within ProSteel. If you are working e.g. with system constructions which together with individual adaptations form your final project, BlockCenter gives you fast access to these prepared constructions. As it is a matter of ProSteel-blocks, the behaviour of these construction groups after insertion is the same as if they have just been created out of individual components. Of course it is also possible to manage any 2D-blocks by means of the BlockCenter or to add these blocks to your shop drawings (e.g. special labelling fields for your customers, recurring details of construction, and so on). Within the BlockCenter, you will find a great number of useful functions for your working with blocks. In addition, there is also an efficient database included allowing a classification and later search for the required 3D- or 2D-blocks. Here, you see the two BlockCenter dialogs (navigation dialog on the left, selection dialog on the right) together with a ProSteel-drawing:
Page 0- 1
BlockCenter
Navigation Dialog
In a tree structure, all existing block directories or groups are listed in navigation dialog. You can either choose a display reflecting the directory structure of your hard disk or a user-defined display. Sorting of the user-defined display can be designed freely to a large extent and then saved as a template (see function >'Template'). In addition, you may set different display filters. Navigation dialog is used when: - The current block directory (or block group) is modified - A directory is created or removed from hard disk - Blocks are created - The database structure is revised - The sorting of the display is changed. If a block group (e.g. system construction XYZ) has been selected, you also could hide this dialog to gain more space for construction on your screen.
Page 0 - 2
BlockCenter
Selection Dialog
In selection dialog, all blocks existing in the selected directory (or in the selected block group) are listed. They are displayed together with the drawing name and a preview. Of course it depends on the settings of sorting and filters in navigation dialog which block drawings are finally offered for selection. Selection dialog is used when: - a block is inserted into a drawing - an existing block is modified or deleted - the search data (classification) of the block are entered or modified The figures of preview are created by AutoCAD during saving of a drawing and show this drawing including current zoom setting at the moment of saving. Apart from scaling of size, you don't have any further influence on the display within the BlockCenter.
Database
In contrast to other ProSteel-functions, where all required data are stored in the drawing, BlockCenter is working with an additional database. The advantage of this database is that the blocks, especially if there are a great number of blocks, available at once after the function has been loaded. Neither a prolonged search in the directories nor a query of drawing data is necessary any more. In addition, user has a greater influence which drawings are integrated into the BlockCenter and which ones are not integrated. The database format was developed for the BlockCenter and permits fast access to all data required for sorting and selection. The additional content of the database (user-defined database fields) can be designed as you like. You may decide yourself which data fields are used to classify your blocks for selection and search and how they have to be named. Different properties of the block drawing are already taken from the drawing when a block is created (or even at a later time) and entered in previously defined database fields. Some search criteria will be available at once. If these fields are not required, they can of course be removed from the database.
Page 0- 3
BlockCenter
Creation
Select the option directory structure as display for the creation of a block. Now check the directory where the block has to be stored in navigation dialog and select the entry create block via context menu. Select all components of the model which have to be adopted in the block and pick the main insertion point of the block. Finally, you are asked for the alignment of the block to allow insertion with correct alignment afterwards: When you select ESC, the correct UCS will be used. Alternatively, it is possible to pick a point on the later x-axis as well as a point on the x/y-plane. Please note, however, that at later insertion the block will automatically always be aligned in a way that the coordinate system pre-defined here is corresponding with the current drawing UCS. It is however possible to define alternative insertion points and alignments. Now, a new drawing will be created and displayed containing the selected component parts. This drawing can be modified further as you like: you can e.g. add other ProSteel- and AutoCAD-elements or additional insertion points. Hint: As long as this drawing has not been saved, it cannot be adopted into the database. It is possible to cancel block creation. It is not before the block drawing has been stored once which can also be done when you quit this function that the block will be finally adopted into the database and be displayed as preview in selection dialog.
Selection
Select an appropriate sorting in the settings and then check the desired block group in navigation dialog by clicking on it. Depending on the setting, this may either be a directory or any user-defined sorting criteria. Within navigation dialog, you may scroll up and down the tree structure, as you are accustomed to doing in Windows-Explorer.
Page 0 - 4
BlockCenter If you click on a new entry, selection dialog will be filled with small preview figures as well as with the file names of available blocks. Only those blocks are displayed, which have been adopted into the database and which meet the possibly activated filter condition. There may be other drawings included in the directory. Select the desired block by clicking the preview figure in selection dialog. Above the selection list, additional information on the selected block will be displayed which can also be defined freely.
Modification
When you want to open an existing block for working or looking on it, select the entry Edit block in the context menu after block selection. The block drawing now is opened as new drawing that can be modified. If you want to keep the modification, the drawing has of course to be stored.
Delete
Select the entry delete block in the context menu after block selection to remove a block from the database. Now, you can determine whether you only want to delete the entry in the database or also the complete drawing on your hard disk. If you don't delete the drawing, it is possible to adopt it again into the database at a later time. Any additionally entered data of this block are of course lost because they have been stored in the database and not in the drawing. Additional insertion points, are kept, because they are stored in the drawing as visible objects.
Page 0- 5
BlockCenter
Page 0 - 6
BlockCenter
Page 0- 7
BlockCenter
Group Block Directory Block path here, you see the basic directory of the blocks to be managed by the BlockCenter. These blocks are stored in subdirectories. In this basic directory, you will also find the database file so that you could work with different block directories (and databases). To modify the directory, click on the button on the right of the display. Then, you can determine the directory anew via file selection dialog. Please note that the blocks may only be in subdirectories of this basic directory.
Standard fields... Here, you determine the behaviour at a database update. The meaning of the options Do not replace, Always replace and Only replace blanks is described in detail in chapter 'Update database'.
Page 0 - 8
BlockCenter
Group Options for Insertion Group objects at insertion of blocks, the program ignores all block elements not belonging to a group. This option is, however, only valid for special insertion variants planned for future versions. here, you specify the ball diameter with which the additional insertion points will be displayed.
Insertion points
Pattern Rotation Angle Here, you specify the angle of rotation of the block about the insertion point.
Group Display Preview Directory... Here, you can set the height of preview windows in the display dialog. In navigation dialog, the block groups are displayed depending on the directory structure on the hard disk. You always have to use this sorting for the creation of new blocks, because otherwise you won't be able to determine a target directory for the block file. It is possible to create an individual sorting for the navigation dialog depending on the contents of the user-defined database fields. Sorting then will be made in an hierarchic structure in the order which is displayed in the list on the right.
User...
ARROW RIGHT Click on this button to add a property field to the list. Then, a dialog box will be opened where the existing database fields are displayed. Select the desired field out of this list. ARROW LEFT Display All Click on this button to remove the checked field from the list. At user-defined sorting, the blocks, which cannot be clearly assigned, will be displayed as well. This is the case when the corresponding field doesn't exist in the database or when it is empty. Then, the block will be assigned to a standard field of the sorting level in question. At all sorting, only those blocks will be displayed the database fields of which have not been completely filled in. Thus, it is easy for you to find out whether all database fields which are used for a possible search exist with valid entries.
Incomplete
Page 0- 9
BlockCenter
Use Filter
At sorting, the blocks are filtered depending on user-defined criteria. Only those blocks will be displayed which meet the filter condition (and of course the sorting condition). A specific selection is made possible. Here, you see the currently selected filter template. Click on the small button on the right of the information field to select a template. Please refer to chapter 'Display Filter' for a detailed description of how to create a filter template.
Display Filter
User-defined Sorting
One important strength of the BlockCenter is the user-defined sorting according to any user-defined criteria. Fur this purpose, you can define your own database fields and fill them later with data of the corresponding block. In the settings, you may now specify a hierarchy according to which the blocks have to be displayed at a user-defined sorting. Here an example to make things clear: Let us assume that among others you created database fields for the shape, for the whole pattern and for the shear protection to classify prepared root points and you indicate exactly these fields in this order as sorting. If you now switch over to user-defined sorting, the tree-structure in the navigation dialog will be as follows: the contents of the field 'shape' will be displayed on top level, the contents of the field 'hole pattern' will be displayed on the following level below, and so on. For each data input, e.g. in the field 'shape' (e.g. HEA140 and HEA160) an entry will be created on the same level in the tree-structure and blocks with identical contents will be sorted there (analogously to the directories and sub-directories on the hard disk). This helps you to find out similar blocks at a great number of blocks. To avoid slightly differing entries for the same thing, all data existing for this field will be displayed in a list at data input. Assignments can be made, too. This helps you to avoid that once you enter e.g. HEA140 and once you enter HE140A.
Page 0 - 10
BlockCenter
D.2.5
Working with the database is divided into four essential parts: definition of data fields, input of actual block data, maintenance of the database and use of the data for display and filter.
Group Field Definition List Here, you see the field names of already defined data fields. If you want to edit or to delete one of the fields, click on it for selection. Here, you enter the field name of the new database field. Field names always consist of capital letters (small letters will be automatically transformed) and already existing names are ignored. It is useful to enter reasonable field names as these are displayed in the selection dialogs for sorting and search. For each field a description may be added as auxiliary text for the other dialogs.
Field Name
Page 0- 11
BlockCenter
Here, you specify the labelling of the input field for field data in the input dialog for block data. Here, you may specify a describing auxiliary text for the database field, which will be displayed in the other dialogs at selection of this field. As you should use concise and easy field names, you can add more information to the field by this way. The data of the database field will be displayed in selection dialog after selection of a block. This helps limiting the display to some essential fields in the case that there is a great number of data fields.
Display:
Group Data Text Field Data are evaluated as mere text. Sorting is made in alphabetical order so that the entry "11" would be sorted in front of the entry "2". Data are evaluated as integer. Here, the entry "B2" would be sorted in front of the entry "A11" because the numerical part has priority. Data are evaluated as float. If the imperial unit system is used, the units inch and foot will be displayed correctly.
Integer
Floating Point
Floating Point (fix) Data are evaluated as float. If the imperial unit system is used, the units will not be displayed in inch and foot (e.g. for angles).
Page 0 - 12
BlockCenter
Page 0- 13
BlockCenter
Page 0 - 14
BlockCenter
Update of Database
Click on the entry Update database in the context menu of navigation dialog to update an existing database. In this case, the program searches for drawing files, which dont exist any more in the block directory, and removes them from the database. At the same time, new drawing files and sub-directories will be adopted into the database. At update of the database, the entered data and modifications of data fields are kept. You may define via pre-settings what has to be done with the standard fields during update. When the option 'Don't replace standard fields' was selected, no entries in the standard fields will be modified, i.e. new drawings won't be examined either. When the option 'Always replace standard fields' was selected, all drawings will be searched for standard data and any possible modifications will be lost. When the option 'Only replace blank standard fields' was selected, newly added drawings will be examined, as their standard fields are still blank. All others won't be taken into consideration. When some standard fields were removed from the database, they won't be restored during update. By means of update, it is, however, possible to make sure that modifications in the block files will cause an update of the remaining standard fields. The program assumes that deleted standard fields won't be required any more. Please note that each drawing in question has to be opened for update in order to determine the drawing data. This process may require some time until it is finished.
Page 0- 15
BlockCenter
Display Filter
Another strength of the BlockCenter is the display filter according to certain search criteria. Before the blocks are displayed in the selected sorting, the program first checks whether each single block meets the filter conditions on the basis of its database entries. For this purpose, logical links may be created between the existing data fields and their contents. There is no limit concerning the complexity of the query. Different filter combinations can be stored as templates and then defined as activated filter in the settings for the sorting. You may e.g. specify that only blocks having holes will be displayed if they have 4 enforced holes. Then, the neighbouring figure will show you the result of filtering at a given sorting according to shape, hole pattern and if they are enforced. To be able to work reasonably with the filters, user should have a certain mathematical understanding of logically linked notions. It is very easy to create a filter condition never producing any positive result at all in combination with the existing data a corresponding check doesn't take place.
Boolean operators
Simple queries only consist of one comparing condition such as e.g. whole pattern = 4. It is, however, the logical link between several comparing conditions, which is really interesting. Therefore, you may specify a logical operator by means of which the next inserted comparing condition shall be linked with the existing condition. To facilitate input, previous pairs are automatically put into brackets, in case of a change of the operator. It is possible to create search queries such as (A AND B) OR (A AND C) in an easy way. A, B and C here are variables of simple comparing conditions of data field, operator and content. An existing term can be manually put into brackets, too, if the condition is not in pairs. The following condition serves as example: ((A AND B) OR C) AND D.
Page 0 - 16
BlockCenter
Define Filter
To define a filter term click on the entry Edit display filter in the context menu of navigation dialog. The following dialog box will be opened:
Group comparable term List Here, all user-defined database fields are displayed which may be used for the search criteria. Each field may be used as often as you like. Select the desired field by clicking on it in the list. Then, the field name will be displayed on the right. In the information line, the auxiliary text for this field will be displayed containing more detailed information on the data field. here, user presets an individual comparing condition consisting of field name, comparing operator and block data. Logical operators to form the complete filter condition can combine several comparing conditions. The current database field, which can be modified by clicking on it in the list. Here, the comparing operator is selected linking the database field and the block data (content of the field) to build a comparing condition.
Display fields
Page 0- 17
BlockCenter
> Right
Possible block data (contents of the field) of the selected data field in a dropdown-list. Impossible comparing conditions will be avoided.
After all three components of a comparing condition were preset; you can add this condition to the complete filter condition by clicking on the INSERT button. Depending on the existing conditions and selected logical links, appropriate brackets are set by the program. Group Filter Condition Display field the complete filter condition, if need be, as logical link consisting of several comparing conditions. If a comparing condition has already been inserted, the activated logical operator of the following comparing condition will be displayed as well.
OPERATOR OR Click on this button to select the logical operator OR as logical link for the following comparing condition.
BRACKET Click on this button to force the program to put the existing filter conditions into brackets manually. Brackets are always necessary when the complete result of a (partial) condition has to be linked with another, as the combination of (A AND B) OR C is different to A AND (B OR C). INSERT Click on this button to add the current comparing condition to the complete filter condition.
Page 0 - 18
BlockCenter
DELETE Click on this button to delete the comparing condition, which was added last.
DELETE ALL Click on this button to delete the complete filter condition.
Page 0- 19
BlockCenter
Page 0 - 20
Roof/Wall Panels
D.3
Roof/Wall Panels
This command allows you to divide any surface with roof-wall shapes and display them in colour. You choose orientation and grid spacing. The program then determines necessary cut-outs in the shapes. You can work with all shapes, including special shapes and plates. Layout is done on the active UCS plane. It is recommended to use a top view of the UCS plane.
Surface Layout
To divide a wall surface by means of front shapes, outer bordering of the surface as well as possible inner cuts have to exist as poly-lines first. After having loaded the function, click the Outer Poly-Line of the Surface first and then the direction determining line for alignment. Now, pick the Origin of Division and the following dialog appears for further specifications:
Page D.3 - 1
Roof/Wall Panels
Here, you are prompted to indicate the grid length (i.e. the lengths of the shapes to be installed). Here, you are prompted to indicate the grid width. If the grid width exceeds the shape width, the layout will show gaps - if the grid width is smaller, you will have overlaps. In the neighbouring input field, the shape width of the currently selected shape is displayed (see Shapes tab). Here, you enter the distance between layout and active UCS plane. By entering positive values, you move the surface along the positive Z-axis of UCS. Here, you enter a projection of the shape over the grid length at the upper end. If you enter a positive value, the shape is shortened and a gap is shown. If you enter a negative value, the shape is extended and overlaps with he next grid element. Here, you enter a projection of the shape over the grid length at the lower end. If you enter a positive value, the shape is shortened and a gap is shown. If you enter a negative value, the shape is extended and overlaps with the previous grid element. Here, you enter the dimension by which the shape insertion points to be moved horizontally from the center of the grid. The command automatically reacts to a modification of the polygon. If this field is checked, the shapes, which are longer or wider than the outer poly-line, are cut at this poly-line. Here you enter how grid lines are moved against each other in longitudinal direction. No offset means that they are not moved. Centered offset means that they are moved in a way that a new line begins in the middle of the previous line (laid brick pattern). Dimensions mean that the lines are offset against each other by a value you entered in the neighbouring input field.
Depth
Offset Top
Offset Bottom
Page D.3 - 2
Roof/Wall Panels
Colour Normal
Select a colour for all shapes not being cut by entering the AutoCAD colour code. The colour can also be selected by clicking the BUTTON which is situated at the right. Select a colour for all shapes being cut by entering the AutoCAD colour code. The colour can also be selected by clicking the BUTTON which is situated at the right. Using this option resets the colours to their original values after the dialog function has been finished.
Colour Cut
Original Colour
Shape Selection
Choose the component parts to be used for installation on the second page.
Shapes
Unless having checked Use Poly-Plates field, you select here the shape to be used for installation. You can select the shape according to the shape categories in the lists.
Page D.3 - 3
Roof/Wall Panels
Plates
If the Use Poly-Plates field is checked, a rectangular polyplate is used as installation element instead of a shape. You can determine the dimensions in the Plate Width and Plate Thickness input fields, the length corresponds to the Grid Length corrected by the offset value. You can specify a name for the plate in the selection list. If the Grid field is checked, a plate grid (e.g. for a grating at the installation of stage coverings) is created for being displayed.
Poly-Cuts
You can enter additional cut outs into a surface at which the shapes have to be cut as well. In order to do this, the poly-lines of the cut outs are required which can, however, still be drawn when the function is activated.
Poly-Cuts
Here, you can see the number of additional cut outs existing at the moment.
Page D.3 - 4
Roof/Wall Panels
By clicking this button, you can insert a cut out into the division. Click the poly-line of the cut out in order to do so. If the poly-line doesnt yet exist, you can draw it directly before loading this option. By clicking this button, you can delete the currently selected cut out and close the surface at this position. If you have several cut outs in the division, you can select the required cut out by pressing << and >>. Here the example of a gable wall automatically lined with wall facing elements. The dark surfaces show the elements that do not have to be cut out; the light surfaces have to be cut out. In addition, 2 openings have been inserted.
Page D.3 - 5
Roof/Wall Panels
Page D.3 - 6
D.4
Use this command to distribute as many AutoCAD blocks as desired evenly across a shape length and add their insertion points as markings to the shape (e.g. for NC-output). Of course, you can just add markings without inserting a block. In addition, the function allows for the parametric generation of thread bolts or similar solids of revolution at simultaneous distribution analogously to the distribution of blocks described above.
Page D.4 - 1
Group Distances Spacing Front Offset End Offset Here you enter the distance between the individual insertion points. Here you enter the distance from shape start to the first insertion point. Here you enter the distance from last insertion point to the end of the shape.
Page D.4 - 2
Insertion Rules
Since in most cases the length of a shape does not coincide with the settings, you can define the rules for distribution here. End Dimensions The margin dimensions are exactly adhered to and the internal distance is averaged. Inner Values The inner values are adhered to and the margin dimensions are averaged. Centre Inner Values - The inner values are adhered to and the rest is evenly distributed at the front and at the back. At Plate Drilling This option is especially meant for distribution of anchor bolts or similar things at base plates. The parts are aligned at the existing drillings and fixed below a plate. Pick at Plate You select the insertion points of the component parts within the plate. Position and height are determined from the plate. You enter the diameter of marking or nipple hole. You enter the depth of marking or nipple hole.
Group Options Shape Center Create Marks.. Lower No Detailing Insert Blocks Create Group In Part List In Bolt List The markings are attached to the center of the selected shapes. The marking or nipple holes are attached. The component parts are attached below the plate. The component parts inserted here are not detailed in the DetailCenter. The selected weld bolts are attached. The shapes and bolts form a group. The component parts attached with this function are added to the parts list. The component parts attached with this function are added to the bolt list.
Page D.4 - 3
Bottom Dia Bottom Top Dia. Top Length Bolt Dia. Bolt Length
Diameter of the bolts base Length of the bolts base Diameter of the bolts head Length of the head Diameter of bolt nipple Length of bolt nipple
Group Others Name List The bolt name in the parts list The list of available entries in the selected bolt database
This button distributes the bolts on the selected shapes according to the preset rules.
This button permits individual placing of bolts on the selected shapes. Here, each insertion point is indicated individually.
Here you see two examples for the distribution of welded bolts on shapes:
Page D.4 - 4
The options concerning the distribution are identical with the distribution of thread bolts. So you can refer to this chapter for more detailed information. Hole Dia Sign You can specify a code for the drill holes to be created. This code serves for selection of special NC-programs being able to recognize this code. This is the path to the block to be inserted. The list of saved blocks from the database
Page D.4 - 5
Select the database to be used. The component parts are seized for the parts list.
Page D.4 - 6
Page D.4 - 7
Page D.4 - 8
Auxiliary Tools
D.5 D.5.1
An important task of modern CAD systems is to avoid errors during construction. First and foremost this is to avoid collisions. This functions serves for the detection and display of collisions within any kind of component parts. There are various reasons for collisions to occur. In addition this function helps you to check whether bolts can be mounted or not. The check is made on the base of the parts volume. If a collision is detected, the collision volume is displayed on screen and the component parts in question are highlighted. Then, you can zoom on all collisions one after the other and check the positions concerned. At collision check, xref-drawings are evaluated as well.
Min. Volume
Minimal collision volume, from which on the collision is seized as such. The display is made in drawing units (such as e. g. mm). This avoids that your attention is distracted from important things by collisions, which are due to minimal tolerances. Factor by which the zoom window is increased when you zoom on the found parts to get a survey on the whole situation. Display of the current collision solid and the total amount of solids found.
Display Scaling
Actual/Max.
Page D.5 - 1
Auxiliary Tools
Use this button to start collision check. You are prompted to select all parts to be checked. All colliding components now are highlighted with a colour defined in the settings, and the collision solids are displayed. You can of course select a complete model. Please note that the required time increases with the square of the number of selected component parts. The reason is that each part has to be checked with each other part. Therefore, it is often more reasonable to check only a certain junction point at a time. All selected bolts are checked with regard to any possible collisions.
Use this button to remove the highlighting of the parts and to delete all found collision solids as long as they are situated on the collision layer. Use this button to select the next found collision solid for examination. Use this button to select the previous found collision solid for examination.
Page D.5 - 2
Auxiliary Tools
Options
During collision check, you can specify which component parts have to be checked against each other. A filter is available for the selection of the parts to be checked.
Shapes
can be checked for collisions with shapes, plates, bolts and bodies. The collision volume is only displayed for the selected pairings. can be checked for collisions with plates, bolts and bodies. The collision volume is only displayed for the selected pairings. can be checked for collisions with bolts and bodies. The mounting space of the bolts which can be specified in bolt style can be used as well. The collision volume is only displayed for the selected pairings. Bodies can be checked against other bodies. The collision volume is only displayed for the selected pairings.
Plates
Bolts
Bodies
Highest Resolution The component parts are temporarily switched over to highest possible resolution for collision check. Mounting Area At collision check with bolts, the mounting area of bolts is taken into consideration as well.
Page D.5 - 3
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.2
Center of Gravity
Use this function to calculate the center of gravity of any parts. Select the parts in question and the calculation is started. A ball in the model and numerically in the dialog line visually displays the result. There, you obtain information about the defined volume, the exact coordinates of the center of gravity (in world coordinates) as well as the total weight of the parts. Please note that, in contrast to previous versions than Release 18, different specific weights are taken into consideration.
Page D.5 - 4
Auxiliary Tools
Resolution Max. Indicate the resolution of the unfolding. The higher the indicated value, the more detailed is the scan of the component searching for any possible outlets or notches. The greatest acceptable value is 360. Use ACIS Inner Contour Switches the component part from unfolding to ACIS. The result may be an increase of accuracy. The inner contour of tube shapes is unfolded as well.
Page D.5 - 5
Auxiliary Tools Group Colours Outer Contour Outside Edges Tessellation L. Bend Line Create Tessel. colour of the outer contour of the developments. colour of the tessellation lines of the outer contour. colour of possibly existing bent edges of the outer contour. If this field is checked, tessellation lines are displayed.
Group Colours Inner Contour Outer Edge Tessellation L. colour of the inner contour of the developments. colour of the tessellation lines of the inner contour.
Creating Development
After you have exited the dialog, you have to click the shape that is to be unwound or developed. The desired operation is then supplied sticking to the crosshairs. Position it freely anywhere in the model and process it further if desired. If you have selected Inner Contour, both developments are sticking to the crosshairs in the form of two properly positioned blocks. Position them anywhere in the model and then process them individually.
Page D.5 - 6
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.4
Move Objects
Use this function to simulate moving of any parts along a line, poly-line or spline. This can be applied for visualizations or to check whether parts can be assembled. The objects are moved along a guideline in a set speed. In addition, you can choose whether you only want to move the parts or whether they have to be rotated as well.
Resolution
Enter here into how many equal parts the guide line has to be divided. The higher the value, the more regular and the more fluent the simulated movement will be. Wait in milliseconds after each single movement. This value controls the speed of the simulated movement. The objects are not only moved along the guide line, but also rotated around this line. This means, if you have a sharp bend in the line, the parts will be rotated along this bend.
After clicking the OK button, seize the guide line first. This may be a line, polyline, spline or an arc. Then seize the parts and the simulation starts.
Page D.5 - 7
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.5
Create ACIS-DWG
If you process 3D-models using other 3D-programs, it often will be necessary to convert the existing ProSteel-component parts into mere ACIS-bodies. After having loaded the function, you have to select the component parts which you want to convert. Important: Please note that the converted component parts dont keep their ProSteel-intelligence such as shape reference, logical links etc. The body, however, is inserted additionally and the original component part is only hidden. You can make it visible again using the command PS_REGEN.
Batch Processing
To avoid having to process each drawing individually, batch processing is available if you have many drawings. All drawings of a directory are processed automatically and the converted drawings are saved in another directory.
Source Directory Enter the directory containing the drawings you want to have converted automatically. Target Directory Enter the directory where you want to save all converted drawings. The target directory mustnt be identical with the source directory nor must it be beneath the source directory. Purge Drawing Recursive Groups Each drawing is purged before it is saved. Drawings in sub directories of the selected directory are processed as well. Each component part group is converted as common ACISbody. Otherwise, each component part of the group is converted individually.
Page D.5 - 8
Auxiliary Tools
Resolution
The resolution of the component parts (without radii etc.) is kept individually per part. Otherwise, the ACIS-body is created with the maximum possible resolution. The original component parts are not only hidden after conversion, but completely deleted. The converted ACIS-bodies are kept on the layer of the original component part. Otherwise, all bodies are created on the current layer. If this field is not activated, you can easily copy the result of conversion from the drawing.
Page D.5 - 9
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.6
If you have to pass on 3D or 2D-drawings, it is sometimes necessary that they dont contain any ProSteel objects any more. This command converts each object of the drawing into its original AutoCAD graphical elements so that the recipient doesnt get any Proxy -message any during loading. Important: Please note that the information of the drawing is visually kept, but that the complete ProSteel-intelligence of the component parts such as shape reference, logical links etc. is irretrievably lost.
Batch Processing
To avoid having to process each drawing individually, batch processing is available if you have many drawings. All drawings of a directory are processed automatically and the converted drawings are saved in another directory.
Source Directory Enter the directory containing the drawings you want to have converted automatically. Target Directory Enter the directory where you want to save all converted drawings. The target directory mustnt be identical with the source directory nor must it be beneath the source directory. Purge Drawing Recursive Each drawing is purged before it is saved. Drawings in sub directories of the selected directory are processed as well.
Page D.5 - 10
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.7
This function is only available in a specific version of ProSteel for Autodesk Architectural Desktop (ADT) from Autodesk. This AutoCAD application is specifically designed for architects and contains a variety of steel shapes. With a call to this function you can convert the ADT shapes into ProSteel shapes for further use of the ProSteel manipulation functionality for steel construction. After a call to the function you should choose all the ADT shapes that should be converted. If ProSteel finds a corresponding shape in its database then the ADT shape is deleted and is replaced with the suitable ProSteel shape.
Page D.5 - 11
Auxiliary Tools
Page D.5 - 12
D.6
Analysis display allows you to control and to work on the effective static analysis lines of the shapes to get an optimum output for translation to static analysis programs. From the individual interfaces, you can force the output of analysis display. The effective lines defined by you will be output instead of the center lines of the shapes. If no modifications were made here, the effective lines correspond to center lines. This function offers you, the possibility to modify the effective lines independently of the insertion of a shape to balance e.g. eccentricities, if these have no importance for calculation or to close open nodes.
Effective Lines
After loading the function, you first have to select the objects that are to be switched to analysis display. Having made this selection, you only see an individual line of each shape, representing the effective static analysis line. The different colours within the line help you to recognize whether the end is connected with another shape (representing a node) or whether it is open (e.g. a cantilever). If the end is open and not a cantilever, then you are dealing with eccentric shapes in most cases and you could create a closed system by means of this function. It is possible to modify the effective lines manually by using the offered options of this function or by modifying them via AutoCAD grips.
Page D.6 - 1
Check colours...: If this field is checked, the colours of the represented shape ends will be verified automatically, every time the function is loaded. See button ->'Update colours' Check connect...: If this field is checked, the different parts will be verified automatically whether they are connected with each other or not, every time the function is loaded. Display is adapted accordingly. Hide ... If these fields are checked, the selected objects will be hidden to provide a clearer view. You can hide work frames, structural elements (auxiliary lines of structural elements), polyplates, bolts and connecting parts such as web angles, etc.
Shorten offsets: If this field is checked, the cantilevered ends at a node will be shortened, so that there will be no offsets. You can specify the maximum possible offset in the corresponding input field Max. Offset. All values larger than the actual value e.g. a cantilever and will not be taken into account. When this button is clicked, the program tries to connect the effective static analysis lines automatically to create a closed system. If the effective lines are situated in a common plane, they are extended to each other and a node is symbolically represented as a ball. At the same time, the ends adopt the same colour as the center part of the line to display a closed connection. Please note, that the penetrating lines are not divided at the nodes. You can force this division later during export. When this button is clicked, the program verifies whether a connection to neighbouring parts or an open end exists. The represented colour will be modified accordingly. Red signifies that there is an open end and green means that this end is connected with a neighbouring part. The difference between this function and the function 'Automatic' is, that here the program only checks and the display is updated where as the function 'Automatic' tries to create a connection and when doing this can also modify the effective line.
Page D.6 - 2
If this button is clicked, the components in question are connected with each other by means of a manual link. For this purpose you have to select the components afterwards. The main part of the manual connection keeps its position; the connected parts are related to this main part so that their effective lines can e.g. be positioned diagonally towards it. A node will be created automatically. A manual link does not have any further meaning. It only serves for creation of intended connections. On one hand, these connections are used in this function for the definition of nodes. On the other hand, they allow dimensioning of system lines at detailing.
Start X,Y,Z
the coordinates of the start point of the effective static analysis line in absolute coordinate values.
Page D.6 - 3
the coordinates of the end point of the effective static analysis line in absolute coordinate values. If this field is checked, the values of the corresponding end have been modified manually (and mostly, they differ from the center line).
Connected with: If this field is checked, the corresponding end is connected with another shape by means of a node No Discrimination If this field is checked, you can avoid a division of the shape in individual lines between the nodes of connecting shapes at export of static data. In export functions, you can, avoid this limitation so that you don't have to modify each single shape if this division is desired. See function ->'Export Allows picking the start point of AEC.
Page D.6 - 4
Data Exchange
D.7 D.7.1
It is possible to send and receive data to and from other programs via the import and export interfaces of ProSteel. In most cases, these are 3D-constructions of other CAD-programs or the static analysis systems of programs for static analysis calculations. The exchange takes place via a special file format defined by independent standard committees like e.g. Deutscher Stahlbauverband DSTV (German Association of Steel Construction) or even by the program manufacturers themselves. The data to be exchanged are mostly saved as ASCII-text file; therefore they are independent of the used operating systems. In case of possible transfer problems they can be adapted with any text editor you like. Additionally to the "acknowledged" formats, ProSteel also has its own exchange format based on a clear text file. This format exactly describes the positioning and detailing of component parts, group structure and parts list or part information.
Page D.7 - 5
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 6
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 7
Data Exchange
Group Exchange List Internal Name Here, you will find a list of all designations used by ProSteel. You can assign as many alternative exchange designations to each of these internal names as you like. The current selection is displayed in the grey input field. Here, you select the shape type. When the input field Material has been checked, this previous type selection is not available. Here, you select the shape size or the material designation to which you want to assign the alternative names.
Page D.7 - 8
Data Exchange
Replace as
Enter a new designation and insert it into the list. The program doesnt differentiate capitalization or the use of small initial letters. Since exchange designations can only be inserted, you have to insert the new entry first and then delete the old one, if you only want to modify an entry. Here, you will find the exchange designations of the ProSteel designation selected on the left. The first name in the list is the designation used during export of a ProSteel model. By clicking this button, the new exchange designation specified in the input field Replace is assigned to the selected ProSteel designation. By clicking this button, the selected exchange designation is removed from the selected ProSteel designation. By clicking this button, the selected exchange designation is selected for export and moved to the first position in the list. Here, you can make the above-mentioned assignments for shape designations. Here, you can make the above-mentioned assignments for material designations. all-internal names are displayed no matter whether exchange designations have been assigned or not. Only those internal names are displayed to which exchange designations have already been assigned. Only those internal names are displayed to which exchange designations have not been assigned.
INSERT
Group Others File Content Add Names the file path of the current exchange list. A short description of the content of the new exchange list or of the list, which has been loaded at the very moment. The exchange designations of the shape data base are entered when an exchange list is created or completed.
Page D.7 - 9
Data Exchange
Dialog-Commands
LOAD By clicking this button, you can load an exchange list. It is also possible to import an exchange list in dBASE-format by selecting the file type in the file selection dialog, which opens then. dBASE-import is not available when you select the dialog via the interface dialogs. STORE By clicking this button, you can store the current exchange list. It is possible to export an exchange list in dBASE-format by selecting the file type in the file selection dialog, which opens then. dBASE-export is not available when you select the dialog via the interface dialog. NEW By clicking this button, a new exchange list is created based on the shape and material database of ProSteel. Thus, you obtain all available internal names and you can add the desired exchange designations to them. If the field Add Exchange Designation at New/Update has been checked, the exchange designations of the shape database are entered, too. UPDATE By clicking this button, new entries based on the shape or material database of ProSteel are added to the current exchange list.
Page D.7 - 10
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 11
Data Exchange
Content
line type, (F) group line (S) shape entry (M) material entry shape type when shape group or "Material" when material group ProSteel shape file (when material group: no entry necessary) Internal ProSteel designation metric Internal ProSteel designation imperial (for material like field 3) exchange designation (1st list entry, is also export name) if need be, further exchange designation (2nd list entry) if need be, further exchange designations (next list entries) The dBASE-file with the shape data of the data directory of ProSteel. Here specified without path with name and extension. Type designation (e.g. DIN_HEA); the different sizes are the shape entries up to the next group line.
Page D.7 - 12
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 13
Data Exchange
Individual page of the selected interface. Individual page of the selected interface.
General Settings Common page for all interfaces. Conversion Common page for all interfaces.
In the following chapters, you will find a description of the different interfaces and of their property pages. In most cases, the corresponding manufacturers or standard committees can obtain a description of the interface formats.
Dialog Commands
CONTINUE (OK) By clicking this button, import or export will be continued, if the selected interface command is waiting for further specifications or if the process has been stopped for your information. LIST By clicking this button, you can select an existing exchange list for import or export.
PROCESS By clicking this button, you can process an existing exchange list for import or export or select another list.
FILE If you click this button, the read or created interface file will be displayed if it is an ASCII-text file.
ERROR REPORT By clicking this button, you can view an error report, if it is created by the selected interface command. In this error report, you are e.g. informed whether errors have occurred in a read file or whether certain data cannot be evaluated by ProSteel.
Page D.7 - 14
Data Exchange
Import Data
When this function is loaded, a file selection dialog opens where you can select the required interface under File Type. Then, you select the file to be imported. Depending on the interface, an interface dialog opens where you can make further specifications concerning the data to be imported. After file selection resp. after confirmation of import process in the dialog, the data are evaluated and the ProSteel model is created. Depending on the complexity of the interface and on the volume of the data, this process may take some time. You are, however, informed about the current state in the AutoCADcommand line or in the interface dialog. After the creation of the model has been finished, a note box will be displayed.
Working Areas
A working area can be created automatically to allow you to work with the basic views of the imported model immediately. A rectangular working area will be created approximately describing the outer dimensions of the model (only the end points of the shape axes are considered at the calculation). This is an ideal starting point for the control of the imported model resp. for the creation of further views.
Page D.7 - 15
Data Exchange
Unknown Designations
As the data in the exchange formats mostly are the used shapes and plates, it is recommended to provide all existing shape databases correctly. You should do this above all if you import constructions containing foreign shape series. In most cases, the interface formats only transfer one shape name as reference; the actual information on the geometry of the cross-section comes from the importing program. ProSteel supports so-called exchange lists to cope with the different designations. The imported name is translated into a valid ProSteel shape and the selection of substitute cross-sections is made possible. If the name does not exist, the shape is considered to be unknown. A dialog appears where you can assign a ProSteel shape to the unknown shape.
Unknown ProSteel
The imported shape name, which is not found. here, you enter the access code or you select the shape from a list by clicking SELECTION button. The shape type (e.g. HEA) is displayed first at selection. After having selected the shape type, you can select the required shape from the existing shape sizes by double-clicking the entry. The specified assignment is permanently stored in a file. Otherwise, it is only valid for the current load of import command. Thus, it will also be available for later selections of this or other import commands.
Permanent
Page D.7 - 16
Data Exchange
The assignment of unknown designations is also available for material names. The process is the same as described under shape names.
General Settings
If the interface dialog is available in the selected import format, it can also contain a page for General Settings apart from the specific pages. This page is identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the import process. Depending on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields are not activated.
Error Report
An error report is created during import and model generation. You can see here which data are defective or which cannot be evaluated by ProSteel. If such an error report was created, you can display it by clicking the ERROR REPORT button in the dialog box. A working area of 6 basic views is created with the help of the outer dimensions of the imported model. Here, you can indicate the name of the working area. If it still exists, the new views obtain the index "2".
Page D.7 - 17
Data Exchange
Connect
Continuous shape parts (bars) are connected to a common shape. Only those shapes are connected which have the same size and position, which are situated on a common axis and which dont exceed a preset distance of the end points.
> Max. Distance Here, you enter the maximum distance, which is allowed for the end points to be connected to be recognized as continuous shape. > Tolerance Value Here, you enter a tolerance for possible deviations of the gusset coordinates. This is reasonable when you import data of static analysis programs as these are generating a system of bars from gusset to gusset (e.g. plate connection) although in reality it is a continuous shape.
Connecting Shapes The static program transfers this system as 4 bars of 1-2, 2-3, 4-2 and 5-2. Four shapes are created first which are connected in the way that there will be one remaining shape of 1-3 and one of 4-5. Supposed the fact that bars of 1-2, 2-3, 4-4a and 5-5a were transferred, the bars 4-4a and 5-5a would only be connected to a shape if the distance of 4a to 5a was smaller than indicated in Max. Distance input field.
Page D.7 - 18
Data Exchange
Conversion
If the interface dialog is available in the selected import format, it can also contain a page for Conversion apart from the specific pages. This p age is identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the import process. Depending on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields are not activated.
Query
At import process, you are prompted for each unknown shape or material in a dialog so that you can select a replacing shape. If this field has not been checked, the unknown shape cannot be created. However, it might be that certain parts are not required for very big models. Therefore, a replacement is not necessary. Here, you see the file name of the currently used exchange list.
Import-Table
Page D.7 - 19
Data Exchange
Export Data
When this function is loaded, you first have to select the parts to be exported in the model and a file selection dialog opens and you can select the required interface under the option File Type. Then, you select the file to be exported. Depending on the interface, an interface dialog opens where you can make further specifications concerning the format. After file selection resp. after confirmation of export process in the dialog, the model data are evaluated and the data record is created. Depending on the complexity of the interface and on the volume of the data, this process may take some time. You are, however, informed about the current state in the AutoCADcommand line or in the interface dialog. After the creation of the file has been finished, a note box will be displayed.
Page D.7 - 20
Data Exchange
General Settings
If the interface dialog is available in the selected export format, it can also contain a page for General Settings apart from the specific pages. This page is identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the export process. Depending on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields are not activated.
Error Report
An error report is created during exports and file generation. You can see here which model data cannot be evaluated by ProSteel for the interface. If such an error report was created, you can display it by clicking the ERROR REPORT button in the dialog box. Continuous shapes at connections or theoretical points of intersection with other shapes are divided. A possibly existing protection against division at possible nodes is ignored at export of analysis display. Since the division is mostly desired, you should deactivate this option only in exceptional cases.
> Max. Distance Here, you enter the maximum distance, which is allowed for the end point of a shape towards the continuous shape to be recognized as shape to be divided.
Page D.7 - 21
Data Exchange
Here, you enter the minimum length of the bar, which has to be created by the division. If this length is smaller, a division will not be made and eccentricities will be determined instead.
This is reasonable when you export data to static analysis programs as these are expecting a system of bars from gusset to gusset (e.g. plate connections) although in reality it is a continuous shape. As ProSteel of course cannot be as specialized as a static program, you can switch off this option by this way, if the static program offers better functions for this purpose. Analysis Instead of the CAD-position of the actual shape an alternative static effective line is exported. This line can be individually adapted for each shape to your requirements for the transfer of static systems by means of the Analysis Display command. You can avoid e.g. open nodes or eccentricities (due to different insertion levels).
Dividing Shapes The ProSteel model has the shapes of 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6. The shape of 1-2 is divided first into two parts of 1-6a and 6a-2. Another division of the new created shape 1-6a and two other parts 1-4a and 4a-6a is made, if the resulting two bars have at least the same length as indicated in Min. Bar Length input field.
Page D.7 - 22
Data Exchange
Conversion
If the interface dialog is available in the selected export format, it can also contain a page for Conversion apart from the specific pages. This page is identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the export process. Depending on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields are not activated.
Always Flat Steel It is always a flat steel shape, which is exported even if the type has not been defined as flat steel in the database. If Unknown A flat steel shape is exported as poly-plate (metal sheet) if the type has not been defined as flat steel in the data base.
Always Poly-Plate Each flat steel shape is exported as poly-plate (metal sheet). Query At import process, you are prompted for each unknown shape or material in a dialog so that you can select a replacing shape. If this field has not been checked, the unknown shape cannot be created. However, it might be that certain parts are not required for very big models. Therefore, a replacement is not necessary. Here, you see the file name of the currently used exchange list.
Export-Table
Page D.7 - 23
Data Exchange
D.7.6
There is a direct data interface to the analysis program for static analysis calculations RSTAB of Messrs. Ing.-Software Dlubal GmbH which works without explicit exchange file. The prerequisite is that ProSteel and RSTAB have been installed and started on the same machine. Apart from the transfer of the system and of the cross-sections, this exchange supports a better adaptation of the system to the requirements of static calculation with RSTAB as well as an intelligent modification mechanism. Only the corrected cross-sections or insertion points of existing bars/shapes are transferred so that already assigned data in the other software are kept. After having selected the command, you obtain a list of the interfaces supporting the direct exchange. Select the entry 'Dlubal RSTAB' and the dialog for data export with an RSTAB-extension will be displayed. Since the data exchange is based on an extension of the Product Interface Steel Construction, please refer to the corresponding chapters there for further information. After the transfer was started, RSTAB will automatically report data import. For more detailed information, please refer to your RSTAB-documentation. If you want to work with the modification mechanism, dont forget to save your model after data export because information is stored in the drawing database.
Import in ProSteel
When you receive RSTAB data, ProSteel will automatically report the data import. If you want to work with the modification mechanism, the corresponding ProSteel model has of course to be open before. On an additional dialog page for RSTAB data import you can select which modifications have to be transferred to your ProSteel model.
Page D.7 - 24
Data Exchange
D.7.7
New Interfaces
In this chapter, you will find a description of the interface dialogs and implementation degrees of the different interfaces. Please note, however, that this is the state at printing of the manual and that your current ProSteel version can have been extended in the meantime. Please refer to the up-dated hints o n your installation-CD. As the implementation degree of import and export can differ from each other, these areas are treated separately at each interface description. These are data which can be interpreted or written by ProSteel at the very moment the import exchange file might however contain further data which could be read at a later moment. Due to their data structure, most of the interfaces support this selective reading of data. Load data of static programs can e.g. be assigned to an element, the position in the space as well. If the load data cannot be evaluated, this doesnt have any influence on the interpretation of position.
Page D.7 - 25
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 26
Data Exchange
This page shows the entries of the exchange file header and doesnt accept any further settings. You can only interrupt the import process if it isnt the required file.
Group Others Ignore Unknown interface commands of the current implementation degree are ignored and cannot be re-exported. This means that only those entries remain in the file, which can be processed by ProSteel.
Page D.7 - 27
Data Exchange
This option is provided for a later implementation degree of the interface. In this degree, it will be possible to manage modifications and to transfer unknown data 1:1. If need be, the references will be up-dated. Position Numbers The imported position numbers are adopted into the parts properties. Control Entries The reference numbers and codes of the exchange file parts are adopted into the shape properties. This facilitates finding mistakes or incomplete data resp. controlling the origin of modifications.
Group Format-Selection CAD At mixed data, the CAD elements (component parts) are preferred and any possible static analysis data are only evaluated as additional information. At mixed data, the static elements (bars) are preferred and any possible CAD data are only evaluated as additional information. This is an option for a later implementation degree.
Static Analysis
Data Export ProSteel is able to export the CAD-system data for standard shapes and plates, however without detailing processes and connection elements. A plate made out of a number of polygons is exported correctly. If different detailing processes created it, only the basic polygon will be output. In addition, the static system for standard shapes can be written. Depending on the settings on the General Settings page, it is tried to deter mine intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities. After file selection, you can enter the header area specifications in the appearing interface dialog. Click on the OK button of the dialog box to continue the export. The model is analysed and the export data record is prepared according to your settings on the Option page. The data then are written in the selected file by once again clicking the OK button.
Page D.7 - 28
Data Exchange
You can see the selected output file as this name is entered in the exchange file. Here, you enter the variable header area data or the part code (authorization). The authorization is entered in the header area and builds together with a time mark the code for the origin resp. the modification of a component part.
the model data are exported as CAD system data (component parts) or as static system (bars). A file of CAD and static data is written. The CAD data are preferred and the static data describe the static system of these CAD data. This is an option for a later implementation degree.
Page D.7 - 29
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 30
Data Exchange
Group Others Bolts Processing All bolts existing in the model and being assigned to a group are output. the processing of component parts is output. Apart from that the output is only limited to the position of shapes and plates as well as to their parts list data to keep the file small e.g. for mere parts list programs. Groups and single parts having the same position number are summed up to one entry and the corresponding number of pieces is indicated. In this case, the exported geometry and drawing data can only partly be used because they only refer to the first part acquired by chance. This option is, however, reasonable for the evaluation of parts list data because it can help to minimize the data record considerably.
Sum up
Group Floating Point Output Length/Size Here, you enter the accuracy for all values except for the coordinate points. It is always the complete number of digital places which is exported, if need be they are filled up with noughts. Here, you enter the accuracy for all values of CAD-coordinate points. It is always the complete number of digital places which is exported, if need be they are filled up with noughts. In drawings, the sizes are output in the imperial system e.g. 1-2 3/8. Otherwise, the decimal value is output in inches (in our example 14.375).
Coordinates
Inches
Page D.7 - 31
Data Exchange
Data Import All model data including detailing processes, structures and component part references (logical links) are entered which are necessary for the assembly of a complete ProSteel model. Afterwards, the model can be detailed with the same functionality as if it was created in the importing system.
Data Export ProSteel can export the 3D-model data including any detailing processes, structures and component part references (logical links). This means that all data necessary for the assembly of a complete ProSteel model in another ProSteel target system will be sent. Afterwards, this can be detailed with the same functionality as if it had been created there.
Page D.7 - 32
Data Exchange
STAAD III-Interface
The STAAD III interface serves for the exchange of static systems between the programs of STAAD program family and ProSteel. Data can also be exchanged with any kind of software being able to interpret this format. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.std The exchange format corresponds to the output file of the graphic editor of this program family.
Data Import ProSteel is able to evaluate the static system data for standard shapes, i.e. the position of the parts in the space including eccentricities. Please note that it is not possible to interpret all shortened display forms like REPEAT etc. in the data format of the exchange file. The list shortenings of the form n TO m are, however, understood.
Data Export ProSteel is able to export the static analysis system for standard shapes. Depending on the settings on the page General Settings, it is tried to determine even intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
Page D.7 - 33
Data Exchange
STAAD.PRO Interface
The STAAD.PRO interface serves for the exchange of static systems between the programs ProSteel and STAAD.PRO. Data can also be exchanged with any kind of software being able to interpret this format. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.std The exchange format corresponds to the output file of the graphic editor of this program family.
Data Import ProSteel is able to evaluate the static system data for standard shapes (from the single shape table in STAADPRO), i.e. the position of the parts in the space including eccentricities. Please note that it is not possible to support plates/sheet metal plates and shapes with double cross-sections, back/back cross-sections and weld shapes in this version.
Data Export ProSteel is able to export the static analysis system for standard shapes. Depending on the settings on the page General Settings it is tried to determine even intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
Page D.7 - 34
Data Exchange
PXF-Interface
The PXF interface serves for the exchange of constructions between the programs of REBIS program family and ProSteel. Data can also be exchanged with any kind of software being able to interpret this format. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.pxf
Data Import ProSteel can evaluate the data group 4000 for standard shapes, i.e. the position of the parts in the space. In addition, general data groups and coordinates that are necessary for transfer are evaluated.
Data Export ProSteel is able to export the data group 4000 for standard shapes. In addition, general data groups and coordinates that are necessary for transfer are exported.
Page D.7 - 35
Data Exchange
SDNF-Interface
The SDNF interface (Steel Detailing Neutral Format) serves for the exchange of CAD-data between programs being able to interpret this format. A static analysis system can of course also be transferred via the shape position. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.sdf Data Import ProSteel is able to evaluate the CAD-system data for standard shapes and plates, i.e. the position of the parts in the space without detailing processes and connection elements. Plates, the contours of which are transferred as polygons are displayed correctly. If cuts or similar things created the shape, this information would be lost and only the mostly rectangular basic solid would be displayed.
Data Export ProSteel is able to export the CAD-system data for standard shapes and plates without detailing processes and connection elements. A plate made out of a number of polygons is exported correctly. If detailing processes created it, only the basic polygon will be output. In addition, the static analysis system for standard shapes can be written. Depending on the settings on the General Settings page, it has tried to determine intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
Page D.7 - 36
Data Exchange
Here, you enter the variable header area data of the SDNF-file. Here, you can choose the units for the output of length and coordinate values. In combination with a suitable exchange list it is thus possible to create a file with imperial units from a metric drawing file or vice versa.
Degree of Implementation The implementation corresponds to standard SDNF-3.0; the following elements are supported in exchange: Packet 00 Packet 10 Packet 20 Packet 22 Packet 60 Head Data (Title Packet) Straight Standard Shapes (Linear Member Packet) Polygonal Plates (Plate Element Packet) Drill Holes (Hole Element Packet) Bent Shapes (Arc Member Packet)
Page D.7 - 37
Data Exchange
KISS-Interface
The KISS interface (Keep It Simple Steel) provides for the exchange of parts list data between programs, which are able to interpret this format. Therefore, only export is possible here. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.kss Data Export ProSteel is able to export the parts list data of single parts such as shapes and plates. Since the KISS format only indirectly supports the group structure, you can determine the belonging to a certain group by means of dispatch number, but this is lost in case of similar parts in different groups because each part is only exported once with its total amount.
Group Others Customer Here, you enter the variable header area data of the KISS-file.
US-mark Number: The US-mark-number of the corresponding group the part is assigned to is exported as shipping number. Otherwise, the position number of the group the part is belonging to will be exported. When the component part doesnt belong to a group, no shipping number will be exported. When it belongs to different groups, the selected number of the group which was found first will be exported.
Page D.7 - 38
Data Exchange
Group Annotation Note Here you specify which part data have to be exported as note into the file. No A note is not exported. Note 1 The content of the note field 1 of the parts properties is exported. Note 2 - The content of the note field 2 of the parts properties is exported.
Group Surface Surface Here you specify which part data have to be exported as surface into the file. No A surface is not exported. Note 1 The content of the note field 1 of the parts properties is exported. Note 2 - The content of the note field 2 of the parts properties is exported.
Group Format Default Format Default Here you specify the output format of the part designation depending on the indicated part type as a combination of format variable and constant terms. The output can be set separately for flat steel, plates and standard shapes.
Page D.7 - 39
Data Exchange
Switches
If the switch is checked, the program uses the format default specified by you. Otherwise, the standard export designation of ProSteel is used instead. Here you specify the format description for the name of the part. Here you specify the format description for the length of the part. The format default is reset to a given standard value.
Description of Format Variables All format variables are in round brackets and inside of these brackets, they start with a $-sign which identifies them as variable. Then the format specifications for the desired dimension, unit system, display and accuracy follow in exactly this order.
Dimension L W T c i m d f length of the part width of the part height or thickness of the part output according to the unit system of the drawing output always in inches output always in millimetres floating point number fraction (only with inches)
Units
Display Accuracy
0..8 number of digits after the decimal point or parts of fraction (1/2n)
Thus, the format variable ($Lif3) means that the length of the part is exported in inches with fraction display and an accuracy of 1/8 inch, e.g. 10-3/8. If you require e.g. the specification of a plate with the thickness in inches as fraction (with an exact accuracy of 1/16 inch) as well as with metric dimensions for width and length having each one digit after the decimal point in the form PL3/4x200.0 or for the length 300.0, you have to set the default PL($Tif4)x($Wmd1) in the first input field and the default ($Lmd1) in the second input field.
Page D.7 - 40
Data Exchange
CIMSteel/2-Interface
The CIMSteel/2 interface is an internationally used exchange format of structural analysis and production data which is supported by many other programs as an industrial standard. File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.stp Data Import ProSteel can evaluate the CAD system data of standard shapes and plates, i.e. the position of the component parts in the space including detailing processes such as drill holes or cuts. In addition, the structural analysis system for standard shapes can be read, i.e. the position of the component parts in the space including the eccentricities. ProSteel can automatically differentiate between the different types of CIMSteel/2. Data Export ProSteel can export the CAD system data of standard shapes and plates, including detailing processes such as drill holes or cuts. In addition, the structural analysis system for standard shapes can be written. In the export dialog, you can previously select whether the complete CAD data have to be exported or only the structural analysis system.
Page D.7 - 41
Data Exchange
Degree of Implementation The implementation corresponds to CIM Steel Integration Standards Release 2. The file format is according to standard ISO 10303-21:94 (with the entity definition according to LPM6). ProSteel can export 3 different types of CIMSteel/2 data models with the entity definition on certain levels. Static Data (Analysis Model) Gusset points of standard shapes including eccentricities, cross-sections of shapes and material. CAD-Data (Design Model) Position and length of standard shapes, outer geometry of sheet metal plates, cross-sections of shapes and material Manufacturing Data (Manufacturing Model) Position and length of standard shapes, outer geometry of sheet metal plates, cross-sections of shapes, material, volume properties (e.g. drill holes, oblong holes, intersections)
Page D.7 - 42
Data Exchange
D.7.8
Previous Interfaces
In the following chapter, you will find the description of the interfaces, which have already been integrated, in ProSteel for quite some time. They cannot or not yet be controlled via the common import and export dialog. You can reach these interfaces by their own command names and each single interface has its own user control, which often differs from the others. This does not mean that the used file format corresponds to an outmoded state. The content of the data is always on the latest passed version of the standard committees. All these formats have proved their worth in practice and are intensively used there.
Page D.7 - 43
Data Exchange
Title Block Data Here, the title block data of the data records 1 through 5 of the PPS file are defined. Work No. Order No. Drawing No. Enter the work no. (max. 2 digits). It will appear in data record No. 1 of the PPS file. Enter the order no. (max. 8 digits). It will appear in data record no. 2 of the PPS file. Enter the drawing no. (max. 3 digits). It will appear in data record no. 4 of the PPS file.
Page D.7 - 44
Data Exchange
Index
Determine the revision index (1 character) of the drawing. It will also appear in data record no. 4 of the PPS and is added to the drawing number. A revision index defined in the title block (Rev. Index) will make this information superfluous. Specify the person in charge by a name (max. 12 characters). The name will appear in data record no. 5 of the PPS file. Definition of a name in the title block will make this information superfluous. Output of internally calculated weights. Otherwise, no output will take place, and the values will be given by the PPS. Output of internally calculated surfaces. Otherwise, no output will take place, and the values will be given by the PPS.
Prepared by
Accord. to DSTV The order of the panels is according to the DSTV standards. Apart from this, you can determine yourself the order by entering the values 1-27 in the input fields under Panel Order. Material=Name+ the name of the component part is set in front of the material name. Header Bolt Quality Separator The header is output At the output of bolts, the bolt quality is output. The delimiters of data records are determined.
Point at Dec.Val. If this field has been checked, a point is used for decimal values instead of the comma. Insert NC-Dat.. Without Group If this field has been checked, NC production data are output as well. If this field has been checked, no groups (main parts and accessory parts) are output, but all component parts are output as single parts. Here you find the optional fields of the drawings title block. They will all appear in data record no. 9. Define the revision index (1 character) of the drawing. When this panel is used, the Title Block Data / Index panel will be superfluous. Identifier of groups consisting of 3 characters Group name consisting of 30 characters
Group Name
Page D.7 - 45
Data Exchange
Surface finish Addition to weight in percent Name of the person in charge of TB Input of TB-date Date on which the drawing has been presented for approval. Date on which the drawing has been returned after approval. Date on which the drawing has been transferred to the test engineer.
Release Product. Date of release for production Field Order Order All fields available for output List of fields to be used
Length Tolerance Tolerance value which is used to combine the output of component parts with similar length to one entry. Path Output path of the file. Specify the path and the name of the PPS data output file via the left button. PPS-file name and path can be freely defined by the user. If possible, it should contain the order number and a drawing number. Output of PPS-file is started.
The material designations correspond to the standard names for data transfer of steel construction issued in August 1993 (2nd. edition). Hints for Transfer to Knierim Since the Knierim system cannot process different groups of components having the same main part as pos. no. 12.1 or12A, these groups require special handling. In such cases, use the option 25=Max+1 at positioning. Thus you obtain different position numbers for such cases. The Knierim system will accept these numbers without any problem since they are handled as Zparts. If you want all component groups to be handled as Z-parts, turn off the option Transfer Mainpart Group and enter a start value for group positioning.
Page D.7 - 46
Page D.7 - 47
Data Exchange
This interface can read and process data as described herein. Please note that the format mentioned previously does not give port definitions. Only the correct shapes can be entered in the defined position. Herein, the bi-directional information flow of the static CAD static is described. At the very moment, only the flow static CAD has been implemented. Import File Give full description of the path of the data record to be read in or select a file by clicking the File button on the right. Data records of any static data end with *.sc2. This option has not yet been implemented. All system lines being defined by the data are created. They are filed in the layer PS_RAHMEN. All defined shapes are inserted. First, no optimizing is made. Collinear shapes of identical type and alignment are not combined. Such shapes are due to the fact that structural analysis is made from one junction point to the next, whereas a shape can stretch over several junction points.
Page D.7 - 48
Data Exchange
Connect Elements This option activates optimizing. Shapes of the same type and of same position are combined in a way that a shape has maximum length. Collinear Tolerance This value in mm indicates up to which distance segments can be considered as collinear and thus suitable for connection. Angle Tolerance This value in degrees indicates up to which angle distance segments can be considered as collinear and thus suitable for connection. Shape Table Since the shape designations used in the different structural analyses are not always identical to those used by ProSteel, you will be asked when entering a file with an unknown designation. After selection of shape table, the following dialog window opens. Here, you can manage and delete the entered data, or even enter new data.
Page D.7 - 49
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 50
Data Exchange NC-Data Output After you have created your 3D model and performed a positioning (prerequisite), you may generate your NC data. This is done with the ProSteel menu option OTHERS / NC DATA GENERATION or by using the PS_NC_DATA command. The following dialog box appears after the command has been selected:
Choose the output format. You can either create a format according to DSTV or a DXF-output for plates. Here you enter the max.12 digits of the order number, which will later be the first entry in the parts description header in the NC file. Here you enter the max.12 digits of the drawing number, which will later be the second entry in the parts description header in the NC file. any existing file with the same name will be overwritten without asking for confirmation first. If this option is activated, every shape, if it is a straight one with an uncut end, will be turned so that this end is viewed as the shape start.
Drawing No.
Page D.7 - 51
Data Exchange
Sign 3D Cuts
This enables you to indicate a signature block. If this option is activated, 3D cut information is created. This information consists of a SC-record with base on the cutting plane and the cutting plane perpendicular. If this option is activated, three-dimensional holes are indicated with one originating point and the perpendicular of the hole. If this field is checked, the NC-data are principally output in the metric unit system. Otherwise, the unit system of the current drawing will be used.
3D Holes
Metric Output
Upper Edge Mod.The output is arranged in a way that the parts are situated as in the model, i.e. the upper edge is at the top, no matter of the parts ECS position. Insert ProSteel The ProSteel header is inserted into the file. There you will find information about date, etc.
Max. Hole Offset Here, you can indicate a maximum distance of the hole center to the outer edges of the part (reference area) to the inside, up to which a hole is still assigned to this view. This may be important for special shapes. Shapes as Acis Shapes are converted into an ACIS-model before output. Plates as Acis Powder Lines Plates are converted into an ACIS-model before output. The powder lines of the tight fitting add-on parts are created for main parts.
INSERT Click on this button to start the NC-output. You are prompted to select the parts for which the NC-data have to be generated. After all parts have been selected, the parts structure is analysed and the corresponding data records of the NC-file are generated.
Page D.7 - 52
Position No. Send No. Job No. Drawing No. Label Note After Input Position Text Size Input Field
The position number is entered into the signature text. The dispatch number is entered into the signature text. The order number is entered into the signature text. The drawing number is entered into the signature text. The shape name is entered into the signature text. The comment row 1 is entered into the signature text. The text of the input field is entered into the signature text. Select the position of the signature text. Select the text size of the signature text in mm. Enter here any additional input text.
Page D.7 - 53
You can specify the layer names and the colours for the DXF-output of plates. Contour Layer Contour Colour Name of the outer contour layer Colour number of the layer
Inner Contour Layer Name of the inner contour layer Inner Contour Colour Colour number of the layer Hole Layer Hole Colour Text Layer Text Colour Line1/2 Name of the hole layer Colour number of the hole layer. Name of the text layer Colour number of the layer Any additional text which is written into the output file (Bottom corner on the left of output); wildcards may be used. The list of wildcards is as follows:
Page D.7 - 54
Data Exchange
%DAY% %MONTH% %YEAR% %HOUR% %MINUTE% %DWG_PROJECT_NAME% %DWG_ORDER_NAME% %DWG_PROJECT_NUMBER% %DWG_ORDER_NUMBER% %DWG_DRAWING_NAME% %DWG_DRAWING_NUMBER% %DWG_DRAWING_INDEX% %DWG_CREATED_NAME% %DWG_CREATED_DATE% %DWG_CHECKED_NAME% %DWG_CHECKED_DATE% %DWG_CLEARED_NAME% %DWG_ CLEARED _DATE% %DWG_LVPOS1% %DWG_LVPOS2% %DWG_LVPOS3% %DWG_LVPOS4% %DWG_COMMENT1% %DWG_COMMENT2% %DWG_COMMENT3% %DWG_COMMENT4% %DWG_CUSTOMER% %DWG_DRAWING_PAGE% If the part belongs to a group %GROUPNAME% %GROUPNOTE1% %GROUPNOTE2% %GROUPPOSNUM% %GROUPSENDNUM% %GROUPARTICLE% %GROUPCOUNT% %GROUPTOTALCOUNT% %GROUPFAMILYCLASS% %GROUPWEIGHT% %GROUPLENGTH% %GROUPWIDTH% %GROUPHEIGHT%
file creation date file creation date file creation date file creation time file creation time Project name Order name Project number Order number Drawing name Drawing number Drawing index Created by Created on Checked by Checked on Cleared by Cleared on LV Pos1 LV Pos2 LV Pos3 LV Pos4 Comment1 Comment2 Comment3 Comment4 Customer Drawing page
Group name Comment 1 Comment 2 Position number Shipping number Article number Number of groups Overall number Family class Group weight complete group length complete group width complete group height
Page D.7 - 55
Data Exchange
For all other objects (if available) %NAME% Name %TRANSPORTNAME Transport name %INTERNALNAME% Internal Name %KEY% Shape key %NOTE1% Comment1 %NOTE2% Comment2 %KATALOG% Catalogue %POSNUM% Position number %SENDNUM% Shipping number %ORIGINALNUM% Original Position number %ARTICEL% Article number %HANDLE% AutoCAD Handle %STYLENAME% Name of detailing style %MATERIAL% Material number %COUNT% Quantity %TOTALCOUNT% Total quantity %PARTART% Part Type %DISPLAYCLASS% Display class as number %AREACLASS% Area class as number %FAMILYCLASS% Family class as number %PPSZPART% Marker for PPS output %AREACLASSNAME% Area class %DISPLAYCLASSNAME% Display class %FAMILYCLASSNAME% Family class %SHAPECLASS% Shape class %COLORINDEX% Object colour %FREEDESCRIPTION% Additional description %LENGTH% Length %WIDE% Width %HEIGTH% Height %SLOPEDHEIGTH% Sloped height %WEIGHT% Weight %CUTAREA% Cut area %PAINTAREA% Paint area %LENADD% Additional length %INSERTX% Insert offset X %INSERTY% Insert offset Y %SCALE% Scaling factor %TENSION% Tension (bolt) %DM% Diameter (bolt)
Page D.7 - 56
Data Exchange
%KLEMMLEN% %MOUNTINGBOLT% %ORIGIN% %XAXIS% %YAXIS% %ZAXIS% %GROUPREL% %MODIFYFLAG% Text Height
Clamp length (bolt) Bolt type Point of insertion X-axis Y-axis Z-axis Group relevation Modify flag
Slotted Hole as Two Holes A slotted hole is exported with two holes instead of with one. Decimal Point Defines the number of exported digits after the decimal point of the DXF output. This influences the accuracy of the exported DXF files.
DXF-Output as 2D The exported geometry is exported as plane contour. All z-coordinates of the geometry are reset to 0 at output. The option Use Arcs and Lines instead of Polyline serves for division of polylines into arcs and lines at output.
Page D.7 - 57
Folder Path Where your output files have to be filed. Folder Name File Appendix Use Drawing Put P first For output, a directory of this name is created under a path and the individual files are stored there. Define how the annex to your files has to look like(.nc, .output, ...).. The drawing name is used as directory name. A P is put in front of the file name which is formed on the base of the position number. Permits to look at created NC-files and to modify them
Page D.7 - 58
Data Exchange
All files in the indicated directory are deleted when you click on this button. This function creates a block in the drawing from a NC-file. Only outer contour and drill holes are created. Without outer contour, no drill holes will be created.
Example for the Output of a NC-File ST 123 125 3 3 RST_37-2 1 HE200B I 2980.00 200.00 200.00 15.00 9.00 18.00 61.30 1.15 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 BO o o EN
492.48o 492.48o
Page D.7 - 59
Data Exchange
Page D.7 - 60
Appendix
E Appendix
Page E - 1
Appendix
Page E - 2
E.1
This function generates a complete staircase construction with several stair heads including handrail and corresponding working frames. This requires that you just click the starting point and a point in the direction of the stairs (treading direction). The number of required individual steps will be automatically calculated based on your specifications. This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying your input directly and immediately on screen. The dimensions of the staircase can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips. For a staircase with several stair heads you can add the floors one after the other in the open dialog. The complete construction including the handrail can be saved afterwards as template. For later staircase tower constructions, it is possible to create an assembly of standards which can be adapted to the local conditions if need be. Here you see a staircase with intermediate stair head and bent running as created from a template:
Page E.1 - 1
Dimensions
The width of the staircase across outer steel edge Entire length of the stair construction The height of the staircase from starting point to upper edge stair head including gridiron. The desired rise of the staircase steps
Upper Insertion Point If this field is checked, the insertion point is on the upper side of the staircase instead of on the lower side (and it is running to the bottom) Riser Count Angle Treading real The resulting number of steps The resulting gradient of the staircase The resulting exact treading depth of the steps; however, you can specify a fixed value before and the construction will be calculated again based on this value. The resulting exact rise of the steps; however, you can specify a fixed value before and the construction will be calculated again based on this value. If this field is checked, you can monitor the changes of the settings immediately on screen.
Actual Rise
Dynamic
Page E.1 - 2
Landings
Lower Landing
The length of the lower stair head. to create the stair head, you have to check the input field in front of it. Otherwise, the staircase cheeks are cut at the basic plane and the stair head is omitted. The length of the upper stair head
Upper Landing
Create No Upper Platform No landing is created at the upper end of the staircase. The staircase shapes are cut off perpendicularly. US-Definition Stair Foot Length The definition of the landing lengths is made according to American Standard. Enter the dimensions of the staircase foot. If you enter the value 0, the staircase cheek directly hits the basic plane.
Page E.1 - 3
Vertical Section Enter a vertical cut from the front edge of the staircase cheek. This field is only available if no length was specified for the staircase foot, i.e. if the staircase cheek directly hits the basic plane. Ground Distance Here, you can insert a gap between the staircase foot and the basic plane, e.g. to have enough space for a completing construction or for foundations. This field is only available if no length was specified for the staircase foot, i.e. if the staircase cheek directly hits the basic plane. Web Grating Side Offset Height of the attached gridiron The projection of the attached gridirons beyond the outer edge of the staircase construction. Negative values decrease the dimension of gridirons.
Upper Edge Equal The upper edge of the inserted gridirons are mounted equal to upper edge lateral parts. The side offset is set to 0.
Platforms
Page E.1 - 4
No. of Platforms Enter the number of floors (intermediate stair heads). Inner Distance Enter the measure between two staircases (including cheek shapes) if the intermediate stair heads are stair heads for change over. Select the floor you want to process. If you enter an angle here, you can create the bent running of the staircase or stair heads for change over (180). Negative values create an opposite sense of rotation.
Length, Height... Please refer to the figure below for exact meaning of the distances. Here you see the most important measures of a staircase with intermediate stair heads and stair heads for change over (standard version):
Page E.1 - 5
Shapes
Shape Type etc. Here, you select the shapes for the stair and the stair head cheeks.
Bolts
Drill Stringer
If this field is checked, the stair cheeks are drilled to permit bolting the steps or the handrail.
Page E.1 - 6
Bolt .../Handrail
If this field is checked, the cheeks and the handrail are bolted, if a handrail exists. Select the required bolt type in the selection list. If this field is checked, the cheeks and the steps are bolted. Select the required bolt type in the selection list.
Bolt .../Step
Steps
Create Steps
If this field is checked, the staircase steps are generated. You can choose between standard steps, shape steps and block steps. When you have selected shape or block steps, you can select the shape type or the block in the selection lists as usual. Enter the depth of the staircase steps. Distances for the mounting holes of the staircase steps. b is the distance of the holes from the upper edge of the steps, c is the height of the fastening of staircase steps, d is the hole spacing of both mounting holes.
Increment b,c,d
The distance of the axes of the steps mounting holes The hole diameter of the steps mounting holes. The distance of the axes of the rear oblong step hole.
Page E.1 - 7
Offset
The offset of the staircase steps from the front edge of the staircase to the back. Negative values move the steps to the front.
Handrail
Create Handrail If this field is checked, a handrail is added to the staircase. Simplified Start Offset The handrails are not modelled, but only displayed as system lines. Here, you enter an offset value which moves the start of the handrail from the front edge of the staircase to the back. Negative values move the handrail to the front. In case of staircases without basic stair head, you can move the start of the handrail to a position where a bolt mounting is possible. Analogously to start offset, you enter here an offset value for the end of the handrail. Here, you enter an offset value that moves the handrail from the outer edge of the staircase to the outside. This permits you to mount the handrail outside the staircase on other shapes or on the wall. Here, you enter an offset value that moves the handrail from the upper edge of the staircase cheek to the top. This permits you to attach a grout or an individual fastening.
Height Offset
Page E.1 - 8
Connection
Here, you specify the bolting of handrail and staircase cheek. Automatic The program tries to determine the most suitable fastening. Vertical - The handrail is always bolted on the staircase cheek from above, independently of the settings in the used handrail template. By Side The handrail is always bolted laterally on the staircase cheek, independently of the settings in the used handrail template. Individual The settings in the handrail template are used. If you enter a value bigger than 0 in this input field, a vertical connecting plate is inserted between plate and staircase cheek in case of lateral mounting.
Side Offset
Hand. Template Select the template to be used for the handrail in the selection list. This template describes the exact structure. Click this button to preset the handrail structure (shapes, distances, etc.) or to edit the used handrail template. Another dialog opens then which is identical with the structural element Handrail. Thus you can refer to this dialog for further information. At staircases with handrail, this handrail will be created as structural element of its own. This permits you to construct and modify the handrail in detail independent of the staircase .
Page E.1 - 9
Work Frame
Created Views
A separate working frame can be created showing a direct overview on the staircase to allow for better working at the staircase within the bounds of a bigger construction. By clicking the fields Front View, Lateral View Left, Lateral View Right or Top View, you can create the corresponding working frame. Enter the general name of the working frame. If you enter a value here, the size of the different frames is decreased. Therefore you can better select frames which are lying next to each other.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page E.1 - 10
E.2
This function generates a handrail along a previously drawn 3-dimensional polyline. After calling the function, you will be prompted to pick this polyline, and the program then constructs the handrail along this line. You can choose between a parametrical construction of the handrail and a construction by user-defined blocks. At parametrical construction, all component parts are directly created from the default settings in your dialogs. At the second variant, you use any user-defined blocks which will be automatically adapted within certain borders. After the command was selected, a dialog opens where you can set the specifications while verifying your input directly and immediately on screen. The spatial development of the handrail may still be modified at a later time by changing the polyline using its grips.
Generalities
Layout
Here you determine whether the handrail has to be carried out as parametrical construction or with user-defined blocks. When you selected parametrical construction, you will find all further settings in the section Dimensions. When you selected blocks, you will find all further settings in the section Blocks. If this field is checked, you can verify the modified settings directly and immediately on screen. A modification of the polyline has immediate effects, too.
Dynamic
Page E.2 - 1
Draw Diagonal
If this field is checked, an auxiliary diagonal of the actual structural object is drawn in the different segments to facilitate its selection. If this field is checked, you can manually release the update of the handrail by pressing a button. Here you determine whether another parent group has to be formed out of all handrail components (including their inner group structure). You can choose between No Group, Component Part Group and Assembly. Here you indicate the name of the parent group. Wildcards for the overall dimensions ($(L), $(W), $(H)) are permitted.
Group Name
For more detailed information about the group structure, please refer to the section about workshop drawings in this chapter.
Dimensions
The distance between the drawn polyline and the beginning of the posts including possible fastening plate. The distance of the upper edge of the newel posts or the center of the railing head (if in place) measured perpendicular to the polyline. The center distance of the upper knee-high rail (if in place) measured perpendicular to the polyline.
Page E.2 - 2
The center distance of the middle knee-high rail (if in place) measured perpendicular to the polyline. The center distance of the lower knee-high rail (if in place) measured perpendicular to the polyline. Radius of the railing head at the corners of the handrail. If a radius is specified the corresponding shape bends are applied; otherwise a mitred joint is cut. Radius of the knee-high guardrail at the corners of the handrail. If a radius is specified the corresponding shape bends are applied; otherwise a mitred joint is cut. Radius of the baseboard at the corners of the handrail. If a radius is specified the corresponding shape bends are applied; otherwise a mitred joint is cut. Here you indicate the thickening radius at the gusset points between posts and e. g. knee-high guardrails.
Thickening Dia.
Page E.2 - 3
Post Distance
Post Spacing
Here you specify the approximate spacing of the rail posts within the individual polyline segments. Normal The segment is regularly divided and the predetermined post distance is adapted. Adapt First The post distance of the default setting is kept and only the first part of the segment is corrected. Adap tLast The post distance of the default setting is kept and only the last part of the segment is corrected. Adapt First/Last The post distance of the default setting is kept and only the first and the last part of the segment are corrected equally. The distance of the rail posts within the individual polyline segments. Depending on the setting, the program uses this information to space out the newel posts in regular intervals and rounds the value up or down as needed. If this button is checked, the values of the determined post distances are never rounded up. The post distance is regarded as the maximum value. If necessary, additional posts are inserted. The spacing of the corner posts between two handrail segments starting with the intersection of the polyline segments.
Post Distance
Maximum
Edge Offset
Page E.2 - 4
Min.Segment Length The minimum length of a handrail segment from which on posts are created. Thus you avoid e. g. the creation of posts at the inner edge of intermediate landings at staircases with changing direction. Min.Segment 2nd Post The minimum length of a handrail segment from which on two posts are created at the beginning and at the end. If the actual length is smaller (but larger than the Minimum Segment Length), only one post will be created in the middle of the segment.
Offsets
Posts Inside
If this field is checked, the end posts are moved to the inside. The post distances in the first and last segment are decreased by the value specified for the offset of the railing head. If this field is checked, the default settings for railing head offset are used for all shapes. Projection of the corresponding shape starting from the middle of the first rail post towards the outside. Projection of the corresponding shape starting from the middle of the last rail post towards the outside. Here you can individually determine start and end offset of the different shapes if the option Keep All Equal has been deactivated.
Keep All Equal Start Offset End Offset All Input Fields
Page E.2 - 5
Segments
Create Segments
The handrail is subdivided into several independent segments, each having their own start, end and inner posts.
Length maximum... The indicated length is the maximum length of a segment and mustnt be exceeded. Segment Length Defines the length of the different segments. It may be that the length is corrected, depending on the default settings of spacing. Indicates the distance from 1 segment to the other. Here you indicate the distribution of the segment lengths along the length of the handrail segment. Equally means that all segments have the same length. Adapt First or Adapt Last means that all segments have the indicated length, but the first or the last segment is shorter. Here you determine whether another parent group has to be formed out of all segments (including their inner group structure). You can choose between No Group, Component Part Group and Assembly. Here you indicate the name of the parent group. Wildcards for the overall dimensions ($(L), $(W), $(H)) are permitted.
Gap Distribution
Group Status
Group Name
For more detailed information about the group structure, please refer to the section about workshop drawings in this chapter. End form
Page E.2 - 6
Structural Element Handrail You have the possibility to round off the railing head of the handrail at its corners in different ways or to combine it with the other component parts. These default settings can be individually determined for the beginning and the end of the handrail.
Transitions without End Offset Selection List Here you specify the form of the handrails end. Leave No detailing takes place. Up to Outer Edge The handrail is extended up to the outer edge of the post. Mitre Joint The handrail and the end post are cut to build a mitre joint. Round Off The handrail and the end post are combined by means of a bent part. Enter the radius in the Radius input field. Indicates the radius for rounding off. It can be defined either as absolute value or as many times the amount of the handrail diameter. Enter e. g. *2.
Radius
Page E.2 - 7
Transitions with End Offset Selection List Here you specify the form of the handrails end. Additional shape parts are added in the handrail outside the end post. Leave No detailing takes place. Mitre Joint The additional shape parts in the handrail are cut to build a mitre joint. Round Off The additional shape parts in the handrail are combined by means of a bent part. Enter the radius in the Radius input field. Here you specify up to which height the handrail has to be extended to the bottom. When you select knee-high guardrail above, center or below (if they exist), an additional perpendicular part will be added. Indicates the radius for rounding off. It can be defined either as absolute value or as many times the amount of the handrail diameter. Enter e. g. *2. If this field has been checked, the handrail will be extended up to the end support after detailing.
Combine with
Radius
Close
Page E.2 - 8
Shapes
Here you can select the shapes for the individual sections of the handrail. However, the corresponding section is generated only if checked appropriately in the check box. For example, if you would like to generate a handrail with only two knee-high guardrails, then deactivate one of the three options for knee-high guardrails. In the selection lists you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes are available for selection.
Click on the button to copy the default settings of another component part into the current selection. A small dialog opens where you can select the source. Thus it is e. g. possible to synchronize the settings for all knee-high guardrails.
Comp.Part Group Shape Class Shape Size Shape Type Insertion Plane Angle Mirror BUTTON +
The settings are valid for the selected shape group. The class or catalogue of the selected shape. The size of the selected shape. The type of the selected shape. The insertion plane of the shape. Here you can choose between Center, Lower Edge and Upper Edge. The rotation around the insertion axis. The shape is mirrored before insertion. The settings of another component part group are copied into the current selection.
Page E.2 - 9
If this field is checked, the baseboard will be inserted at the other side of the railing posts. You specify the distance of outer edge of railing post and inner edge of baseboard. This permits you to keep some space for individual fastenings or grouts. The distance between the drawn polyline and the lower edge of baseboard. Negative values will move the baseboard towards the bottom.
Height Offset
Page E.2 - 10
Min. Segment Length The minimum segment length (distance from one post to the other) from which on filler rods will be created. Edge Distance The distance between the center of the first and last filler rod and the center of the corresponding handrail post
Intermediate Distance The distance of the center of two filler rods; this value can be corrected depending on the segment length. Distance Top Distance Bottom Insertion Offset Insertion from Insertion up to Insertion Position The distance between the filler rods and the upper insertion position. The distance between the filler rods and the lower insertion position. Filler rod offset from insertion plane towards the front or back side. Here you select at which position the filler rods start (upper insertion position). Here you select at which position the filler rods end (lower insertion position). Here you select the depth position of the filler rods towards the knee-high guardrails. You can choose between front edge, center and rear edge.
Page E.2 - 11
Cut at
Here you select the bordering edge of the knee-high guard rails or handrail the insertion points of filler rods refer to. You can choose between inner edges, center and outer edges. Here you indicate how to treat a possible collision between filler rods and knee-high guardrails (e. g. in case of center position). Ignore The collision is ignored. Divide The filler rod is divided at the knee-high guardrails. Any information about distances top/bottom is taken into consideration anew for each divided rod. Perforate The knee-high guardrails are perforated so that the filler rod can run through it.
If Collision
Handrail segment with spacing bars between the handrail and the upper knee-high guardrail.
Page E.2 - 12
Posts
You can taper the post on top or bottom by means of cuts in order to reach a better adaptation to the base plate or to the handrail.
Top horizontal
determines the horizontal length of the cuts at the upper end of the post. Two cuts are made, one at the outside and one at the inside of the handrail. determines the vertical length of the two cuts at the upper end of the post. determines the horizontal length of the cuts at the lower end of the post. Two cuts are made, one at the outside and one at the inside of the handrail. determines the vertical length of the two cuts at the lower end of the post.
Bottom vertical
Page E.2 - 13
Post Connection
Here you select the fastening of the handrail posts. If None is checked, no fastening will be provided. If Vertical is checked, the plates will be perpendicular to the post (base plates). If Lateral is checked, plates or bent connections will be welded to the outside of the post.
Layout
Here you select how the handrail is fastened. Depending on selection, you have different possibilities which may also influence other dialog tabs. If this field is checked, lateral connecting plates will be welded on the other side of the posts. This option is only available for lateral connections. If this field has been checked, you can specify other dimensions for diagonal handrail segments e.g. at a stringer. This option is only available for vertical connections. Here you indicate how the lateral connection plates have to be executed. This option is only available for lateral connections. Complete Plate All plates are created with the complete dimensions. Shorten Outer The plates at the two outside posts are cut at the outside to be flush with the support. Only Right Side All plates are cut on the left side to be flush with the supports. Only Left Side All plates are cut on the right side to be flush with the supports.
Outside
For Diagonals
Plate Layout
Page E.2 - 14
Projection Side
In case of plates which are cut to be flush (projection= 0) you can indicate a projection beyond the edges of the supports here and thus modify the plate size. Negative values will reduce the size of projection towards the inside. This option is only available for lateral connections. . Specify the width of the connecting plates. Specify the length (height) of the connecting plates. Specify the thickness of the connecting plates. Enter the diameter of fastening holes. Enter the axis distance of fastening holes. Enter the vertical distance of fastening holes, if you selected lateral connecting plates. You can thus create a plate with four holes. If you enter the value 0, only two holes are created. Enter the diameter of an additional zinc outlet hole (center position towards post axis). If you enter a value bigger than 0, a perpendicular connecting plate will be inserted between plate and post. If you indicated an Inlet Radius in addition, the additional plate will be omitted and the connection will be made as bent post. If you enter a value bigger than 0, the connection will be made as bent post with perpendicularly welded plate. If this field has been checked, a poly-plate will be created instead of a flat steel. If this field has been checked, base plates will be rotated by 90.
Plate Wiidth Plate Length Plate Thickness Hole Dia w (horizontal) w (vertical)
Page E.2 - 15
Post Post-Handrail
Here you select how to connect the different handrail posts with the handrail. Depending on selection, you can describe the connection in a more detailed way by means of further parameters.
Layout
Here you indicate the layout of the connection. Leave No processing is made. Straight Cut The post is shortened up to the lower edge of the handrail. Complex Cut The post is adapted to the handrail by means of two simple diagonal cuts. With Rod An additional shape is inserted between posts and handrail. Boolean The post is exactly adapted to the handrail by means of a boolean cut. Here you enter an additional distance between post and handrail. When you have selected the Rod option, this is the length of the rod. The thickness of an additional round cover plate at the upper edge of the post if the Rod option has been selected. The diameter of an additional round cover plate at the upper edge of the post if the Rod option has been selected.
Gap Distance
Page E.2 - 16
Layout
Here you indicate the layout of the connection. Leave No processing is made. Straight Cut The knee-high guardrail is divided into individual elements at the outer edges of the posts by means of straight cuts. Complex Cut The knee-high guardrail is adapted to the post in question by means of two simple diagonal cuts and divided into individual elements. Drill At the position of the knee-high guardrails, the posts are drilled so that the shapes can run through them as a whole. Boolean The knee-high guardrails are exactly adapted to the posts by means of a boolean cut. Here you enter an additional distance between post and kneehigh guardrail if you have selected the Straight Cut or Complex Cut option. Here you enter the diameter of the drill hole in the post if you have selected the Drill option.
Gap Distance
Hole Diameter
Page E.2 - 17
Blocks
Apart from the parametrical construction, you can build the handrail by using user-defined blocks. Different blocks are available for the post variants (e. g. beginning, end, corners) and fillings. You will find all necessary settings on this page and on the subordinate dialog tabs. Partly they are identical with those of parametrical construction. For more detailed information about selection and distribution of user-defined blocks, please refer to section Working with User -defined Blocks in this chapter.
Between Posts
Here you specify how the user-defined blocks have to be inserted in general. Leave Only the post blocks are inserted. Connect Handrail The post blocks are inserted and especially marked shapes are connected with each other (e. g. as handrail). Insert Inner Block In addition, the blocks for the fillings are inserted. Insert and Combine In addition, the blocks for the fillings are inserted and especially marked shapes of the post blocks are combined with each other (e. g. as handrail). The directory with the user-defined blocks for the handrails; it contains further divided subdirectories for posts and fillings.
Block Directory
Page E.2 - 18
The settings on this dialog tab correspond to the post distribution of parametrical construction. Please refer to this tab for more detailed information.
Blocks Segments
The settings on this dialog tab correspond to the segments of parametrical construction. Please refer to this tab for more detailed information.
Page E.2 - 19
Blocks Posts
Here you select the block which has to be used for the corresponding post variant. Here you determine whether a parent group has to be formed out of the component parts of the posts. You can choose between No Group, Subgroup and Component Part Group. Here you indicate the name of the parent group. Wildcards for the overall dimensions ($(L), $(W), $(H)) are permitted.
Group Name
Page E.2 - 20
Blocks Fillings
Here you select the block to be used for the filling of the handrail. Here you specify how to adapt the inserted block of the filling in longitudinal direction to the current space between two posts. Leave The block is not modified. Stretch Across Center The block is stretched from the center to the left and to the right side. Stretch Poportionally All elements of the filling are regularly stretched proportionally. Dynamic All, Start... The elements are stretched dynamically within the indicated borders and multiplied. You can choose whether the length has to be balanced at the beginning, at the end or at beginning and end. When the width is adapted dynamically, the information included in the block is evaluated for the minimum/maximum distances (e. g. at vertical filler rods). Here you determine whether a parent group has to be formed out of the component parts of the fillings. You can choose between No Group, Subgroup and Component Part Group. Here you indicate the name of the parent group. Wildcards for the overall dimensions ($(L), $(W), $(H)) are permitted.
Group Status
Group Name
Page E.2 - 21
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Posts Posts are inserted at any possible corner and intermediate points of the polyline. You can specify different blocks for start, end and the straight intermediate points of the poly-line. In addition, you can determine different blocks for rightangled corners (+90 and -90 each) and for the angles deviating from this (positive and negative as well). However, only one deviating intermediate angle is possible. You could use corners of 45 beside the right-angled corners for your handrail, but not corners of 45 and 30 at the same time. The neighboring figure shows the selection of the different post blocks. You see the beginning (1) and the end (2) of the poly-line as well as the intermediate post (3). The corner post (4) is a +90 corner, the corner post (5) is a -90 corner, corresponding to the UCS and the running direction of the poly-line. . For all other angles the corner rotating in positive direction (6) or the corner rotating in negative direction (7) is selected.
Page E.2 - 22
Structural Element Handrail The post has to be defined in WCS, the positive z-axis corresponds to the height of the handrail. At insertion on a staging post, the positive x-axis is always aligned towards the running direction of the previous poly-line segment (except for the initial post) the origin (0, 0, 0) of the WCS corresponds to the later insertion point on the staging post. Indicate the code P in the parts properties of the actual post shape under Note 2. If you are working with fillings, all connecting elements, which have to be connected with the fillings later, get the code C here. Define a block attribute with the name DP for initial and final post to be able to place these fillings correctly (at intermediate and corner post, you have two block attributes DP1 and DP2). The filling is created later in a way that its block attributes are laying exactly one above the other as counterparts.
Handlrails, Knee-High Guardrails and Kick Boards These are defined in the post blocks as well as they are in general connected to them. They are short shapes which have to be aligned parallel towards the x/yplane and which contain the code R in the parts properties under Note 2. After insertion of the post blocks these marked parts are connected to common elements if possible. Enter the code R,NC if you dont want to combine them.
Fillings The special characteristic of fillings is the fact that the distance between the assigned posts is not known at definition. To avoid having to define an own block for each possible distance, the elements are adapted to the current dimension by means of the options Stretch/Upset and Move. In addition, filling elements which once were defined can be regularly multiplied by means of dynamic distribution. A twisted filler rod has e. g. to be modelled only once to arrange it in a grid of 100-110 mm in the handrail segments. The filling has to be defined in the WCS as well. The positive z-axis corresponds to the height of the handrail. At insertion, the positive x-axis is always aligned towards the running direction of the corresponding poly-line segment. The origin (0, 0, 0) of the WCS lies in the middle of the block.
Page E.2 - 23
Structural Element Handrail Define two block attributes DP1 and DP2 to be able to place the fillings correctly. The filling is created later in a way that its block attributes and those of the posts are laying exactly one above the other. If you want a dynamic distribution, all elements to be distributed get the code FB in the parts properties under Note 2. Two other block attributes FBSTART and FBEND determine the nominal grid size including the gaps. Depending on the default settings for length adaptation, the actual grid size can however be bigger or smaller. You can limit the area in order to determine borders for example the protection against falling through the bars. If you enter the value MIN=100 in the input field for the block attribute FBSTART and the value MAX=110 in the input field for the block attribute FBEND, the distance will always be between 100 and 110 mm. Additional Hints No user-defined blocks may contain any group structures. In the handrail function, you decide at a later moment which component parts automatically have to form groups, subgroups or assemblies. The codes entered in the parts properties of the block templates under Note 2 will be removed after insertion. In the finished 3D-model, the data field can be used for the parts list as usual.
Page E.2 - 24
Example
The following example shows the possibilities of handrail construction with userdefined blocks and dynamic distribution of filler rods.
Corner support 45 The different posts and the filling element are constructed in the block templates and the filling element only contains the principle. At generation along the polyline it will be adapted to the current segment length. As it is only a matter of corners of 90 and 45, the whole construction can be saved in a template and be reproduced. The neighboring figure shows the block of the filling element in detail. Since both filler rods alternate, they are modelled together, too. An exact distribution in a 150 mm grid including length compensation at the beginning and at the end of the segment is desired. This is why you find two block attributes FBSTART and FBEND each on the right and left side of the bars (with the input demand MIN and MAX=150). The filler rods and spheres have the code FB and in the drill holes of the upper butt straps you will find the block attributes DP1 and DP2 for the adaptation to the posts. The posts also have such butt straps with the same attributes in the drill holes of the butt straps for fixation.
Page E.2 - 25
Structural Element Handrail In handrail function, it is specified that the filling element as well as the supports have to form their own groups. An assembly can be built out of two supports and a filling element in order to display the main dimensions of construction and installation as common drawing. The following drawing is an automatic 2D-production drawing of a filling segment. Here you see that the length compensation of the distribution was effected at the edges and that the desired grid is exactly kept.
The possible 2D-detailing of a whole assembly shows how the filling element is placed between the different posts.
Page E.2 - 26
Due to a free construction via user-defined blocks (which adapt themselves dynamically) and due to the forming of parent and subordinate groups, you get complex handrails including 2D-plans in no time at all. Finally,here an the overall view as horizontal projection with the most important dimensions of the complete handrail.
Page E.2 - 27
Page E.2 - 28
E.3
This function generates a hangar frame from two support members and two crossbars, which can be connected to one another in different ways. This requires that you click on the outer edge insertion point of the left and right vertical frame members. This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying your input directly and immediately on screen. The dimensions of the frame can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
The width of the hangar frame across outer steel edge. Enter the roof ridge width into this field if you have selected an asymmetrical hangar frame. Here you indicate the ridge height of the crossbars. Changing the value will affect the pitch of the roof. If this field is checked, you can monitor the settings immediately on screen. If this field is checked, a symmetrical hangar frame is generated by applying the values specified for one side to the other side. If this field is checked, the hangar frame (object frame) is marked with two additional diagonals. If this field is checked, a frame is generated only with a crossbeam. In this case, the specifications for the ridge height are unimportant.
Page E.3 - 1
Left Eave Height Here, you indicate the left eaves height of the crossbars. Right Eave Height Here, you indicate the right eaves height of the crossbars. Top Side Base Specify the distance of the supports from floor level (the pick points of the supports) required to add base plates.
Left Column Offset Here, you indicate the projection of the left support upper edge beyond the height of the eaves. Right Column Offset Here, you indicate the projection of the right support upper edge beyond the height of the eaves. Left Roof Angle Here, you indicate the roof pitch of the left crossbar. Changing the value will affect the ridge height of the roof. Right Roof Angle Here, you indicate the roof pitch of the right crossbar. Changing the value will affect the ridge height of the roof.
Page E.3 - 2
Shapes
This dialog tab is used to select the corresponding shapes for the left and right vertical frame members as well as the crossbars. If you have selected a symmetrical hangar frame, the values specified for the left side are applied to the right side.
Which Shape
Here, you can select the shape the settings have to be applied to. Please note that at Symmetrical setting, the right shapes cannot be set because the values of the left shapes are applied to them. Here, you select the shape type (normal, special shapes, etc.) Here, you select the shape class or catalogue. Here, you select the shape size. Here, you select how the supports have to be inserted related to the frame.
Page E.3 - 3
Attachment
Determines the kind of connection between crossbar and support: Adapt - The crossbar is cut to the support. You can specify a distance in the neighboring field Distances. Angle Cut - The crossbar and the support are cut to have a mitred joint. You can specify a gap in the neighboring field. Haunch - The connection is designed as a frame haunch. You can select a haunch template in the neighboring field. The connection is designed as a plate connection. You can select a template for the plate connection in the neighboring field. Use the option Turn to rotate an unsymmetrical plate. No connections are made.
Free Plate
Align As is
Page E.3 - 4
Apex
This dialog tab is used to select the connection type for joining crossbars at the ridge point. Attachment Determines the kind of connection between crossbar and support: Angle Cut - The crossbar and the support are cut to have a mitred joint. You can specify a gap in the neighboring field. Free Plate - The connection is designed as a plate connection. You can select a template for the plate connection in the neighboring field. Use the option Turn to rotate an unsymmetrical plate. Align As is -No connections are made
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too, you have the possibility to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. To do this, select the component part and then select the settings to be applied.
Page E.3 - 5
Page E.3 - 6
E.4
This function generates a truss girder from the upper and lower cord as well as the diagonals and many existing intermediate studs. Upper and lower cords can also be generated from two side-by-side shapes. This requires that you click on the left and right outer edge of the truss girder, which then adds the truss to the current plane of the user coordinate system. This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying your input directly and immediately on screen. The dimensions of the binder can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
Select the different variations of the framework (parallel or alternating diagonals with or without intermediate studs). Select on which side the bracing has to be carried out. The complete length of the girder Height of the girder from bottom edge of lower cord up to intersection of upper edges of upper cords in the middle (top of roof ridge) Roof slope of upper cord.
Roof Angle
Page E.4 - 1
Side Height
Height of the girder from bottom edge of lower cord up to upper edge of upper cord measured on the sides. This value remains constant, while the value in the height filed can change if you adjust the pitch of the roof and vice versa. The distance of the axis of any existing intermediary studs at the rim of the roof truss outer edge (represented with the object frame). The distance of the axis of any existing intermediary studs in the center of the roof truss centerline The distance of the segments of the truss girder (spacing of the girder junctions with parallel diagonals)
Outer Distance
Segment Numb. The number of truss girder segments Plate Width The spacing of the shapes, if, for example, upper and lower cords are generated from two side-by-side (U-shaped) shapes.
Shapes
Select for which shape the settings are valid. Select the shape types to be used. Enter the class or the catalogue. Select the shape size.
Page E.4 - 2
Front/Back
If these fields are checked, the selected shapes are added to the corresponding side of the truss girder. For example, you can also generate a truss girder from two side-by side Ushaped shapes.
Distances
Top Chord Top Chord Inside Bottom Chord Fit Shape Ends Top Diagonal
The distance of the upper cord at the rim from the outer edge of the roof truss (represented with the object frame). The distance of the upper cord in the center of the roof truss centerline The distance of the lower cord at the rim from the outer edge of the roof truss (represented with the object frame). If this field is checked, the diagonals at upper/lower cord are cut to fit. The distance of the diagonal from upper cord, if, e.g., connective plates are to be inserted.
Bottom Diagonal The distance of the diagonal from lower cord, if, e.g., connective plates are to be inserted. Fit Shape Ends Top Vertical If this field is checked, any existing intermediate studs at upper (vertical) or lower cord are cut to fit. The distance of any intermediate studs from upper cord if connective plates are to be inserted
Page E.4 - 3
Bottom Vertical
The distance of any intermediate studs from lower cord if connective plates are to be inserted
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page E.4 - 4
E.5
Command Name:
This function generates a purlin course within a specified plane. For this, you select the area to be filled by clicking on the left lower and the right upper corner. The purlins are then inserted into this area with their lower edge flush with the plane of the current user coordinate system. An additional application consists of the possibility to insert secondary beams (joists) within two main girders. For this purpose, you have to finish the input of area at the first point using ESC. Then, you are prompted to enter the first main girder, then the second one. The dimensions for the purlin course then are defined by the end points of the main girders. In addition, you have the possibility to connect them with each other by means of a template. This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying your input directly and immediately on screen. The spacing of the purlin course can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips. Diagonals are possible as well.
Page E.5 - 1
General
The purlins are rotated around this angle value, which means they are arranged in a diagonal fashion. Here, you can move the purlin course in positive Z-direction by applying the indicated value. If this field is checked, the modifications of the settings can be monitored immediately on screen. If this field is checked, modifications of the structural element will be carried out symmetrically by drawing the grips. If this field is checked, the area to be filled (object frame) is marked with two additional diagonals. If this field is checked, the purlins at the edges of the area to be filled are cut flush. Values in the fields Left Projection and Right Projection are then not considered.
Page E.5 - 2
Dimensions
Fixed Grid
If the Grid field is checked, you can indicate in the neighboring input field the approximate distance of the purlins within the area between first and last purlin. The program divides the distances regularly according to this specification and the value is rounded up or down correspondingly. The actual distances then are displayed in the Effective Grid field. If the Grid field is not checked, you can freely define the grid division within the area between the first and last purlin in the Distances list. You can vary the number and the distance, as you like. The distances are used inverted. The distance from the centerline of the lowest purlin to the outer edge of the selected area. The distance from the centerline of the topmost purlin to the outer edge of the selected area. If one of these options is activated, the selected distances are also kept in the grid; otherwise they are centered.
Free Grid
Page E.5 - 3
Offset Left
Specify a purlin projection extending past the left outer edge of the selected area. In case of a diagonal edge, this value references the centerline of the purlin; negative values shorten the purlin towards the inside. Specify a purlin projection extending past the right outer edge of the selected area. In case of a diagonal edge, this value references the centerline of the purlin; negative values shorten the purlin towards the inside.
Offset Right
Shapes
Here, you can select the desired shape as usual; all shapes are available for selection. Indicates the insertion position of the girders related to the insertion axis. If this field is checked, the shape position is mirrored at the length axis to turn the web side e.g. at U-shapes. Specifies the rotation of the shapes around the insertion axis.
Alternatively, you can also use a joist girder instead of a standard shape (see structural element Joist Girder) the template of which can be sel ected on an additional dialog tab.
Page E.5 - 4
Border Lines
Cut Lines
Cutting edges can be added subsequently to permit the creation of non-rectangular purlin courses as well. Click this button to add a cutting edge. Then, you are prompted for a borderline to be clicked or to be defined by 2 points. All purlins intersecting this edge are divided at the edge with the distance specified in the Cut Width input field. Click on this button to remove a selected cutting edge.
Poly-cut
Apart from cutting edges, it is also possible to add sections for light domes or similar things. The procedure is the same as for sections; the only difference is that you have to click on a polyline here. Click on this button to add another section.
Page E.5 - 5
Connections
If you have selected alternative insertion on the base of two main girders, the following page will be displayed in addition:
Which Page
Here you select for which side the settings have to be valid. You can define both sides simultaneously or each single side individually. The parts are only inserted; no connection is created. The girders are coped. You either select a previously defined template or the simplified specifications are valid. If you want one of the following connections, select the previously defined template.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page E.5 - 6
E.6
This function is used to create a ladder including its fastening at the wall. In addition, you can add a safety cage to the ladder. To do this, just click the left and right insertion point of the ladder and then the height point (to determine the length) or any other point you like, if the length has to be determined later. Then a dialog opens where you can set the specifications by direct monitor control. The ladder dimensions can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
The width of the ladder as clear dimension between the uprights. The height of the ladder without possible projection as help for climbing out. The desired distance between the rungs. The program divides the distances between first and last rung regularly according to this specification and the value is rounded up or down correspondingly. The actual resulting distance between the rungs is displayed.
Actual Riser
Distance to Floor The distance between the upper edge of the first rung and the ground area of the ladder.
Page E.6 - 1
The distance between the upper edge of the last rung and the climbing out surface of the ladder. The height of the help for climbing out related to the climbing out surface of the ladder (axis measure). The depth of the help for climbing out (axis measure) The front jump-in of the help for climbing out (axis measure), if it has to be created with a bend. If this field is checked, you can monitor the modification of settings immediately on screen. If this field is checked, a diagonal of the actual structural element is drawn in the ladder to support an easier selection.
Fit Rungs If this field is checked, the rungs are adapted to the uprights. Round tubes are e.g. cut with each other.
Page E.6 - 2
Shapes
Select the shapes of the ladder uprights and rungs as usual. All shapes are available for selection. You can rotate the shapes around their insertion axis here. The upright shape can be rotated by increments of 90 whereas the rungs can be rotated by increments of 45. If this field is checked, the corresponding shape will be mirrored before insertion.
Mirror
Page E.6 - 3
Wall Mounting
You can add a wall fastening to the ladder here. The wall shape is, however, only created if the Wall Shape field has been checked before. In the Selection Lists, you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes are available for selection.
You can rotate the wall shape around its insertion axis here by checking the required angle. If this field is checked, the wall shape will be mirrored before insertion. Select the insertion position of the wall shape. Inner Edge The wall shape is inserted at the inner edge of the upright and shows to the inside. Centrally The wall shape is inserted in axis position on the height of upright axis. Outer Edge The wall shape is inserted at the outer edge of the upright and shows to the outside. The distance between upright axes and wall surface where the ladder has to be mounted.
Wall Distance
Distance to Floor The distance between the axis of the first wall shape and the ground area of the ladder. Distance The desired distance of the wall shapes. The program divides the distances between the first and last wall shape regularly according to this specification and the values are rounded up or down correspondingly.
Page E.6 - 4
Top Distance
The distance between the axis of the last wall shape and the climbing out area of the ladder.
Safety Cage
You can add a safety cage to the ladder here. The safety cage is only created if the Safety Cage field has been checked before. In the Selection Lists, you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes are available for selection.
Here, you can rotate the shape around its insertion axis. If this field is checked, the shape will be mirrored before insertion. Here you can select the insertion position of the wall shape. Inner Edge The wall shape is inserted at the inner edge of the upright and shows to the inside. Centrally The wall shape is inserted in axis position on the height of upright axis. Outer Edge The wall shape is inserted at the outer edge of the upright and shows to the outside.
Enter the radius of cage stiffeners. Specify how many longitudinal rungs the cage has to consist of. The bars will be divided regularly on the resulting semicircle.
Page E.6 - 5
Lower Radius
Lower Distance Specify the distance of the lowest shackle to the next shackle. If you dont want to have a conical cage, you can keep the value 0 in this field and in the lower radius field. Depth etc. Please refer to the below figure for the meaning of the other distances.
Distance to Floor Distance from the floor to the first shackle. Distance The desired distance of the stiffeners (rings) of the safety cage. The program divides the distances between the first and last ring regularly according to this specification and the values are rounded up or down correspondingly. The distance from the top to the first shackle
Top Distance
Page E.6 - 6
Lateral Climbing Out You can provide a lateral climbing out for an existing safety cage. Position The lateral climbing out has to lead to the left, to the right or to both sides.
Upper Distance The distance of the lateral climbing out to the upper upright of the ladder. Lower Distance The distance of the lateral climbing out to the upper edge of the safety cage. Extended Distance The offset of the lateral climbing out in climbing out direction beyond the dimensions of the safety cage.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page E.6 - 7
Page E.6 - 8
E.7
This function serves for creation of a joist as it is often used in the USA. This joist is a pre-fabricated element in lightweight construction that is offered in different executions and lengths.
Dimensions
the length of the joist the height of the joist the distance of shapes in transverse direction
Calculate Spacing The inner distance is calculated for the vertical and diagonal components based on the selected shapes. Roof Angle Continuous... Seat Height Seat Length Lower Retreat The joist is built as a saddle roof. The joist is built as desk roof. defines the height of the lateral seats. Here, you can define the length of the seats for both sides separately. Here, you can indicate the lower retreat referring to the upper length for both sides separately.
Upper Shape Offset Here, you can indicate the upper shape offset above the selected length for both sides separately.
Page E.6 - 1
Lower Shape Offset Here, you can indicate the lower shape offset for both sides separately. Dynamic 2D Display The joist rebuilds the shapes immediately after modifications. The joist is depicted as 2D-display. No 3D-shapes are created or displayed. The display depends on the view direction.
Layout
Layout
Here, you can select the kind of layout you want to have. 5 different types are available for selection: Symmetrical The layout consists of upper and lower girder as well as of vertical and diagonal shapes. Single Lacing The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists as well as of single bent intermediate beams. Double Lacing - The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists as well as of double bent intermediate beams. Tension Rods Type1 - The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists as well as of tension rods. Tension Rods Type2 - The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists as well as of tension rods.
Segment Count Here, you specify the number of individual segments. At option 1, this number has to be divisible by 2, at option 2 and 3, not to be divisible by 2. At the remaining options, you can enter any number. Segment Distance The distance from one segment to the other
Page E.7 - 2
The distance from the outside to the first minimum. The distance from the last minimum to the last maximum. The distance from the next to last maximum to the next to last minimum. The distance from the next to last minimum to the inner maximum. The distance of the inner segments.
Rounding Radius This indicates the rounding radius at the two lacing types.
Shapes
Here, you select for which rod area the corresponding settings have to be valid. Here, you select which shape type is to be used. Depending on the offset you selected only certain shape types are available. Here, you select which shape class is to be used. Depending on the offset you selected only certain shape classes are available. Here, you select the desired shape size.
Shape Class
Shape Size
Page E.6 - 3
Layout
Here, you select which layout you want to have. Since normally the inner structure of the joist is not interesting, you can switch off this function. If you want to have it displayed nevertheless, but you dont want to have displayed the individual objects, you can set the layout to Simple. In this mode, the shapes are displayed as part of the structural element. If you want to have displayed all details and you want to change some shapes, you can select Complete View. The settings dont have any influence on the display of the seats.
Top Seats
Here, you specify the display and the design of the top seats. You can choose between shapes, plates and seat sockets which can be determined by means of parameters. Due to the great number of different designs, it is, however, possible as well to select the top seat as individual user block and to have designed it here. Layout Seat Length Seat Width Seat Thick Insert Holes Select the design of the top seat here. Indicates the length of the shape, plate or socket. Indicates the width of the metal sheet or socket. Indicates the thickness of the metal sheet or socket Select this option if you want to insert a hole field into the seat.
At Length Direction Indicates the design of the hole field at length direction.
Page E.7 - 4
Indicates the hole diameter. Indicates the additional value to the hole diameter. Indicates the distance of the insertion point of the hole from the corresponding definition or endpoint.
Down Seat
Here, you specify the display and the design of the down seats. For more detailed information, please refer to the description of top seats.
Page E.6 - 5
User-defined Blocks
You can design both seats and top and bottom chords as user-defined blocks. In this case, no top or bottom chord shapes are generated, but your individual blocks are inserted and resolved at the insertion position.
Upper Chords as Blocks You activate the insertion of upper chords as userdefined blocks. Connect Shapes If this option has been activated, the corresponding shapes if existing are connected with each other. Left/Right Here, you select the blocks for left and right side separately.
The same options are available for the selection of user-defined blocks for the lower chord.
Page E.7 - 6
Seat Blocks
If you have selected the top and down seats as blocks, you can select the corresponding blocks here.
Page E.6 - 7
Data
Here, you enter the general parts list data of the joist. They will be displayed in the parts list.
Name Item No. Note1,2 Pos No. Weight Line Type In Partlist
joist name the item number of the joist the two note fields for comments. the position number of the joist. the weight of the joist. line type of the system lines. the joist is taken over into the parts list.
Page E.7 - 8
Database
When a valid database has been entered in the options, you can choose a previously defined joist from the available values.
Options
Allow Shapes in Partlist If this option is activated, the corresponding partlist flag is set at inserted shapes.
Page E.6 - 9
Allow Shapes in DetailCenter If this option is activated, the corresponding detailing flag is set at inserted shapes. Display Shapes in Overviews If this option is activated, the inserted shapes are displayed in 2D-overviews. Block path Database Indicates the path where the available user-defined blocks have been stored. Indicates the database which serves for the selection of previously defined values.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the component part and then select the settings.
Page E.7 - 10
E.8
It frequently occurs that the properties of existing component parts have to be modified. There are several different ways to select the properties function. There ProSteel puts in a context sensitive way all available parameters at disposal for modification. The most frequent way of selection is to highlight the part(s) and then to open the context menu by means of the right mouse button. There, you find the option ProSteel properties. Another possibility is to use the function PS_PROP_CHECK. In addition, the COM-module Double-Click is available as well. You can call the PS-properties by double-clicking the parts. No matter which way you choose, ProSteel analyses which parts were selected and only provides the properties valid for these parts for modification. Make sure that the desired type of component part has been selected first if you want to modify several parts simultaneously. This means, if you want to modify all plates of a model, you have to make sure that the first selected object is a plate. All other selected elements are filtered accordingly. In this case, you can e.g. select a plate and then the complete model, and then all component parts that are not plates are automatically filtered out. The dialog windows can be divided into three different categories. 1. - Dialogs being specific for a component part type. 2. - Dialogs offering processing actions. 3. - Dialogs being generally valid for all component parts. The first group depends on the selected type. The second group is not displayed if several parts have been selected and depends on the processing actions included. The third group is generally displayed for all elements.
Page E.7 - 1
E.8.1 Shapes
Layout
On this dialog tab, you can modify the display of shapes individually. At insertion, the shapes obtain the settings that were made and can be overwritten individually.
Layout Holes
Here, you specify how the shape has to be depicted. Here, you specify the depiction of drill holes.
Only Outer Cont. Only the first outer contour is displayed. At tubes, e.g., the inner cylinder will not be displayed. Modeller The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be used, you cannot switch it off. The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but more precise than the facet-modeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACISand facet-modeller volume models.
Acis
A calculated 2D-depiction depending on the current view direction is displayed instead of standard 3D-depiction. The centerline of the shape is displayed.
Page E.8 - 2
The gravity line is displayed. If crack lines have been defined for this shape, they are displayed. The name of the component part is displayed dynamically at the part. The position depends on the angle of vision. The settings are made in the global settings. If a short position has been filed in the database; it will be used instead of the complete name. The Entity Coordinate System is displayed. It mainly serves for verifying purposes. The part is displayed transparent at shading.
Direction marker If the component part has got a benchmark during detailing, this will be displayed. 2D-Section Automatic 2D cut information is displayed.
Page E.7 - 3
Shape Type
Here, you can modify the shape type of one or several shapes.
Select the type of the shape. Select the desired resolution of the shape. Select the class or library of the shape. Select the size of the shape. The data base information about this shape is displayed.
Treat As Singl If you have selected a combi shape or a weld shape, you can specify whether the individual components have to be treated as single parts. The same is valid if the shape has not yet been exploded.
Page E.8 - 4
Positions
Use this dialog tab to specify the insertion or reference axis. You can select the desired points in the preview.
Select Line
Here, you specify whether the insertion point or the reference axis has to be set. As long as a reference axis doesnt exist, this option cannot be accessed. X value of insertion Y value of insertion Input value for rotation The shape is rotated around the current insertion axis by the input value. The shape is rotated around the current insertion axis by the input value. The shape is rotated around the current insertion axis by +90 degrees. The shape is rotated around the current insertion axis by -90 degrees.
Page E.7 - 5
The insertion points are rotated and thus mirrored at the Yaxis.
Data
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
The name of the shape for parts list and output. The material of the shape for parts list and output. The blank note 1 field. The blank note 2 field The position number of the shape
Page E.8 - 6
Shipping number can be used alternatively or additionally to the position number Fixed stored position number Item number of the part The number of parts for this element. Normally this is always 1. This is the number of parts of this position number in the model. This value is only correct after positioning. It is displayed whether this shape has been modified since last detailing. After scanning the parts with the DetailCenter, this field is automatically deleted and the modification information is managed in the DetailCenter. The shape is adopted into the parts list. The shape is not displayed in the DetailCenter.
Adopt No Detail.
Values
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Shape length; if this value is modified, the length is modified from the shape end. The width of the shape The height of the shape
Page E.7 - 7
The weight of the shape The weight is calculated via the volume modeler and not on the base of the length and the weight in meters. Length addition to the calculated length The number of parts for this element. Normally this is always 1. This is the number of parts of this position number in the model. This value is only correct after counting.
Page E.8 - 8
Conical
Depending on the selected shape, this dialog tab can look different. This is the dialog tab of a standard shape.
Change in height in mm per meter length The diagonal dividing cut is displayed.
For weld shapes, the slope can also be defined via the climb. It is, however, also possible to indicate starting and end height. In addition, some tools are available to manipulate the cross-section or to realize a cross-section that changes several times.
Page E.7 - 9
Change in height in mm per meter length Height at the beginning of the shape; only available if no other manipulation was made. Height at the end of the shape, only available if no other manipulation was made. Use this button to define the height of a weld shape at any point or along a line. If necessary, a new polygon point will be created. The side situated next to the picked point will be modified. Then, another dialog opens where you can indicate the height. The height up to then is displayed, and you can enter the desired new height. A new edge is inserted into the web plate at the picked point. The height remains unchanged. The edge situated next is deleted from the web plate.
This button permits modifying the edges of the web plate using the grips. All other grips of this shape are deactivated at that moment. This button permits the management of the projections of upper and bottom flange at the starting and end point. The following dialog appears.
Page E.8 - 10
Bottom Fl. Start The projection of the bottom flange at the starting point of the shape is indicated. Bottom Fl. End Top Flange.Start The projection of the bottom flange at the end point of the shape is indicated. The projection of the upper flange at the starting point of the shape is indicated.
Top Flange. End The projection of the upper flange at the end point of the shape is indicated. This button permits the management of the flange thickness table. Using this table, you can assign different widths and thicknesses to individual segments of the shape. The following dialog appears:
Page E.7 - 11
This button permits to click on a flange edge to add it to the table. The preset values are taken over first, which however, can be directly modified in the table. The current table entry is deleted using this button. The thickness is reset.
Upper and bottom flange are considered separately. The indication of the flange refers to the number of flanges from the starting point per side. It is recommended to edit the thicknesses after having determined the bend points. A modification of the form by insertion or deletion of points modifies the table as well because the number of flanges is modified.
Page E.8 - 12
Static View
If the static view has been activated in the global settings, the static values are displayed in the dialog. For a more detailed description of the options please refer to the chapter Static View.
Bend
If the selected shape is an arc shape, this dialog tab is additionally displayed.
The radius of the arc shape up to the center line The angle between the x-axis of the ECS and the starting point of the shape in degree The angle between the x-axis of the ECS and the end point of the shape in degree. Rotation around the insertion axis in degree
Page E.7 - 13
Shortening
If the shape is displayed in 2D-mode, additional shortenings may have been inserted into the shape. You can see these shortenings on this dialog tab.
Page E.8 - 14
E.8.2 Plates
Layout
Use this dialog tab to modify the depiction of plates individually. At insertion, the plates obtain the settings that were made and thus can be overwritten individually.
Here, you specify how the plate has to be depicted. Here, you specify the depiction of drill holes. The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be used, you cannot switch it off. The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but exacter than the facetmodeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACIS- and facet-modeler volume models. A calculated 2D-depiction depending on the current view direction is displayed instead of standard 3D-depiction. The centerline of the plate is displayed The name of the component part is displayed dynamically at the part. The position depends on the angle of vision. The settings are made in the global settings.
Acis
Page E.7 - 15
If a short position has been filed in the database; it will be used instead of the complete name. The Entity Coordinate System is displayed. It mainly serves for verifying purposes. The part is displayed transparent at shading. A plate grid is displayed on the upper side of the plate. This grid represents a gridiron or similar things.
Position
Use this dialog tab to specify the plate position related to the insertion point and to the insertion plane. Length Width Thickness Height Offset Plate length; only available if the plate is in rectangular mode. Plate width; only available if the plate is in rectangular mode. Plate thickness Position of the insertion plane above the ECS plane
The edge at which the plate is inserted related to the ECSplane. x-offset related to the insertion point. y-offset related to the insertion point. The rectangular basic form of the plate is kept, and you cannot change it into another form using the grips. If this option is deactivated, you cannot reset it.
Symbol Direction Size Specifies the size of the symbol direction on plate grids.
Page E.8 - 16
Data
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Name Name Material Note1 Note2 Pos No Ship.No. Orig. Pos No Item
The name of the plate for parts list and output. The final name built according to the settings with dimensions. The material of the plate for parts list and output. The blank note 1 field The blank note 2 field The position number of the plate Shipping number; can be used alternatively or additionally to the position number Fixed position number Item number of the plate
Page E.7 - 17
It is displayed whether this plate has been modified since last detailing. The plate is adopted into the parts list. The plate is not displayed in the DetailCenter.
Man. Alignment The dimensions of the plate are determined according to a selected direction. Man. Surface The direction of the surface symbol was determined manually.
Values
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
The length of the plate The width of the plate The thickness of the plate the weight of the plate The weight is calculated via the volume modeler and not on the base of the dimensions. The number of parts for this element. Normally this is always 1. This is the number of parts of this position number in the model. This value is only correct after positioning.
Page E.8 - 18
Fixed Form
The plate can only be modified by means of manipulations such as cuts or Boolean operations.
Page E.7 - 19
E.8.3 Bolts
Layout
Use this dialog tab to modify the depiction of bolts individually. At insertion, the bolts obtain the settings that were made and the selected bolt style; thus they can be overwritten individually.
Here, you specify how the bolt has to be depicted. Here, you specify the coating. The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be used, you cannot switch it off. The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but exacter than the facetmodeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACIS- and facet-modeler volume models. The bolt is displayed in a calculated 2D-depiction.
Acis
2D Bolt
Page E.8 - 20
Mounting Space The assembly room is displayed as well. It mainly serves for verifying whether an assembly is possible. Individually specifies whether the mounting space has to be read out of the bolt style. 2D Transparency Countersunk The bolt is depicted as 2D-symbol. The part is displayed transparent at shading. The bolt is displayed as countersunk bolt.
Hexagon Socket The bolt is executed as hexagon socket. Mounting Bolt Bolt Washer Nut Lock Nut The bolt is checked as assembly bolt, in contrast to workshop bolts. This has an influence on the assembly parts list. The bolt is depicted. The lower washer is depicted. The nut is depicted The safety nut is depicted
Tapered Washer The tapered washers are activated, but not displayed. They serve as basis for the parts list entries. You can choose between U- and I-form washers. 2 2
nd nd
Washer Tapered
The second washer is depicted. The second tapered washer is depicted. The insertion direction of the bolt is turned.
Page E.7 - 21
Data
Name Material Style Note1 Note2 Pos No Ship.No. Item Number Total
The name of the bolt for parts list and output. The material of the bolt for parts list and output. The assigned bolt style The blank note 1 field The blank note 2 field The position number of the bolt Shipping number; can be used alternatively or additionally to the position number The item number of the shape The number of bolts for this element. Normally this is always 1. This is the number of parts of this position number in the model. This value is only correct after positioning.
Page E.8 - 22
Values
Length Dia Grip Length Weight Addition Modified Adopt Bolt Washer Nut Safety Nut
Bolt length Bolt diameter The calculated clamping length of the bolt The weight of the bolt Length addition to the bolt It is displayed whether this bolt has been modified since last detailing. The bolt is adopted into the parts list. The bolt is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired. The washer is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired. The nut is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired. The safety nut is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired.
Tapered Washer The tapered washer is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired.
Page E.7 - 23
2 2
Washer Tapered
The second washer is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired. The second tapered washer is listed in the parts list as single data record, if desired. The pre-tension of the bolt in percent.
nd
Pre-Tension
Page E.8 - 24
Layout
Please refer to the section about the shapes for the individual descriptions of these setting options.
Data
The parts list data of these component parts are identical with the parts described until now. Please refer to the above chapters for the description of the different fields.
Page E.7 - 25
Values
The parts list values of these component parts are identical with the parts described until now. Please refer to the above chapters for the description of the different fields.
Page E.8 - 26
In Bolt List
The special part at parts list output has to be adopted into the bolt list. You can differ between mounting bolt and workshop bolt. The special part has to generate a Z-entry at PPS-data generation.
PPS Z-Part
Page E.7 - 27
E.8.6 Assemblies
Assemblies are separate objects in ProSteel. They serve for extending the group structures. In contrast to groups and subgroups, they are not connected with a main part and carry their group information themselves. The data are managed as follows.
Kind of depiction of an assembly object; this may be no depiction, UCS-symbol, sphere or wrapping box. Indicates the size of the assembly symbol in the current drawing. Indicates whether the assembly object is switched over to 2Dmode or not. This controls the depiction of the whole assembly structure in the drawing.
Page E.8 - 28
ProSteel Properties Dialogs All other properties are subdivided into the tabs data and values as it is the case with all other component parts.
Page E.7 - 29
E.8.9 Roof/Wall-Objects
Please refer to the corresponding chapter of this manual where the modification of roof/wall-objects is described.
E.8.10
The properties of label objects such as position flags, elevations, weld marks, manual dimensioning objects and benchmark can also be set specifically for each component part.
E.8.11
Please refer to the corresponding chapters of this manual where the setting of a drawing parts list and of a drawing containment list is described.
Page E.8 - 30
E.8.12
3D Modifications
The processing actions included in the ProSteel-elements can mostly be modified or deleted on the property pages described in the following. Please refer to the following chapters to find out how it works.
Page E.7 - 31
Boolean Operations
Use this dialog tab to modify or delete the Boolean operations included in the part.
Indicates the length of the discharge-solid. Indicates the width of the discharge-solid. Indicates the height of the discharge-solid. Indicates the kind of Boolean operation an. Indicates the type of the discharge-solid. Indicates the modeller-type of the discharge-solid. It is important here to keep the modeller on Variable to be able to switch over the modeling of the complete component part correctly. Click on this button to create the discharge-solid as new element. Click on this button to remove the Boolean operation or all processings.
Page E.8 - 32
Facet
Use this option to edit the chamfers included in the part. The dialog tab is analogous to the Plate Editor. Please refer to this chapter for the description of the different processing parameters.
Page E.7 - 33
E.8.13
Flat Cuts
Use this dialog tab to process and delete flat cuts (diagonal cuts) included in the component part.
Phi Dx Phi Dy
Indicates the rotation angle around the x-axis Indicates the rotation angle around the y-axis
Center of Rota Indicates the rotation point Click on this button to delete the cut or all cuts.
Page E.8 - 34
E.8.14
Poly-Cuts
On this dialog tab, all poly-cuts included in the part will be displayed.
Length Offset
Modify the length of the poly-cut using this button. Modify the offset of the poly-cut using this button. Click on this button to delete the poly-cut or all poly-cuts.
Page E.7 - 35
E.8.15
Edge Processing
Here, you can modify the edge properties of plates. Please refer to the corresponding chapter in this manual for the settings.
Click on this button to delete the processing of an edge or all processings of an edge.
Page E.8 - 36
E.8.16
Notches (Outlets)
Use this dialog tab to modify the properties of the currently selected notch.
Indicates the length of the notch. Indicates the width of the notch. Indicates the height of the notch.
Insertion Position Indicates the insertion position of the notch. Click on this button to delete the notch or all notches.
Page E.7 - 37
E.8.17
Common Properties
In this section, you will find a description of the general parts properties. The properties described here are not always completely available, but are only displayed if required.
Group
On this dialog tab the data of the group/subgroup/assembly are listed to which the component part in question belongs.
Page E.8 - 38
Use these two buttons to switch through the group hierarchy of the selected component part.
Page E.7 - 39
Logical Links
On this dialog tab, the logical links of the part are listed.
Indicates whether the link is activated. You may also deactivate the link here. Internal code of the link The action is described by which the link has been created. Indicates the modifications of the part caused by this link. Is a name which is used to make this connection visible in the DetailCenter later. This entry can be written by automatic positioning. Is a designation which is used to make this connection visible in the DetailCenter later. This entry can be written by automatic positioning. The entries Ident and Name only exist when the option Logical Links/Extended Input has been activated in the global settings.
Ident
Page E.8 - 40
Use this button to delete the link or all links directly. Click on this button to edit the static connection data of the connection. This entry only exists when the option Logical Links/Extended Input has been activated in the global settings.
Page E.7 - 41
Assignments
Use this dialog tab to make the assignments to the drawing object. These assignments may differ from one part to the other. They are however described in the corresponding chapters.
Here, you can assign a detailing style to the part. Here, you can assign a display class to the part. Here, you can assign the part to an area class that you created before. Here, you can assign the part to a part family (e. g. support or girder). Here, you can see the current process-status of the component part.
Page E.8 - 42
E.9
Here, you will find a short survey how you can call the ProSteel functions documented in the manual using AutoCAD. Function 2D 2D-Cut Out 3D 3D-Modifications A Add 3D-Volume Add Shape Segment Area Classes Automatic 2D-Cut B Benchmark Bend Edged Plates BlockCenter Bolts Bracings Bracings, dynamic Butt-Joint Connection C Calculate Center of Gravity Chamfer Plate Edge Clean AutoCAD-Drawing Clean AutoCAD-Drawing (Batch) Collision Check Connection-Editor Construction Lines D.5.2 B.12.2 D.5.6 D.5.6 D.5.1 B.26 B.2.1 PS_WEIGHTCENTER PS_CHAMFER PS_CLEAN_PROXY PS_BATCH_CLEAN_DWG PS_COLLISION PS_EDIT_CONNECTIONS PS_CONST C.6 B.9.4 D.2 B.14 B.24 B.23 B.20 PS_BENCHMARK PS_PLATE PS_BLOCKCENTER PS_BOLT PS_VERBAND PS_BRACING PS_LASCHE B.11.7 B.8.5 B.5.4 C.18 PS_ADD PS_ADD_SECTION PS_AREA_CLASS PS_ADD_2DCUT B.11 PS_MODIFY C.16 PS_CUT_OUT Chapter Command Name
Page E.7 - 1
ProSteel Command Reference Containlist Convert ADT-Shapes Cranked 2D-Cut Create ACIS-Solid Create ACIS-Solid (Batch) Create 3D-Cone Create 3D-Conic Pipe Create 3D-Cross-section transition Create 3D-Cuboid Create 3D-Cylinder Create 3D-Extrusion Solid Create 3D-Rotation Solid Create 3D-Solid Create 3D-Sphere Create 3D-Torus Cut Plane D Data Export Data Import DetailCenter Dimensioning Points Dispatch Bolts and Blocks Display Pickhelpers Display Program Version Drawing Information Drawing Frame Drawing Partslist Drill and Bolt DSTV NC-Interface DSTV PPS-Interface D.7.5 D.7.4 C.1 C.7 D.4 C.1.6 A.1.2 B.29 C.10 B.31 B.13 D.7.8 D.7.8 PS_EXPORT PS_IMPORT PS_DETCENTER PS_INSERT_MANDIM PS_DISPATCH PS_PICKHELPER PS_VERSION PS_DWG_INFO PS_FORMAT PS_DWG_PARTLIST PS_DRILL PS_NC_DATA PS_PPS B.32 D.5.7 C.5 D.5.5 D.5.5 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.10 B.3.6 PS_DWG_CONTAINLIST PS_CONVERT_ADTSHAPES PS_CRANKEDVIEW PS_CREATE_ACIS PS_BATCH_CREATE_ACIS PS_SOLID_CONE PS_SOLID_CONICPIPE PS_SOLID_RECT2CIRCLE PS_SOLID_BOX PS_SOLID_CYLINDER PS_SOLID_EXTRUDE PS_SOLID_ROTATE PS_SOLID_HULL PS_SOLID_SPHERE PS_SOLID_TORUS PS_CUTPLANE
Page E.7 - 2
ProSteel Command Reference DSTV Static-Interface E Edit Exchange Map Elevations Endplates F Face UCS Face View Family Classes Flatten Viewport Free View G Global Settings Global Scale Global View Groundplates Groups Gusset Plates H Hatches Hide Hide Exclude Hide Exclude Plane Hide Group Exclude Hide Group Hide Plane Hole Display I Insert Gratings Insert Plates B.9.3 B.9 PS_PLATE PS_PLATE B.25 B.5.1 B.5.1 B.5.1 B.5.1 B.5.1 B.5.1 C.17 PS_VOUTE PS_HIDE PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE_PLANE PS_HIDE_GROUP_EXCLUDE PS_HIDE_GROUP PS_HIDE_PLANE PS_HOLE_DISPLAY_STYLE A.6 C.9 B.3.3 B.17 B.27 B.22 PS_GLOBAL_SETTINGS PS_SCALE PS_GLOBAL_VIEW PS_GROUNDPL PS_GROUP PS_GUSSET_PLATE B.3.2 B.3.2 B.5.5 C.19 B.3.5 PS_FACE_UCS PS_FACE_VIEW PS_FAMILY_CLASS PS_VIEWPORT_FLATTEN PS_FREEVIEW D.7.2 C.13 B.16 PS_EXCHANGE_MAP PS_KOTE PS_ENDPLATE D.7.8 PS_STATIK
Page E.7 - 3
ProSteel Command Reference Insert Shapes Intersection 3D-Volume L Language Selection Layer Functions M Manual 2D-Cut Manual 2D-Shortening Manual Dependency of Part Manual Dimensioning Measure Distance Move and Copy Parts N Notch O Object View Object-UCS Outlet P Perspective View Plate Editor Positioning Process Partlist Project Management Process Status Purlin Connection R Regenerate Roof and Wall Covering Rounding off Plate Edge B.5.2 D.3 B.12.2 PS_REGEN PS_ROWADISPATCH PS_BEND_EDGE B.3.7 B.12 B.28 B.30.2 A.5 B.5.6 B.21 PS_PERSP PS_PLATE_EDITOR PS_POS PS_CREATE_PARTLIST PS_PROJECT PS_PROCESS_STATUS PS_PURLIN_CONN B.3.1 B.3.1 B.11.1 PS_OBJ_VIEW PS_OBJ_UCS PS_OUTLET B.11.6 PS_NOTCH C.11 C.15 C.8 C.12 B.2.2 B.4 PS_MAN_CUT PS_SHORT2D PS_MANUAL_LINK PS_DIM PS_CONST_MSE PS_COPY A.2 B.1 PS_LANGUAGE PS_LAYER B.8 B.11.7 PS_INS_PROF PS_COMMEN
Page E.7 - 4
S Search Parts Seize Partslist Shear Plates Simulate Movement Special Parts Special Shapes Static Effective Lines Stiffeners Structural Element Joist Structural Element Truss Girder Structural Element Handrail Structural Element Hangar Frame Structural Element Purlin Position Structural Element Ladder Structural Element Stairs Subtract 3D-Volume Subtract Intersection 3D-Volume T Top View Tubes Unwind V Visibility Classes B.5.3 PS_HIDE_CLASS B.3.4 D.5.3 PS_TOPVIEW PS_UNWIND B.5.7 B.30.1 B.19 D.5.4 D.1.1 D.1.2 D.6 B.15 E.7 E.4 E.2 E.3 E.5 E.6 E.1 B.11.7 B.11.7 PS_SEARCH PS_PARTLIST PS_SCHEARPLATE PS_KINEMATIK PS_CREATE_SPEZPART PS_CREATE_SOPRO PS_ANALYSIS PS_RIP PS_JOIST PS_TRUSS PS_HANDRAIL PS_FRAME PS_PFETTE PS_LADDER PS_STAIRS PS_SUB PS_COMMEN_SUB
Page E.7 - 5
W Webangle Weldmarks Workframe Views Workframes B.18 C.14 B.7 B.6 PS_STEGW PS_WELD PS_SETBKS PS_WORKFRAME
Page E.7 - 6
Own Notes
Page E.10 - 1
Own Notes
Page E.10 - 2